AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON SEPTEMBER 2, 1997
    
 
                                                 REGISTRATION NO. 333-31535
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
 
                              -------------------
 
   
                                AMENDMENT NO. 1
                                       TO
    
 
                                    FORM S-1
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
 
                    THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
             (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
   
                                                                          
               DELAWARE                                  5641                                 31-1241495
   (State or other jurisdiction of           (Primary standard industrial          (I.R.S. employer identification
    incorporation or organization)           classification code number)                       number)
THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. ONE DODGE DRIVE WEST CALDWELL, NEW JERSEY 07006 (973) 227-8900 (Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices) STEVEN BALASIANO, ESQ. VICE PRESIDENT AND GENERAL COUNSEL THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. ONE DODGE DRIVE WEST CALDWELL, NEW JERSEY 07006 (973) 227-8900 (Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service) COPIES OF COMMUNICATIONS TO: STROOCK & STROOCK & LAVAN LLP HALE AND DORR LLP 180 MAIDEN LANE 60 STATE STREET NEW YORK, NEW YORK 10038 BOSTON, MASSACHUSETTS 02109 ATTN.: JEFFREY S. LOWENTHAL, ESQ. ATTN.: PATRICK J. RONDEAU, ESQ. (212) 806-5400 (617) 526-6000
APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO PUBLIC: As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective. If any of the securities being registered on this form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box. / / If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. / / If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. / / If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434, please check the following box. / / CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
PROPOSED MAXIMUM PROPOSED MAXIMUM TITLE OF EACH CLASS OF AMOUNT TO OFFERING PRICE AGGREGATE AMOUNT OF SECURITIES TO BE REGISTERED BE REGISTERED PER SHARE (1) OFFERING PRICE (1) REGISTRATION FEE 4,600,000 Common Stock, $.10 par value........ shares(2) $15.00 $69,000,000 $20,909(3)
(1) Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee in accordance with Rule 457 under the Securities Act of 1933. (2) Includes 600,000 shares of Common Stock subject to an over-allotment option granted to the Underwriters. (3) Previously paid. ------------------------ THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR UNTIL THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID SECTION 8(A), MAY DETERMINE. - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -------------------------------------------------------------------------------- INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT BECOMES EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION OR SALE WOULD BE UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY SUCH STATE. SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED SEPTEMBER 2, 1997 4,000,000 SHARES [LOGO] COMMON STOCK ALL OF THE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK OFFERED HEREBY ARE BEING SOLD BY THE COMPANY. PRIOR TO THIS OFFERING, THERE HAS BEEN NO PUBLIC MARKET FOR THE COMMON STOCK OF THE COMPANY. IT IS CURRENTLY ESTIMATED THAT THE INITIAL PUBLIC OFFERING PRICE WILL BE BETWEEN $13.00 AND $15.00 PER SHARE. SEE "UNDERWRITING" FOR A DISCUSSION OF FACTORS TO BE CONSIDERED IN DETERMINING THE INITIAL PUBLIC OFFERING PRICE. THE COMMON STOCK HAS BEEN APPROVED FOR LISTING ON THE NASDAQ NATIONAL MARKET UNDER THE SYMBOL "PLCE." SEE "RISK FACTORS" BEGINNING ON PAGE 8 FOR A DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN FACTORS THAT SHOULD BE CONSIDERED BY PROSPECTIVE PURCHASERS OF THE COMMON STOCK OFFERED HEREBY. ----------------- THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE. PRICE TO UNDERWRITING PROCEEDS TO PUBLIC DISCOUNT(1) COMPANY(2) PER SHARE............. $ $ $ TOTAL (3)............. $ $ $
(1) SEE "UNDERWRITING" FOR INFORMATION CONCERNING INDEMNIFICATION OF THE UNDERWRITERS AND OTHER MATTERS. (2) BEFORE DEDUCTING OFFERING EXPENSES PAYABLE BY THE COMPANY, ESTIMATED AT $ . (3) CERTAIN STOCKHOLDERS OF THE COMPANY HAVE GRANTED TO THE UNDERWRITERS A 30-DAY OPTION TO PURCHASE UP TO 600,000 ADDITIONAL SHARES OF COMMON STOCK SOLELY TO COVER OVER-ALLOTMENTS, IF ANY. IF THE UNDERWRITERS EXERCISE THIS OPTION IN FULL, THE TOTAL PROCEEDS TO THE COMPANY WILL REMAIN UNCHANGED, AND THE TOTAL PRICE TO PUBLIC, UNDERWRITING DISCOUNT AND PROCEEDS TO THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS WILL BE $ , $ AND $ , RESPECTIVELY. SEE "UNDERWRITING." THE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK ARE OFFERED BY THE SEVERAL UNDERWRITERS NAMED HEREIN, WHEN, AS AND IF DELIVERED TO AND ACCEPTED BY THE UNDERWRITERS AND SUBJECT TO THEIR RIGHT TO REJECT ANY ORDERS IN WHOLE OR IN PART. IT IS EXPECTED THAT DELIVERY OF THE CERTIFICATES REPRESENTING SUCH SHARES WILL BE MADE AGAINST PAYMENT THEREFOR AT THE OFFICE OF MONTGOMERY SECURITIES ON OR ABOUT , 1997. ------------------- MONTGOMERY SECURITIES DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE SECURITIES CORPORATION SMITH BARNEY INC. LEGG MASON WOOD WALKER INCORPORATED , 1997 [The Inside Front Cover Page of the Prospectus consists of a gatefold that shows three photographs of a Company store, along with a large version of the Company's logo. On the inside of the gatefold are numerous photographs of children wearing the Company's apparel and accessories, interspersed with small versions of the Company's logo.] CERTAIN PERSONS PARTICIPATING IN THIS OFFERING MAY ENGAGE IN TRANSACTIONS THAT STABILIZE, MAINTAIN, OR OTHERWISE AFFECT THE PRICE OF THE COMMON STOCK. SUCH TRANSACTIONS MAY INCLUDE STABILIZING TRANSACTIONS AND THE PURCHASE OF COMMON STOCK TO COVER SYNDICATE SHORT POSITIONS. FOR A DESCRIPTION OF THESE ACTIVITIES, SEE "UNDERWRITING." 2 PROSPECTUS SUMMARY THE FOLLOWING SUMMARY IS QUALIFIED IN ITS ENTIRETY BY THE MORE DETAILED INFORMATION AND FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, INCLUDING THE NOTES THERETO, CONTAINED ELSEWHERE IN THIS PROSPECTUS. EXCEPT AS OTHERWISE INDICATED, ALL INFORMATION IN THIS PROSPECTUS GIVES EFFECT TO A 120-FOR-ONE STOCK SPLIT OF THE COMMON STOCK (THE "STOCK SPLIT") AND THE CONVERSION OF ALL OUTSTANDING SHARES OF THE COMPANY'S SERIES B COMMON STOCK INTO A TOTAL OF 7,659,889 SHARES OF COMMON STOCK (THE "SERIES B CONVERSION"), BOTH OF WHICH WILL BE EFFECTED PRIOR TO CONSUMMATION OF THE OFFERING MADE BY THIS PROSPECTUS. ALL REFERENCES TO THE COMPANY'S FISCAL YEARS REFER TO THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED ON THE SATURDAY NEAREST TO JANUARY 31 OF THE FOLLOWING YEAR. FOR EXAMPLE, REFERENCES TO FISCAL 1996 SHALL MEAN THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 1, 1997. THE COMPANY The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Company") is a leading specialty retailer of high quality, value-priced apparel and accessories for newborn to twelve year old children. The Company designs, contracts to manufacture and sells its products under "The Children's Place" brand name. As of September 1, 1997, the Company operated 140 stores, primarily located in regional shopping malls in the eastern half of the United States. The Company's net sales have increased from $96.6 million in fiscal 1993 to $143.8 million in fiscal 1996 and operating income has increased from $1.4 million in fiscal 1993 to $12.8 million in fiscal 1996. In the first six months of fiscal 1997, net sales totaled $72.7 million as compared to $56.4 million in the first six months of fiscal 1996. The Company has achieved comparable store sales increases over prior years of 13.2%, 10.0% and 8.6% during fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, and 2.5% in the first six months of fiscal 1997. Net sales per gross square foot have increased from $226 in fiscal 1993 to $335 in fiscal 1996. These increases are primarily the result of a merchandising and operational repositioning of the Company over the last five fiscal years under the direction of the Company's current management team. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business." In fiscal 1996, new stores for which fiscal 1996 was the first full year of operations had average net sales of $1,250,000. The average investment for these new stores, including capital expenditures (net of landlord contribution), initial inventory (net of merchandise payables) and pre-opening costs, was $371,000. New stores have generally achieved profitability within the first full quarter of operations, with average fiscal 1996 store level operating cash flow of $288,000 (23.0% of net sales) for stores for which fiscal 1996 was the first full year of operations. In fiscal 1996, these stores yielded a cash return on investment of 77.6%. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." In July 1996, following a private financing in which the Company raised $37.4 million of net proceeds through the issuance of senior subordinated notes, Series B Common Stock and warrants, the Company began to implement an aggressive growth strategy designed to capitalize on its business strengths and its strong store economics. From July 1, 1996 through the end of fiscal 1996, the Company opened a total of 16 new stores, growing to 108 stores. During fiscal 1997 through September 1, 1997, the Company has opened 32 stores. The Company intends to continue its expansion program and currently plans to open approximately 15 additional stores during the remainder of fiscal 1997 and at least 60 stores in fiscal 1998. See "Business--Store Expansion Program" and "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--1996 Private Placement." 3 BUSINESS STRENGTHS AND STRATEGY The Company believes that its value-based, proprietary brand business strategy has been and will continue to be the key to its success as a specialty retailer. The following strengths have contributed to the success of the Company's merchandising and operating strategies: UNIQUE PRICE-VALUE POSITIONING. By offering quality clothing and accessories under "The Children's Place" brand name at prices 20% to 30% below most of its direct mall-based competitors, the Company believes that it has built a loyal base of customers who regularly purchase from the Company as their children grow. The Company believes that the value created by the price and quality of its merchandise has enabled it to establish a unique market position. See "Business--Merchandising" and "--Sourcing and Procurement." MERCHANDISING STRATEGY. The Company's merchandising strategy is built on the offering of key basic items at prices which the Company believes represent exceptional values, complemented by fashion items and accessories to create a fully coordinated look. The Company designs its merchandise to present a fresh and youthful image that management believes is unique to "The Children's Place" brand. See "Business-- Merchandising" and "--Sourcing and Procurement." STRONG BRAND IMAGE. The Company believes that it has built a strong brand image for "The Children's Place" by (i) selling its products exclusively in its own stores, (ii) creating a uniform appearance in merchandise presentation, (iii) providing a consistent selection of coordinated separates and accessories for children, and (iv) offering high quality products at value prices. The Company believes that these factors foster consumer loyalty to "The Children's Place" brand name. See "Business--Merchandising" and "--Company Stores." BROAD CONSUMER APPEAL. The Company believes that its high-quality merchandise assortment, offered at "everyday value prices" so that customers need not wait for special sales, enable it to appeal to a broad range of consumers across all socioeconomic groups and to compete successfully in a wide range of regional shopping malls, outlet centers and other locations. See "Business--Merchandising--Everyday Value Pricing" and "--Company Stores." VERTICALLY INTEGRATED OPERATIONS. The Company controls the design, sourcing and sale of its private label children's apparel and accessories. The Company believes that the vertical integration of its operations, from in-house design to in-store presentation, enables the Company to identify and respond to market trends, uphold rigorous product quality standards and control the cost of its merchandise. See "Business-- Merchandising" and "--Company Stores." EXPERT SOURCING. The Company combines management's extensive sourcing experience with a cost-based buying strategy. Management has established close, long-standing and mutually beneficial relationships with numerous manufacturers. Through these relationships and its extensive knowledge of component costs of apparel, the Company believes that it has been able to purchase high quality products at low costs. See "Business--Merchandising" and "--Sourcing and Procurement." PROVEN MANAGEMENT TEAM. The Company has a seasoned, highly experienced management team, with its 12 most senior members having an average of 17 years in the retail and/or apparel business and an average of eight years with the Company. The Company believes that management's substantial experience favorably positions the Company for future expansion. See "Management." The Company's principal executive offices are located at One Dodge Drive, West Caldwell, New Jersey 07006. Its telephone number is (973) 227-8900. Investors should carefully consider the risk factors relating to the Company and this offering described on pages 8 through 13 of this Prospectus. 4 THE OFFERING
Common Stock offered by the Company:.................... 4,000,000 shares Common Stock to be outstanding after the offering:......................................... 24,622,103 shares(1) Use of proceeds:........................................ To repay the Company's 12% Senior Subordinated Notes, to repurchase a portion of the Company's outstanding warrants, to reduce outstanding borrowings under the Company's revolving credit facility, and for working capital and other general corporate purposes. Nasdaq National Market symbol:.......................... PLCE
- ------------------------ (1) Excludes 1,743,240 shares of Common Stock issuable under outstanding options, of which 577,632 are currently exercisable. 5 SUMMARY HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS AND AVERAGE NET SALES PER GROSS SQUARE FOOT) The following information is qualified in its entirety by the financial statements appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus.
FISCAL YEAR ENDED(1) SIX MONTHS ENDED -------------------------------------------------- ------------------------ JANUARY 29, JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 3, AUGUST 2, 1994 1995 1996 1997 1996 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA: Net sales........................................... $ 96,649 $ 107,953 $ 122,060 $ 143,838 $ 56,412 $ 72,737 Gross profit........................................ 28,874 33,724 38,626 54,052 18,112 23,820 Operating income.................................... 1,364 2,329 4,062 12,802 120 696 Interest expense, net............................... 1,150 1,303 1,925 2,884 1,182 1,815 Income (loss) before income taxes, extraordinary items and the cumulative effect of accounting change............................................ 214 1,026 1,690 9,522 (1,441) (1,225) ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Provision (benefit) for income taxes(2)............. 53 54 36 (20,919) 21 (492) Extraordinary gains(3).............................. 15,169 490 0 0 0 0 Net income (loss)(4)................................ $ 14,780 $ 1,462 $ 1,654 $ 30,441 $ (1,462) $ (733) ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Pro forma net income (loss) per common share(5)..... $ 1.28 $ (0.03) Pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding(5).................................... 23,804,185 23,804,185 Pro forma supplemental net income per common share(6).......................................... $ 1.23 $ 0.01 SELECTED OPERATING DATA: Number of stores open at end of period.............. 87 87 91 108 95 134 Comparable store sales increase (decrease)(7)(8).... (2.2%) 13.2% 10.0% 8.6% 8.1% 2.5% Average net sales per store(8)(9)................... $ 1,124 $ 1,264 $ 1,362 $ 1,479 $ 611 $ 618 Average square footage per store(10)................ 4,954 4,786 4,528 4,284 4,392 4,147 Average net sales per gross square foot(8)(11)....................................... $ 226 $ 259 $ 292 $ 335 $ 138 $ 146
AT AT AUGUST 2, 1997 -------------------------------------------------- ------------------------ JANUARY 29, JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AS 1994 1995 1996 1997 ACTUAL ADJUSTED(12) ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- BALANCE SHEET DATA: Working capital (deficit)........................... $ (11,621) $ (10,398) $ (17,630) $ 11,951 $ 2,079 $ 7,052 Total assets........................................ 26,600 26,556 32,073 64,479 79,748 79,514 Long-term debt...................................... 23,719 21,626 15,735 20,504 18,928 489 Stockholders' equity (deficit)...................... (15,338) (13,388) (11,735) 27,298 26,077 49,255
(FOOTNOTES ON FOLLOWING PAGE) 6 - ------------------------------ (1) All references to the Company's fiscal years refer to the 52- or 53-week year ended on the Saturday nearest to January 31 of the following year. For example, references to fiscal 1996 mean the fiscal year ended February 1, 1997. Fiscal 1995 was a 53-week year. (2) The provision (benefit) for income taxes for fiscal 1996 reflected the reversal of a valuation allowance of $21.0 million on a net deferred tax asset. See Note 9 of the Notes to Financial Statements. (3) Extraordinary gains during fiscal 1993 and fiscal 1994 represented forgiveness of debt in connection with a debt restructuring undertaken with the consent of the Company's creditors. (4) Net income for fiscal 1993 included a $550,000 charge relating to the cumulative effect of a change in accounting for inventory capitalization. (5) Pro forma net income (loss) per common share is calculated by dividing net income (loss) by the pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding. The pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding used in computing pro forma net income (loss) per common share for fiscal 1996 and the first six months of fiscal 1997 are based on the number of common shares and common share equivalents outstanding after giving effect to (i) the 1996 Private Placement described elsewhere in this Prospectus, (ii) the cancellation of the preferred stock discussed in Note 10 of the Notes to Financial Statements, (iii) the granting of management options in conjunction with the 1996 Private Placement as discussed in Note 11 of the Notes to Financial Statements and (iv) the Stock Split and the Series B Conversion described elsewhere in this Prospectus, as if all such events had occurred on the first day of fiscal 1996. (6) The pro forma supplemental net income per common share gives effect to (i) the elimination of interest expense on long-term debt that will not remain outstanding after the consummation of this offering and (ii) the issuance of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock in this offering, as if each such event had occurred on the first day of the period indicated. The pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding of 25,789,690 used in computing pro forma supplemental net income per common share is based upon the number of common shares and common share equivalents outstanding after giving effect to the repurchase of certain warrants, the exercise of one-third of an outstanding warrant, the issuance of shares in this offering, and the events described in clauses (i) through (iv) of footnote (5). (7) The Company defines comparable store sales as net sales from stores that have been open for more than 14 full months and have not been substantially remodeled during that time. (8) For purposes of determining comparable store sales increase (decrease), average net sales per store and average net sales per gross square foot, fiscal 1995 results were recalculated based on a 52-week year. (9) Represents net sales from stores open throughout the full period divided by the number of such stores. (10) Average square footage per store represents the square footage of stores open on the last day of the period divided by the number of such stores. (11) Represents net sales from stores open throughout the full period divided by the gross square footage of such stores. (12) Adjusted to give effect to the sale of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock offered by the Company in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $14.00 and the application of the estimated net proceeds therefrom, as described in "Use of Proceeds." 7 RISK FACTORS BEFORE PURCHASING THE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK OFFERED HEREBY, A PROSPECTIVE INVESTOR SHOULD CONSIDER THE SPECIFIC FACTORS SET FORTH BELOW AS WELL AS THE OTHER INFORMATION SET FORTH ELSEWHERE IN THIS PROSPECTUS. SEE "MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS" AND "BUSINESS" FOR A DESCRIPTION OF OTHER FACTORS AFFECTING THE BUSINESS OF THE COMPANY GENERALLY. AGGRESSIVE GROWTH STRATEGY The Company intends to pursue an aggressive growth strategy over the next several years. From July 1, 1996 through the end of fiscal 1996, the Company opened 16 new stores, growing to 108 stores. The Company has opened 32 stores during fiscal 1997 through September 1, 1997 and expects to open approximately 15 additional stores during the remainder of fiscal 1997. In a typical new store, capital expenditures (net of landlord contribution) approximate $200,000. In addition, a new store typically requires a $100,000 investment in inventory (net of merchandise payables) and other pre-opening expenses. The Company anticipates that it will spend a total of approximately $14.0 million in fiscal 1997 for capital expenditures and inventory relating to new store openings. The Company currently plans to spend at least $19.0 million to open at least 60 new stores in fiscal 1998. The Company reviews its expansion plans on a regular basis, in light of opportunities that may arise, and may determine to open a larger number of stores in fiscal 1998 than currently planned. The Company's future operating results will depend largely upon its ability to open and operate new stores successfully and to manage a growing business profitably. This will depend upon a number of factors, including (i) the availability of suitable store locations, (ii) the ability to negotiate acceptable lease terms, (iii) the ability to timely complete necessary construction or remodeling, (iv) the ability to obtain an adequate supply of finished products, (v) the ability to hire and train qualified managers and other employees, (vi) the ability to continue to upgrade its management information and distribution systems, (vii) the ability to manage increased distribution, including the ability to relocate the Company's distribution center to a larger facility, (viii) the ability to successfully integrate new stores into the Company's existing operations, and (ix) the ability to recognize and respond to regional differences in customer preferences (such as climate-related preferences). All of the Company's current stores are located in the eastern half of the United States, primarily in regional malls in and around major metropolitan areas. The Company intends to focus its expansion by establishing clusters of stores in states in which it already has stores or in contiguous states. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to achieve its planned expansion on a timely and profitable basis or that it will be able to achieve results similar to those achieved in existing locations in prior periods. Operating margins may also be adversely affected during periods in which expenses have been incurred in anticipation of new store openings. Any failure to successfully and profitably execute its expansion plans could have a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company believes that cash generated from operations and funds available under the Company's revolving line of credit will be sufficient to fund its capital requirements at least through fiscal 1998. However, there can be no assurance that the Company will not be required to seek additional funds for its capital needs. The inability to secure such funds or to obtain such funds on acceptable terms could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations--Liquidity and Capital Resources" and "Business--Store Expansion Program." CHANGES IN COMPARABLE STORE SALES RESULTS FROM PERIOD TO PERIOD Numerous factors affect comparable store sales results, including among others, weather conditions, fashion trends, the retail sales environment, economic conditions and the Company's success in executing its business strategy. The Company's quarterly comparable store sales results have fluctuated significantly in the past. The Company does not expect its comparable store sales to continue to increase at rates similar 8 to those achieved in recent periods. Moreover, there can be no assurance that comparable store sales for any particular period will not decrease in the future. Fluctuations in the Company's comparable store sales results could cause the price of the Common Stock to fluctuate significantly and could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." MERCHANDISE TRENDS The Company's continued success will depend in part on its ability to anticipate and respond to fashion trends and consumer preferences. The Company's design, manufacturing and distribution process generally requires up to nine months, during which time fashion trends and consumer preferences may change. Any failure by the Company to anticipate, identify or respond to future fashion trends may adversely affect customer acceptance of its products or require substantial markdowns, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business--Merchandising." DISRUPTIONS IN RECEIVING AND DISTRIBUTION All of the Company's merchandise is currently shipped directly from manufacturers through freight consolidators to the Company's distribution center in West Caldwell, New Jersey. The Company's operating results depend in large part on the orderly operation of this receiving and distribution process, which depends on manufacturers' adherence to shipping schedules and the Company's effective management of the distribution center. In addition, there can be no assurance that the Company has anticipated, or will be able to anticipate, all of the changing demands which its expanding operations will impose on its receiving and distribution system, nor can there be any assurance that events beyond the control of the Company, such as a strike or other disruption affecting the parcel service that delivers substantially all of the Company's merchandise to its stores, will not result in delays in delivery of merchandise to stores. The Company intends to relocate its distribution facility during fiscal 1998 to accommodate future growth and is in the process of selecting a suitable site. There can be no assurance that delays, cost overruns or other complications in the relocation to a new distribution facility will not result in a significant interruption in the receipt and distribution of merchandise. Any such event could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business--Distribution." RELIANCE ON INFORMATION SYSTEMS The Company relies on various information systems to manage its operations and regularly makes investments to upgrade, enhance or replace such systems. During fiscal 1998, the Company intends to install a warehouse management system to facilitate more efficient receiving and distribution of inventory and intends to replace its current point-of-sale ("POS") software with an upgraded system. Any delays or difficulties in executing transitions to these or other new systems, or any other disruptions affecting the Company's information systems, could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business-- Management Information Systems." DEPENDENCE ON UNAFFILIATED MANUFACTURERS AND INDEPENDENT AGENTS The Company does not own or operate any manufacturing facilities and is therefore dependent upon independent third parties for the manufacture of all of its products. The Company's products are currently manufactured to its specifications pursuant to purchase orders by more than 50 independent manufacturers located primarily in Asia, principally in Taiwan, Hong Kong, Turkey, China, Thailand, the Philippines and Sri Lanka. In fiscal 1996, approximately 38% of the Company's merchandise was manufactured in Taiwan, 25% in Hong Kong, 8% in Turkey and 7% in China. Substantially all merchandise that the Company purchases from Hong Kong, China and the Philippines, representing approximately 35% of the Company's total purchases in fiscal 1996, is purchased through a single Hong Kong-based trading company which has an exclusive arrangement with the Company. Excluding the approximately 20 manufacturers represented by this trading company, the Company's ten largest manufacturers accounted for 44% of the 9 Company's total purchases during fiscal 1996, with the top four such manufacturers each accounting for between 5% and 8%. The Company has no exclusive or long-term contracts with its manufacturers and competes with other companies for manufacturing facilities. In addition, the Company has no formal written agreement with the Hong Kong-based trading company. Although management believes that it has established close relationships with the Company's principal manufacturers and independent agents, the inability to maintain such relationships or to find additional sources to cover future growth could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business--Sourcing and Procurement." RISKS OF USING FOREIGN MANUFACTURERS; POSSIBLE ADVERSE IMPACT OF UNAFFILIATED MANUFACTURERS' FAILURE TO COMPLY WITH ACCEPTABLE LABOR PRACTICES The Company's business is subject to the risks generally associated with purchasing products from foreign countries, such as foreign governmental regulations, political instability (including uncertainty concerning the future of Hong Kong following the transfer of Hong Kong to China on July 1, 1997), currency and exchange risks, quotas on the amounts and types of merchandise which may be imported into the United States from other countries, disruptions or delays in shipments and changes in economic conditions in countries in which the Company's manufacturing sources are located. The Company cannot predict the effect that such factors will have on its business arrangements with foreign manufacturing sources. If any such factors were to render the conduct of business in a particular country undesirable or impractical, or if the Company's current foreign manufacturing sources were to cease doing business with the Company for any reason, the Company's business and operating results could be adversely affected. The Company's business is also subject to the risks associated with changes in United States legislation and regulations relating to imported apparel products, including quotas, duties, taxes and other charges or restrictions on imported apparel. The Company cannot predict whether such changes or other charges or restrictions will be imposed upon the importation of its products in the future, or, generally, the effect any such event would have on the Company. However, if China were to lose its Most Favored Nation trading status with the United States, such event could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business--Sourcing and Procurement." The Company requires its independent manufacturers to operate in compliance with applicable laws and regulations. While the Company's purchasing guidelines promote ethical business practices, the Company does not control such manufacturers or their labor practices. The violation of labor or other laws by an independent manufacturer of the Company, or the divergence of an independent manufacturer's labor practices from those generally accepted as ethical in the United States, could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business--Sourcing and Procurement." FOREIGN CURRENCY FLUCTUATIONS The Company conducts its business in United States dollars. However, because the Company purchases substantially all of its products overseas, the cost of these products may be affected by changes in the values of the relevant currencies. To date, the Company has not considered it necessary to hedge against foreign currency fluctuations. Although foreign currency fluctuations have had no material adverse effect on the Company in the past, there can be no assurance that such fluctuations will not have such an effect on the Company in the future. DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL The leadership of Ezra Dabah, the Company's Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board, and of Stanley B. Silver, the Company's President and Chief Operating Officer, has been instrumental in the Company's success. The loss of the services of either Mr. Dabah or Mr. Silver could have a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company has entered into employment agreements with Messrs. Dabah and Silver, but there can be no assurance that the Company will be able to retain their services. In addition, other members of management have substantial experience and expertise in the Company's business and have made significant contributions to its growth and success. The loss of services 10 of one or more of these individuals, or the inability to attract additional qualified managers or other personnel as the Company grows, could have a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company is not protected by any key-man or similar life insurance for any of its executive officers. See "Management." COMPETITION The children's apparel retail business is highly competitive. The Company competes in substantially all of its markets with GapKids, BabyGap and Old Navy (each of which is a division of The Gap, Inc.), The Gymboree Corporation, Limited Too (a division of The Limited, Inc.), J.C. Penney Company, Inc., Sears, Roebuck and Co. and other department stores that sell children's apparel and accessories, as well as certain discount stores such as Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. and Kids "R" Us (a division of Toys "R" Us, Inc.). The Company also competes with a wide variety of local and regional specialty stores and with other national retail chains and catalog companies. One or more of its competitors are present in substantially all of the malls in which the Company has stores. Many of the Company's competitors are larger than the Company and have access to significantly greater financial, marketing and other resources than the Company. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to compete successfully against existing or future competition. See "Business--Competition." PROPRIETARY CREDIT CARD Sales under "The Children's Place" credit card program represented approximately 15% of the Company's net sales in fiscal 1996. The private label credit card program is operated by Hurley State Bank, through its agent, SPS Payment Services, Inc. ("SPS"), on terms that currently do not provide for recourse against the Company. In connection with its efforts to increase the number of cardholders and encourage use of its proprietary credit card, the Company, from time to time, may consider changing these arrangements to provide for either full or partial recourse. Any such changes may subject the Company to losses from unpaid charges and could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business-- Marketing." FLUCTUATIONS IN QUARTERLY RESULTS AND SEASONALITY As is the case with many apparel retailers, the Company experiences seasonal fluctuations in its net sales and net income, with the greater amount of the Company's net sales and net income typically realized during the third and fourth quarters of the fiscal year, which include the back-to-school and holiday seasons. Net sales and net income are generally weakest during the first two fiscal quarters and are often lower during the second fiscal quarter than during the first fiscal quarter. The Company has experienced first and second quarter losses in prior years and expects to experience second quarter losses, and may experience first quarter losses, in the future. The Company's quarterly results of operations may also fluctuate significantly from quarter to quarter as a result of a variety of other factors, including the timing of new store openings and related pre-opening and other start-up expenses, net sales contributed by new stores, increases or decreases in comparable store sales, adverse weather conditions, shifts in timing of certain holidays, changes in the Company's merchandise mix and overall economic conditions. Any failure by the Company to meet its business plans for the third and fourth quarter of any fiscal year would have a material adverse effect on the Company's earnings, which in all likelihood would not be offset by satisfactory results achieved in other quarters of the same fiscal year. In addition, because the Company's expense levels are based in part on expectations of future sales levels, a shortfall in expected sales could result in a disproportionate decrease in the Company's net income. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations--Quarterly Results and Seasonality." IMPACT OF ECONOMIC, REGIONAL AND OTHER BUSINESS CONDITIONS The Company's business is sensitive to customers' spending patterns, which in turn are subject to prevailing regional and national economic conditions such as interest rates, taxation and consumer 11 confidence. All of the Company's stores are located in the eastern half of the United States and the Company anticipates that substantially all stores to be opened in fiscal 1997 and fiscal 1998 will be in states where the Company presently has operations or in contiguous states. Therefore, the Company is, and will continue to be, susceptible to changes in regional economic conditions, weather conditions, demographic and population characteristics, consumer preferences and other regional factors. The Company is also dependent upon the continued popularity of malls as shopping destinations and the ability of mall anchor tenants and other attractions to generate customer traffic in the malls where the Company's stores are located. Any economic or other conditions decreasing the retail demand for apparel or the level of mall traffic could have a material adverse effect on the Company. See "Business--Company Stores." NET OPERATING LOSS CARRYFORWARDS The Company reported net operating loss carryforwards ("NOLs") of $57.3 million on its fiscal 1995 income tax return. The Company expects that $11.4 million of these NOLs will be utilized to offset taxable income earned by the Company in its 1996 taxable year, leaving $45.9 million to be utilized in subsequent taxable years. The Company does not believe that this offering will affect the Company's ability to utilize these NOLs. However, because the amount and availability of these NOLs are subject to review by the Internal Revenue Service, there can be no assurance that the NOLs would not be reduced or their use limited as the result of an audit of the Company's tax returns. In addition, future events, including certain transactions involving outstanding shares of the Company's Common Stock, could affect the Company's ability to utilize its NOLs. If the amount of these NOLs were reduced or their availability limited, the Company could be liable for additional taxes with respect to its 1996 taxable year, and its tax liability could be increased for its current and subsequent taxable years. See Note 9 of the Notes to Financial Statements. CONTROL BY CERTAIN STOCKHOLDERS After the sale of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby, Ezra Dabah and certain members of his family will own beneficially 11,920,440 shares of the Company's Common Stock, constituting approximately 48.3% of the outstanding Common Stock. Two funds managed by Saunders Karp & Megrue, L.P. ("SKM"), The SK Equity Fund, L.P. and SK Investment Fund, L.P. (collectively, the "SK Funds"), together with a former consultant to SKM (collectively with the SK Funds, the "SKM Investors"), will own approximately 7,659,889 shares or 31.1% of the outstanding Common Stock (assuming that the underwriters' over-allotment option is not exercised). See "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management." Pursuant to a stockholders agreement, the SKM Investors and all the Company's other current stockholders, who will own in the aggregate 82.9% of the outstanding Common Stock after this offering, have agreed to vote for the election of two nominees of the SKM Investors and three nominees of Ezra Dabah to the Company's Board of Directors. As a result, the SKM Investors and Ezra Dabah will be able to control the election of five of the Company's seven directors. In addition, if the SKM Investors and Mr. Dabah were to vote together, they would be able to determine the outcome of any matter submitted to a vote of the Company's stockholders for approval, including the election of the remaining two directors. See "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management--Stockholders Agreement" and "Description of Capital Stock--Certain Certificate of Incorporation Provisions." POTENTIAL IMPACT OF SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE; REGISTRATION RIGHTS Sales of substantial amounts of Common Stock in the public market following this offering could have an adverse effect on the market price of the Common Stock. The 4,000,000 shares offered hereby will be freely tradeable in the public market, except to the extent purchased by affiliates of the Company. All of the remaining 20,622,103 shares to be outstanding upon consummation of this offering will become eligible for sale in the public market, subject to compliance with the volume and manner of sale requirements of Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act, upon the expiration of "lock-up" agreements with the Underwriters not to sell such shares until 180 days after the date of this Prospectus. Holders of such shares have contractual rights to have those shares registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission for resale to the public. In addition, following this offering, the Company intends to file a registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission covering shares of Common Stock issued or 12 reserved for issuance under the 1996 Stock Option Plan, the Company's 1997 Stock Option Plan and the Company's 1997 Employee Stock Purchase Plan and, upon effectiveness of such registration statement, any shares subsequently issued under such plans will be eligible for sale in the public market, except to the extent restricted by lock-up agreements and subject to compliance with Rule 144 in the case of affiliates of the Company. See "Shares Eligible for Future Sale." UNCERTAINTY AS TO FUTURE EXISTENCE OF ACTIVE TRADING MARKET; POSSIBLE VOLATILITY OF STOCK PRICE Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Common Stock. Although the Common Stock has been approved for listing on the Nasdaq National Market, there can be no assurance that an active trading market in the Common Stock will develop subsequent to this offering or, if developed, that it will be sustained or that the market price of the Common Stock will not decline below the initial public offering price. The initial public offering price will be determined by negotiations between the Company and the Representatives. For a description of the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price, see "Underwriting." The Nasdaq National Market has experienced and is likely to experience in the future significant price and volume fluctuations which could adversely affect the market price of the Common Stock without regard to the operating performance of the Company. Furthermore, there can be no assurance that the Company will continue to satisfy the requirements to have its Common Stock listed on the Nasdaq National Market. In addition, the Company believes that factors such as quarterly fluctuations in its financial results, its comparable store sales results, trading prices for common stock of other retailers, the overall economy and the condition of the financial markets could cause the price of the Common Stock to fluctuate substantially. DILUTION Purchasers of Common Stock in this offering will incur immediate dilution of $12.00 per share in net tangible book value per share of Common Stock (assuming an offering price of $14.00 per share, the midpoint of the range shown on the cover page of this Prospectus). See "Dilution." ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECT OF CERTAIN PROVISIONS OF THE COMPANY'S CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION AND BYLAWS Certain provisions of the Company's Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (the "Certificate of Incorporation") and Amended and Restated ByLaws (the "ByLaws") may be deemed to have anti-takeover effects and may discourage, delay or prevent a takeover attempt that a stockholder might consider in its best interest. These provisions, among other things, (i) classify the Company's Board of Directors into three classes, each of which will serve for different three year periods, (ii) provide that only the chairman of the Board of Directors may call special meetings of the stockholders, (iii) provide that a director may be removed by stockholders only for cause by a vote of the holders of more than two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote, (iv) provide that all vacancies on the Company's Board of Directors, including any vacancies resulting from an increase in the number of directors, may be filled by a majority of the remaining directors, even if the number is less than a quorum, (v) establish certain advance notice procedures for nominations of candidates for election as directors and for stockholder proposals to be considered at stockholders' meetings, and (vi) require a vote of the holders of more than two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote in order to amend the foregoing provisions and certain other provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and ByLaws. In addition, the Board of Directors, without further action of the stockholders, is permitted to issue and fix the terms of preferred stock which may have rights senior to those of the Common Stock. Moreover, the Company is subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the "DGCL") which would require a two-thirds vote of stockholders for any business combination (such as a merger or sale of all or substantially all of the Company's assets) between the Company and an "interested stockholder," unless such transaction is approved by a majority of the disinterested directors or meets certain other requirements. In certain circumstances, the existence of these provisions which inhibit or discourage takeover attempts could reduce the market value of the Common Stock. See "Description of Capital Stock--Certain Certificate of Incorporation and ByLaw Provisions" and "--Delaware Law and Certain Charter Provisions." 13 COMPANY HISTORY The Company was founded in 1969 as a children's retailer. In 1989, the Company was purchased by D.G. Acquisition Corp. ("DG Acquisition"), a company owned by Ezra Dabah and certain members of his family, from Federated Department Stores. During fiscal 1990 and 1991, the Company experienced substantial losses due to, among other things, the legacy of its outmoded merchandising strategy of selling brands at discount prices and a poor real estate portfolio, including many stores in need of remodeling. Consequently, in 1991, Mr. Dabah, who was serving as Chairman of the Board of Directors, assumed the position of Chief Executive Officer and became involved in the Company's day-to-day operations. Mr. Dabah also recruited Stanley B. Silver, a seasoned retail executive, as Chief Operating Officer. Under the leadership of Messrs. Dabah and Silver, the Company's management team recognized that a strategy of selling branded merchandise at discount prices was not sustainable given the high occupancy costs associated with the Company's large, mall-based locations. Accordingly, the Company repositioned its merchandise strategy to one in which it would design, contract to manufacture and sell its own line of private label apparel and accessories under "The Children's Place" brand name at everyday value prices. At the same time, the new management team took steps to stabilize the Company's operations by closing approximately half of the Company's 170 stores and focusing the Company's operations in the eastern half of the United States. The Company also developed a new store prototype that reflected a reduction in average store size from 5,500 square feet to 3,500 square feet. In addition, in July 1992, management commenced negotiations with the Company's creditors, which resulted in a consensual restructuring of the Company's indebtedness by the end of 1993. By 1993, the Company had fully implemented its merchandising strategy and was exclusively selling its internally designed apparel and accessories under "The Children's Place" brand name at everyday value prices. As a result of the Company's successful implementation of its new merchandising strategy and its restructured real estate portfolio, the Company generated net income in fiscal 1993 and improved its operational performance in each succeeding year as it continued to refine its merchandising and operating strategies. However, debt repayment obligations prevented the Company from investing capital into the expansion of its store base. Accordingly, in late fiscal 1995, the Company began to look for new financing. In July 1996, the Company consummated private placement transactions with the SKM Investors and Nomura Holding America Inc. (the "Noteholder") (such transactions, collectively, the "1996 Private Placement"), which resulted in net proceeds to the Company of $37.4 million. These proceeds enabled the Company to repay a substantial portion of its outstanding indebtedness, redeem certain outstanding shares of Common Stock and begin to implement an aggressive program of opening new stores. From July 1, 1996 to September 1, 1997, the Company has increased the number of its stores from 93 to 140. For a full description of the 1996 Private Placement, see "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions." 14 USE OF PROCEEDS The net proceeds to be received by the Company from the sale of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby, after deducting the estimated underwriting discount and estimated expenses of the offering, are estimated to be $50.7 million, assuming an offering price of $14.00 per share. Of such net proceeds, the Company will use $20.5 million to pay the principal amount of, and accrued interest on, the Company's 12% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2002 (the "Senior Subordinated Notes") held by the Noteholder. In addition, the Company will use $25.8 million of the net proceeds from the offering to repurchase a warrant (the "Noteholder Warrant") held by the Noteholder and two-thirds of a warrant (the "Legg Mason Warrant") held by Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated ("Legg Mason"). The amount to be used to repurchase the Noteholder Warrant and such portion of the Legg Mason Warrant will be adjusted proportionately with any change in the initial public offering price from $14.00 per share. The balance of the net proceeds will be used (i) to reduce borrowings outstanding under the Company's senior revolving credit facility (the "Foothill Credit Facility") with Foothill Capital Corporation ("Foothill Capital") and/or (ii) for working capital and general corporate purposes. Pending such uses, the Company intends to invest the net proceeds of this offering in investment-grade, interest-bearing securities. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations--Liquidity and Capital Resources" and "Underwriting." In the event that the underwriters' over-allotment option is exercised, the Company will not receive any proceeds from the sale of shares pursuant to such option. DIVIDEND POLICY The Company has never paid dividends on its Common Stock and does not anticipate paying dividends on its Common Stock in the foreseeable future. It is the present intention of the Company's Board of Directors to retain any future earnings of the Company to finance its operations and the expansion of its business. The Foothill Credit Facility prohibits any payment of dividends. Any determination in the future to pay dividends will depend upon the Company's earnings, financial condition, cash requirements, future prospects, covenants in the Company's credit facility and any future debt instruments and such other factors as the Board of Directors deems appropriate at the time. 15 CAPITALIZATION The following table sets forth the capitalization of the Company as of August 2, 1997 (i) on an actual basis (giving effect to the Stock Split), (ii) as adjusted to give pro forma effect to the Series B Conversion and (iii) as further adjusted to give effect to the sale of the 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock offered by the Company hereby at an assumed initial public offering price of $14.00 per share and the application of the estimated net proceeds therefrom as described under "Use of Proceeds" and to the issuance of 201,414 shares upon the exercise of one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant. The table should be read in conjunction with the historical financial statements of the Company and the notes thereto and the other financial information appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus.
AS OF AUGUST 2, 1997 ------------------------------------ ACTUAL PRO FORMA AS ADJUSTED --------- ---------- ----------- (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS) Senior Subordinated Notes....................................................... $ 20,000 $20,000 $0 Less: Unamortized discount.................................................... (1,561)(1) (1,561)(1) 0 Other long-term debt and capital lease obligations (less current portion)....... 12 12 12 Total long-term debt and capital lease obligations (less current portion)....... 18,451 18,451 12 Stockholders' equity: Preferred Stock, $1.00 par value: Shares authorized -- 1,000,000(2) Shares outstanding -- none Series A Common Stock, $.10 par value......................................... 1,276 -- -- Shares authorized -- 27,600,000 Shares outstanding -- actual 12,760,800(3); pro forma 0; as adjusted 0 Series B Common Stock, $.10 par value......................................... 5 -- -- Shares authorized -- 70,000 Shares outstanding -- actual 47,238; pro forma 0; as adjusted 0 Common Stock, $.10 par value: Shares authorized -- 100,000,000(2) Shares outstanding -- actual 0; pro forma 20,420,689(3); as adjusted 24,622,103(4)............................................................. -- 2,042 2,462 Additional paid-in capital.................................................... 57,354 56,593 81,146 Accumulated deficit(5)........................................................ (32,558) (32,558) (34,353) --------- ---------- ----------- Total stockholders' equity................................................ 26,077 26,077 49,255 --------- ---------- ----------- Total capitalization...................................................... $ 44,528 $44,528 $49,267 --------- ---------- ----------- --------- ---------- -----------
- ------------------------ (1) The unamortized discount on the Senior Subordinated Notes is attributable to the issuance of the Noteholder Warrant. (2) Prior to the consummation of the offering made hereby, the Company's Certificate of Incorporation will be amended to increase the number of authorized shares of Common Stock to 100,000,000 and the number of authorized shares of Preferred Stock to 1,000,000. (3) Does not include 2,739,348 shares issuable upon exercise of the Noteholder Warrant and the Legg Mason Warrant or shares issuable upon exercise of stock options outstanding on August 2, 1997. (4) Does not include shares issuable upon exercise of stock options outstanding on August 2, 1997. (5) The as adjusted retained earnings (deficit) amount reflects the effect of an extraordinary item representing the write-off of unamortized debt issuance costs and unamortized debt discount, net of taxes, as a result of the repayment of the Senior Subordinated Notes in connection with this offering. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations." 16 DILUTION As of August 2, 1997, the Company's net tangible book value (defined as total assets, excluding deferred financing costs, less total liabilities) was $24.6 million, or $1.21 per share of Common Stock (adjusted to give pro forma effect to the Stock Split and to the Series B Conversion). Dilution represents the difference between the amount per share of Common Stock paid by investors in this offering, and the net tangible book value per share of Common Stock after this offering. After giving effect to the sale by the Company of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $14.00 per share and the use of proceeds therefrom as described in "Use of Proceeds" and to the issuance of 201,414 shares upon the exercise of one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant, the pro forma net tangible book value of the Company at August 2, 1997 would have been $49.3 million, or $2.00 per share of Common Stock. This represents an immediate increase in net tangible book value of $0.79 per share of Common Stock to the Company's existing stockholders, and an immediate dilution of $12.00 per share of Common Stock to investors purchasing in this offering. This per share dilution is illustrated in the following table: Assumed initial public offering price....................................... $ 14.00 --------- Pro forma net tangible book value before this offering.................... $1.21 Increase in pro forma net tangible book value attributable to this offering(1)............................................................. $0.79 --------- Pro forma net tangible book value after this offering....................... $ 2.00 --------- Dilution to investors purchasing in this offering........................... $ 12.00 ---------
- ------------------------ (1) Reflects the receipt of the net proceeds from the sale of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock in this offering and the use of $25.8 million of such net proceeds to repurchase the Noteholder Warrant and two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant. The following table summarizes, as of August 2, 1997, the differences between the existing stockholders (including Legg Mason) and the investors purchasing in this offering (adjusted to give pro forma effect to the Stock Split and to the Series B Conversion), with respect to the number of shares of Common Stock purchased, the total consideration paid and the average price per share of Common Stock paid. The determination of the total consideration and average price per share paid by existing stockholders has been based upon the consideration paid by stockholders to acquire the Company and subsequent contributions to the capital of the Company, net of amounts paid to redeem shares.
AVERAGE PRICE PER NUMBER PERCENT AMOUNT PERCENT SHARE ------------ ----------- -------------- ----------- ----------- Existing stockholders................................ 20,622,103 83.8% $ 58,754,000 51.2% $ 2.85 New investors........................................ 4,000,000 16.2% $ 56,000,000 48.8% $ 14.00 ------------ ----- -------------- ----- ----------- Total.............................................. 24,622,103 100.0% $ 114,754,000 100.0% ------------ ----- -------------- ----- ------------ ----- -------------- -----
The foregoing tables assume no exercise of outstanding stock options after August 2, 1997. At August 2, 1997, 1,444,080 shares of Common Stock were subject to outstanding options, at a weighted average exercise price of $2.677 per share, of which options for 577,632 shares were exercisable. To the extent any such stock options are exercised, there will be further dilution to new investors. See "Management--Stock Option and Other Plans for Employees--Stock Option Plans." 17 SELECTED HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA The following table sets forth certain historical and pro forma financial and operating data for the Company. The selected historical financial data for the Company is qualified by reference to, and should be read in conjunction with, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," the financial statements and notes thereto and other financial information appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus. The statement of operations data set forth below for fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, and the balance sheet data as of February 3, 1996 and February 1, 1997, have been derived from the Company's historical financial statements, which statements have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public accountants ("Arthur Andersen"), as indicated in their report included elsewhere herein. The statement of operations data set forth below for fiscal 1993, and the balance sheet data as of January 29, 1994 and January 28, 1995, have been derived from the Company's historical financial statements audited and reported on by Arthur Andersen, which are not included in this Prospectus. The historical financial data for fiscal 1992 have been derived from the Company's historical financial statements audited by another independent public accounting firm, which are not included in this Prospectus. The historical information for the six months ended August 3, 1996 and August 2, 1997, and as of August 2, 1997, has been derived from the unaudited financial statements of the Company and reflects, in the opinion of management, all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments) necessary to present fairly the financial position as of, and the results for, such interim periods. The results of operations for the six months ended August 2, 1997 are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for the full fiscal year.
SIX MONTHS FISCAL YEAR ENDED(1) ENDED --------------------------------------------------------------- ----------------------- JANUARY 30, JANUARY 29, JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 3, AUGUST 2, 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1996 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS) STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA: Net sales.......................... $ 114,126 $ 96,649 $ 107,953 $ 122,060 $143,838 $ 56,412 $72,737 Gross profit....................... 28,764 28,874 33,724 38,626 54,052 18,112 23,820 Selling, general and administrative expenses......................... 28,051 24,156 27,873 30,757 36,251 15,926 19,287 Pre-opening costs.................. 41 79 178 311 982 212 1,222 Depreciation and amortization...... 3,664 3,275 3,344 3,496 4,017 1,854 2,615 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Operating income (loss)(2)......... (15,670 ) 1,364 2,329 4,062 12,802 120 696 Interest expense, net.............. 2,562 1,150 1,303 1,925 2,884 1,182 1,815 Other expense, net................. 0 0 0 447 396 379 106 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Income (loss) before income taxes, extraordinary items and cumulative effect of accounting change........................... (18,232 ) 214 1,026 1,690 9,522 (1,441 ) (1,225) Provision (benefit) for income taxes(3)......................... 0 53 54 36 (20,919 ) 21 (492) ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Income (loss) before extraordinary items............................ (18,232 ) 161 972 1,654 30,441 (1,462 ) (733) Extraordinary gains(4)............. 0 15,169 490 0 0 0 0 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Net income (loss)(5)............... $ (18,232 ) $ 14,780 $ 1,462 $ 1,654 $ 30,441 $ (1,462 ) $ (733) ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ---------- Pro forma net income (loss) per common share(6).................. $ 1.28 $ (0.03) ----------- ---------- ----------- ---------- Pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding(6)............ 23,804,185 23,804,185 Pro forma supplemental net income per common share(7).............. $ 1.23 $ 0.01 SELECTED OPERATING DATA: Number of stores open at end of period........................... 87 87 87 91 108 95 134 Comparable store sales increase (decrease)(8)(9)................. 8.5% (2.2% ) 13.2% 10.0% 8.6% 8.1% 2.5% Average net sales per store (in thousands)(9)(10)................ $ 1,123 $ 1,124 $ 1,264 $ 1,362 $ 1,479 $ 611 $ 618 Average square footage per store(11)........................ 5,049 4,954 4,786 4,528 4,284 4,392 4,147 Average net sales per gross square foot(9)(12)...................... $ 220 $ 226 $ 259 $ 292 $ 335 $ 138 $ 146
18
AT ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- JANUARY 30, JANUARY 29, JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 2, 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS) BALANCE SHEET DATA: Working capital (deficit)..................... $ (52,540) $ (11,621) $ (10,398) $ (17,630) $ 11,951 $ 2,079 Total assets.................................. 31,107 26,600 26,556 32,073 64,479 79,748 Long-term debt................................ 66,311 23,719 21,626 15,735 20,504 18,928 Stockholders' equity (deficit)................ (52,061) (15,338) (13,388) (11,735) 27,298 26,077
- ------------------------ (1) All references to the Company's fiscal years refer to the 52- or 53-week year ended on the Saturday nearest to January 31 of the following year. For example, references to fiscal 1996 mean the fiscal year ended February 1, 1997. Fiscal 1995 was a 53-week year. (2) The operating income (loss) for fiscal 1992 included a reorganization and restructuring charge of $12.7 million related to a strategic operational restructuring plan to close 93 stores, reduce other stores' square footage and reduce other administrative overhead costs. (3) The provision (benefit) for income taxes for fiscal 1996 reflected the reversal of a valuation allowance of $21.0 million on a net deferred tax asset. See Note 9 of the Notes to Financial Statements. (4) Extraordinary gains during fiscal 1993 and fiscal 1994 represented forgiveness of debt in connection with a debt restructuring undertaken with the consent of the Company's creditors. (5) Net income for fiscal 1993 included a $550,000 charge related to the cumulative effect of a change in accounting for inventory capitalization. (6) Pro forma net income (loss) per common share is calculated by dividing net income (loss) by the pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding. The pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding used in computing pro forma net income (loss) per share for fiscal 1996 and the first six months of fiscal 1997 are based on the number of common shares and common share equivalents outstanding after giving effect to (i) the 1996 Private Placement described elsewhere in this Prospectus, (ii) the cancellation of the preferred stock discussed in Note 10 of the Notes to Financial Statements, (iii) the granting of management options in conjunction with the 1996 Private Placement as discussed in Note 11 of the Notes to Financial Statements and (iv) the Stock Split and the Series B Conversion described elsewhere in this Prospectus, as if all such events had occurred on the first day of fiscal 1996. (7) The pro forma supplemental net income per share gives effect to (i) the elimination of interest expense on long-term debt that will not remain outstanding after the consummation of this offering and (ii) the issuance of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock in this offering, as if each such event had occurred on the first day of the period indicated. The pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding of 25,789,690 used in computing pro forma supplemental net income per common share are based upon the number of common shares and common share equivalents outstanding after giving effect to the repurchase of the Noteholder Warrant and two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant, the exercise of one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant, the issuance of shares in this offering, and the events described in clauses (i) through (iv) of footnote (6). (8) The Company defines comparable store sales as net sales from stores that have been open for more than 14 full months and have not been substantially remodeled during that time. (9) For purposes of determining comparable store sales increase (decrease), average net sales per store and average net sales per gross square foot, fiscal 1995 results were recalculated based on a 52-week year. (10) Represents net sales from stores open throughout the full period divided by the number of such stores. (11) Average square footage per store represents the square footage of stores open on the last day of the period divided by the number of such stores. (12) Represents net sales from stores open throughout the full period divided by the gross square footage of such stores. 19 MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS THIS PROSPECTUS CONTAINS FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS THAT INVOLVE RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES. THE COMPANY'S ACTUAL RESULTS COULD DIFFER MATERIALLY FROM THOSE PROJECTED IN SUCH FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS. FACTORS THAT COULD CAUSE OR CONTRIBUTE TO SUCH DIFFERENCES INCLUDE, BUT ARE NOT LIMITED TO, THOSE DISCUSSED IN THIS SECTION, AS WELL AS THOSE DISCUSSED IN "RISK FACTORS" AND ELSEWHERE IN THIS PROSPECTUS. THE COMPANY UNDERTAKES NO OBLIGATION TO PUBLICLY UPDATE OR REVISE ANY FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS, WHETHER AS A RESULT OF NEW INFORMATION, FUTURE EVENTS OR OTHERWISE. THE FOLLOWING DISCUSSION OF THE COMPANY'S HISTORICAL FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS SHOULD BE READ IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE HISTORICAL FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND THE NOTES THERETO AND THE OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION APPEARING ELSEWHERE IN THIS PROSPECTUS. THE COMPANY'S FISCAL YEAR ENDS ON THE SATURDAY CLOSEST TO JANUARY 31 OF THE FOLLOWING YEAR. THE RESULTS FOR FISCAL 1994, 1995, AND 1996 REPRESENT THE 52-WEEK PERIOD ENDED JANUARY 28, 1995, THE 53-WEEK PERIOD ENDED FEBRUARY 3, 1996 AND THE 52-WEEK PERIOD ENDED FEBRUARY 1, 1997, RESPECTIVELY. GENERAL The Company is a leading specialty retailer of children's apparel and accessories. As of September 1, 1997, the Company operated 140 stores primarily in regional shopping malls in the eastern half of the United States. In July 1996, following the 1996 Private Placement, the Company began to implement an aggressive growth strategy designed to capitalize on its business strengths and its strong store economics. From July 1, 1996 through the end of fiscal 1996, the Company opened a total of 16 stores, growing to 108 stores. During fiscal 1997 through September 1, 1997, the Company has opened 32 stores. The Company intends to continue its expansion program and currently plans to open approximately 15 additional stores during the remainder of fiscal 1997 and at least 60 stores in fiscal 1998. As a result of increases in comparable store sales and the opening of new stores, the Company's net sales increased from $108.0 million in fiscal 1994 to $143.8 million in fiscal 1996 and operating income increased from $2.3 million to $12.8 million over the same period. During the past 12 months, the Company has concentrated on building the infrastructure necessary to manage its growth strategy, including the opening and remodeling of stores. During fiscal 1996 and the first six months of fiscal 1997, the Company hired additional management personnel in the areas of store operations, real estate, store construction, merchandising and finance. In fiscal 1998, the Company intends to relocate its distribution center to a larger facility and to install a warehouse management system to accommodate the Company's continued growth. The Company has achieved comparable store sales increases on an annual basis in each year following fiscal 1993. The Company defines its comparable store sales as net sales from stores that have been open for more than 14 full months and that have not been substantially remodeled during that time. The Company reported comparable store sales growth over prior years of 13.2%, 10.0% and 8.6% during fiscal 1994, fiscal 1995 and fiscal 1996, respectively, and 2.5% in the first six months of fiscal 1997. The Company believes that these increases were primarily the result of a successful merchandising and operational repositioning of the Company, including the restructuring of its real estate portfolio. The Company does not expect comparable store sales to continue to increase at rates similar to those that it has experienced in recent years. The Company incurs significant store pre-opening costs, consisting primarily of payroll, supply and advertising expenses. The Company's policy is to expense these pre-opening costs as incurred. The Company anticipates repaying the $20.0 million principal amount of the Senior Subordinated Notes, together with accrued interest, out of the net proceeds of its initial public offering. Consequently, the Company expects to incur a non-cash, extraordinary charge to earnings during the third quarter of fiscal 1997 of approximately $1.7 million, resulting from the write-off of unamortized debt issuance costs 20 and unamortized debt discount, net of taxes. This charge will negatively impact the Company's third quarter fiscal 1997 results of operations. During fiscal 1996 and the preceding fiscal years, the Company paid federal income taxes based on the Alternative Minimum Tax ("AMT") at an effective tax rate of 2% and minimum taxes in most states due to its utilization of its NOL carryforwards. At the end of fiscal 1996, management determined, based on the Company's results of operations and projected future results, that it was likely that the NOL carryforwards could be utilized in subsequent years to offset tax liabilities. As a result of this determination, the Company reversed a valuation allowance on the Company's deferred tax asset on its balance sheet. Accordingly, the Company's net income for fiscal 1997 and future years will require calculation of a tax provision based on statutory rates in effect. Until the NOL is fully utilized or expires, this tax provision will not be paid in cash (other than to the extent of the federal AMT and state minimum taxes) but will reduce the deferred tax asset on the balance sheet. RESULTS OF OPERATIONS The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, selected statement of operations data expressed as a percentage of net sales:
FISCAL YEAR ENDED SIX MONTHS ENDED ------------------------------------------- ------------------------ JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 3, AUGUST 2, 1995 1996 1997 1996 1997 ------------- ------------- ------------- ----------- ----------- Net sales............................................ 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% Cost of sales........................................ 68.8 68.4 62.4 67.9 67.3 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Gross profit......................................... 31.2 31.6 37.6 32.1 32.7 Selling, general and administrative expenses......... 25.8 25.2 25.2 28.2 26.5 Pre-opening costs.................................... 0.2 0.3 0.7 0.4 1.7 Depreciation and amortization........................ 3.1 2.8 2.8 3.3 3.5 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Operating income..................................... 2.1 3.3 8.9 0.2 1.0 Interest expense, net................................ 1.2 1.6 2.0 2.1 2.5 Other expense, net................................... -- 0.3 0.3 0.7 0.2 ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Income (loss) before income taxes and extraordinary item............................................... 0.9 1.4 6.6 (2.6) (1.7) Income tax provision (benefit)....................... -- -- (14.5) -- (0.7) Extraordinary gain................................... 0.5 -- -- -- -- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- Net income (loss).................................... 1.4% 1.4% 21.1% (2.6)% (1.0 )% ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- ----- -----
SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 2, 1997 COMPARED TO SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 Net sales increased by $16.3 million, or 28.9%, to $72.7 million during the first six months of fiscal 1997 from $56.4 million during the first six months of fiscal 1996. Net sales for the 26 new stores opened and the six stores remodeled during the first six months of fiscal 1997 and for those stores opened or remodeled during fiscal 1996 not yet qualifying as comparable stores contributed $15.2 million of the increase in net sales. During the first six months of fiscal 1997, comparable store sales increased 2.5% and contributed $1.3 million of the increase in net sales. The first six months of fiscal 1997 were compared to a strong first six months of fiscal 1996, in which comparable store sales increased 8.1%. The fiscal 1997 increase in comparable store sales was attributable in part to strength in the Company's big girls', legwear and newborn departments, partially offset by weaker sales in the boys' departments. Net sales were also impacted by the closing of a store during 1996 which contributed $0.2 million to net sales during the first six months of fiscal 1996. 21 Gross profit increased by $5.7 million to $23.8 million during the first six months of fiscal 1997 from $18.1 million during the first six months of fiscal 1996. As a percentage of net sales, gross profit increased to 32.7% in the first six months of fiscal 1997 from 32.1% in the first six months of fiscal 1996. The increase in gross profit as a percentage of net sales was principally due to the leveraging of distribution expenses over a larger store base and increased sales volume. Gross profit was also favorably impacted by a higher initial markup, partially offset by higher markdowns in the boys' departments. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased by $3.4 million to $19.3 million during the first six months of fiscal 1997 from $15.9 million during the first six months of fiscal 1996, but decreased as a percentage of net sales to 26.5% in the first six months of fiscal 1997 from 28.2% in the first six months of fiscal 1996. The decrease as a percentage of net sales was primarily due to a reduction in store payroll expense as a percentage of net sales and higher average store sales levels which provided greater leverage of store expenses. The increased sales base also offset the increased investment in the Company's corporate infrastructure to support its planned new store expansion program. During the first six months of fiscal 1997, pre-opening costs were $1.2 million as compared to $0.2 million during the first six months of fiscal 1996, reflecting the opening of 26 new stores in the first six months of fiscal 1997 as compared to four new stores during the first six months of fiscal 1996. Depreciation and amortization amounted to $2.6 million in the first six months of fiscal 1997 as compared to $1.9 million in the comparable prior year period. The increase in depreciation and amortization primarily relates to the increase in the number of stores. Interest expense, net, for the first six months of fiscal 1997 was $1.8 million, or 2.5% of net sales, as compared to $1.2 million, or 2.1% of net sales, in the comparable prior year period. The increase in interest expense was primarily due to interest on the Senior Subordinated Notes, which were outstanding for approximately one month of the prior year period. Other expense, net, for the first six months of fiscal 1997 amounted to $0.1 million, or 0.2% of net sales, as compared to $0.4 million, or 0.7% of net sales, in the comparable prior year period. During the first six months of fiscal 1997, other expenses primarily consisted of an anniversary fee on the Foothill Credit Facility. During the first six months of fiscal 1996, other expenses primarily comprised anniversary and credit agreement amendment fees relating to the Foothill Credit Facility. The Company recorded a net loss before income taxes of $1.2 million during the six months ended August 2, 1997 as compared with a net loss of $1.4 million in the comparable prior year period. As a percentage of net sales, the Company's loss before income taxes decreased to 1.7% during the first six months of fiscal 1997 from 2.6% during the first six months of fiscal 1996 due to the factors discussed above. During the first six months of fiscal 1997, the Company recorded a tax benefit for federal, state and local taxes of $0.5 million, or 0.7% of net sales, which reflected an effective tax rate of approximately 40%. During the first six months of fiscal 1996, the Company recorded a tax provision for state minimum taxes. No federal tax provision was recorded in the first six months of fiscal 1996 due to the Company's NOL. The Company had net losses of $0.7 million and $1.5 million for the first six months of fiscal 1997 and the first six months of fiscal 1996, respectively. YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 1, 1997 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 3, 1996 Net sales increased by $21.8 million, or 17.8%, to $143.8 million during fiscal 1996 from $122.1 million in fiscal 1995. Net sales for the 18 new stores opened and the five stores remodeled during fiscal 1996, and for those stores opened or remodeled during fiscal 1995 not yet qualifying as comparable stores, contributed $17.9 million of the increase in net sales. Comparable store sales, restated to reflect a comparable 52-week period, increased by 8.6% and contributed approximately $8.6 million of the increase 22 in net sales. Comparable store sales increased by 10.0% in fiscal 1995. The increase in comparable store sales reflected the strength of the Company's newborn, underwear and accessory departments. The above increases were offset by the closure of five stores during fiscal 1995 and one store during fiscal 1996, which in the aggregate generated a net sales decrease of $3.5 million in fiscal 1996 as compared to fiscal 1995. In addition, fiscal 1995 was a 53-week year, with the extra week contributing $1.2 million to fiscal 1995 net sales. Gross profit increased by $15.4 million to $54.1 million during fiscal 1996 from $38.6 million during fiscal 1995. As a percentage of net sales, gross profit increased to 37.6% during fiscal 1996 from 31.6% during fiscal 1995. Merchandise margins improved 4.9% from the previous year primarily due to higher initial markups and a reduction in the markdown rate. In addition, the Company's buying, distribution and occupancy expenses decreased as a percentage of net sales due to the increased store base and sales volume. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased by $5.5 million to $36.3 million during fiscal 1996 from $30.8 million during fiscal 1995, but remained constant at 25.2% of net sales in both fiscal years. The $5.5 million increase was primarily due to the operation of an increased number of stores. In addition, there were increased management incentive bonuses, advertising costs and expenses related to the expansion of the real estate and store construction functions to support the Company's growth strategy. However, as a result of the increased store base and sales volume, these additional expenses did not increase selling, general and administrative expenses as a percentage of net sales. During fiscal 1996, pre-opening costs were $1.0 million, or 0.7% of net sales, as compared to $0.3 million, or 0.3% of net sales, during fiscal 1995. The increase in pre-opening costs reflects the opening of 18 stores in fiscal 1996 as compared to nine stores in fiscal 1995. Depreciation and amortization amounted to $4.0 million in fiscal 1996, or 2.8% of net sales, as compared to $3.5 million, or 2.8% of net sales, in fiscal 1995. The increase in depreciation and amortization was primarily due to new stores. Interest expense, net, for fiscal 1996 totaled $2.9 million, or 2.0% of net sales, as compared to $1.9 million, or 1.6% of net sales, in the prior year. The increase in interest expense in fiscal 1996 was due primarily to interest on the Senior Subordinated Notes issued during fiscal 1996, partially offset by reduced borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility and the elimination of interest expense on various loans repaid by the Company with proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement. Other expense, net, for fiscal 1996 amounted to $0.4 million, or 0.3% of net sales, as compared to $0.4 million, or 0.3% of net sales, in fiscal 1995. During fiscal 1996, other expenses consisted primarily of anniversary and credit agreement amendment fees related to the Foothill Credit Facility. During fiscal 1995, other expenses consisted primarily of $0.4 million in fees and related legal and professional costs associated with the Foothill Credit Facility. Income before income taxes and extraordinary items increased by $7.8 million to $9.5 million during fiscal 1996 from $1.7 million during fiscal 1995 and increased to 6.6% of net sales in fiscal 1996 from 1.4% of net sales in fiscal 1995 due to the factors discussed above. During fiscal 1996, the Company recorded an income tax benefit of $20.9 million. This income tax benefit primarily resulted from the reversal of a valuation allowance of $21.0 million on a net deferred tax asset, based on the Company's results of operations in fiscal 1996 and projected future results. For fiscal 1995, the Company recorded a tax provision for state minimum taxes and the federal AMT. No other federal tax provision was recorded by the Company in fiscal 1995 due to its NOL. The Company had net income of $30.4 million and $1.7 million for fiscal 1996 and fiscal 1995, respectively. 23 YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 3, 1996 COMPARED TO YEAR ENDED JANUARY 28, 1995 Net sales increased by $14.1 million, or 13.1%, to $122.1 million during fiscal 1995 from $108.0 million in fiscal 1994. Net sales for the nine new stores opened and the 12 stores remodeled during fiscal 1995, and for those stores opened or remodeled during fiscal 1994 not yet qualifying as comparable stores, contributed $9.0 million of the increase in net sales. Comparable store sales during fiscal 1995 increased by 10.0% and contributed $8.3 million of the increase in net sales. Comparable store sales had increased by 13.2% in fiscal 1994. The fiscal 1995 increase in comparable store sales reflected the strength of the Company's newborn and baby boy and big girl departments along with the expansion of the underwear/ legwear departments. The above increases were offset by the closing of five stores during fiscal 1995 and six stores during fiscal 1994, which in the aggregate generated a net sales decrease of $4.8 million in fiscal 1995 as compared to fiscal 1994. In addition, fiscal 1995 was a 53-week year, with the extra week contributing $1.6 million to fiscal 1995 net sales. Gross profit increased by $4.9 million to $38.6 million during fiscal 1995 from $33.7 million during fiscal 1994. As a percentage of net sales, gross profit increased to 31.6% during fiscal 1995 from 31.2% in fiscal 1994. The increase as a percentage of net sales during fiscal 1995 was attributable to increased leverage of store occupancy costs resulting from the higher sales volume and a higher initial markup, partially offset by a higher markdown rate and increased merchandise design expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased by $2.9 million to $30.8 million during fiscal 1995 from $27.9 million during fiscal 1994, but decreased as a percentage of net sales to 25.2% in fiscal 1995 from 25.8% in fiscal 1994. The increase in selling, general and administrative expenses was primarily due to the increased number of stores in operation and the introduction of the Company's proprietary credit card program. The decrease in selling, general and administrative expenses as a percentage of net sales was primarily the result of improved store payroll productivity and a reduction in corporate overhead expenses as a percentage of net sales due to the Company's larger store base and increased sales volume. During fiscal 1995, pre-opening costs were $0.3 million, or 0.3% of net sales, as compared to $0.2 million, or 0.2% of net sales, in fiscal 1994, reflecting the opening of nine stores in fiscal 1995 as compared to six stores in fiscal 1994. Depreciation and amortization amounted to $3.5 million in fiscal 1995, or 2.8% of net sales, as compared to $3.3 million, or 3.1% of net sales, in fiscal 1994. The increase in depreciation and amortization was primarily due to new and remodeled stores. Interest expense, net, for fiscal 1995 was $1.9 million, or 1.6% of net sales, as compared to $1.3 million, or 1.2% of net sales, in fiscal 1994. The increase in fiscal 1995 interest expense was due primarily to interest on borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility. Other expense, net, for fiscal 1995 amounted to $0.4 million, or 0.3% of net sales. During fiscal 1995, other expenses were comprised primarily of fees and related legal and professional costs associated with the Foothill Credit Facility. Income before income taxes and extraordinary items increased by $0.7 million to $1.7 million during fiscal 1995 from $1.0 million during fiscal 1994 and increased to 1.4% of net sales in fiscal 1995 from 0.9% of net sales in fiscal 1994 due to the factors discussed above. The Company's recorded income tax provision for fiscal 1995 and fiscal 1994 represented a provision for state minimum taxes and the federal AMT. No other federal tax provision was recorded due to the use of the Company's NOL. In fiscal 1994, the Company recorded an extraordinary gain of $0.5 million relating to the forgiveness of debt. The Company had net income of $1.7 million and $1.5 million for fiscal 1995 and fiscal 1994, respectively. 24 LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES During its three most recent fiscal years and the first six months of fiscal 1997, the Company's primary uses of cash have been to finance new store openings, purchase inventory, provide for working capital and make required principal and interest payments on its debt. Until the 1996 Private Placement, the Company met its cash requirements through cash flow from operations, the sale of equity securities and borrowings under its lines of credit. Since the 1996 Private Placement, the Company has been able to meet its cash needs, including those associated with the opening of new stores, principally by using cash flow from operations and borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility. Cash flows provided by operating activities were $1.3 million, $7.7 million and $7.8 million in fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively. During the first six months of fiscal 1996 and 1997, cash flows used in operating activities were $4.5 million and $2.9 million, respectively. The increase in cash flows from operating activities in fiscal 1995 was primarily the result of an increase in accounts payable. In fiscal 1996, cash flows from operating activities increased primarily as a result of an increase in net income, partially offset by a decrease in payables. The decrease in net cash used in operating activities during the first six months of fiscal 1997 was due primarily to an increase in accounts payable partially offset by an increase in inventory resulting from the Company's store expansion program. Cash flows used in investing activities were $2.7 million, $6.9 million and $8.5 million in fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, and $2.8 million and $10.2 million in the first six months of fiscal 1996 and 1997, respectively. Cash flows used in investing activities relate primarily to store openings and remodelings and computer equipment for the Company's executive offices. In fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, the Company opened 6, 9 and 18 stores while remodeling 3, 12 and 5 stores, respectively. In the first six months of fiscal 1996 and 1997, the Company opened 4 and 26 stores while remodeling 5 and 6 stores, respectively. Cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities were $1.2 million, ($0.5) million and $3.5 million in fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, and $7.2 million and $10.2 million in the first six months of fiscal 1996 and 1997, respectively. The decrease in cash flows from financing activities in fiscal 1995 was primarily the result of the net repayments on long-term debt, partially offset by higher borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility and lower payments on obligations under capital leases. In fiscal 1996, cash flows from financing activities increased as a result of the 1996 Private Placement with the SKM Investors and the Noteholder. The net proceeds of the 1996 Private Placement were used to redeem certain outstanding shares of Common Stock, repay existing long-term debt and reduce outstanding borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility. The increase in cash flows from financing activities during the first six months of fiscal 1997 related primarily to the utilization of the Foothill Credit Facility to fund seasonal working capital needs and the Company's store expansion program partially offset in the prior year by the net proceeds resulting from the 1996 Private Placement. The Company has a working capital revolving credit facility with Foothill Capital. As of February 1, 1997, there were no amounts borrowed under the Foothill Credit Facility and, as of August 2, 1997, a total of $12.5 million had been borrowed under the Foothill Credit Facility. In addition, as of February 1, 1997 and August 2, 1997, the Company had outstanding $4.7 million and $7.0 million, respectively, in letters of credit under the Foothill Credit Facility. Availability under the Foothill Credit Facility as of February 1, 1997 and August 2, 1997 was $11.9 million and $5.8 million, respectively. The Company amended its credit facility with Foothill Capital on July 31, 1997 to increase the Foothill Credit Facility from $20.0 million to $30.0 million (including an increase in the sublimit for letters of credit from $10.0 million to $20.0 million). The amount that may be borrowed by the Company under the amended Foothill Credit Facility depends upon the levels of inventory and accounts receivable. Amounts outstanding under the amended facility bear interest at a floating rate equal to the reference rate of Norwest Bank Minnesota N.A. or, at the Company's option, the 30-day LIBOR Rate plus a pre- 25 determined spread. The LIBOR spread is 1 1/2% or 2%, depending upon the Company's financial performance from time to time. Borrowings under the amended facility mature in July 2000 and provide for one year automatic renewal options. The amended Foothill Credit Facility contains certain financial covenants including, among others, the maintenance of minimum levels of tangible net worth, working capital and current ratios, and imposes certain limitations on the Company's annual capital expenditures, as defined in the amended Foothill Credit Facility. Management believes that the Company will be able to comply with the financial covenants contained in the amended facility and does not believe that compliance with these covenants will interfere with its business or the implementation of its growth strategy. Credit extended under the amended Foothill Credit Facility continues to be secured by a first priority security interest in the Company's present and future assets, intellectual property and other general intangibles. In July 1996, the Company consummated the 1996 Private Placement with the SKM Investors and the Noteholder, which resulted in net proceeds to the Company of $37.4 million. These net proceeds were used to repay certain outstanding indebtedness and to redeem certain outstanding shares of Common Stock. The successful completion of the 1996 Private Placement enabled the Company to implement a growth strategy built on opening new stores through the reinvestment of operating cash flow which had previously been dedicated to debt repayment obligations. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--1996 Private Placement." The Company obtained a waiver from Foothill Capital and an amendment from the Noteholder with respect to the capital expenditure limitations for fiscal 1996 under the Foothill Credit Facility and the Senior Subordinated Notes. The waiver and amendment enabled the Company to open additional stores in connection with its expansion. During fiscal 1995, fiscal 1996 and the first six months of fiscal 1997, the Company incurred capital expenditures of $6.9 million, $8.5 million and $10.2 million, respectively. In a typical new store, capital expenditures (net of landlord contribution) approximate $0.2 million. In addition, a new store typically requires a $0.1 million investment in inventory (net of merchandise payables) and other pre-opening expenses. Management anticipates that total capital expenditures in fiscal 1997, relating primarily to new and remodeled stores and ongoing store maintenance programs, will be approximately $15.2 million. Management plans to fund these capital expenditures from cash flow from operations. The Company currently has no material commitments for capital other than the Foothill Credit Facility. The Company expects, however, to enter into a commitment with respect to a new distribution center and corporate headquarters. The Company believes that its current financing arrangements under the Foothill Credit Facility and its anticipated level of internally generated funds will be adequate to fund its capital requirements for at least the next 18 to 24 months. The Company's capital needs consist of working capital expenditures, including inventory and capital expenditures relating to new and remodeled stores, expenditures for computer hardware and software required in connection with the Company's growth, and interest payments on indebtedness. The Company's ability to meet these capital requirements, and its continued need for external financing, will depend on its ability to generate cash from operations and successfully implement its store expansion plans. QUARTERLY RESULTS AND SEASONALITY The Company's quarterly results of operations have fluctuated and are expected to continue to fluctuate materially depending on a variety of factors, including the timing of new store openings and related pre-opening and other startup expenses, net sales contributed by new stores, increases or decreases in comparable store sales, adverse weather conditions, shifts in timing of certain holidays, changes in the Company's merchandise mix and overall economic conditions. The Company's business is also subject to seasonal influences, with heavier concentrations of sales during the holiday and back-to-school seasons. As is the case with many retailers of apparel and related merchandise, the Company typically experiences lower net sales during the first two fiscal quarters and are 26 often lower during the second fiscal quarter than during the first fiscal quarter. The Company has experienced first and second quarter losses in the past and may experience such losses in the future. Because of these fluctuations in net sales and net income (loss), the results of operations of any quarter are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be achieved for a full fiscal year or any future quarter. See "Risk Factors--Fluctuations in Quarterly Results and Seasonality." The following table sets forth certain statement of operations data and operating data for each of the Company's last ten fiscal quarters and the percentage of net sales represented by the line items presented. The quarterly statement of operations data and selected operating data set forth below were derived from unaudited financial statements of the Company and reflect, in the opinion of management, all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments) necessary to present fairly the results of operations for these fiscal quarters.
FISCAL FISCAL 1995 1996 -------------------------------------------------- ------------------------------------- FIRST SECOND THIRD FOURTH FIRST SECOND THIRD QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS) STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA: Net sales........................ $ 25,433 $ 23,181 $ 33,713 $ 39,733 $ 30,438 $ 25,974 $ 40,353 Gross profit..................... 7,224 5,530 11,640 14,232 10,238 7,873 16,976 Operating income (loss).......... (440) (2,423) 3,065 3,860 1,557 (1,438) 6,347 AS A PERCENTAGE OF NET SALES: Gross profit..................... 28.4% 23.9% 34.5% 35.8% 33.6% 30.3% 42.1% Operating income (loss).......... (1.7) (10.5) 9.1 9.7 5.1 (5.5) 15.7 SELECTED OPERATING DATA: Comparable store sales increase (decrease)..................... 25.6% 19.0% 0.8% 3.5% 9.8% 6.2% 8.1% Stores open at end of period..... 90 90 94 91 93 95 104 FISCAL 1997 ------------------------ FOURTH FIRST SECOND QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER ----------- ----------- ----------- STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS DATA: Net sales........................ $ 47,073 $ 39,203 $ 33,534 Gross profit..................... 18,965 14,018 9,802 Operating income (loss).......... 6,336 2,618 (1,922) AS A PERCENTAGE OF NET SALES: Gross profit..................... 40.3% 35.8% 29.2% Operating income (loss).......... 13.5 6.7 (5.7) SELECTED OPERATING DATA: Comparable store sales increase (decrease)..................... 9.7% 5.0% (0.5%) Stores open at end of period..... 108 119 134
27 BUSINESS OVERVIEW The Company is a leading specialty retailer of high quality, value-priced apparel and accessories for newborn to twelve year old children. The Company designs, contracts to manufacture and sells its products under "The Children's Place" brand name. As of September 1, 1997, the Company operated 140 stores, primarily located in regional shopping malls in the eastern half of the United States. The Company's net sales have increased from $96.6 million in fiscal 1993 to $143.8 million in fiscal 1996 and operating income has increased from $1.4 million in fiscal 1993 to $12.8 million in fiscal 1996. In the first six months of fiscal 1997, net sales totaled $72.7 million as compared to $56.4 million in the first six months of fiscal 1996. The Company has achieved comparable store sales increases over prior years of 13.2%, 10.0% and 8.6% during each of fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, and 2.5% in the first six months of fiscal 1997. Net sales per gross square foot have increased from $226 in fiscal 1993 to $335 in fiscal 1996. These increases are primarily the result of a merchandising and operational repositioning of the Company over the last five fiscal years under the direction of the Company's current management team. In fiscal 1996, new stores for which fiscal 1996 was the first full year of operations had average net sales of $1,250,000. The average investment for these new stores, including capital expenditures (net of landlord contribution), initial inventory (net of merchandise payables) and pre-opening costs, was $371,000. New stores have generally achieved profitability within the first full quarter of operations, with average fiscal 1996 store level operating cash flow of approximately $288,000 (23.0% of net sales) for stores for which fiscal 1996 was the first full year of operations. In fiscal 1996, these stores yielded a cash return on investment of 77.6%. In July 1996, following a private financing in which the Company raised $37.4 million of net proceeds, the Company began to implement an aggressive growth strategy designed to capitalize on its business strengths and its strong store economics. From July 1, 1996 through the end of fiscal 1996, the Company opened a total of 16 new stores, growing to 108 stores. During fiscal 1997 through September 1, 1997, the Company has opened 32 stores. The Company intends to continue its expansion program and currently plans to open approximately 15 additional stores during the remainder of fiscal 1997 and at least 60 stores in fiscal 1998. The Company and other children's retailers capitalize on the fact that children typically require new clothes every season, and often more than once within a season. The Company believes that the children's apparel market generated approximately $26.9 billion in retail purchases in calendar 1996. Management estimates that total sales of children's apparel grew at a compound annual rate of approximately 4.6% between calendar 1991 and calendar 1996. In addition, there are approximately four million births in the United States each year. The Company believes that the size and growth of its market, coupled with its business strengths and expansion strategies, should provide significant opportunities for growth in the future. BUSINESS STRENGTHS AND STRATEGY The Company believes that its value-based, proprietary brand business strategy has been and will continue to be the key to its success as a specialty retailer. The following strengths have contributed to the success of the Company's merchandising and operating strategies: UNIQUE PRICE-VALUE POSITIONING. By offering quality clothing and accessories under "The Children's Place" brand name at prices 20% to 30% below most of its direct mall-based competitors, the Company believes that it has built a loyal base of customers who regularly purchase from the Company as their children grow. The Company believes that the value created by the price and quality of its merchandise has enabled it to establish a unique market position. See "--Merchandising" and "--Sourcing and Procurement." 28 MERCHANDISING STRATEGY. The Company's merchandising strategy is built on the offering of key basic items at prices which the Company believes represent exceptional values, complemented by fashion items and accessories to create a fully coordinated look. The Company designs its merchandise to present a fresh and youthful image that management believes is unique to "The Children's Place" brand. See "-- Merchandising" and "--Sourcing and Procurement." STRONG BRAND IMAGE. The Company believes that it has built a strong brand image for "The Children's Place" by (i) selling its products exclusively in its own stores, (ii) creating a uniform appearance in merchandise presentation, (iii) providing a consistent selection of coordinated separates and accessories for children, and (iv) offering high quality products at value prices. The Company believes that these factors foster consumer loyalty to "The Children's Place" brand name. See "--Merchandising" and "--Company Stores." BROAD CONSUMER APPEAL. The Company believes that its high-quality merchandise assortment, offered at "everyday value prices" so that customers need not wait for special sales, enable it to appeal to a broad range of consumers across all socioeconomic groups and to compete successfully in a wide range of regional shopping malls, outlet centers and other locations. See "--Merchandising--Everyday Value Pricing" and "--Company Stores." VERTICALLY INTEGRATED OPERATIONS. The Company controls the design, sourcing and sale of its private label children's apparel and accessories. The Company believes that the vertical integration of its operations, from in-house design to in-store presentation, enables the Company to identify and respond to market trends, uphold rigorous product quality standards and control the cost of its merchandise. See "--Merchandising" and "--Company Stores." EXPERT SOURCING. The Company combines management's extensive sourcing experience with a cost-based buying strategy. Management has established close, long-standing and mutually beneficial relationships with numerous manufacturers. Through these relationships and its extensive knowledge of component costs of apparel, the Company believes that it has been able to purchase high quality products at low costs. See "--Merchandising" and "--Sourcing and Procurement." PROVEN MANAGEMENT TEAM. The Company has a seasoned, highly experienced management team, with its 12 most senior members having an average of 17 years in the retail and/or apparel business and an average of eight years with the Company. The Company believes that management's substantial experience favorably positions the Company for future expansion. See "Management." MERCHANDISING MERCHANDISE OFFERING. The Company's merchandise is divided into four divisions--girlswear, boyswear, newborn and accessories. The Company's merchandise offers a balanced assortment of styles in fashionable colors and patterns, with the aim of consistently creating a fresh, youthful look that the Company believes is unique to "The Children's Place" brand. Each year the Company presents four major seasonal lines (spring, summer, back-to-school, holiday) and two transitional lines. Within each season, the Company offers a fresh assortment of coordinated basic and fashion apparel with complementary accessories designed to encourage multiple item purchases. EVERYDAY VALUE PRICING. The Company's pricing strategy is to set prices that the Company believes provide value to its customers and are below those of comparable quality products sold by most of its direct mall-based competitors. The Company employs this everyday value pricing strategy to attract and retain customers by allowing customers to make purchases without having to wait for special sales. The Company's mark-down policy is to systematically reduce prices on slow-moving merchandise. MERCHANDISE EXPANSION STRATEGY. The Company periodically evaluates opportunities for selective product extensions. In fiscal 1997, the Company introduced a new layette line and expanded its big boy and big 29 girl departments to include size 16. The Company expects to continue to seek opportunities to expand its customer base and enhance the productivity of its stores through further development of existing merchandise categories and the continued introduction of new merchandise classifications. DESIGN AND PRODUCT DEVELOPMENT. Each of the Company's seasonal lines begins with the compilation of market intelligence regarding fashion trends approximately nine months before the season, through extensive European and domestic market research, the purchase of prototype samples, media, trade shows, fashion magazines, the services of fashion and color forecast organizations and analysis of prior season performance. Potential items are designed using computer aided design ("CAD") technology, giving the Company the opportunity to consider a wide range of style and fashion options. PLANNING AND ALLOCATION. The merchandise planning team creates a detailed purchasing plan for each season covering each department, each category and each key basic item, based on historical and current selling trends. The Company typically orders 90% of the purchasing plan five months before the season, saving 10% to respond quickly to new fashion trends and reorders of key basic items. The production process takes approximately four to five months from order confirmation to receipt of merchandise at the Company's distribution facility. The merchandise planning team also monitors current and future inventory levels on a weekly basis and analyzes sales patterns to predict future demand for various categories. The Company regularly monitors sales of each style and color and maintains some flexibility to adjust merchandise on order for future seasons or to accelerate delivery of merchandise. The merchandise planning team is also responsible for planning and allocating merchandise to each store based on sales volume levels for each department, category and key basic item and other factors. See "Risk Factors-- Merchandise Trends." SOURCING AND PROCUREMENT After a product line is conceptualized and purchase levels are determined, the Company's sourcing team makes on-site visits to the Company's independent agents and various manufacturers to negotiate product costs and arrange delivery of merchandise manufactured to the Company's specifications. COST-BASED BUYING. The Company combines management's extensive sourcing experience with a cost-based buying strategy in order to lower costs and increase margins. Management believes it has a thorough understanding of the economics of apparel manufacturing, enabling the Company to determine the most cost-effective country and manufacturer from which to source each particular item. Relying on its supplier relationships and management's knowledge of component costs, the Company believes it has been able to arrange for the manufacture of high quality products at low cost. One important aspect of the Company's sourcing strategy is that its Chief Executive Officer, Ezra Dabah, who has over 25 years of merchandising, apparel and buying experience, frequently travels to meet with the Company's agents and manufacturers. MANUFACTURERS. The Company's apparel is produced to its specifications by more than 50 independent manufacturers located primarily in the Far East and elsewhere in Asia. In fiscal 1996, the majority of the Company's merchandise was produced in Taiwan and Hong Kong. The remainder of the Company's merchandise was produced in Turkey, China, the United States and certain other countries. To broaden its sourcing base, the Company also has begun to source from manufacturers located in lower cost markets, such as the Philippines, Thailand and Sri Lanka. These three markets accounted for approximately 12% of the Company's total purchases in fiscal 1996, as compared to approximately 6% in fiscal 1995. The Company has no exclusive or long-term contracts with its manufacturers and typically transacts business on an item-by-item basis under purchase orders at freight on board ("FOB") cost in United States dollars. The Company purchases merchandise through a Hong Kong-based trading company, with which the Company has no formal written agreement, for most of its procurements from manufacturers located in China, Hong Kong and the Philippines. In addition, the Company has entered into agreements with commissioned independent agents elsewhere in the Far East and in Turkey to assist in sourcing and pre- 30 production approval, production, inspection and ensuring timely delivery of merchandise. The Company has developed long-term, continuous relationships with key individual manufacturers and raw material suppliers which management believes have yielded numerous benefits, including quality control and favorable costs, and have afforded it flexible working arrangements and a steady flow of merchandise supply. In addition, although they are not contractually obligated to do so, the Hong Kong-based trading company and a commissioned independent agent in Taiwan each have exclusive arrangements with the Company. See "Risk Factors--Dependence on Unaffiliated Manufacturers and Independent Agents." SYSTEMS. The Company employs a work-in-process tracking system that enables it to anticipate potential delivery delays and take action to mitigate the impact of such delays. By using this system together with the Company's purchase order and advanced shipping notification systems, the Company and its independent agents actively monitor the status of each purchase order from order confirmation to merchandise receipt. The Company has experienced occasional shipment delays, but no such delay has had a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company is pursuing software technologies to further enhance communication of the production and pre-approval status of its work-in-process directly from its overseas agents. QUALITY ASSURANCE. To ensure quality and promote consumer confidence in "The Children's Place" products, the Company utilizes its own, in-house quality assurance laboratory to test and evaluate all fabric and trimming materials against a comprehensive range of physical performance standards before bulk production can begin. The Company's director of quality control and/or the quality control personnel of the Company's independent agents visit the various manufacturing facilities to monitor and improve the quality control and production process. With this focus on pre-production quality approval, the Company is generally able to detect and correct quality related problems before bulk production begins. The Company does not accept its finished apparel products until each purchase order receives formal certification of compliance from its agents' inspectors. 31 COMPANY STORES EXISTING STORES. As of September 1, 1997, the Company operated 140 stores, all of which are located in the eastern half of the United States. Most of the Company's stores are clustered in and around major metropolitan areas. The Company's stores are concentrated in major regional malls, with the exception of seven outlet stores and two urban street stores. The map and store list below set forth by state and city the number and location of stores operated by the Company: [The Prospectus contains a graphic of a Map of the United States which sets forth the number of stores operated by the Company in each state in which it has stores.] CONNECTICUT-6 INDIANA-6 MASSACHUSETTS-13 NEW HAMPSHIRE-3 NEW YORK-26 OHIO-6 Danbury Merrillville N. Attleboro Salem Rochester (3) Columbus (2) Manchester Lafayette Kingston Manchester Buffalo Dayton Meriden Ft. Wayne East Taunton Nashua Syracuse (2) Cincinnati (3) Waterford Greenwood Braintree Albany Trumbull Indianapolis Natick NEW JERSEY-19 Niagara Falls PENNSYLVANIA-12 West Hartford Evansville Saugus E. Brunswick Garden City Springfield Worcester Deptford White Plains Willow Grove DELAWARE-2 KENTUCKY-1 Marlborough Princeton Huntington Station Philadelphia (4) Newark Florence Burlington Freehold Valley Stream Exton Wilmington Watertown Lawrenceville Massapequa North Wales MAINE-2 Peabody Eatontown Lake Grove Langhorne FLORIDA-1 Kittery Cambridge Cherry Hill Bay Shore King of Prussia Coral Springs S. Portland Holyoke Mays Landing Riverhead York Wayne New York (7) Pittsburgh ILLINOIS-13 MARYLAND-9 MICHIGAN-7 Paramus (2) Yorktown Heights Vernon Hills Gaithersburg Grand Rapids Woodbridge Middletown SOUTH CAROLINA-1 Bloomingdale Baltimore Novi Rockaway Nanuet Myrtle Beach Norridge Columbia Dearborn Livingston N. Riverside Parkville Troy Secaucus NORTH CAROLINA-3 TENNESSEE-1 Lincolnwood Annapolis Sterling Heights Jersey City Winston-Salem Nashville St. Charles Owings Mills Harper Woods Bridgewater Raleigh Schaumburg Waldorf Portage Voorhees Greensboro VIRGINIA-5 Orland Park Glen Burnie Toms River Fairfax Gurnee Towson MINNESOTA-4 Virginia Beach Chicago Bloomington Richmond Calumet City Maplewood Winchester Aurora Minnetonka Woodbridge West Dundee Burnsville
32 STORE ENVIRONMENT. The Company's prototype store measures approximately 3,500 square feet and features a design that incorporates light maple wood floors, fixtures and trim set against a white color scheme, accented by the hunter green used in the Company's logo. The Company believes that the environment created by its "apple-maple" prototype store promotes a shopping experience that is inviting and friendly. The store is brightly lit, featuring floor-to-ceiling glass windows that allow the Company's colorful fashions to attract customers from the outside. A customized grid system throughout the store's upper perimeter displays featured merchandise, marketing photographs and key basic item prices. Suspended signs direct customers to departments within the store where each merchandise line is displayed as a separate collection of coordinated basic and fashion items, with matching accessories. The Company believes that its merchandise presentation effectively displays "The Children's Place" look and creates a visually attractive selling environment that maximizes customer convenience and encourages the purchase of multiple items. To achieve uniform merchandise presentation and to maximize sales of coordinating items, store management is provided with detailed written and visual store plans that specify merchandise placement. Standardization of store design and merchandise presentation also promotes effective usage and productivity of selling space and maximizes customer convenience in merchandise selection. By seeking a uniform appearance in store design and merchandise presentation, the Company believes that it is able to maintain and enhance "The Children's Place" brand image. As of September 1, 1997, approximately 75% of the Company's stores (excluding outlet stores) are based on the new "apple-maple" prototype. The Company generally remodels its stores to the new prototype specifications as their leases are renewed. In many cases, conversion to the new prototype involves relocation within a mall as well as a significant reduction in space. STORE OPERATIONS. The Company's store operations are directed by the Company's Vice President of Store Operations, three regional managers and 15 district managers. Individual stores are managed by a store manager and up to three co-managers depending on sales volume. A typical store employs a number of full time and part time sales associates, and hires additional part time associates based on seasonal needs. Regional and district managers spend a majority of their work week on store selling floors, providing direction, motivation, training and support to field personnel. Store managers are responsible for supervising customer service, store presentation, staff scheduling, shrinkage control and seeing that the store achieves its planned sales goals. Customer service is a major focus for store management and sales associates, and continuing efforts are made to maximize selling productivity. The Company engages in an ongoing process of training management and sales associates in the areas of customer service, selling skills, merchandising, procedures and controls, utilizing visual aids, training manuals and training workshops. Management maintains a high level of communication between the central office and stores. Frequent downloads through the POS registers, biweekly mail packs to each store, voicemail and district manager conference calls augment the frequent store visits by the regional and district managers. In addition, quarterly home office and district manager meetings engender a strong team culture. The Company is continuing to improve the communication between the central office and its stores with the use of new technology. STORE EXPANSION PROGRAM In mid-1996, the Company began implementing an aggressive growth strategy designed to capitalize on its business strengths and its strong store economics. From July 1, 1996 to the end of fiscal 1996, the Company opened 16 stores. During fiscal 1997 through September 1, 1997, the Company has opened 32 stores. The Company intends to continue its store expansion program and currently plans to open 33 approximately 15 additional stores during the remainder of fiscal 1997 and at least 60 stores in fiscal 1998. The Company believes that its value pricing and its merchandise assortment appeal to customers in all socioeconomic groups, affording it substantial expansion opportunities. There are hundreds of regional malls, street locations and outlet centers in the United States that the Company believes would be suitable sites for the Company's stores. The Company's expansion strategy focuses primarily on mall-based locations. The regional malls which the Company targets are typically high volume centers, generally measuring one million square feet or more, having at least three department stores or other anchor tenants and various specialty retailers, as well as several entertainment features (such as restaurants, a food court and/or movie theaters). The Company conducts extensive analyses of potential store sites, taking into account the performance of other specialty retail tenants, the existing anchor stores and other stores, the size, type and average sales per square foot of the mall and the demographics of the surrounding area. The most important consideration for the Company in evaluating a store location within a mall is placement of the store relative to mall traffic patterns. In addition, the Company continuously evaluates opportunities to add stores in other types of locations, such as outlet centers and urban street locations. The Company intends to focus its expansion by establishing clusters of stores in states in which it already has stores or in contiguous states in order to strengthen "The Children's Place" brand name recognition. See "Risk Factors--Aggressive Growth Strategy." MARKETING ADVERTISING AND PROMOTION. The Company strives to enhance its reputation and image in the marketplace and build recognition and equity in "The Children's Place" brand name by advertising its image, product and message through in-store photographs and product displays, direct mail and, to a lesser extent, regional and national print media. The Company's point of purchase marketing strategy uses high image visuals to highlight the individual departments and seasonal fashion looks, promoting key basic items at price points representing exceptional value, and focusing on store-front and window displays to attract customers into the stores. The Company primarily relies on mall-based traffic and its reputation, loyal customer base and brand image to generate sales. Moreover, instead of relying on special holiday or one-day promotions to stimulate sales, the Company relies on its everyday value pricing strategy to attract customers. To encourage larger purchases, the Company periodically distributes coupons providing a discount on purchases above a specified minimum. PROPRIETARY CREDIT CARD. The Company views the use of a proprietary credit card as an important marketing and communication tool and introduced "The Children's Place" credit card in January 1995. Pursuant to a merchant services agreement with the Company, Hurley State Bank issues to the Company's customers private label credit cards for use exclusively at the Company's stores and extends credit to such customers. Hurley State Bank's agent, SPS, administers the approval, issuance and administration of the credit card program. For these services, the Company pays to Hurley State Bank a merchant fee which is calculated as a percentage of sales under the credit card. The number of holders of the Company's proprietary credit card has grown to over 250,000, and these customers accounted for approximately 15% of the Company's fiscal 1996 net sales. The Company believes that its proprietary credit card promotes affinity and loyalty among those customers who use the card and facilitates communication with such customers through delivery of coupons and promotional materials. The Company markets its proprietary credit card by offering customers who apply for a card a 15% discount on their initial purchase using the card. The Company's average dollar sale to customers using "The Children's Place" card has been substantially higher than the Company's overall average dollar sale. The Company's credit card operations are conducted through a third party credit card service. See "Risk Factors--Proprietary Credit Card." 34 MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEMS The Company's management information and electronic data processing systems consist of a full range of retail, financial and merchandising systems, including purchase order management, importing, inventory planning and control, inventory distribution, sales reporting and accounts payable. These systems operate on a Hitachi EX/27 platform mainframe computer and utilize a combination of third party and proprietary software packages. Management views technology as an important tool in efficiently supporting its rapid growth and maintaining a competitive industry position. Unit and dollar sales information is updated daily in the merchandise reporting systems by polling each store's POS terminals. Through automated nightly two-way electronic communication with each store, sales information, payroll hours and other store initiated transfers are uploaded to the host system, and price changes and other information are downloaded through the POS devices. Information obtained from such daily polling generally results in automatic merchandise replenishment in response to the specific stock keeping unit ("SKU") requirements of each store. The Company evaluates information obtained through daily reporting to identify sales trends and to implement merchandising decisions regarding markdowns and allocation of merchandise. The Company is committed to utilizing technology to further enhance its competitive position. In this regard, the Company is scheduled to install a warehouse management system during fiscal 1998 in connection with the planned relocation of its distribution center. The Company also intends to replace its POS software during fiscal 1998 to enhance customer service and communication between the Company's central office and its stores. See "Risk Factors--Reliance on Information Systems." DISTRIBUTION All merchandise is currently received, inspected, processed and distributed through the Company's 65,000 square foot leased distribution facility at its headquarters in West Caldwell, New Jersey. In light of its stringent quality assurance procedures implemented during the manufacturing process, the Company has been able to substantially reduce the physical inspection of garments received at the distribution facility. Accordingly, most merchandise "flows through" within one business day of its receipt at the distribution facility and is shipped directly to stores each weekday by commercial carrier, reducing costs and expediting delivery to the Company's stores. The Company has experienced occasional shipment delays, but no such delay has had a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company intends to move its distribution center to a larger facility during fiscal 1998 to accommodate the Company's continued growth and is evaluating suitable sites for, and whether to purchase or lease, such new facility. See "Risk Factors--Disruptions in Receiving and Distribution." COMPETITION The children's apparel retail business is highly competitive. The Company competes in substantially all of its markets with GapKids, BabyGap and Old Navy (each of which is a division of The Gap, Inc.), The Gymboree Corporation, Limited Too (a division of The Limited, Inc.), J.C. Penney Company, Inc., Sears, Roebuck and Co. and other department stores that sell children's apparel and accessories, as well as certain discount stores such as Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. and Kids "R" Us (a division of Toys "R" Us, Inc.). The Company also competes with a wide variety of local and regional specialty stores and with other national retail chains and catalog companies. One or more of its competitors are present in substantially all of the malls in which the Company has stores. Many of the Company's competitors are larger than the Company or have access to significantly greater financial, marketing and other resources than the Company. The Company believes that the principal factors of competition in the Company's marketplace are perceived value, price, quality, merchandise assortment, brand name recognition, customer service, and a friendly store environment. Management believes that the Company has been able to effectively compete 35 against other retailers of children's apparel because of its reputation in the marketplace and consistent merchandise offering of high quality, everyday value-priced childrenswear, sold in a friendly environment. See "Risk Factors--Competition." TRADEMARKS AND SERVICE MARK Each of "The Children's Place," "Baby Place," "The Place," "TCP" and "Authentic Tiny Tee" has been registered as a trademark and/or a service mark with the United States Patent and Trademark Office. The registration of the trademarks and the service marks may be renewed to extend the original registration period indefinitely, provided the marks are still in use. The Company intends to continue to use and protect its trademarks and service marks and maintain their registrations. The Company also intends to take action to protect its trademarks in certain foreign countries. The Company believes its trademarks and service marks have received broad recognition and are of significant value to the Company's business. PROPERTIES The Company's executive offices and distribution center are located in West Caldwell, New Jersey, and are occupied under the terms of a lease covering approximately 91,000 square feet. The Company expects to relocate its offices and distribution center during fiscal 1998 but may continue to be obligated on its current lease until its expiration in March 1999. Many of the Company's store leases contain provisions requiring landlord consent to a change in control of the Company. Such provisions may be triggered by this offering or future offerings of securities by the Company. However, the Company believes that because of its good relations with its landlords and because most of its leases are at market rents, these provisions should not have a material adverse effect on the Company. All of the Company's existing store locations are leased by the Company, with lease terms expiring between 1998 and 2008 and with an average unexpired lease term of 7.5 years. The leases for most of the existing stores are for terms of ten years and provide for contingent rent based upon a percent of sales in excess of specified minimums. Leases for future stores will likely include similar contingent rent provisions. For a map and list of the geographic locations of the Company's existing stores, see "--Company Stores-- Existing Stores." EMPLOYEES As of August 2, 1997, the Company had approximately 680 full-time employees, of whom approximately 180 are based at the Company's headquarters and distribution center, and approximately 1,370 part-time employees. None of the Company's employees is covered by a collective bargaining agreement. The Company believes its relations with its employees are good. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS The Company is involved in various legal proceedings from time to time incidental to the conduct of its business. In the opinion of management, any ultimate liability arising out of such proceedings will not have a material adverse effect on the financial condition or results of operations of the Company. 36 MANAGEMENT DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the executive officers and directors of the Company:
NAME AGE POSITION - ------------------------------------------ ----------- --------------------------------------------------------------- Ezra Dabah................................ 44 Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer Stanley B. Silver......................... 59 President, Chief Operating Officer and Director Seth L. Udasin............................ 41 Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer Steven Balasiano.......................... 34 Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary Mario A. Ciampi........................... 37 Vice President -- Real Estate & Construction Ed DeMartino.............................. 46 Vice President -- Management Information Systems Robert Finkelstein........................ 45 Vice President -- Merchandising Planning and Allocation Nina L. Miner............................. 48 Vice President -- Design and Product Development Salvatore W. Pepitone..................... 50 Vice President -- Distribution Center Mark L. Rose.............................. 32 Vice President -- Sourcing and Production Susan F. Schiller......................... 36 Vice President -- Store Operations Diane M. Timbanard........................ 52 Vice President -- Merchandising Manager Stanley Silverstein....................... 72 Director John F. Megrue............................ 39 Director David J. Oddi............................. 27 Director
EZRA DABAH has been Chief Executive Officer of the Company since 1991 and Chairman of the Board and a Director since purchasing the Company in 1989 with certain members of his family. Mr. Dabah has more than 25 years of apparel merchandising and buying experience. From 1972 to May 1993, Mr. Dabah was a director and an executive officer of The Gitano Group, Inc. and its affiliates (collectively, "Gitano"), a company of which Mr. Dabah and certain members of his family were principal stockholders and which became a public company in 1988. From 1973 until 1983, Mr. Dabah was in charge of product design, merchandising and procurement for Gitano. In 1983, Mr. Dabah founded and became President of a children's apparel importing and manufacturing division for Gitano which later became an incorporated subsidiary, Eva Joia Incorporated. Mr. Dabah is Stanley Silverstein's son-in-law and Nina Miner's brother-in-law. See "Certain Relationships and Related Transactions--Dabah Family and Gitano Legal Proceedings" for information concerning certain legal proceedings involving Mr. Dabah. STANLEY B. SILVER has been President and Chief Operating Officer of the Company since June 1996 and prior to that served as the Company's Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer since joining the Company in 1991. Mr. Silver has been a Director of the Company since July 1, 1996. Before joining the Company in 1991, Mr. Silver held various posts at Grand Met PLC and Mothercare PLC in the United Kingdom and The Limited, Inc. in the United States. Mr. Silver has over 25 years of retailing experience in Europe and the United States and currently serves as Chairman of the Retail Council of New York State. SETH L. UDASIN has been Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer since 1996. Since joining the Company in 1983, Mr. Udasin has held various other positions, including Controller from 1988 to 1994 and Vice President -- Finance from 1994 to 1996. STEVEN BALASIANO has been Vice President and General Counsel since joining the Company in December 1995 and Secretary since January 1996. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Balasiano practiced law in the New York offices of the national law firms of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP from 1992 to 1995 and Kelley Drye & Warren from 1987 to 1992. 37 MARIO A. CIAMPI has been Vice President -- Real Estate and Construction since joining the Company in June 1996. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Ciampi was a principal of a private consulting firm, specializing in retail and real estate restructuring, from 1991 to 1996, in which capacity he was retained as an outside consultant on the Company's real estate activities since 1991. ED DEMARTINO has been Vice President -- Management Information Systems since 1991. Mr. DeMartino began his career with the Company in 1981 as a System Development Project Manager and was subsequently promoted to Director -- MIS in 1989. ROBERT FINKELSTEIN joined the Company in 1989 as Vice President -- Merchandise Planning and Allocation. Immediately prior to joining the Company, Mr. Finkelstein was a Director of Distribution for Payless Shoe Stores. NINA L. MINER has been Vice President -- Design and Product Development since joining the Company in 1991. Before joining the Company, Ms. Miner held various management positions at E.J. Gitano. Ms. Miner is Stanley Silverstein's daughter and Ezra Dabah's sister-in-law. SALVATORE W. PEPITONE has been Vice President -- Distribution Center since joining the Company in 1991. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Pepitone was employed in a similar capacity by E.J. Gitano. MARK L. ROSE has been Vice President -- Sourcing and Production since 1992. Mr. Rose joined the Company in 1990 and was promoted to Senior Product Buyer that year. Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Rose held various positions at Macy's. SUSAN F. SCHILLER has been Vice President -- Store Operations since 1994. Ms. Schiller began her career with the Company as an Assistant Store Manager in 1985 and subsequently served in various positions, including Director of Store Communications from 1991 to 1993 and Director of Store Operations from 1993 to 1994. DIANE M. TIMBANARD has been Vice President -- Merchandising Manager since joining the Company in 1990. Prior to joining the Company, Ms. Timbanard held various merchandising and management positions, including Vice President of Merchandising for Macy's. STANLEY SILVERSTEIN has been a Director of the Company since July 1, 1996. Mr. Silverstein also serves as Chairman of the Board of Directors of Nina Footwear, a company he founded with his brother in 1952. Mr. Silverstein is Nina Miner's father and Ezra Dabah's father-in-law. JOHN F. MEGRUE has been a Director of the Company since July 1996. Mr. Megrue has been a partner of SKM Partners, L.P., which serves as the general partner of SKM and the SK Funds, since 1992. From 1989 to 1992, Mr. Megrue was a Vice President and Principal at Patricof & Co. and prior thereto he served as a Vice President at C.M. Diker Associates. Mr. Megrue also serves as Vice Chairman of the Board and Director of Dollar Tree Stores, Inc. and Chairman of the Board and Director of Hibbett Sporting Goods, Inc. DAVID J. ODDI has been a Director of the Company since April 1997. Mr. Oddi joined SKM as an Associate in 1994 and is currently a Principal of SKM. Prior to joining SKM, Mr. Oddi was a financial analyst in the Leveraged Finance Group at Salomon Brothers Inc. 38 EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION The following table summarizes the compensation for fiscal 1996 for the Company's Chief Executive Officer and each of its four other most highly compensated executive officers: SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
LONG-TERM COMPENSATION(2) ANNUAL COMPENSATION(1) ---------------- ALL OTHER SECURITIES COMPENSATION ---------------------- UNDERLYING ------------- NAME AND PRINCIPAL POSITION SALARY($) BONUS($) OPTIONS(#) ($) - ----------------------------------------------------- ---------- ---------- ---------------- ------------- Ezra Dabah........................................... $ 490,403 $ 383,604 0 $ 708(3) Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer Stanley B. Silver.................................... $ 325,778 $ 203,934 249,000 $ 133,980(4) President and Chief Operating Officer Diane M. Timbanard................................... $ 228,846 $ 89,396 99,600 $ 590(3) Vice President -- Merchandising Manager Nina L. Miner........................................ $ 191,461 $ 77,957 149,400 $ 456(3) Vice President -- Design and Product Development Mark L. Rose......................................... $ 173,634 $ 68,544 149,400 $ 647(3) Vice President -- Sourcing and Production
- ------------------------ (1) Includes bonuses earned in fiscal 1996, portions of which were paid in fiscal 1997. Other annual compensation did not exceed $50,000 or 10% of the total salary and bonus for any of the named executive officers. (2) Each of the options granted becomes exercisable at the rate of 20% on or after six months following the date of grant and 20% on or after each of the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant. See "--Stock Option and Other Plans for Employees--Stock Option Plans." (3) Amounts shown consist of the Company's matching contributions under The Children's Place 401(k) Savings and Investment Plan. (4) Reflects the value of (i) the purchase for $50,000, of shares of Common Stock valued at approximately $173,600 at the time of purchase, pursuant to an exercise of an option, and (ii) insurance premiums of $10,380 paid by the Company with respect to term life insurance for the benefit of Mr. Silver. 39 OPTIONS GRANTED IN LAST FISCAL YEAR The following table sets forth certain information concerning options granted during fiscal 1996 to each executive officer named in the Summary Compensation Table. To date, no options have been exercised.
POTENTIAL REALIZABLE VALUE AT ASSUMED ANNUAL RATES OF STOCK NUMBER OF PRICE APPRECIATION FOR SECURITIES % OF TOTAL OPTION TERM(3) UNDERLYING OPTIONS GRANTED IN EXERCISE EXPIRATION ------------------------ NAME GRANTED(1) FISCAL 1996 PRICE(2) DATE 5% 10% - ------------------------------ ------------------- ------------- ----------- ----------- ---------- ------------ Ezra Dabah.................... 0 0% $ 0 N/A $ 0 $ 0 Stanley B. Silver............. 249,000 17.2% 2.677 6/28/06 420,400 1,064,262 Diane M. Timbanard............ 99,600 6.9% 2.677 6/28/06 168,160 425,705 Nina L. Miner................. 149,400 10.4% 2.677 6/28/06 252,240 638,557 Mark L. Rose.................. 149,400 10.4% 2.677 6/28/06 252,240 638,557
- ------------------------ (1) Each of the options granted becomes exercisable at the rate of 20% on or after six months following the date of grant and 20% on or after each of the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant. See "--Stock Option and Other Plans for Employees Stock Option Plans." (2) The exercise price was fixed at the date of the grant and represented the fair market value per share of Common Stock on such date. (3) In accordance with the rules of the Commission, the amounts shown on this table represent hypothetical gains that could be achieved for the respective options if exercised at the end of the option term. These gains are based on assumed rates of stock appreciation of 5% and 10% compounded annually from the date the respective options were granted to their expiration date and do not reflect the Company's estimates or projections of future Common Stock prices. The gains shown are net of the option exercise price, but do not include deductions for taxes or other expenses associated with the exercise. Actual gains, if any, on stock option exercises will depend on the future performance of the Common Stock, the option holders' continued employment through the option period, and the date on which the options are exercised. COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS Beginning with the consummation of the offering made hereby, each member of the Company's Board of Directors who is not an officer of the Company or an affiliate of the SKM Investors (any such director, an "Eligible Director") will receive an annual fee of $15,000 for serving on the Board. Such independent directors also will receive $1,000 for each Board or committee meeting attended plus reimbursement of expenses for each such meeting. All directors will be entitled to receive options under the Company's stock option plans. See "-- Stock Option and Other Plans for Employees -- Stock Option Plans." Directors of the Company received no compensation, as directors, during the Company's last fiscal year. COMMITTEES OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS To date, the Company has not had a formal Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors and all compensation-related decisions have been made by the entire Board based upon the recommendations of Messrs. Dabah and Silver. Subsequent to this offering, the Company intends to create a Compensation Committee and an Audit Committee of the Board of Directors. The Company expects that, following the completion of this offering, two independent directors will be elected to the Company's Board of Directors. At least a majority of the members of each of the Audit Committee and the Compensation Committee will be independent directors. 40 EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS The Company is a party to employment agreements with certain executive officers. EZRA DABAH Mr. Dabah's employment agreement (the "Dabah Agreement") provides that he will serve as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company from June 27, 1996 through June 27, 1999, at an initial salary of $480,000 per year, subject to annual review. Mr. Dabah's service after June 27, 1999 shall continue for successive three year periods, subject to termination in accordance with the termination provisions of the Dabah Agreement. Mr. Dabah is also entitled to receive a semi-annual bonus in an amount equal to the product of (x) 50% of his semi-annual base salary multiplied by (y) a pre-determined bonus percentage fixed by the Board of Directors for any stated six-month period of not less than 20% nor more than 200%, based on the Company's performance during such six-month period. The Dabah Agreement also provides for certain insurance and other benefits to be maintained and paid by the Company. The Dabah Agreement provides that if Mr. Dabah's employment is terminated by the Company without cause or for disability, or by Mr. Dabah for good reason or following a change in control (as each such term is defined in the Dabah Agreement), the Company will be required to pay Mr. Dabah three times his base salary then in effect, which amount will be payable within 30 days following his termination. Mr. Dabah also will be entitled to receive any accrued but unpaid bonus compensation and all outstanding stock options under the Company's stock option plans will immediately vest. If Mr. Dabah's employment is terminated for any of the above reasons, the Company also will be required, with certain exceptions, to continue to maintain life insurance, medical benefits and other benefits for Mr. Dabah for three years. The Dabah Agreement also provides that Mr. Dabah will not, with certain exceptions, engage or be engaged in a competing business for a period of five years following termination of his employment. STANLEY B. SILVER Mr. Silver's employment agreement (the "Silver Agreement") provides that he will serve as President and Chief Operating Officer of the Company from June 27, 1996, and that such service shall continue unless terminated in accordance with the termination provisions of the Silver Agreement, at an initial salary of $320,000 per year, subject to annual review. Mr. Silver also is entitled to receive a semi-annual bonus in an amount equal to the product of (x) 40% of his semi-annual base salary multiplied by (y) the pre-determined bonus percentage fixed by the Board of Directors for any stated six-month period of not less than 20% nor more than 200%, based on the Company's performance during such six-month period. The Silver Agreement also provides for certain insurance and other benefits to be maintained and paid by the Company. The Silver Agreement provides that if Mr. Silver's employment is terminated without cause by the Company (as such term is defined in the Silver Agreement), the Company will be required to pay Mr. Silver an amount equal to his base salary then in effect for two years, which amount is payable in equal monthly installments over a two year period following his termination. Mr. Silver will also be entitled to receive any accrued but unpaid bonus compensation and the Company will be required, with certain exceptions, to continue to maintain life insurance, medical benefits and other benefits for Mr. Silver for two years. If Mr. Silver's employment is terminated without cause following a change in control, all outstanding stock options issued to Mr. Silver under the Company's stock option plans shall immediately vest. The Silver Agreement also provides that Mr. Silver will not, with certain exceptions, engage or be engaged in a competing business for a period of two years following termination of his employment. 41 OTHER EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS The Company has also entered into employment agreements with certain of its other executive officers which provide for the payment of severance equal to the officer's salary for a period of six to nine months following any termination without cause. STOCK OPTION AND OTHER PLANS FOR EMPLOYEES STOCK OPTION PLANS The 1996 Stock Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "1996 Plan") was adopted by the Company and approved by the Company's stockholders as of June 28, 1996. All key executive officers of the Company, as determined by a committee consisting of Messrs. Dabah and Silver, were eligible to receive options under the 1996 Plan. A total of 1,743,240 shares were authorized for issuance under the 1996 Plan. Options with respect to all of these shares will have been granted under the 1996 Plan prior to this offering. Effective with this offering, the Board of Directors of the Company will discontinue any future grants of options under the 1996 Plan. The 1997 Stock Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "1997 Plan") was adopted by the Company and approved by the Company's stockholders prior to this offering. The 1996 Plan and the 1997 Plan (collectively, the "Plans") will be administered by a Stock Option Plan Committee of the Company's Board of Directors which solely consists of two or more directors, except that prior to the offering the Plans were administered by a committee consisting of Messrs. Dabah and Silver. All employees and directors of the Company, as may be determined from time to time by the Stock Option Plan Committee, will be eligible to receive options under the 1997 Plan. In addition, Eligible Directors of the Company will automatically receive a limited number of options, as described below. A total of 1,000,000 shares will be authorized for issuance under the 1997 Plan. Not more than 250,000 shares of Common Stock may be the subject of options granted to any individual during any calendar year. Upon consummation of the offering, the Company will grant options with respect to approximately 250,000 shares at exercise prices equal to the initial public offering price to certain eligible employees under the 1997 Plan, none of which will be granted to executive officers. The exercise price of an incentive stock option and a non-qualified stock option is fixed by the Stock Option Plan Committee at the date of grant; however, the exercise price under an incentive stock option must be at least equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock at the date of grant, and 110% of the fair market value of the Common Stock at the date of grant for any incentive stock option granted to any individual who owns more than 10% of the voting power or value of all classes of stock of the Company (a "10% Owner"). Stock options are exercisable for a duration determined by the Stock Option Plan Committee, but in no event more than ten years after the date of grant (or five years after the date of grant in the case of an incentive stock option granted to a 10% Owner). Unless otherwise determined by the Stock Option Plan Committee at the time of grant, options granted under the 1996 Plan are exercisable cumulatively at the rate of 20% on or after six months following the date of grant and 20% on or after each of the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant and options granted under the 1997 Plan will be exercisable cumulatively at the rate of 20% on or after December 31st of the year of grant and 20% on or after each of the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant. The aggregate fair market value (determined at the time the option is granted) of the Common Stock with respect to which incentive stock options are exercisable for the first time by a participant during any calendar year (under all stock option plans of the Company) shall not exceed $100,000; to the extent this limitation is exceeded, such excess options shall be treated as non-qualified stock options for purposes of the Plans and the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"). 42 At the time a stock option is granted, the Stock Option Plan Committee may, in its sole discretion, designate whether the stock option is to be considered an incentive stock option or a non-qualified stock option, except that incentive stock options can be granted only to employees. Stock options granted to employees with no such designation shall be deemed incentive stock options. The 1997 Plan will also provide for automatic grants of non-qualified stock options to Eligible Directors. Upon the consummation of the offering, each Eligible Director will be granted an option to purchase 5,000 shares of Common Stock for a purchase price equal to the initial public offering price. Each Eligible Director who is initially elected to the Board of Directors of the Company following the consummation of the offering will be granted an option to purchase 5,000 shares of Common Stock upon such director's initial election to the Board, for a purchase price equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock on the date of grant. On the last day of each fiscal year of the Company (beginning with the fiscal year commencing on a date following the offering), each Eligible Director will be granted an additional option for 5,000 shares of Common Stock, for a purchase price equal to the fair market value of the Common Stock on the date of grant; provided that any Eligible Director initially elected to the Board during a fiscal year will be granted an option for a prorated portion of 5,000 shares on the last day of the fiscal year during which such person was elected. Each of the foregoing options granted to Eligible Directors will have a duration of ten years and will become exercisable cumulatively at the rate of one-third on or after each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the date of grant. Payment of the purchase price for shares acquired upon the exercise of options may be made by any one or more of the following methods: in cash, by check, by delivery to the Company of shares of Common Stock already owned by the option holder, or by such other method as the Stock Option Plan Committee may permit from time to time, including by furnishing a promissory note to the Company or by a "cashless" exercise method. However, a holder may not use previously owned shares of Common Stock to pay the purchase price under an option, unless the holder has beneficially owned such shares for at least six months. Stock options become immediately exercisable in full upon (i) the holder's retirement at or after age 65, (ii) the holder's disability or death, (iii) a "Change in Control" (as defined in the Plans) or (iv) the occurrence of such special circumstances as in the opinion of the Stock Option Plan Committee merit special consideration. Stock options terminate at the end of three months following the holder's termination of employment or service. This period is extended to one year in the case of the disability or death of the holder and, in the case of death, the stock option is exercisable by the holder's estate. However, stock options terminate immediately upon a holder's termination of employment or service for cause. The options granted under the Plans contain anti-dilution provisions which will automatically adjust the number of shares subject to the option in the event of a stock dividend, split-up, conversion, exchange, reclassification or substitution. In the event of any other change in the corporate structure or outstanding shares of Common Stock, the number of shares and the class of shares available for grants under the 1997 Plan or upon the exercise of any outstanding options granted under either of the Plans shall be adjusted so as to prevent dilution or enlargement of rights. The Company shall obtain such consideration for granting options under the 1997 Plan as the Stock Option Plan Committee in its discretion may request. Each option may be subject to provisions to assure that any exercise or disposition of Common Stock will not violate federal and state securities laws. No option may be granted under the 1997 Plan after the day preceding the tenth anniversary of the adoption of the 1997 Plan. The Board of Directors or the Stock Option Plan Committee may at any time withdraw or amend the Plans and may, with the consent of the affected holder of an outstanding option at any time withdraw or amend the terms and conditions of outstanding options. Any amendment which would increase the 43 maximum number of shares issuable pursuant to the Plans, or to any individual under the 1997 Plan, or change the class of individuals to whom options may be granted, shall be subject to the approval of the stockholders of the Company. 401(K) SAVINGS PLAN The Company has adopted The Children's Place 401(k) Savings and Investment Plan (the "401(k) Plan"), which is intended to be a qualified plan under Sections 401(a) and 401(k) of the Code. Employees of the Company generally are eligible to participate in the 401(k) Plan following the date any such employee attains the age of twenty-one and completes one year of service with the Company. Each participant may elect to defer the receipt of between 1% and 15% of such participant's compensation (a "Deferral Election") and have the Company contribute such compensation to the 401(k) Plan, on such participant's behalf, up to an annual statutory limitation. For 1997, a participant cannot elect to defer more than $9,500. This amount is adjusted by the Secretary of the Treasury to reflect increases in the cost of living. In addition to the contribution made pursuant to each participant's Deferral Election, the Company makes a matching contribution (a "Matching Contribution") in an amount equal to the lesser of 50% of the participant's deferral election or 2.5% of the participant's salary. The Company's Matching Contributions and earnings thereon generally become nonforfeitable upon the participant's completion of five years of service. However, such contributions will become fully vested regardless of years of service if the participant's employment terminates by reason of retirement at or after age 55, disability or death. A participant is always 100% vested in such participant's other benefits under the 401(k) Plan. All of the contributions under the 401(k) Plan are held in trust (the "Trust") and allocated to one or more accounts maintained on behalf of each participant. The Trust is divided into various investment vehicles, one of which will be the Common Stock of the Company. When a participant leaves the employ of the Company for any reason, the participant will be entitled to receive an amount equal to the vested value of such participant's accounts. A participant's benefit will be paid to such participant, or, in the case of his or her death, to such participant's beneficiary, in a lump sum payable in either cash or Common Stock, to the extent that any funds have been invested in Common Stock Fund under the 401(k) Plan. Also, all or a part of certain amounts contributed to the 401(k) Plan may be withdrawn, in the case of financial hardship, or for any reason after age 59 1/2. Finally, a participant may borrow the vested amounts allocated to such participant's account, up to certain specified limits. Interest is payable to the 401(k) Plan on any amounts borrowed. The expenses of administering the 401(k) Plan are paid by the Company. EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN The Company's Board of Directors expects to adopt, and anticipates that the Company's stockholders will approve, The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the "Employee Stock Purchase Plan"). Under the Employee Stock Purchase Plan, a maximum of 360,000 shares of Common Stock may be purchased from the Company by employees through payroll withholding pursuant to offerings under the Employee Stock Purchase Plan, following the consummation of this offering. The purchase price of the Common Stock will be 85% of the fair market value of the Common Stock on the date of the offering commencement or termination, whichever is lower. The Employee Stock Purchase Plan will be established pursuant to the provisions of Section 423 of the Code. All employees of the Company (or of any future subsidiaries of the Company designated by the Compensation Committee), except for employees who own Common Stock of the Company or options on such stock which represent 5% or more of the Common Stock of the Company, will be eligible to participate. The Employee Stock 44 Purchase Plan will be administered by the Compensation Committee. The Compensation Committee shall have discretion to administer, interpret and construe any and all provisions of the Employee Stock Purchase Plan. The Compensation Committee's determinations will be conclusive. In the event of certain corporate transactions or events affecting the Common Stock or structure of the Company, the Compensation Committee may make certain adjustments set forth in the Employee Stock Purchase Plan. The Board may amend, alter or terminate the Plan at any time; provided, however, that stockholder approval will be required for any amendment that would increase the maximum number of shares issuable pursuant to the Employee Stock Purchase Plan and subject to the requirement that no rights under an outstanding option may be impaired by such action without the consent of the holder thereof. The shares of Common Stock which may be purchased pursuant to the Employee Stock Purchase Plan will be made available from authorized but unissued shares of Common Stock or from treasury shares. No employee will be granted any right to purchase Common Stock with a value in excess of $25,000 per year. MANAGEMENT INCENTIVE PLAN The Company has a Management Incentive Plan under which key executives of the Company with significant operating and financial responsibility are eligible to earn seasonal cash incentive compensation payments that are paid twice each year. Prior to the beginning of each six month period, operating income objectives are established by the Compensation Committee. Any objectives set anticipate a "stretch" performance level, and are based on an analysis of historical performance and growth expectations for the business. These objectives and determination of results are based entirely on financial measures. Annual incentive compensation targets established for eligible executives range from 10% to 50% of base salary, as established by the Compensation Committee. Executives earn their target incentive compensation if the Company achieves the established operating income. The amount of incentive compensation paid to executives can range from zero to double their targets, based upon the extent to which operating income objectives are achieved. The minimum level at which an executive would earn any incentive payment, and the level at which an executive would earn the maximum incentive payment of double the target, are established by the Compensation Committee prior to the commencement of each bonus period, and actual payouts are based on a straight-line interpolation based on these minimum and maximum levels and the target operating income objectives. Payouts under the Management Incentive Plan based on fiscal 1996 performance amounted to $1.2 million. COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION During its most recent fiscal year, the Company did not have a formal Compensation Committee. However, Messrs. Dabah and Silver participated in deliberations of the Company's Board of Directors concerning executive officer compensation. See "--Committees of the Board of Directors." LIMITATION OF LIABILITY AND INDEMNIFICATION As permitted by the DGCL, the Company has adopted provisions in its Certificate of Incorporation and ByLaws which eliminate, subject to certain exceptions, the personal liability of directors to the Company and its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of the directors' fiduciary duties. The Certificate of Incorporation and ByLaws also provide for the indemnification of directors and officers of the Company and require the Company to advance expenses to its officers and directors as incurred in connection with proceedings against them for which they may be indemnified. The Company also has entered into agreements to indemnify its directors which are intended to provide the maximum indemnification permitted by the DGCL. These agreements, among other things, indemnify each of the Company's directors for certain expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and settlement amounts incurred by such director in any action or proceeding, including any action by or in the right of the Company, on account of such director's service as a director of the Company. The Company believes that these indemnification provisions are necessary to attract and retain qualified persons as directors. The Company intends to obtain insurance for the benefit of the directors and officers of the Company insuring such persons against certain liabilities, including liabilities under federal and state securities laws. 45 SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT The following table provides information at September 1, 1997, with respect to ownership of Common Stock by (i) each beneficial owner of five percent or more of the Company's Common Stock, (ii) each director of the Company, (iii) each of the Company's five most highly compensated executive officers in fiscal 1996 and (iv) all directors and executive officers as a group. For the purpose of computing the percentage of the shares of Common Stock owned by each person or group listed in this table, any shares not outstanding which are subject to options or warrants exercisable within 60 days after September 1, 1997 have been deemed to be outstanding and owned by such person or group, but have not been deemed to be outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage of the shares of Common Stock owned by any other person. Except as indicated in the footnotes to this table, the persons named in the table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares of Common Stock shown as beneficially owned by them.
SHARES BENEFICIALLY NAME AND ADDRESS OF BENEFICIAL OWNER OWNED PERCENT OF CLASS - ------------------------------------------------------------------------ ------------ -------------------------- BEFORE AFTER OFFERING OFFERING(1) ----------- ------------- The SK Equity Fund, L.P. (2)(3)......................................... 7,659,889 37.5% 31.1% SK Investment Fund, L.P. (2)(3)......................................... 7,659,889 37.5% 31.1% John F. Megrue (2)(3)................................................... 7,659,889 37.5% 31.1% Allan W. Karp (2)(3).................................................... 7,659,889 37.5% 31.1% Thomas A. Saunders III (2)(3)........................................... 7,659,889 37.5% 31.1% Christopher K. Reilly (2)(3)............................................ 7,659,889 37.5% 31.1% David Oddi (2)(4)....................................................... 0 0% 0% Ezra Dabah (5)(6)....................................................... 9,893,400 48.4% 40.2% Stanley B. Silver (5)(7)................................................ 603,600 2.9% 2.4% Stanley Silverstein (5)(8).............................................. 6,249,360 30.6% 25.4% Diane M. Timbanard (9).................................................. 39,840 * * Nina L. Miner (9)....................................................... 59,760 * * Mark L. Rose (9)........................................................ 59,760 * * Nomura Holding America Inc. (10)........................................ 1,992,252 8.9% 0% 2 World Financial Center New York, New York 10281 All Directors and Executive Officers as a Group 19,733,401 94.0% 78.3% (15 persons)(11)......................................................
- ------------------------ * Less than 1%. (1) Does not give effect to the exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment option. The SKM Investors have granted an option to the Underwriters, exercisable during the 30-day period after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to an aggregate of 600,000 shares of Common Stock, solely to cover over-allotments, if any. If such option is exercised in full, the SKM Investors will own 7,059,889 shares, or 28.7% of the Common Stock. Of the 600,000 shares to be sold if the over-allotment option is exercised in full, 584,221 shares are to be sold by The SK Equity Fund, L.P., 8,468 shares are to be sold by SK Investment Fund, L.P. and 7,311 shares are to be sold by a former consultant to SKM. (2) The address of this person is Two Greenwich Plaza, Suite 100, Greenwich, CT 06830. (3) Includes (i) 7,458,445 shares owned by The SK Equity Fund, L.P., (ii) 108,108 shares owned by SK Investment Fund, L.P. and (iii) 93,336 shares owned by a former consultant to SKM, as to which The SK Equity Fund, L.P. has certain rights. SKM Partners, L.P. is the general partner of each of The SK 46 Equity Fund, L.P. and SK Investment Fund, L.P. Messrs. Karp, Megrue, Reilly and Saunders are general partners of SKM Partners, L.P., and therefore may be deemed to have beneficial ownership of the shares shown as being owned by the SK Funds. Messrs. Karp, Megrue, Reilly and Saunders disclaim beneficial ownership of such shares, except to the extent that any of them has a limited partnership interest in SK Investment Fund, L.P. (4) Does not include shares owned by The SK Equity Fund, L.P. or SK Investment Fund, L.P. Mr. Oddi is a principal of SKM and has a limited partnership interest in SK Investment Fund, L.P. (5) The address of this person is c/o The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc., One Dodge Drive, West Caldwell, New Jersey 07006. (6) Includes (i) 6,549,000 shares held by trusts or custodial accounts for the benefit of Mr. Dabah's children and certain other family members, of which Mr. Dabah or his wife is a trustee or custodian and as to which Mr. Dabah or his wife, as the case may be, has voting control, and as to which shares Mr. Dabah disclaims beneficial ownership, and (ii) 39,600 shares held by Mr. Dabah's wife. Does not include (i) 1,098,480 shares beneficially owned by Stanley Silverstein, Mr. Dabah's father-in-law, (ii) a total of 868,800 shares beneficially owned by other members of Mr. Dabah's family and (iii) 59,760 shares subject to options exercisable within 60 days after September 1, 1997, which are beneficially owned by Nina Miner, Mr. Dabah's sister-in-law. (7) Includes 99,600 shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options exercisable within 60 days of July 17, 1997. (8) Includes 5,150,880 shares held by trusts for the benefit of Mr. Silverstein's children and grandchildren, of which Mr. Silverstein's wife is a trustee, and as to which Mrs. Silverstein has voting control, and as to which shares Mr. Silverstein disclaims beneficial ownership. Does not include (i) 4,742,520 shares beneficially owned by Ezra Dabah, Mr. Silverstein's son-in-law, or Mr. Dabah's wife and (ii) 59,760 shares subject to options exercisable within 60 days after September 1, 1997, which are beneficially owned by Nina Miner, Mr. Silverstein's daughter. (9) Reflects shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options exercisable within 60 days of July 17, 1997. (10) Reflects shares issuable upon exercise of a warrant, which will be repurchased by the Company upon consummation of the offering. (11) Includes shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options exercisable within 60 days of July 17, 1997. After the sale of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby, (i) Ezra Dabah and certain members of his family will own beneficially 11,920,440 shares of the Company's Common Stock, constituting approximately 48.3% of the outstanding Common Stock and (ii) the SKM Investors will own 7,659,889 shares or approximately 31.1% of the outstanding Common Stock (assuming that the underwriters' over-allotment option is not exercised). Pursuant to the Amended Stockholders Agreement described below, the SKM Investors and certain other stockholders, who will own in the aggregate 82.9% of the outstanding Common Stock, have agreed to vote for the election of two nominees of the SKM Investors and three nominees of Ezra Dabah to the Company's Board of Directors. As a result, the SKM Investors and Ezra Dabah will be able to control the election of five of the Company's seven directors. In addition, if the SKM Investors and Mr. Dabah were to vote together, they would be able to determine the outcome of any matter submitted to a vote of the Company's stockholders for approval, including the election of the remaining two directors. See "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management" and "Description of Capital Stock--Certain Certificate of Incorporation Provisions." 47 STOCKHOLDERS AGREEMENT Prior to consummation of this offering, the Company and all of its existing stockholders, who will own in the aggregate 82.9% of the Common Stock immediately after this offering, will enter into an Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement (the "Amended Stockholders Agreement"). The Amended Stockholders Agreement will place certain limitations upon the transfer in privately negotiated transactions of shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by Ezra Dabah, Stanley Silver and the SKM Investors. In addition, the Amended Stockholders Agreement will provide that (i) so long as Ezra Dabah, together with members of his family, beneficially owns shares representing at least 25% of the shares of Common Stock owned by such parties on the date of the Amended Stockholders Agreement, the Company's existing stockholders will be obligated to vote all shares as to which they have voting rights in a manner such that the Board will at all times include three directors nominated by Ezra Dabah and (ii) so long as the SKM Investors beneficially own shares representing at least 25% of the shares of Common Stock owned by such parties on the date of the Amended Stockholders Agreement, the Company's existing stockholders will be obligated to vote all shares as to which they have voting rights in a manner such that the Board will at all times include two directors nominated by the SKM Investors. Nominees for the remaining director positions will be designated by the Company's Board of Directors, subject to the approval of the SKM Investors, which approval may not be unreasonably withheld. Pursuant to the Amended Stockholders Agreement, Ezra Dabah, Stanley Silver and Stanley Silverstein were designated as director nominees by Mr. Dabah and were elected to the Board, and John Megrue and David Oddi were designated as director nominees by the SKM Investors and were elected to the Board. The Amended Stockholders Agreement will provide that so long as the SKM Investors beneficially own shares representing at least 25% of the outstanding Common Stock, the Company will not, without the affirmative vote of at least one director nominated by the SKM Investors, engage in specified types of transactions with certain of its affiliates (not including the SKM Investors), take action to amend the Company's Bylaws or Certificate of Incorporation or increase or decrease the size of the entire Board of Directors. The Amended Stockholders Agreement will also provide that certain specified types of corporate transactions and major corporate actions will require the approval of at least two-thirds of the members of the Board of Directors. Under the terms of the Amended Stockholders Agreement, the rights of any party thereunder will terminate at the time that such party's Common Stock constitutes less than 25% of the shares of Common Stock owned by such party on the date the Amended Stockholders Agreement. All the provisions of the Amended Stockholders Agreement will terminate when no party to the Amended Stockholders Agreement beneficially owns shares representing at least 25% of the outstanding Common Stock owned by such party on the date of the Amended Stockholders Agreement. 48 CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS CERTAIN INDEBTEDNESS On December 28, 1993, the Company agreed to be a co-maker of two installment notes issued as of that date by Ezra Dabah and certain of his family members in connection with their bankruptcy proceedings. Although the Company was a co-maker of the installment notes, the notes expressly provided that they were non-recourse to the Company. The Company agreed to be a co-maker of these installment notes in consideration for the waiver of certain claims in the amount of $20.0 million for repayment of funds previously loaned to the Company by its stockholders. One such installment note, in the principal amount of $2,650,000 ("Note A"), was non-interest bearing and provided for three annual principal payments. Note A was secured by a pledge of shares of the Company's Common Stock held by Ezra Dabah and certain of his family members. Note A was repaid by the Company on July 1, 1996 with a portion of the net proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement. The other installment note, in the principal amount of $2,110,000 ("Note B" and, collectively with Note A, the "Installment Notes"), provided for monthly principal payments of $50,000, commencing November 30, 1995 and continuing through October 31, 1998, with the remaining balance of $310,000 due on November 30, 1998. Interest on Note B accrued at the rate of 5% per annum for the first two years only, of which 3% per annum was payable monthly and the remaining 2% was added to the principal balance, to be paid at final maturity. Note B was secured by a lien on certain personal assets of Ezra Dabah and certain of his family members. The Company repaid Note B on May 28, 1997. Management believes that the transactions described in the preceding paragraph were upon terms and conditions at least as favorable to the Company as could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties. 1996 PRIVATE PLACEMENT In July 1996, the SKM Investors purchased shares of the Company's newly issued Series B Common Stock for an aggregate purchase price of $20.5 million. Under the terms of the Series B Common Stock, such shares were entitled to a liquidation preference over the outstanding Series A Common Stock held by the Company's other stockholders and carried certain special voting and other rights. The shares of Series B Common Stock purchased by the SKM Investors are convertible into 7,659,889 of Common Stock. Such conversion will be effected immediately prior to consummation of the offering made by this Prospectus. Concurrently with the issuance of the Series B Common Stock to the SKM Investors, the Company sold the Senior Subordinated Notes and the Noteholder Warrant to the Noteholder, for a purchase price of $20.0 million. The Company also paid the Noteholder funding and structuring fees in the aggregate amount of $300,000. The Noteholder Warrant expires in 2006 and represents the right to purchase 1,992,252 shares of Common Stock at an exercise price of $2.677 per share, which is equal to the per share purchase price paid by the SKM Investors. The Senior Subordinated Notes are governed by the terms of a note and warrant purchase agreement which provides for certain operating restrictions and financial covenants. Upon consummation of this offering, the Senior Subordinated Notes will be repaid in full at 100% of their principal amount and the Company will repurchase the Noteholder Warrant for an aggregate purchase price determined by multiplying (a) the initial public offering price per share minus the underwriting discount per share (assumed to be 7% of the initial public offering price per share) minus the $2.677 exercise price per share of such warrant by (b) the 1,992,252 shares of Common Stock subject to such warrant. See "Use of Proceeds." As compensation for Legg Mason's services as placement agent in connection with the 1996 Private Placement, the Company granted Legg Mason the Legg Mason Warrant and paid Legg Mason a cash fee of $1,645,000. The Legg Mason Warrant expires in 2006 and represents the right to purchase 747,096 shares of Common Stock at an exercise price of $2.677 per share, which is equal to the per share purchase 49 price paid by the SKM Investors. Upon consummation of this offering, the Company will repurchase two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant for a purchase price determined by multiplying (a) the initial public offering price per share minus the underwriting discount (assumed to be 7% of the initial public offering price per share) minus the $2.677 exercise price per share of such warrant by (b) the 498,064 shares of Common Stock subject to the portion of such warrant being repurchased. See "Use of Proceeds." Legg Mason has informed the Company that, concurrently with such redemption, Legg Mason will exercise the remaining one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant and will receive 201,414 shares of Common Stock pursuant to such exercise (assuming an initial public offering price of $14.00 per share). At the time of the 1996 Private Placement, the Company entered into a Registration Rights Agreement with its existing stockholders, the SKM Investors, the Noteholder and Legg Mason, providing for demand and piggyback registration rights under certain circumstances. In addition, the Company and its existing stockholders entered into (i) a Stockholders Agreement with the SKM Investors providing for, among other things, certain restrictions on the issuance and transfer of shares of the Company's capital stock held by its existing stockholders, certain voting rights relating to the election of directors, and veto rights of the directors nominated by the SKM Investors with respect to certain specified matters, and certain other rights granted to the SKM Investors, and (ii) a Warrantholder Agreement with the Noteholder and Legg Mason pursuant to which the Company and its existing stockholders agreed to grant certain rights to the Noteholder. The Registration Rights Agreement and the Stockholders Agreement are being amended and restated in their entirety in connection with the offering made hereby and the Warrantholder Agreement will terminate upon the Company's repurchase of the Noteholder Warrant and the Legg Mason Warrant. For descriptions of the Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement and the Amended and Restated Registration Rights Agreement, see "Security Ownership by Certain Beneficial Owners and Management--Stockholders Agreement" and "Description of Capital Stock--Registration Rights." At the time of the 1996 Private Placement, there were no existing relationships between the Company and the SKM Investors or the Noteholder. The Company used $11.8 million of net proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement to redeem certain outstanding shares of Common Stock held by certain members of the family of Ezra Dabah and used $2.9 million of such net proceeds to repay certain indebtedness of the Company owed to Mr. Dabah and certain members of his family as described below. At the time of the 1996 Private Placement, all outstanding shares of preferred stock, all of which were held by Mr. Dabah and certain of his family members, were surrendered for no consideration. Concurrently with the 1996 Private Placement, the Company paid a transaction fee of $250,000 to SKM and reimbursed SKM for $50,000 of out-of-pocket expenses. The Company also entered into an advisory agreement with SKM on June 28, 1996, pursuant to which SKM agreed to provide certain financial advisory services to the Company in connection with the Company's ongoing business and financial matters, including operating and cash flow requirements, corporate liquidity and other corporate finance concerns. In consideration for these services, SKM is entitled to receive an annual fee of $150,000, payable quarterly in advance. Pursuant to the advisory agreement, the Company incurred fees to SKM of approximately $93,000 in fiscal 1996 and approximately $75,000 during the first six months of fiscal 1997. The Company also agreed to indemnify SKM for certain losses arising out of the provision of its advisory services and to reimburse certain of SKM's out-of-pocket expenses. The advisory agreement will continue in effect in accordance with its terms following the offering. RELATED PARTY LOANS In July 1994, Ezra Dabah, Stanley Silverstein and Mr. Dabah's mother made loans to the Company for working capital purposes in the aggregate amount of $2.5 million. The loans bore interest at rates ranging from 4% to 8% per annum and were subordinated to the Company's working capital facility with its senior 50 lender. In addition, Stanley Silverstein loaned the Company $300,000 in March 1996 at 8% interest per annum. All such loans were repaid with a portion of the net proceeds of the 1996 Private Placement. During fiscal 1994, Ezra Dabah forwarded funds in the amount of $488,000 to the Company for the subscription for shares to be issued to Mr. Dabah, subject to approval of the Company's Board of Directors, at a future date. The Company's Board of Directors determined to not issue such shares and refunded the $488,000 to Mr. Dabah on July 31, 1997. Management believes that each of the transactions described in the preceding two paragraphs was upon terms and conditions at least as favorable to the Company as could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties. DABAH FAMILY AND GITANO LEGAL PROCEEDINGS Ezra Dabah, certain members of his family and DG Acquisition filed petitions for reorganization under chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code in November 1992. In October 1993, a plan of reorganization was confirmed and all of the debtors' pre-bankruptcy obligations were discharged. With the express approval of the creditors' committee, the plan permitted Mr. Dabah and his family members to retain their ownership of the Company. Pursuant to the terms of such plan of reorganization, certain proceedings, not related to the Company, were initiated by the liquidating trustee appointed as part of the Dabah family bankruptcy case and are currently continuing. In March 1994, Gitano filed a petition under the United States Bankruptcy Code and its assets were subsequently sold to an unaffiliated third party. On several occasions Gitano stockholders initiated litigation against Gitano and certain of its officers, including Mr. Dabah, asserting claims under the federal securities laws, which litigation was ultimately settled. The claims against Mr. Dabah and the other defendants primarily related to alleged misleading and inaccurate statements in public documents in violation of Rule 10b-5 promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. These claims were settled with the establishment of a settlement fund for the benefit of the plaintiff class. Pursuant to the terms of the settlement, the plaintiffs withdrew any claims they had asserted against Mr. Dabah. 51 DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK The following description of the capital stock of the Company is subject to the Delaware General Corporation Law, as amended (the "DGCL"), and to provisions contained in the Company's Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (the "Certificate of Incorporation") and Amended and Restated Bylaws (the "Bylaws"), copies of which have been filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part. Reference is made to such exhibits for a detailed description of the provisions thereof summarized below. Upon consummation of the offering made hereby, the authorized capital stock of the Company will consist of one million shares of preferred stock, par value $1.00 per share, without designation (the "Preferred Stock"), none of which will be issued and outstanding, and 100,000,000 shares of Common Stock, $.10 par value per share, of which 24,622,103 shares will be issued and outstanding (excluding shares issuable pursuant to stock options). Prior to this offering, the Company's common stock has been designated in two series, the Series A Common Stock and the Series B Common Stock. Prior to the consummation of this offering, the Series B Stock will be converted into Series A Common Stock and the Series A Common Stock will be redesignated as Common Stock. COMMON STOCK DIVIDENDS. After any requirements with respect to dividends on any Preferred Stock have been met, the holders of Common Stock will be entitled to receive such dividends, if any, as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors on the Common Stock, which dividends will be paid out of assets legally available therefor and will be distributed pro rata in accordance with the number of shares of Common Stock held by each such holder. See "Dividend Policy." VOTING RIGHTS. Each holder of Common Stock is entitled to one vote per share on each matter to be voted on by stockholders. Because there is no cumulative voting of shares, the holders of a majority of the voting power of the shares voting for the election of directors can elect all of the directors if they choose to do so. See "Risk Factors--Control by Insiders and Certain Other Stockholders." LIQUIDATION RIGHTS. In the event of any liquidation, distribution or sale of assets, dissolution or winding-up of the Company, holders of Common Stock will be entitled to share equally and ratably in all assets available for distribution to stockholders after payment of creditors and distribution in full to the holders of any series of Preferred Stock outstanding at the time of any preferential amount to which they may be entitled. OTHER TERMS. The Common Stock carries no preemptive rights and is not convertible, redeemable or assessable, or entitled to the benefit of any sinking fund. TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR. The transfer agent and registrar for the Company's Common Stock is American Stock Transfer & Trust Company. PREFERRED STOCK The Board of Directors is empowered to issue Preferred Stock from time to time in one or more series, without stockholder approval, and with respect to each series to determine, subject to limitations prescribed by law, (i) the number of shares constituting such series, (ii) the dividend rate on the shares of each series, whether such dividends shall be cumulative and the relation of such dividends to the dividends payable on any other class of stock, (iii) whether the shares of each series shall be redeemable and the terms thereof, (iv) whether the shares shall be convertible into Common Stock and the terms thereof, (v) the amount per share payable on each series or other rights of holders of such shares on liquidation or dissolution of the Company, (vi) the voting rights, if any, of shares of each series, and (vii) generally any other rights and privileges not in conflict with the Certificate of Incorporation or the DGCL for each series 52 and any qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof. To date, no series of Preferred Stock has been authorized and no shares of Preferred Stock have been issued. The issuance of Preferred Stock by action of the Board of Directors could adversely affect the voting power, dividend rights and other rights of holders of the Common Stock. Issuance of a series of Preferred Stock also could, depending on the terms of such series, either impede or facilitate the completion of a merger, tender offer or other takeover attempt. Although the Board of Directors is required to make a determination as to the best interests of the stockholders of the Company when issuing Preferred Stock, the Board of Directors could act in a manner that would discourage an acquisition attempt or other transaction that some, or a majority, of the stockholders might believe to be in the best interests of the Company or in which stockholders might receive a premium for their stock over the then prevailing market price. Although there are currently no plans to issue shares of Preferred Stock or rights to purchase such shares, management believes that the availability of the Preferred Stock will provide the Company with increased flexibility in structuring possible future financings and acquisitions and in meeting other corporate needs that might arise. The authorized shares of Preferred Stock are available for issuance without further action by the Company's stockholders, unless such action is required by applicable law or the rules of any stock exchange on which the Common Stock may then be listed. CERTAIN CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION AND BYLAW PROVISIONS Certain provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws may be deemed to have anti-takeover effects and may discourage, delay or prevent a takeover attempt that a stockholder might consider in its best interest. These provisions, among other things, (i) classify the Company's Board of Directors into three classes, each of which will serve for different three year periods, (ii) provide that only the chairman of the Board of Directors may call special meetings of the stockholders, (iii) provide that a director may be removed by stockholders only for cause by a vote of the holders of more than two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote, (iv) provide that all vacancies on the Company's Board of Directors, including any vacancies resulting from an increase in the number of directors, may be filled by a majority of the remaining directors, even if the number is less than a quorum, (v) establish certain advance notice procedures for nominations of candidates for election as directors and for stockholder proposals to be considered at stockholders' meetings, and (vi) require a vote of the holders of more than two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote in order to amend the foregoing provisions and certain other provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and ByLaws. In addition, the Board of Directors, without further action of the stockholders, is permitted to issue and fix the terms of preferred stock which may have rights senior to those of the Common Stock. DELAWARE LAW AND CERTAIN CHARTER PROVISIONS The Company is subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the DGCL. In general, this statute prohibits a publicly-held Delaware corporation from engaging in a "business combination" with an "interested stockholder" for a period of three years after the person becomes an interested stockholder, unless (i) prior to such time the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder was approved by the Company's Board of Directors, or (ii) upon consummation of the transaction which resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock of the Company outstanding at the commencement of the transaction, subject to certain exceptions, or (iii) at or subsequent to such time, the business combination is approved by the Company's Board of Directors and authorized at an annual or special meeting of stockholders by the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the holders of the Company's outstanding voting stock not owned by the interested stockholder. An "interested stockholder" is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns (or within the prior three years did own) 15% or more of the Company's voting stock. Such provisions could render the Company more difficult to be acquired pursuant 53 to an unfriendly acquisition by a third party by making it more difficult for such person to obtain control of the Company without the approval of the Board of Directors. The Company has included in its Certificate of Incorporation provisions to eliminate the personal liability of its directors for monetary damages resulting from breaches of their fiduciary duty to the extent permitted by the DGCL and to indemnify its directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of the DGCL. See "Management--Limitation of Liability and Indemnification." SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE Upon completion of the offering, the Company will have a total of 24,622,103 shares of Common Stock outstanding (excluding shares issuable pursuant to stock options). Of these shares, the 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock offered hereby will be freely tradable without restriction or registration under the Securities Act by persons other than "affiliates" of the Company, as defined in the Securities Act, who would be required to sell under Rule 144 under the Securities Act. The remaining 20,622,103 shares of Common Stock outstanding will be "restricted securities" as such term is defined by Rule 144 (the "Restricted Shares"). The Restricted Shares were issued and sold by the Company in private transactions in reliance upon exemptions from registration under the Securities Act. Of the Restricted Shares, 396,120 shares will be eligible for sale in the public market in reliance on Rule 144(k) immediately following the commencement of this offering. The remaining 20,225,983 Restricted Shares will be eligible for sale in the public market pursuant to Rule 144 and Rule 701 under the Securities Act beginning 90 days after the date of this Prospectus as described below. All of the Restricted Shares are subject to lock-up agreements with the Underwriters. See "Underwriting." In general, under Rule 144 as currently in effect, a person (or persons whose shares are aggregated) who has beneficially owned restricted securities for at least one year (including the holding period of any prior owner except an affiliate), including persons who may be deemed "affiliates" of the Company, would be entitled to sell within any three-month period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of 1% of the number of shares of Common Stock then outstanding (approximately 246,221 shares upon completion of the offering) or the average weekly trading volume of the Common Stock during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a Form 144 with respect to such sale. Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to certain manner of sale provisions and notice requirements, and to the availability of current public information about the Company. In addition, a person who is not deemed to have been an affiliate of the Company at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least two years (including the holding period of any prior owner except an affiliate), would be entitled to sell such shares under Rule 144(k) without regard to the requirements described above. Rule 144 also provides that affiliates who are selling shares that are not Restricted Shares must nonetheless comply with the same restrictions applicable to Restricted Shares with the exception of the holding period requirement. Rule 701 promulgated under the Securities Act provides that shares of Common Stock acquired on the exercise of outstanding options may be resold by persons other than affiliates, beginning 90 days after the date of this Prospectus, subject only to the manner of sale provisions of Rule 144, and by affiliates, beginning 90 days after the date of this Prospectus, subject to all provisions of Rule 144 except its one-year minimum holding period. The Company is party to an Amended and Restated Registration Rights Agreement pursuant to which the SKM Investors and the Company's other existing stockholders may demand registration under the Securities Act of shares of the Common Stock held by them at any time after nine months from the date of this Prospectus. The Company may postpone such a demand under certain circumstances. In addition, the Company's existing stockholders may request the Company to include shares of the Common Stock held by them in any registration proposed by the Company of such Common Stock under the Securities Act. 54 As of September 1, 1997, options to purchase a total of 1,444,080 shares of Common Stock pursuant to the 1996 Plan were outstanding with a weighted average exercise price of $2.677 per share. It is expected that options to purchase an additional 299,160 shares will be granted prior to this offering at an exercise price equal to the initial public offering price. In addition, a total of 1,000,000 shares of Common Stock are available for future issuance under the 1997 Plan. Following this offering, the Company intends to file one or more registration statements on Form S-8 under the Securities Act to register shares of Common Stock issuable under the 1996 Plan, the 1997 Plan and the Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Prior to the offering, there has been no public market for the Common Stock and no predictions can be made of the effect, if any, that the sale or availability for sale of shares of Common Stock will have on the market price of the Common Stock. Nevertheless, sales of substantial amounts of such shares in the public market, or the perception that such sales could occur, could materially and adversely affect the market price of the Common Stock and could impair the Company's future ability to raise capital through an offering of its equity securities. See "Risk Factors--Potential Impact of Shares Eligible for Future Sale; Registration Rights." 55 UNDERWRITING The Underwriters named below, represented by Montgomery Securities, Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation, Smith Barney Inc. and Legg Mason (the "Representatives"), have severally agreed, subject to the terms and conditions contained in the Underwriting Agreement, to purchase from the Company the number of shares of Common Stock indicated below opposite their respective names, at the initial public offering price less the underwriting discount set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus. The Underwriting Agreement provides that the obligations of the Underwriters are subject to certain conditions precedent and that the Underwriters are committed to purchase all of the shares of Common Stock if they purchase any.
NUMBER UNDERWRITERS OF SHARES - --------------------------------------------------------------------------------- ---------- Montgomery Securities............................................................ Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation.............................. Smith Barney Inc................................................................. Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated............................................. ---------- Total.......................................................................... 4,000,000 ---------- ----------
The Representatives have advised the Company that the Underwriters propose initially to offer the shares of Common Stock to the public on the terms set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus. The Underwriters may allow to selected dealers a concession of not more than $ per share; and the Underwriters may allow, and such dealers may reallow, a concession of not more than $ per share to certain other dealers. After the initial public offering, the offering price and other selling terms may be changed by the Representatives. The Common Stock is offered subject to receipt and acceptance by the Underwriters, and to certain other conditions, including the right to reject orders in whole or in part. The Representatives have advised the Company that they intend to make a market in the Common Stock after the effective date of this offering. The SKM Investors have granted an option to the Underwriters, exercisable during the 30-day period after the date of this Prospectus, to purchase up to a maximum of 600,000 additional shares of Common Stock from such SKM Investors to cover over-allotments, if any, at the same price per share as the initial shares to be purchased by the Underwriters. To the extent that the Underwriters exercise this option, the Underwriters will be committed, subject to certain conditions, to purchase such additional shares in approximately the same proportion as set forth in the above table. The Underwriters may purchase such shares only to cover over-allotments made in connection with this offering. The Underwriting Agreement provides that the Company and the SKM Investors will indemnify the Underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or will contribute to payments that the Underwriters may be required to make in respect thereof. The Representatives have informed the Company that the Underwriters do not expect to make sales of Common Stock offered by this Prospectus to accounts over which they exercise discretionary authority in excess of 5% of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby. At the request of the Company, the Underwriters have reserved for sale to certain employees of the Company and certain other persons, at the public offering price, up to 200,000 of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby. The number of shares available for sale to the general public will be reduced to the extent such persons purchase such reserved shares. Any reserved shares not so purchased will be offered by the Underwriters to the general public on the same basis as the other shares offered hereby. The Representatives are permitted to engage in certain transactions that stabilize the price of the Common Stock. Such transactions consist of bids or purchases for the purpose of pegging, fixing or maintaining the price of the Common Stock. If the Underwriters create a short position in the Common 56 Stock in connection with the offering, I.E., if they sell more shares of Common Stock than are set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, the Representatives may reduce that short position by purchasing Common Stock in the open market. The Representatives may also elect to reduce any short position by exercising all or part of the over-allotment option described above. In general, purchases of Common Stock for the purpose of stabilization or to reduce a short position could cause the price of the Common Stock to be higher than it might be in the absence of such purchases. Neither the Company nor any of the Underwriters makes any representation or predictions as to the direction or magnitude of any effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of the Common Stock. In addition, neither the Company nor any of the Underwriters makes any representation that the Representatives will engage in such transactions or that such transactions, once commenced, will not be discontinued without notice. Pursuant to a redemption agreement entered into between the Company and Legg Mason, one of the Representatives, the Company will use approximately $5.2 million of the net proceeds of this offering to redeem, immediately prior to the closing of this offering, two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant. The redemption price to be paid by the Company to Legg Mason will be determined by multiplying (a) the initial public offering price per share minus the underwriting discount (assumed to be 7% of the initial public offering price per share) minus the $2.677 exercise price per share of such warrant by (b) the 498,064 shares of Common Stock subject to the portion of such warrant being repurchased. Legg Mason has informed the Company that, concurrently with such redemption, Legg Mason will exercise the remaining one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant and will receive 201,414 shares of Common Stock pursuant to a cashless exercise of such portion of the Legg Mason Warrant (assuming an initial public offering price of $14.00 per share). The Legg Mason Warrant was issued as partial compensation for its services in connection with the 1996 Private Placement; the Company also paid Legg Mason a total cash fee of $1.6 million for services in connection with the 1996 Private Placement. As a result of this warrant redemption, the Conduct Rules of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. require that the initial public offering price be established at a price no higher than that recommended by a "qualified independent underwriter" (as defined in such Conduct Rules) that (i) does not beneficially own 5% or more of the outstanding voting securities of the Company, (ii) participates in the preparation of this Prospectus and the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus is a part and (iii) exercises the usual standards of "due diligence" in respect thereto. Montgomery Securities is acting as such qualified independent underwriter with respect to this offering. As a result of the warrant redemption and its participation as an underwriter in this offering, Legg Mason is expected to receive approximately 9.7% of the gross proceeds of this offering. The Company's stockholders and Legg Mason have agreed that, subject to certain limited exceptions, for a period of 180 days from the date of this Prospectus, they will not, without the prior written consent of Montgomery Securities, directly or indirectly, sell, offer, contract or grant any option to sell or otherwise dispose of any shares of the Company's capital stock, options or warrants to acquire shares of the Company's capital stock, or securities exchangeable or exercisable for or convertible into shares of the Company's capital stock. Montgomery Securities may, in its sole discretion and at any time without notice, release all or any portion of the securities subject to these lock-up agreements. The Company has agreed that, for a period of 180 days from the date of this Prospectus, it will not, directly or indirectly, sell, offer, contract or grant any option to sell or otherwise dispose of any shares of Common Stock, options or warrants to acquire shares of Common Stock, or securities exchangeable or exercisable for or convertible into shares of Common Stock, except that the Company may issue shares of Common Stock or options to purchase Common Stock pursuant to any stock option, stock bonus or other stock plan or arrangement described in this Prospectus, but only if the holders of such shares or options agree in writing not to sell, offer, dispose of or otherwise transfer any such shares or options during such 180-day period. The shares of Common Stock offered hereby have been approved for listing on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol PLCE. 57 Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Common Stock. Consequently, the initial public offering price of the Common Stock will be determined by negotiations among the Representatives and the Company. Among the factors considered in such negotiations will be the history of, and the prospects for, the Company and the industry in which it competes, an assessment of the Company's management, its past and present earnings and the trend of such earnings, the general condition of securities markets at the time of this offering and the market price of publicly traded stock of comparable companies in recent periods. LEGAL MATTERS The validity of the shares offered hereby will be passed upon for the Company by Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP, New York, New York. Certain legal matters will be passed upon for the Underwriters by Hale and Dorr LLP, Boston, Massachusetts. EXPERTS The audited financial statements included in this Prospectus and elsewhere in the registration statement have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public accountants, as stated in their reports with respect thereto, and are included herein, in reliance upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing in giving said reports. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION The Company has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission"), 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, a Registration Statement on Form S-1 (the "Registration Statement") under the Securities Act, for the registration of the Common Stock offered by this Prospectus. Certain of the information contained in the Registration Statement is omitted from this Prospectus, and reference is hereby made to the Registration Statement and exhibits relating thereto for further information concerning the Company and the Common Stock. Statements contained herein concerning the provisions of any document are not necessarily complete and in each instance reference is made to the copy of the document filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement. Each such statement is qualified in its entirety by this reference. The Registration Statement and the exhibits thereto are available for inspection in the principal office of the Commission in Washington, D.C. and photostatic copies of such material may be obtained from the Commission upon payment of the fees prescribed by the Commission. In addition, such material may be electronically examined at the Commission's Web site on the Internet located at http://www.sec.gov. The Company intends to distribute to its stockholders annual reports containing financial statements audited by its independent certified public accountants and quarterly reports containing unaudited financial information for the first three quarters of each fiscal year. 58 INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
PAGE ----- Report of Independent Public Accountants................................................................... F-2 Balance Sheets at February 3, 1996, February 1, 1997 and August 2, 1997 (unaudited)........................ F-3 Statements of Income for the fiscal years ended January 28, 1995, February 3, 1996 and February 1, 1997 and for the six months ended August 3, 1996 (unaudited) and August 2, 1997 (unaudited)............................................................................... F-4 Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity (Deficit) for the fiscal years ended January 28, 1995, February 3, 1996 and February 1, 1997 and for the six months ended August 2, 1997 (unaudited).................................................................. F-5 Statements of Cash Flows for the fiscal years ended January 28, 1995, February 3, 1996 and February 1, 1997 and for the six months ended August 3, 1996 (unaudited) and August 2, 1997 (unaudited)........................................................................... F-6 Notes to Financial Statements.............................................................................. F-7
F-1 After the stock split described in Note 15 to the Company's Financial Statements is effected, we expect to be in a position to render the following audit report which would appear in the final Prospectus. /S/ ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP New York, New York September 2, 1997 REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS To the Stockholders and Board of Directors of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.: We have audited the accompanying balance sheets of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (a Delaware corporation) as of February 1, 1997 and February 3, 1996, and the related statements of income, changes in stockholders' equity (deficit) and cash flows for each of the three fiscal years in the period ended February 1, 1997. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. as of February 1, 1997 and February 3, 1996, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of three fiscal years in the period ended February 1, 1997, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. New York, New York March 13, 1997 (except with respect to the matters discussed in Note 15, as to which the date is , 1997) F-2 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. BALANCE SHEETS (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS)
AUGUST 2, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1997 1996 1997 (UNAUDITED) ----------- ----------- ------------- ASSETS Cash and cash equivalents............................................... $ 569 $ 3,422 $ 631 Accounts receivable..................................................... 641 890 1,637 Inventories............................................................. 12,613 14,425 22,445 Prepaid expenses and other current assets............................... 2,349 3,163 4,281 Deferred income taxes, net of valuation allowance....................... 0 5,788 5,788 ----------- ----------- ------------- Total current assets.................................................. 16,172 27,688 34,782 Property and equipment, net............................................. 15,792 20,299 27,853 Deferred income taxes, net of valuation allowance....................... 0 14,711 15,283 Other assets............................................................ 109 1,781 1,830 ----------- ----------- ------------- Total assets.......................................................... $ 32,073 $ 64,479 $ 79,748 ----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ----------- ------------- LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT) LIABILITIES: Revolving credit facility............................................... $ 8,689 $ 0 $ 12,464 Current portion of long-term debt....................................... 6,808 600 0 Current maturities of obligations under capital leases.................. 692 772 477 Accounts payable........................................................ 12,856 8,322 12,564 Accrued expenses, interest and other current liabilities................ 4,757 6,043 7,198 ----------- ----------- ------------- Total current liabilities............................................. 33,802 15,737 32,703 Long-term debt.......................................................... 7,373 19,040 18,439 Obligations under capital leases........................................ 862 92 12 Other long-term liabilities............................................. 1,771 2,312 2,517 ----------- ----------- ------------- Total liabilities..................................................... 43,808 37,181 53,671 ----------- ----------- ------------- COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT): Preferred stock, $1 par value........................................... 10 0 0 Common stock, Series A, $.10 par value.................................. 0 1,276 1,276 Common stock, Series B, $.10 par value.................................. 0 5 5 Common stock, $.10 par value............................................ 14 0 0 Additional paid-in capital.............................................. 50,557 57,842 57,354 Accumulated deficit..................................................... (62,266) (31,825) (32,558) Less: Treasury stock, 2,800 shares of common stock, at cost............. (50) 0 0 ----------- ----------- ------------- Total stockholders' equity (deficit).................................. (11,735) 27,298 26,077 ----------- ----------- ------------- Total liabilities and stockholders' equity (deficit).................. $ 32,073 $ 64,479 $ 79,748 ----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- ----------- -------------
The accompanying notes to financial statements are an integral part of these balance sheets. F-3 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. STATEMENTS OF INCOME (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS EXCEPT PER SHARE AMOUNTS)
FISCAL YEAR ENDED SIX MONTHS ENDED -------------------------------------- ---------------------------- AUGUST 3, AUGUST 2, JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1996 1997 1995 1996 1997 (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Net sales................................. $ 107,953 $ 122,060 $143,838 $ 56,412 $72,737 Cost of sales............................. 74,229 83,434 89,786 38,300 48,917 ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Gross profit.............................. 33,724 38,626 54,052 18,112 23,820 Selling, general and administrative expenses................................ 27,873 30,757 36,251 15,926 19,287 Pre-opening costs......................... 178 311 982 212 1,222 Depreciation and amortization............. 3,344 3,496 4,017 1,854 2,615 ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Operating income.......................... 2,329 4,062 12,802 120 696 Interest expense, net..................... 1,303 1,925 2,884 1,182 1,815 Other expense, net........................ 0 447 396 379 106 ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Income (loss) before income taxes and extraordinary item...................... 1,026 1,690 9,522 (1,441 ) (1,225 ) Provision (benefit) for income taxes...... 54 36 (20,919) 21 (492 ) ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Income (loss) before extraordinary item... 972 1,654 30,441 (1,462 ) (733 ) Extraordinary item--gain on forgiveness of debt.................................... 490 0 0 0 0 ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Net income (loss)......................... $ 1,462 $ 1,654 $ 30,441 $ (1,462 ) $ (733 ) ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- ----------- ----------- ------------ ------------- ------------- Pro forma net income (loss) per common share (unaudited)....................... $ 1.28 $ (0.03 ) Pro forma weighted average common shares outstanding (unaudited)................. 23,804,185 23,804,185 ------------ -------------
The accompanying notes to financial statements are an integral part of these statements. F-4 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT) FOR THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED JANUARY 28, 1995, FEBRUARY 3, 1996 AND FEBRUARY 1, 1997 AND FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 2, 1997 (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE DATA)
SERIES A SERIES B PREFERRED STOCK COMMON STOCK COMMON STOCK COMMON STOCK ---------------------- ----------------------- ------------------------ ---------------------- SHARES AMOUNT SHARES AMOUNT SHARES AMOUNT SHARES AMOUNT --------- ----------- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----------- --------- ----------- BALANCE, January 29, 1994...... 10,000 $ 10 0 $0 0 $0 137,200 $ 14 Receipt of funds toward common stock subscription............ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Net income..................... 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 --------- --- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----- --------- --- BALANCE, January 28, 1995...... 10,000 10 0 0 0 0 137,200 14 Net income..................... 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 --------- --- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----- --------- --- BALANCE, February 3, 1996...... 10,000 10 0 0 0 0 137,200 14 Surrendered preferred stock.... (10,000) (10) 0 0 0 0 0 0 Exercise of stock options...... 0 0 0 0 0 0 2,800 0 Issuance of warrants........... 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Conversion of common stock to Series A Common Stock........ 0 0 16,800,000 1,680 0 0 (140,000) (14) Issuance of Series B Common Stock, net of transaction costs........................ 0 0 0 0 47,238 5 0 0 Redemption of Series A Common Stock......................... 0 0 (4,039,200) (404) 0 0 0 0 Net income..................... 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 --------- --- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----- --------- --- BALANCE, February 1, 1997...... 0 0 12,760,800 1,276 47,238 5 0 0 Return of funds toward common stock subscription............ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Net loss (unaudited)........... 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 --------- --- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----- --------- --- BALANCE, August 2, 1997 (unaudited)................... 0 $ 0 12,760,800 $ 1,276 47,238 $5 0 $ 0 --------- --- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----- --------- --- --------- --- ---------- ----------- ----------- ----- --------- --- TOTAL ADDITIONAL TREASURY STOCK STOCKHOLDERS' PAID-IN ACCUMULATED ------------------------ EQUITY CAPITAL DEFICIT SHARES AMOUNT (DEFICIT) ----------- ------------ ----------- ----------- ------------ BALANCE, January 29, 1994...... $ 50,069 $ (65,382) (2,800) $ (50) $ (15,339) Receipt of funds toward common stock subscription............ 488 0 0 0 488 Net income..................... 0 1,462 0 0 1,462 ----------- ------------ ----------- ----- ------------ BALANCE, January 28, 1995...... 50,557 (63,920) (2,800) (50) (13,389) Net income..................... 0 1,654 0 0 1,654 ----------- ------------ ----------- ----- ------------ BALANCE, February 3, 1996...... 50,557 (62,266) (2,800) (50) (11,735) Surrendered preferred stock.... 10 0 0 0 0 Exercise of stock options...... 123 0 2,800 50 173 Issuance of warrants........... 1,501 0 0 0 1,501 Conversion of common stock to Series A Common Stock........ (1,666) 0 0 0 0 Issuance of Series B Common Stock, net of transaction costs........................ 18,758 0 0 0 18,763 Redemption of Series A Common Stock......................... (11,441) 0 0 0 (11,845) Net income..................... 0 30,441 0 0 30,441 ----------- ------------ ----------- ----- ------------ BALANCE, February 1, 1997...... 57,842 (31,825) 0 0 $ 27,298 Return of funds toward common stock subscription............ (488) 0 0 0 (488) Net loss (unaudited)........... 0 (733) 0 0 (733) ----------- ------------ ----------- ----- ------------ BALANCE, August 2, 1997 (unaudited)................... $ 57,354 $ (32,558) 0 $ 0 $ 26,077 ----------- ------------ ----------- ----- ------------ ----------- ------------ ----------- ----- ------------
The accompanying notes to financial statements are an integral part of these statements F-5 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
FISCAL YEAR ENDED SIX MONTHS ENDED --------------------------------------- ------------------------ JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 3, AUGUST 2, 1995 1996 1997 1996 1997 ------------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- (UNAUDITED) CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES: Net income (loss)................................................ $ 1,462 $ 1,654 $ 30,441 $ (1,462) $ (733) Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities: Depreciation and amortization................................ 3,344 3,496 4,017 1,854 2,615 Deferred financing fee amortization.......................... 0 0 359 54 304 Loss on disposals of property and equipment.................. 0 156 0 2 25 Extraordinary gain........................................... (490) 0 0 0 0 Deferred taxes............................................... 0 0 (21,263) 0 (572) Changes in operating assets and liabilities: Accounts receivable.......................................... 38 (146) (249) (148) (747) Inventories.................................................. (1,819) (1,601) (1,812) 463 (8,020) Prepaid expenses and other current assets.................... 454 (243) (814) (647) (1,118) Other assets................................................. 251 (29) (128) (6) (229) Accounts payable............................................. (531) 5,691 (4,536) (5,676) 4,242 Accrued expenses, interest and other current liabilities..... 864 530 2,045 1,027 1,360 Payment of restructuring charges............................. (2,265) (1,854) (214) 0 0 ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Total adjustments.......................................... (154) 6,000 (22,595) (3,077) (2,140) ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities.............. 1,308 7,654 7,846 (4,539) (2,873) ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES: Property and equipment purchases................................. (2,723) (6,935) (8,492) (2,759) (10,159) ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net cash used in investing activities............................ (2,723) (6,935) (8,492) (2,759) (10,159) ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES: Borrowings under revolving credit facility....................... 8,500 76,919 141,907 53,413 88,557 Repayments under revolving credit facility....................... (8,000) (73,596) (150,596) (59,147) (76,093) Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt......................... 699 0 20,000 20,000 0 Repayment of long-term debt...................................... (2,067) (3,436) (12,821) (12,521) (1,360) Proceeds from related party loan................................. 2,500 0 0 0 0 Receipt of funds toward common stock subscription................ 488 0 0 0 0 Payment of obligations under capital leases...................... (1,220) (387) (690) (335) (375) Return of funds toward common stock subscription................. 0 0 0 0 (488) Increase in bank overdrafts...................................... 288 0 0 0 0 Redemption of Series A Common Stock.............................. 0 0 (11,845) (11,845) 0 Net proceeds from Series B Common Stock.......................... 0 0 18,763 18,763 0 Exercise of stock options........................................ 0 0 173 173 0 Deferred financing costs......................................... 0 0 (1,392) (1,334) 0 ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities.......... 1,188 (500) 3,499 7,167 10,241 ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents......... (227) 219 2,853 (131) (2,791) Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period............... 577 350 569 569 3,422 ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- Cash and cash equivalents, end of period......................... $ 350 $ 569 $ 3,422 $ 438 $ 631 ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ------ ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
The accompanying notes to financial statements are an integral part of these statements. F-6 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 1. BUSINESS AND ORGANIZATION OF THE COMPANY The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the "Company"), is a specialty retailer of high quality, value-priced apparel and accessories for newborn to twelve year old children. The Company designs, contracts to manufacture and sells its products under "The Children's Place" brand name. As of February 1, 1997, the Company operated 108 stores, primarily located in regional shopping malls in the eastern half of the United States. During the fiscal year ended February 1, 1997 ("Fiscal 1996"), the Company embarked on an aggressive expansion program. During Fiscal 1996, the Company opened 18 new stores and substantially remodeled or relocated 5 stores. During the six months ended August 2, 1997, 26 new stores were opened. During the fiscal year ended February 3, 1996 ("Fiscal 1995"), the Company opened 9 new stores. The Company's future operating results will depend largely upon its ability to open and operate new stores successfully and to manage a growing business profitably. 2. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES FISCAL YEAR The Company's fiscal year is a 52-week or 53-week period ending on the Saturday nearest to January 31. The results for fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996 represent the 52-week period ended January 28, 1995 ("Fiscal 1994"), the 53-week period ended February 3, 1996 and the 52-week period ended February 1, 1997, respectively. USE OF ESTIMATES The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from the estimates made by and assumptions used by management. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS In accordance with the Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No. 95, "Statement of Cash Flows," the Company considers all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents. INVENTORIES Inventories, which consist primarily of finished goods, are stated at the lower of average cost or market as determined by the retail inventory method. COST OF SALES The Company includes its buying, distribution and occupancy expenses in its cost of sales. F-7 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 2. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED) PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT Property and equipment are stated at cost, except for store fixtures and equipment under capital leases which are recorded at the present value of the future lease payments as of lease inception. Property and equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis based upon their estimated useful lives, which range from three to ten years. Amortization of property and equipment under capital leases and leasehold improvements is computed on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease or the estimated useful life, whichever is shorter. DEFERRED FINANCING COSTS The Company capitalizes costs directly associated with acquiring long-term third-party financing, including the value of the Legg Mason warrants attributable to the debt financing portion of the 1996 Private Placement discussed further in Note 3--1996 Private Placement and Note 10--Stockholders' Equity (Deficit). Deferred financing costs are included in other assets and are amortized over the term of the indebtedness. As of February 1, 1997 unamortized deferred financing costs were approximately $1.6 million, net of accumulated amortization of $0.4 million. The Company expects to write-off its unamortized deferred financing costs and debt discount in conjunction with its contemplated repayment of debt following its initial public offering (see Note 15--Subsequent Events). ACCOUNTING FOR IMPAIRMENTS IN LONG-LIVED ASSETS The Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued SFAS No. 121, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for Long-Lived Assets Being Disposed Of," which the Company adopted in the First Fiscal Quarter 1996. This statement requires that long-lived assets and identifiable intangibles be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that carrying amounts of the assets may not be recoverable. The Company continually evaluates the carrying value and the economic useful life of its long-lived assets based on the Company's operating performance and the expected future net cash flows and will adjust the carrying amount of assets which may not be recoverable. The Company does not believe that any impairment exists in the recoverability of its long-lived assets. PRE-OPENING COSTS Store pre-opening costs, which consist primarily of payroll, supply and advertising expenses, are expensed as incurred. ADVERTISING COSTS The Company expenses the cost of advertising when the advertising is first run or displayed. RESTRUCTURING Included in selling, general and administrative expenses for Fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996 is $481,000, $350,000 and $483,000, respectively, of restructuring costs, primarily consisting of legal, consulting and severance costs regarding the closing of numerous store locations. In addition, included in the statement of cash flows for Fiscal 1994 and Fiscal 1995 is the payment of restructuring charges which were recorded prior to Fiscal 1994. F-8 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 2. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED) INCOME TAXES The Company accounts for income taxes under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes" ("SFAS 109"). This standard requires recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities, measured by enacted rates, attributable to temporary differences between financial statement and income tax basis of assets and liabilities. Temporary differences result primarily from accelerated depreciation and amortization for tax purposes and various accruals and reserves being deductible for tax periods in future periods. See Note 9--Income Taxes for a discussion of income taxes and the Company's net operating loss carryforwards. FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS SFAS No. 107, "Disclosures about Fair Values of Financial Instruments," requires entities to disclose the fair value of financial instruments, both assets and liabilities, recognized and not recognized in the balance sheets, for which it is practicable to estimate fair value. For purposes of this disclosure, the fair value of a financial instrument is the amount at which the instrument could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties, other than in a forced or liquidation sale. Fair value is based on quoted market prices for the same or similar financial instruments. As cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable and payable, and certain other short-term financial instruments are all short-term in nature, their carrying amount approximates fair value. The fair values of the Company's long-term debt are discussed further in Note 4--Short and Long-term Borrowings. ACCOUNTING FOR STOCK BASED COMPENSATION The Company accounts for its 1996 Stock Option Plan (the "1996 Plan") under the provisions of Accounting Principles Bulletin ("APB") No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees," under which no compensation cost has been recognized. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" ("SFAS 123"), establishes a fair value based method of accounting for stock-based compensation plans and requires adoption or pro forma disclosure for all transactions entered into after December 15, 1994. See Note 11--Stock Option Plan for a discussion of the Company's pro forma disclosure of its 1996 Plan. ACCOUNTING FOR COMPREHENSIVE INCOME In June 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No. 130, "Reporting Comprehensive Income." Under SFAS No. 130, the Company will be required to present comprehensive income in its primary financial statements. Other comprehensive income represents revenues, expenses, gains and losses that bypass the income statement. The Company will be required to display the cumulative effect of other comprehensive income items as a separate component of stockholders' equity, and present the components of other comprehensive income in its income statement or statement of stockholders' equity. This statement is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 1997 and reclassification of comparative information for prior years' financial statements will be required. Management does not believe that the accompanying financial statements will be affected by the adoption of SFAS No. 130, and will adopt SFAS No. 130 during the first quarter of Fiscal 1998. F-9 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 2. BASIS OF PRESENTATION AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED) RECLASSIFICATIONS Certain prior period balances have been reclassified to conform to current year presentation. UNAUDITED INTERIM FINANCIAL INFORMATION All information with respect to the balance sheet as of August 2, 1997 and the statements of income, changes in stockholders' equity (deficit) and cash flows for the six months ended August 3, 1996 and the six months ended August 2, 1997 is unaudited and has been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for interim financial presentation. In the opinion of management, the unaudited financial statements contain all adjustments necessary for a fair presentation of the results of such periods. The unaudited financial statements have been prepared on a basis consistent with that of the audited financial statements as of February 1, 1997. Certain information and footnote disclosures normally included in financial statements prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles have been condensed or omitted pursuant to the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The results of operations for the six months ended August 2, 1997 are not necessarily indicative of the results of operations that may be expected for the full year. PRO FORMA NET INCOME PER COMMON SHARE Pro forma net income per common share is calculated by dividing net income by the pro forma weighted average common shares and common share equivalents outstanding as if (i) the proposed stock split and Series B conversion as discussed in Note 15--Subsequent Events, (ii) the 1996 Private Placement of Common Stock as discussed in Note 3--Private Placements, (iii) the cancellation of the preferred shares as discussed in Note 10--Stockholders' Equity (Deficit) and (iv) the granting of management options in conjunction with the 1996 Private Placement as discussed in Note 11--Stock Option Plan, occurred on February 4, 1996. Common share equivalents include the Noteholder Warrant, the Legg Mason Warrant, as discussed in Note 3--1996 Private Placement, and management options to purchase common stock, calculated using the treasury stock method in accordance with APB Opinion No. 15, "Earnings per Share," ("APB No. 15") at an estimated initial public offering price. Pro forma fully diluted net income per common share is equal to the amount presented. In February 1997, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued SFAS No. 128, "Earnings per Share." Under SFAS No. 128, the presentation of both basic and diluted earnings per share is required on the statements of income for periods ending after December 15, 1997, at which time restatement will be necessary. Had the provisions of SFAS No. 128 been in effect for Fiscal 1996 and the six months ended August 2, 1997, the Company would have reported pro forma basic net income (loss) per share of $1.49 (unaudited) and $(0.04) (unaudited) for Fiscal 1996 and for the six months ended August 2, 1997, respectively. Under SFAS No. 128, pro forma diluted earnings per share is equal to the pro forma net income per share currently disclosed by the Company. 3. 1996 PRIVATE PLACEMENT During Fiscal 1996, the Company employed the services of Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated ("Legg Mason") to assist, as its placement agent, in the recapitalization of the Company. As a result, pursuant to a note and warrant purchase agreement dated June 28, 1996 (the "Note and Warrant Purchase F-10 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 3. 1996 PRIVATE PLACEMENT (CONTINUED) Agreement") between the Company and Nomura Holding America Inc. (the "Noteholder"), the Company sold to the Noteholder, for a purchase price of $20 million, the Company's 12% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2002 (the "Senior Subordinated Notes") in the principal amount of $20 million, together with a warrant (the "Noteholder Warrant") representing the right to purchase 1,992,252 shares of Common Stock at an exercise price of $2.677 per share. This warrant was valued for financial reporting purposes by an independent appraisal firm at approximately $1.9 million. This amount has been accounted for herein as a credit to additional paid-in capital, net of income tax effect of $0.8 million, and a discount to the Senior Subordinated Notes, and is being amortized over the six year term of the Senior Subordinated Notes. The Company also paid the Noteholder funding and structuring fees in the aggregate amount of $300,000. Concurrent with the sale of the Senior Subordinated Notes, Legg Mason assisted the Company in its sale of its newly issued Series B Common Stock to two funds managed by Saunders Karp & Megrue L.P. ("SKM"), The SK Equity Fund, L.P. and SK Investment Fund, L.P., together with a former consultant to SKM (collectively, the "SKM Investors"). The aggregate proceeds from the sale of the Series B Common Stock were approximately $20.5 million, before deducting transaction costs of approximately $1.7 million. See Note 10--Stockholders' Equity (Deficit) for a discussion of the Series B Common Stock. Concurrently with the 1996 Private Placement, the Company paid a transaction fee of $250,000 to SKM and reimbursed SKM for $50,000 of out-of-pocket expenses. Net proceeds from the sale of the Senior Subordinated Notes and the issuance of the Series B Common Stock (collectively, the "1996 Private Placement"), were used to (i) redeem certain outstanding shares of Common Stock ($11.8 million), (ii) repay certain indebtedness and related interest ($13.5 million), (iii) pay transaction costs ($3.1 million), (iv) reduce borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility (see Note 4--Short- and Long-term Borrowings) and (v) for other general corporate purposes. In conjunction with the 1996 Private Placement, Legg Mason received $1.6 million in cash fees and a warrant to purchase 747,096 shares of Common Stock at an exercise price of $2.677 per share (the "Legg Mason Warrant"). This warrant was valued for financial reporting purposes by an independent appraisal firm at approximately $700,000. An amount equal to 49.4% of the value of the warrant, determined on the basis of gross proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement, was attributable to the placement of the Senior Subordinated Notes, has been credited to additional paid-in capital and capitalized as deferred financing costs in other assets, and is being amortized over the six year term of the Senior Subordinated Notes. See Note 10--Stockholders' Equity (Deficit) for a further discussion of the Legg Mason Warrant. 4. SHORT AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS THE FOOTHILL CREDIT FACILITY On April 12, 1995, the Company entered into a revolving credit facility ("the Foothill Credit Facility") with Foothill Capital Corporation ("Foothill Capital"). The Foothill Credit Facility provided for borrowings of up to $15 million and up to $5 million of letters of credit. In May 1996, the Foothill Credit Facility was amended to provide for up to $20 million in borrowings and up to $10 million of letters of credit. On July 31, 1997, the Foothill Credit Facility was further amended to provide for up to $30 million in borrowings and up to $20 million in letters of credit. The amended Foothill Credit Facility expires in July, 2000 and provides for one year automatic renewal options. As of February 3, 1996, February 1, 1997 and F-11 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 4. SHORT AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS (CONTINUED) August 2, 1997 (unaudited) the Company had $8.7 million, $0.0 million and $12.5 million, respectively, outstanding under the Foothill Credit Facility. Letters of credit outstanding as of February 3, 1996, February 1, 1997 and August 2, 1997 (unaudited) were $2.0 million, $4.7 million and $7.0 million, respectively. Availability as of February 3, 1996, February 1, 1997 and August 2, 1997 was $0.6 million, $11.9 million and $5.8 million, respectively. The availability of borrowings under the amended Foothill Credit Facility is determined as an amount equal to the sum of (i) 90% of eligible accounts receivable, (ii) 30% of the selling price of eligible inventory (not to exceed 65% of the cost of eligible inventory) and (iii) 30% of the retail selling price of inventory to be acquired pursuant to the outstanding letters of credit not to exceed the lower of (a) the face value of the outstanding letters of credit or (b) 65% of the cost of inventory to be acquired pursuant to the outstanding letters of credit. The Company's obligations under the amended Foothill Credit Facility are secured by a first priority security interest on the Company's present and future assets, intellectual property and other general intangibles. The amended Foothill Credit Facility also contains certain financial covenants, including, among others, the maintenance of minimum levels of tangible net worth, working capital and current ratios and maximum capital expenditures, as defined in the amended Foothill Credit Facility, as well as a prohibition on the payment of dividends. The Company obtained a waiver from Foothill Capital with respect to the capital expenditure limitations for fiscal 1996, which enabled the Company to open additional stores in connection with its expansion program. The Company anticipates that the availability for capital expenditures under this covenant will be adequate to support the Company's capital requirements. As of February 1, 1997, the Company was in compliance with all of its other covenants under the Foothill Credit Facility. Noncompliance with these covenants could result in additional fees or could affect the availability of the facility. Amounts outstanding under the amended credit facility bear interest at a floating rate equal to the reference rate of Norwest Bank Minnesota N.A. or, at the Company's option, the 30-day LIBOR Rate plus a pre-determined spread. The LIBOR spread is 1 1/2% or 2%, depending upon the Company's financial performance from time to time. As of each of February 3, 1996 and February 1, 1997, the interest rate charged under the Foothill Credit Facility was 10.75%. In addition, the Company was also required to pay an anniversary fee of $150,000 during Fiscal 1996 and $100,000 during the six months ended August 2, 1997. Borrowing activity under the Foothill Credit Facility was as follows (dollars in thousands):
FOR THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED ------------------------ FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1996 1997 ----------- ----------- Weighted average balances outstanding............................... $ 9,556 $ 5,403 Weighted average interest rate...................................... 11.21% 10.75% Maximum balance outstanding......................................... $ 15,747 $ 12,687
F-12 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 4. SHORT AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS (CONTINUED) LONG-TERM BORROWINGS The fair value of the Company's long-term debt is estimated based on the borrowing rates currently available to the Company for bank loans with similar terms and maturities. Management believes that the carrying amount of the Company's long-term debt approximates fair value. The components of the Company's long-term debt are as follows (dollars in thousands) :
FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 2, 1996 1997 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- (UNAUDITED) Senior Subordinated Notes.................................................. $ 0 $ 20,000 $ 20,000 Installment Notes.......................................................... 4,610 1,360 0 Finchside Notes............................................................ 3,713 0 0 Skiva Note................................................................. 3,358 0 0 Related party loan......................................................... 2,500 0 0 ----------- ----------- ----------- 14,181 21,360 20,000 Less: Current portion...................................................... (6,808) (600) 0 Less: Unamortized discount of Senior Subordinated Notes.................... 0 (1,720) (1,561) ----------- ----------- ----------- Total long-term debt....................................................... $ 7,373 $ 19,040 $ 18,439 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
THE SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES The Senior Subordinated Notes, which mature in 2002, are in the principal amount of $20.0 million and bear interest at a rate of 12% per annum, payable quarterly in arrears on January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1 of each year, commencing on July 1, 1996. These notes have been discounted by $1.9 million relative to the valuation of the Noteholder Warrant for financial reporting purposes (see Note 10-- Stockholders' Equity (Deficit)). This discount is being accreted into interest expense over the six year term of the Senior Subordinated Notes. The Senior Subordinated Notes are governed by the terms of a Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement which provides for certain operating restrictions and financial covenants. The Senior Subordinated Notes by their terms are subordinated to borrowings under the Foothill Credit Facility. The Senior Subordinated Notes rank senior to or pari passu with all other unsecured indebtedness of the Company. The Senior Subordinated Notes may not be prepaid prior to December 31, 1997, except upon consummation of an initial public offering of the Company's Common Stock. On or after December 31, 1997 or, if earlier, upon consummation of an initial public offering, the Senior Subordinated Notes may be prepaid in whole or in part, upon payment of a prepayment premium of 6% through December 31, 1998, decreasing to 4% during 1999 and 2% during 2000, with no prepayment premium thereafter. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Senior Subordinated Notes may be prepaid at any time without a prepayment premium if concurrently with prepayment the Noteholder is afforded the opportunity to sell at least 75% of the stock underlying its warrants in a public offering of the Company. The Company obtained an amendment from the Noteholder with respect to the capital expenditure limitations for fiscal 1996, which enabled the Company to open additional stores in connection with its expansion. F-13 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 4. SHORT AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS (CONTINUED) THE INSTALLMENT NOTES On December 28, 1993, the Company agreed to be a co-maker of two installment notes issued as of that date by the Chairman of the Board and certain of his family members in connection with their bankruptcy proceedings. Although the Company was a co-maker of the installment notes, the notes expressly provided that they were non-recourse to the Company. The Company agreed to be a co-maker of these installment notes in consideration for the waiver of certain claims in the amount of $20.0 million for repayment of funds previously loaned to the Company by its stockholders. One such installment note, in the principal amount of $2,650,000 ("Note A"), was non-interest bearing and provided for three annual principal payments. Note A was secured by a pledge of shares of the Company's Common Stock held by the Chairman of the Board and certain of his family members. Note A was repaid by the Company on July 1, 1996 with a portion of the net proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement. The other installment note, in the principal amount of $2,110,000 ("Note B" and collectively with Note A, the "Installment Notes"), provided for monthly principal payments of $50,000, commencing November 30, 1995 and continuing through October 31, 1998, with the remaining balance of $310,000 due on November 30, 1998. Interest on Note B accrued at the rate of 5% per annum for the first two years only, of which 3% per annum was payable monthly and the remaining 2% was added to the principal balance, to be paid at final maturity. Note B was secured by a lien on certain personal assets of the Chairman of the Board and certain of his family members. The Company repaid Note B on May 28, 1997 (unaudited). THE FINCHSIDE NOTES On June 28, 1991, the Company entered into a $10 million financing agreement with Finchside International, Ltd. ("Finchside"), an unaffiliated lender, which provided for irrevocable letters of credit, draft acceptances and advances (up to 120 days) to finance inventory purchases. The Company subsequently entered into a non-interest bearing agreement (the "Finchside Notes") with Finchside on January 28, 1993 providing for the repayment of $7.6 million in past due amounts under the original financing agreement. The Finchside Notes required installment payments of principal through June 1997. As a result of the Company's financial difficulties leading to its revised agreement with Finchside, the issuance of the Finchside Notes was accounted for as a troubled debt restructuring and therefore no interest was imputed on the Finchside Notes. On July 22, 1994, the Company amended and extended the remaining principal amount of the Finchside Notes of $5,712,000 over seven non-interest bearing payments commencing December 1995 with full repayment required by December 1998. On December 8, 1995, the Company further amended the repayment schedule of the Finchside Notes to provide for a final maturity in August 1998. The Finchside Notes were repaid on June 28, 1996 with a portion of the net proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement. THE SKIVA NOTE During the fiscal year ended January 30, 1993 ("Fiscal 1992"), Skiva International, Inc. ("Skiva") agreed to extend credit to the Company for working capital purposes, under an informal financing arrangement personally guaranteed by certain stockholders of the Company. As a result of a default by the Company during fiscal 1992, Skiva accepted a note from the Company (the "Skiva Note") in the aggregate principal amount of $4,473,000 with no interest. As a result of the Company's financial difficulties leading to its revised arrangement with Skiva, the issuance of the Skiva Note was accounted for as a troubled debt F-14 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 4. SHORT AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS (CONTINUED) restructuring and therefore no interest was imputed on the Skiva Note. In Fiscal 1994, as the Company continued to restructure its business, the terms of the Skiva Note were amended to extend the repayment of the outstanding principal balance of $3,358,000, with no interest, over nine quarterly installment payments commencing in December 1995. On January 1, 1996, the Company further amended the Skiva Note to provide for a revised repayment schedule, an annual interest rate of 10% on the remaining balance and a $154,000 payment for accrued interest for the six month period ended June 30, 1996. The Skiva Note was repaid on June 28, 1996 with a portion of the net proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement. RELATED PARTY LOANS During Fiscal 1994, the Chairman of the Board, his father-in-law and his mother made loans to the Company for working capital purposes in the aggregate amount of $2.5 million. The loans bore interest at rates ranging from 4% to 8% per annum and were subordinated to the Company's working capital facility with its senior lender. In addition, the Chairman of the Board's father-in-law loaned the Company $300,000 in March 1996 at 8% per annum interest. All such loans were repaid with a portion of the net proceeds of the 1996 Private Placement. Interest expense attributable to such loans amounted to $49,000, $184,000 and $84,000 for Fiscal 1994, Fiscal 1995 and Fiscal 1996, respectively. MATURITIES OF LONG-TERM DEBT As of February 1, 1997, the aggregate maturities of long-term debt were as follows (dollars in thousands): 1997............................................................... $ 600 1998............................................................... 760 1999............................................................... 0 2000............................................................... 0 2001............................................................... 0 Thereafter......................................................... 20,000 --------- 21,360 Less: Current portion.............................................. (600) Less: Unamortized discount......................................... (1,720) --------- Total long-term debt........................................... $ 19,040 --------- ---------
F-15 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 5. SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOW INFORMATION Cash paid for interest and income taxes were as follows (dollars in thousands):
FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED FOR THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED -------------------------- ------------------------------------- AUGUST 3, AUGUST 2 JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1996 1997 1995 1996 1997 (UNAUDITED) (UNAUDITED) ----------- ----------- ----------- ------------- ----------- Interest......................................... $ 1,255 $ 1,916 $ 2,369 $ 987 $ 1,498 Income taxes..................................... $ 0 $ 58 $ 70 $ 35 $ 507 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----- -----------
6. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, NET Property and equipment, net is comprised of the following (dollars in thousands):
AUGUST 2, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1997 1996 1997 (UNAUDITED) ----------- ----------- ----------- Leasehold improvements...................................................... $ 15,012 $ 19,226 $ 24,470 Store fixtures and equipment................................................ 6,610 8,604 13,501 Store fixtures and equipment under capital leases........................... 3,642 3,642 3,642 Construction in progress.................................................... 197 910 860 ----------- ----------- ----------- Property and equipment, gross............................................... 25,461 32,382 42,473 Less: Accumulated depreciation and amortization............................. (9,669) (12,083) (14,620) ----------- ----------- ----------- Property and equipment, net................................................. $ 15,792 $ 20,299 $ 27,853 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
7. ACCRUED EXPENSES, INTEREST AND OTHER CURRENT LIABILITIES Accrued expenses, interest and other current liabilities is comprised of the following (dollars in thousands):
FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, AUGUST 2, 1996 1997 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- (UNAUDITED) Accrued salaries and benefits.............................................. $ 1,236 $ 1,878 $ 2,014 Accrued interest........................................................... 196 298 229 Accrued real estate expenses............................................... 825 1,000 1,293 Customer liabilities....................................................... 566 716 695 Accrued taxes other than income............................................ 367 342 413 Other accrued expenses..................................................... 1,567 1,809 2,554 ----------- ----------- ----------- Accrued expenses, interest and other current liabilities................... $ 4,757 $ 6,043 $ 7,198 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
8. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES The Company leases all of its stores, a distribution facility, and certain office equipment and store fixtures under leases expiring at various dates through 2008. Certain of the leases include options to renew. F-16 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 8. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (CONTINUED) The leases require fixed minimum annual rentals plus, under the terms of certain leases, additional payments for taxes, other expenses and rentals based upon sales. Rent expense is as follows (dollars in thousands):
FOR THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED ------------------------------------- JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1995 1996 1997 ----------- ----------- ----------- Store and distribution facility rent Minimum rentals.......................................................... $ 8,915 $ 9,946 $ 11,221 Additional rent based upon sales......................................... 175 175 195 ----------- ----------- ----------- Total store rent..................................................... 9,090 10,121 11,416 Store fixtures and equipment rent.......................................... 711 712 727 ----------- ----------- ----------- Total rent expense................................................... $ 9,801 $ 10,833 $ 12,143 ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------
Future minimum annual lease payments under the Company's operating and capital leases with initial or remaining terms of one year or more, at February 1, 1997, are as follows (dollars in thousands):
OPERATING CAPITAL LEASES LEASES ---------- ----------- Fiscal year-- 1997..................................................................... $ 14,122 $ 828 1998..................................................................... 14,245 92 1999..................................................................... 13,891 0 2000..................................................................... 13,277 0 2001..................................................................... 10,608 0 Thereafter............................................................... 36,869 0 ---------- ----- Total minimum lease payments............................................. $ 103,012 920 ---------- ---------- Less: Interest and executory costs....................................... (56) ----- Present value of net minimum lease payments.............................. 864 Less: Current portion of obligations under capital lease................. (772) ----- Long-term obligations under capital lease................................ $ 92 ----- -----
Many of the Company's store leases contain provisions requiring landlord consent to a change in control of the Company. Management believes that the majority of its leases are at market rents and that these provisions will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial position or results of operations. LITIGATION The Company, from time to time, is involved in litigation arising in the normal course of its business. Management believes that the resolution of all pending litigation, after considering reserves provided for F-17 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 8. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (CONTINUED) in the accompanying financial statements, will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial position or results of operations. 9. INCOME TAXES Components of the Company's provision (benefit) for income taxes consisted of the following (dollars in thousands):
FOR THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED --------------------------------------------- JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1995 1996 1997 --------------- --------------- ----------- Current-- Federal.................................................................. $ 0 $ 36 $ 244 State.................................................................... 54 0 100 Deferred-- Federal.................................................................. 0 0 859 State.................................................................... 0 0 249 Valuation allowance...................................................... 0 0 (22,371) --- --- ----------- Provision (benefit) for income taxes....................................... $ 54 $ 36 $ (20,919) --- --- ----------- --- --- -----------
A reconciliation between the calculated tax provision (benefit) on income based on the statutory rates in effect and the effective tax rate follows (dollars in thousands):
FOR THE FISCAL YEARS ENDED ----------------------------------------- JANUARY 28, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1995 1996 1997 ------------- ------------- ----------- Calculated income tax provision............................................ $ 371 $ 575 $ 3,333 Reversal of valuation allowance............................................ 0 0 (21,042) Utilization of operating loss carryforwards................................ (167) (537) (3,540) State income taxes......................................................... 36 27 259 Nondeductible expenses..................................................... 12 21 24 Other...................................................................... (198) (50) 47 ----- ----- ----------- Tax provision (benefit) as shown on the statements of income............... $ 54 $ 36 $ (20,919) ----- ----- ----------- ----- ----- -----------
Deferred income taxes reflect the impact of temporary differences between amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes as measured by tax laws. These temporary differences are determined in accordance with SFAS No. 109. F-18 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 9. INCOME TAXES (CONTINUED) Temporary differences and net operating loss carryforwards which give rise to deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows (dollars in thousands) :
FEBRUARY 3, 1996 FEBRUARY 1, 1997 --------------------------- ----------------------------- DEFERRED TAX DEFERRED TAX DEFERRED TAX DEFERRED TAX ASSETS LIABILITIES ASSETS LIABILITIES ------------ ------------- ------------ --------------- Current-- Restructuring.......................................... $ 89 $ 0 $ 0 $ 0 Uniform inventory capitalization....................... 181 0 258 0 Inventory.............................................. 121 0 16 0 Expenses not currently deductible...................... 114 0 514 0 Net operating loss carryforwards....................... 0 0 5,000 0 ------------ ------ ------------ ----- Total current...................................... $ 505 $ 0 $ 5,788 $ 0 ------------ ------ ------------ ----- ------------ ------ ------------ ----- Noncurrent-- Amortization of debt issue costs....................... $ 0 $ 0 $ 66 $ 0 Depreciation........................................... 1,021 0 921 0 Deferred rent.......................................... 609 0 925 0 Imputed interest on loans.............................. 0 (668) 139 0 Discount on Senior Subordinated Notes.................. 0 0 0 688 Net operating loss carryforwards....................... 20,904 0 13,348 0 ------------ ------ ------------ ----- Total noncurrent................................... 22,534 $ (668) 15,399 $ 688 ------------ ------ ------------ ----- ------------ ------ ------------ ----- Net noncurrent..................................... 21,866 14,711 ------------ ------------ Total.............................................. 22,371 20,499 ------------ ------------ Valuation allowance...................................... (22,371) 0 ------------ ------------ Total deferred taxes..................................... $ 0 $ 20,499 ------------ ------------ ------------ ------------
At February 1, 1997, the Company had net operating loss carryforwards ("NOLs") totaling approximately $45.9 million which expire for federal income tax purposes during the fiscal years 2003 through 2006. The provisions of SFAS 109 require that the tax benefit of such NOLs be recorded as an asset and, to the extent that management cannot assess that the utilization of all or a portion of such deferred tax assets is more likely than not to be realized, a valuation allowance should be recorded. At February 3, 1996, the Company had net deferred tax assets amounting to approximately $22.4 million and management believed it to be more likely than not that the deferred tax assets would not be utilized based upon the historical performance of the Company. Accordingly, a valuation allowance was recorded against the net deferred tax assets at February 3, 1996. During Fiscal 1996, the Company consummated the 1996 Private Placement, a private placement of debt and equity (see Note 3--1996 Private Placement). The 1996 Private Placement enabled the Company to access capital to expand its business and achieve greater profitability. As a result of the Company's improved operating results during the second half of Fiscal 1996, as well as its projected results for Fiscal 1997 and thereafter, the Company reversed its valuation allowance in the fourth quarter of Fiscal 1996, as it is deemed to be more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will be utilized. Accordingly, the Company's net income for fiscal 1997 and future years will require calculation of a tax F-19 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 9. INCOME TAXES (CONTINUED) provision based on statutory rates in effect. Until the NOLs are fully utilized or expire, this tax provision will not be paid in cash (other than to the extent of the federal alternative minimum tax and state minimum taxes) but will reduce the deferred tax asset on the balance sheet. The amount and availability of these NOLs are subject to review by the Internal Revenue Service. Under the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code, the occurrence of certain events may affect the Company's ability to utilize its NOLs. The Company does not believe any such events occurred during fiscal 1996. 10. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT) The Company's preferred stock, Series A Common Stock, Series B Common Stock and the common stock are comprised of the following (dollars in thousands):
AUGUST 2, FEBRUARY 3, FEBRUARY 1, 1997 1996 1997 (UNAUDITED) ----------- ------------ ------------ Preferred stock: Authorized number of shares............................................ 10,000 10,000 10,000 Issued and outstanding number of shares................................ 10,000 0 0 Liquidation preference................................................. $35,953 $0 $0 Series A Common Stock: Authorized number of shares............................................ n/a 27,600,000 27,600,000 Issued and outstanding number of shares................................ n/a 12,760,800 12,760,800 Series B Common Stock: Authorized number of shares............................................ n/a 70,000 70,000 Issued and outstanding number of shares................................ n/a 47,238 47,238 Liquidation preference................................................. n/a $22,001 $23,283 Common stock: Authorized number of shares............................................ 140,000 n/a n/a Issued and outstanding number of shares................................ 137,200 n/a n/a Treasury stock: Number of shares....................................................... 2,800 0 0 Warrants: Number of shares of Series A Common Stock.............................. n/a 2,739,348 2,739,348
In conjunction with the Company's initial public offering, the Company intends to effectuate a 120-for-one stock split of its Series A Common Stock and anticipates a conversion of all outstanding Series B Common Stock into 7,659,889 shares of Common Stock (see Note 15--Subsequent Events). The Company's financial statements retroactively reflect such stock split. In addition, the Series A Common Stock will be redesignated as Common Stock. The Foothill Credit Facility prohibits the payment of dividends. F-20 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 10. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT) (CONTINUED) PREFERRED STOCK The preferred stock was nonvoting and provided for cumulative dividends. Dividends in arrears amounted to approximately $12.5 million, or $1,245 per share at February 3, 1996. The Company did not declare or pay any dividends during fiscal 1996. The shares of preferred stock were redeemable by the Company at their issuance price plus accrued dividends, whether or not such dividends were earned or declared. Accrued dividends were deducted from net income to calculate net income applicable to common stockholders for historical earnings per share purposes (See Note 2--Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies). On June 28, 1996, the outstanding shares of preferred stock were surrendered for no consideration. Accordingly, at February 1, 1997, 10,000 shares are available for future issuance by the Company. SERIES A COMMON STOCK During Fiscal 1996, the Company converted all outstanding shares of its common stock to 16,800,000 shares of Series A Common Stock. Pursuant to a Redemption Agreement dated June 28, 1996, the Company redeemed a total of 4,039,200 shares of its Series A Common Stock from certain stockholders of the Company for the aggregate amount of $11.8 million. SERIES B COMMON STOCK In conjunction with the 1996 Private Placement, the Company issued 47,238 shares of Series B Common Stock to the SKM Investors (see Note 3--1996 Private Placement). Under the terms of the Series B Common Stock, the approval of holders of a majority of the Series B Common Stock, voting as a seperate class, is required to amend certain provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws, to authorize the issuance of equity securities of the Company ranking senior to or pari passu with the Series B Common Stock, to adopt or amend any certificate of designation with respect to the Company's preferred stock, to modify the rights of the Series B Common Stock in an adverse manner, to authorize the merger of the Company or the sale or disposition of all or substantially all its assets or any other business combination or acquisition transaction as to which stockholder approval is required, to authorize the adoption of any employee stock option or similar plan, to amend the Company's management stock option plan, or to authorize the payment of dividends or other distributions. The holders of Series A Common Stock and Series B Common Stock vote together as a single class on all other matters presented to stockholders. The Series B Common Stock is currently convertible into 7,659,889 shares of Series A Common Stock, which would represent 30.8% of the outstanding shares of the Series A Common Stock on a fully diluted basis. The conversion ratio is subject to adjustment under certain circumstances. In the event of a public offering, the liquidation preference and special voting rights of the Series B Common Stock terminate thirty days after any such event, provided certain conditions are met. The Series B Common Stock carries a liquidation preference initially equal to its purchase price, increasing by 12.5% per annum. After five years, if the Company has not effected an initial public offering, the holders of the Series B Common Stock have the right subject to certain conditions, to require the Company to repurchase the Series B Common Stock at a price equal to the greater of its liquidation preference or fair market value. The Company can avoid this repurchase by allowing the holders of the Series B Common Stock to sell the entire company. The F-21 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 10. STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT) (CONTINUED) Series B Common Stock also has certain registration rights. For additional information on the Series B Common Stock, see Note 15--Subsequent Events. COMMON STOCK During Fiscal 1994, an executive officer of the Company forwarded funds in the amount of $488,000 to the Company towards a subscription for shares to be issued to such executive officer, subject to approval of the Company's Board of Directors, at a future date. Such shares were not issued as of February 1, 1997. The Board of Directors determined to not issue such shares and refunded the $488,000 (unaudited) to such executive on July 31, 1997. During Fiscal 1996, the Company converted all outstanding shares of its common stock to 16,800,000 shares of Series A Common Stock. TREASURY STOCK During Fiscal 1993, the Company purchased 2,800 shares of common stock (subsequently converted into 336,000 shares of Series A Common Stock) for treasury for an aggregate price of $50,000. An option was granted to an executive officer of the Company to purchase such shares for $50,000. Compensation expense of $123,000 was recognized in 1996, reflecting the difference between the appraised value at the time of exercise of the shares underlying the option of $173,000 and the exercise price of the option. On June 5, 1996, the executive officer exercised his option to purchase such shares of treasury stock. WARRANTS In conjunction with the 1996 Private Placement on June 28, 1996 (see Note 3--1996 Private Placement), the Company sold to the Noteholder a warrant to purchase 1,992,252 shares of the Series A Common Stock of the Company at an exercise price of $2.677 per share. The Noteholder Warrant is exercisable for a ten year period beginning after the earlier of January 10, 1997 or the date the Series A Common Stock is first registered under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The Noteholder also has registration rights with respect to shares underlying the Noteholder Warrant. This Noteholder Warrant was valued for financial reporting purposes by an independent appraisal firm at approximately $1.9 million. This amount has been accounted for herein as a credit to additional paid-in capital, net of income taxes, and a discount to the Senior Subordinated Notes, and is being amortized over the six year term of the Senior Subordinated Notes. On June 28, 1996, the Company also issued a warrant to purchase 747,096 shares of the Series A Common Stock of the Company at an exercise price of $2.677 per share to Legg Mason. The Legg Mason Warrant was valued for financial reporting purposes by an independent appraisal firm at approximately $700,000. An amount equal to 49.4% of the value of the Legg Mason Warrant, determined on the basis of gross proceeds from the 1996 Private Placement, was attributable to the placement of the Senior Subordinated Notes, has been credited to paid-in capital and capitalized as deferred financing costs in other assets, and is being amortized over the six year term of the Senior Subordinated Notes. See Note 15--Subsequent Events for additional information about the warrants. F-22 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 11. STOCK OPTION PLAN On June 28, 1996, the Company approved the adoption of the 1996 Stock Option Plan (the "1996 Plan"). The 1996 Plan authorizes the granting of incentive stock options and nonqualified stock options to key employees of the Company. The Plan provides for the granting of options with respect to 1,743,240 shares of Series A Common Stock. The 1996 Plan is administered by a committee of the Board of Directors (the "Committee"). Options granted under the 1996 Plan will have an exercise price established by the Committee provided that the exercise price of incentive stock options may not be less than the fair market value of the underlying shares at the date of grant. The 1996 Plan also contains certain provisions that require the exercise price of incentive stock options granted to shareholders owning greater than 10% of the Company be at least 110% of the fair market value of the underlying shares. At February 1, 1997, no stock options were issued to any stockholders owning greater than 10% of the Company's stock. Unless otherwise specified by the Committee, options will vest at the rate of 20% six months from the date of grant and 20% on each of the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries of the date of grant. On June 28, 1996, options to purchase 1,444,080 shares were granted at the exercise price of $2.677 per share. No additional options were granted in Fiscal 1996. As of February 1, 1997, no options had been exercised under the 1996 Stock Option Plan and options to purchase 288,816 shares were exercisable. For additional information on additional options being granted under the 1996 Plan, see Note 15--Subsequent Events. Effective February 1, 1997, the Company adopted the provisions of SFAS 123. As permitted by SFAS 123, the Company has elected to continue to account for stock-based compensation using the intrinsic value method under Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25. Accordingly, no compensation expense has been recognized for stock-based compensation, since the options granted were at prices that equaled or exceeded their estimated fair market value at the date of grant. If compensation expense for the Company's stock options issued in 1996 had been determined based on the fair value method of accounting, for Fiscal 1996 the Company's net income would have been reduced to the pro forma amounts indicated below: Net income-- As reported.................................................. $30,441,000 Pro forma.................................................... $30,210,000 Pro forma net income per share-- As reported.................................................. $1.28 Pro forma.................................................... $1.27
The fair value of issued stock options was estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model incorporating the following assumptions for options granted in Fiscal 1996: no dividend yield or volatility factor; risk free interest rate of 6.46%; and an expected life of the options of five years. The weighted average grant date fair value for options granted during Fiscal 1996 was $0.74 per share. 12. SAVINGS AND INVESTMENT PLAN The Company has adopted The Children's Place 401(k) Savings and Investment Plan (the "401(k) Plan"), which is intended to qualify under Section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. The 401(k) Plan is a defined contribution plan established to provide retirement benefits for all employees who have completed one year of service with the Company and attained 21 years of age. F-23 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 12. SAVINGS AND INVESTMENT PLAN (CONTINUED) The 401(k) Plan is employee funded up to an elective annual deferral and also provides an option for the Company to contribute to the 401(k) Plan at the discretion of the 401(k) Plan's trustees. The Company did not exercise its discretionary contribution option during Fiscal 1994, Fiscal 1995 and Fiscal 1996. In January 1997, the 401(k) Plan was amended whereby the Company will match the lesser of 50% of the participant's contribution or 2.5% of the participant's compensation. 13. QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED) The following table summarizes the quarterly financial data for the periods indicated (dollars in thousands):
YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 3, 1996 ------------------------------------------ FIRST SECOND THIRD FOURTH QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER --------- --------- --------- --------- Net sales.......................................................... $ 25,433 $ 23,181 $ 33,713 $ 39,733 Gross profit....................................................... 7,224 5,530 11,640 14,232 Net income (loss).................................................. (1,116) (2,959) 2,382 3,347 YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 1, 1997 ------------------------------------------ FIRST SECOND THIRD FOURTH QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER --------- --------- --------- --------- Net sales.......................................................... $ 30,438 $ 25,974 $ 40,353 $ 47,073 Gross profit....................................................... 10,238 7,873 16,976 18,965 Net income (loss).................................................. 637 (2,099) 5,312 26,591(1) YEAR ENDING JANUARY 31, 1998 ------------------------------------------ FIRST SECOND THIRD FOURTH QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER QUARTER --------- --------- --------- --------- Net sales.......................................................... $ 39,203 $ 33,534 -- -- Gross profit....................................................... 14,018 9,802 -- -- Net income (loss).................................................. 1,011 (1,744) -- --
- ------------------------ (1) Includes a reversal of a valuation allowance on a net deferred tax asset (see Note 9--Income Taxes). 14. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS Concurrently with the 1996 Private Placement, the Company entered into a management agreement with SKM which provides for the payment of an annual fee of $150,000, payable quarterly in advance, in exchange for certain financial advisory services. Pursuant to the advisory agreement, the Company incurred fees to SKM of approximately $93,000 in Fiscal 1996 and approximately $75,000 during the six months ended August 2, 1997. For additional information about related party transactions, see Note 3--1996 Private Placement, Note 4--Short and Long Term Borrowings, and Note 10--Stockholders' Equity (Deficit). F-24 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED) (ALL INFORMATION RELATING TO THE SIX MONTHS ENDED AUGUST 3, 1996 AND AUGUST 2, 1997 IS UNAUDITED.) 15. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS In July 1997, the Company filed a registration statement on Form S-1 with the Securities and Exchange Commission which, as amended, provides for an initial public offering of 4,000,000 shares of Common Stock. The Company intends to use the net proceeds of the proposed offering to (i) pay the principal amount of, and accrued interest on, the Senior Subordinated Notes, (ii) repurchase the Noteholder Warrant and (iii) repurchase two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant. As a result of the repayment of the Senior Subordinated Notes, the Company expects to incur a non-cash, extraordinary charge to earnings during the third quarter of Fiscal 1997 of approximately $1.7 million, resulting from the write-off of unamortized debt issuance costs and unamortized debt discount, net of taxes. The repurchase of the Noteholder Warrant and two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant will be accounted for as a reduction of additional paid-in capital. In conjunction with its proposed initial public offering, the Company intends to effect a 120-for-one stock split of the Series A Common Stock (the "Stock Split"), to convert all outstanding shares of the Series B Common Stock into 7,659,889 shares of Series A Common Stock (the "Series B Conversion") and to redesignate the Series A Common Stock as Common Stock (the "Reclassification"). Concurrently with the offering, the Company expects to issue 201,414 shares upon the exercise of one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant. In addition, the Company expects that, prior to the consummation of the initial public offering, the Company will amend and restate its certificate of incorporation and bylaws in order to, among other things, (i) effect the Series B Conversion, the Stock Split and the Reclassification, (ii) authorize 100,000,000 shares of Common Stock, $.10 par value per share, (iii) authorize one million shares of Preferred Stock, par value $1.00 per share, without designation, and (iv) provide for certain anti-takeover provisions. The Company also expects to enter into an amended and restated stockholders agreement with all of its existing stockholders. In addition, the Company intends to adopt a 1997 Stock Option Plan and is considering adopting an Employee Stock Purchase Plan. Moreover, it is expected that, prior to the public offering, options to purchase 299,160 shares of Common Stock at the initial public offering price, will be granted to one or more executive officers under the 1996 Plan and that, thereafter, no further options will be granted under the 1996 Plan. As the options will be issued at the market price, the Company does not anticipate recognizing any additional compensation expense. F-25 [THE INSIDE BACK COVER PAGE OF THE PROSPECTUS CONSISTS OF A GATEFOLD THAT SHOWS A LARGE PHOTOGRAPH OF SIX CHILDREN WEARING THE COMPANY'S APPAREL, ALONG WITH A LARGE VERSION OF THE COMPANY'S LOGO. ON THE INSIDE OF THE GATEFOLD ARE NUMEROUS PHOTOGRAPHS OF CHILDREN WEARING THE COMPANY'S APPAREL AND ACCESSORIES, INTERSPERSED WITH SMALL VERSIONS OF THE COMPANY'S LOGO.] - ----------------------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------- - ----------------------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------- NO DEALER, SALES REPRESENTATIVE OR ANY OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE COMPANY OR BY THE UNDERWRITERS. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY SALE MADE HEREUNDER SHALL UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY SINCE THE DATE HEREOF. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY ANY SECURITIES OFFERED HEREBY BY ANYONE IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT AUTHORIZED OR IN WHICH THE PERSON MAKING SUCH OFFER OR SOLICITATION IS NOT QUALIFIED TO DO SO OR TO ANYONE TO WHOM IT IS UNLAWFUL TO MAKE SUCH SOLICITATION. --------------------- TABLE OF CONTENTS ---------------------
PAGE --------- PROSPECTUS SUMMARY................................... 3 RISK FACTORS......................................... 8 COMPANY HISTORY...................................... 14 USE OF PROCEEDS...................................... 15 DIVIDEND POLICY...................................... 15 CAPITALIZATION....................................... 16 DILUTION............................................. 17 SELECTED HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA..................................... 18 MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS................ 20 BUSINESS............................................. 28 MANAGEMENT........................................... 37 SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT......................................... 46 CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS....... 49 DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK......................... 52 SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE...................... 54 UNDERWRITING......................................... 56 LEGAL MATTERS........................................ 58 EXPERTS.............................................. 58 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION............................... 58 INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS........................ F-1
--------------------- UNTIL , 1997 (25 DAYS AFTER THE DATE OF THIS PROSPECTUS), ALL DEALERS EFFECTING TRANSACTIONS IN THE REGISTERED SECURITIES, WHETHER OR NOT PARTICIPATING IN THIS DISTRIBUTION, MAY BE REQUIRED TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS. THIS IS IN ADDITION TO THE OBLIGATION OF DEALERS TO DELIVER A PROSPECTUS WHEN ACTING AS UNDERWRITERS AND WITH RESPECT TO THEIR UNSOLD ALLOTMENTS OR SUBSCRIPTIONS. 4,000,000 SHARES [LOGO] COMMON STOCK ----------- PROSPECTUS ---------------- MONTGOMERY SECURITIES DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE SECURITIES CORPORATION SMITH BARNEY INC. LEGG MASON WOOD WALKER INCORPORATED , 1997 - ----------------------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------- - ----------------------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------- PART II. INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS ITEM 13. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION. The following sets forth the estimated fees and expenses in connection with the issuance and distribution of the Registrant's securities being registered hereby, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, all of which will be borne by the Registrant: Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee................ $ 21,212 National Association of Securities Dealers filing fee.............. 7,500 Nasdaq National Market listing fee................................. * Printing and engraving expenses.................................... * Legal fees and expenses............................................ * Accounting fees and expenses....................................... * Blue Sky fees and expenses......................................... 11,800 Transfer Agent's fees.............................................. * Miscellaneous expenses............................................. * --------- Total............................................................ $ * --------- ---------
- ------------------------ * To be filed by Amendment ITEM 14. INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS. The Company's Certificate of Incorporation limits the liability of directors (in their capacity as directors but not in their capacity as officers) to the Company or its stockholders to the fullest extent permitted by the DGCL. Specifically, no director of the Company will be personally liable for monetary damages for breach of the director's fiduciary duty as a director, except for liability: (i) for any breach of the director's duty of loyalty to the Company or its stockholders; (ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law; (iii) under Section 174 of the DGCL, which relates to unlawful payments of dividends or unlawful stock repurchases or redemptions, or any successor provision thereto; or (iv) for any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit. The inclusion of this provision in the Certificate of Incorporation may have the effect of reducing the likelihood of derivative litigation against directors, and may discourage or deter stockholders or management from bringing a lawsuit against directors for breach of their duty of care, even though such an action, if successful, might otherwise have benefited the Company and its stockholders. Under the Certificate of Incorporation, the Company will indemnify those persons whom it shall have the power to indemnify to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of the DGCL, which may include liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933. Accordingly, in accordance with Section 145 of the DGCL, the Company will indemnify any person who was or is a party, or is threatened to be made a party, to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than a "derivative" action by or in the right of the Company) by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the Company, against expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if such person acted in good faith and in a manner such person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe was unlawful. A similar standard of care is applicable in the case of derivative actions, except that indemnification only extends to expenses (including attorneys' fees) incurred in connection with the defense or settlement of such an action and then, where the person is adjudged to be liable to the Company, only if and to the extent that the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware or II-1 the court in which such action was brought determines that such person is fairly and reasonably entitled to such indemnity and then only for such expenses as the court deems proper. The Certificate of Incorporation provides that the Company will advance expenses to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of the DGCL. Accordingly, the Company, in accordance therewith, will pay for the expenses incurred by an indemnified person in defending the proceedings specified in the preceding paragraph in advance of their final disposition, provided that, if the DGCL so requires, such person agrees to reimburse the Company if it is ultimately determined that such person is not entitled to indemnification. In addition, pursuant to the DGCL the Company may purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director, employee or agent of the Company against any liability asserted against and incurred by such person in such capacity, or arising out of the person's status as such whether or not the Company would have the power or obligation to indemnify such person against such liability under the provisions of DGCL. The Company intends to obtain insurance for the benefit of the Company's officers and directors insuring such persons against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the securities laws. The Company has entered into agreements to indemnify its directors which are intended to provide the maximum indemnification permitted by Delaware law. These agreements, among other things, indemnify each of the Company's outside directors for certain expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and settlement amounts incurred by such director in any action or proceeding, including any action by or in the right of the Company, on account of such director's service as a director of the Company. ITEM 15. RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES. Within the three years preceding the filing of this Registration Statement, the Company has sold and issued the following securities without registration under the Securities Act (all share numbers and per share amounts have been adjusted to reflect the 120-to-one stock split to occur prior to consummation of the offering). In July 1996, in connection with the 1996 Private Placement described in the Prospectus, the Company issued the following equity securities: (i) A total of 47,238 shares of the Company's Series B Common Stock were sold to the SKM Investors for an aggregate purchase price of $20.5 million. Such shares of Series B Common Stock were convertible into 7,659,889 shares (subject to adjustment under certain circumstances) of Series A Common Stock (representing approximately 30.8% of the Series A Common Stock on a fully diluted basis). Immediately prior to the consummation of the Company's initial public offering, all outstanding shares of Series B Common Stock will be converted into a total of 7,659,889 shares of Common Stock. (ii) The Company issued to the Noteholder, in connection with the Noteholder's purchase of the Company's Senior Subordinated Notes, the Noteholder Warrant. The Noteholder Warrant entitles the holder thereof to purchase 1,992,252 shares of Series A Common Stock (representing approximately 8% of the Series A Common Stock on a fully diluted basis) at an exercise price of $2.677 per share. The total purchase price of the Senior Subordinated Notes and the Noteholder Warrant was $20.0 million. Upon consummation of the Company's initial public offering, the Company will repurchase the Noteholder Warrant as described under "Use of Proceeds." (iii) The Company issued to Legg Mason, as partial compensation for Legg Mason's services as placement agent in connection with the 1996 Private Placement, the Legg Mason Warrant. The Legg Mason Warrant entitles the holder thereof to purchase 747,096 shares of Series A Common Stock (representing approximately 3% of the Series A Common Stock on a fully diluted basis) at an exercise price of $2.677 per share. Upon consummation of the Company's initial public offering, the Company will repurchase two-thirds of the Legg Mason Warrant as described under "Use of Proceeds" and will issue 201,414 shares upon the exercise of the remaining one-third of the Legg Mason Warrant. II-2 During fiscal 1994, an executive officer of the Company forwarded funds in the amount of $488,000 to the Company towards a subscription for shares to be issued to such executive officer, subject to approval of the Company's Board of Directors, at a future date. The Board of Directors determined to not issue such shares and refunded the $488,000 to such executive officer on July 31, 1997. On June 5, 1996, Stanley Silver, Chief Operating Officer of the Company, exercised an option to purchase 2,800 shares of Common Stock held in treasury (subsequently converted into 336,000 shares of Series A Common Stock.) The purchase price for such shares was $50,000. All securities issued in the above-described transactions were offered and sold in reliance upon the exemption from registration under Section 4(2) of the Securities Act. ITEM 16. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES. (a) Exhibits.
EXHIBIT NO. DESCRIPTION OF DOCUMENT - ----------- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1.1 Form of Underwriting Agreement. 3.1 Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company. 3.2 Form of Amended and Restated ByLaws of the Company. 4.1* Form of Certificate for Common Stock of the Company. 5.1* Opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP as to the validity of the securities being registered. 9.1 Form of Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement, dated , 1997. 10.1 1996 Stock Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. 10.2 Form of 1997 Stock Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. 10.3 The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. 401(k) Plan. 10.4* Form of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan. 10.5* The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. Management Incentive Plan. 10.6 Form of Amended and Restated Loan and Security Agreement dated as of July 31, 1997, between the Company and Foothill Capital Corporation. 10.7** Merchant Services Agreement dated December 12, 1994 between the Company and Hurley State Bank. 10.8** Employment Agreement dated as of June 27, 1996 between the Company and Ezra Dabah. 10.9** Employment Agreement dated as of June 27, 1996 between the Company and Stanley B. Silver. 10.10 Form of Indemnification Agreement between the Company and the members of its Board of Directors. 10.11** Lease Agreement dated August 11, 1993 between the Company and Suburban Mall V Associates, as amended by First Amendment to Lease, dated October 21, 1994 between the Company and Suburban Mall V Associates. 10.12 Form of Amended and Restated Registration Rights Agreement, dated , 1997. 10.13 Letter Agreement as to employment, dated January 18, 1991, between the Company and Diane M. Timbanard. 10.14 Letter Agreement as to severance pay, dated January 22, 1991, between the Company and Diane M. Timbanard. 10.15* Form of Redemption Agreement dated as of , 1997 between the Company and Nomura Holding America, Inc. 10.16* Form of Redemption Agreement dated as of , 1997 between the Company and Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated.
II-3
EXHIBIT NO. DESCRIPTION OF DOCUMENT - ----------- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 10.17 Buying Agency Agreement dated September , 1996 between the Company and KS Best International. 10.18 Advisory Agreement dated June 28, 1996 between the Company and Saunders Karp & Megrue, L.P. 23.1 Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP. 23.2* Consent of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1). 24.1** Power of Attorney. 27.1 Financial Data Schedule.
- ------------------------ * To be filed by Amendment. ** Previously filed. (b) Financial Statement Schedules. None. All schedules for which provision is made in the applicable regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission are not required under the related instructions or are inapplicable, and therefore have been omitted. ITEM 17. UNDERTAKINGS. The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the Underwriters at the closing specified in the Underwriting Agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the Underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser. Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions in Item 14, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue. The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that: (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective. (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof. II-4 SIGNATURES Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant has duly caused this Amendment to the Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of West Caldwell, State of New Jersey, on September 2, 1997. THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. BY: /S/ EZRA DABAH ----------------------------------------- Ezra Dabah Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated. SIGNATURE TITLE DATE - ------------------------------ --------------------------- ------------------- /s/ EZRA DABAH Chairman of the Board of September 2, 1997 - ------------------------------ Directors and Chief Ezra Dabah Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer) * President, Chief Operating September 2, 1997 - ------------------------------ Officer and Director Stanley B. Silver * Vice President and Chief September 2, 1997 - ------------------------------ Financial Officer Seth L. Udasin (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer) * Director September 2, 1997 - ------------------------------ Stanley Silverstein * Director September 2, 1997 - ------------------------------ John Megrue * Director September 2, 1997 - ------------------------------ David J. Oddi *By: /s/ EZRA DABAH ------------------------- Ezra Dabah, as Attorney-in-fact II-5 EXHIBIT INDEX
EXHIBIT NO. DESCRIPTION OF DOCUMENT - ----------- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1.1 Form of Underwriting Agreement. 3.1 Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company. 3.2 Form of Amended and Restated ByLaws of the Company. 4.1* Form of Certificate for Common Stock of the Company. 5.1* Opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP as to the validity of the securities being registered. 9.1 Form of Amended and Restated Stockholders Agreement, dated , 1997. 10.1 1996 Stock Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. 10.2 Form of 1997 Stock Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. 10.3 The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. 401(k) Plan. 10.4* Form of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan. 10.5* The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. Management Incentive Plan. 10.6 Form of Amended and Restated Loan and Security Agreement dated as of July 31, 1997, between the Company and Foothill Capital Corporation. 10.7** Merchant Services Agreement dated December 12, 1994 between the Company and Hurley State Bank. 10.8** Employment Agreement dated as of June 27, 1996 between the Company and Ezra Dabah. 10.9** Employment Agreement dated as of June 27, 1996 between the Company and Stanley B. Silver. 10.10 Form of Indemnification Agreement between the Company and the members of its Board of Directors. 10.11** Lease Agreement dated August 11, 1993 between the Company and Suburban Mall V Associates, as amended by First Amendment to Lease, dated October 21, 1994 between the Company and Suburban Mall V Associates. 10.12 Form of Amended and Restated Registration Rights Agreement, dated , 1997. 10.13 Letter Agreement as to employment, dated January 18, 1991, between the Company and Diane M. Timbanard. 10.14 Letter Agreement as to severance pay, dated January 22, 1991, between the Company and Diane M. Timbanard. 10.15* Form of Redemption Agreement dates as of , 1997 between the Company and Nomura Holding America, Inc. 10.16* Form of Redemption Agreement dated as of , 1997 between the Company and Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated. 10.17 Buying Agency Agreement dated September , 1996 between the Company and KS Best International. 10.18 Advisory Agreement dated June 28, 1996 between the Company and Saunders Karp & Megrue, L.P. 23.1 Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP. 23.2* Consent of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1). 24.1** Power of Attorney. 27.1 Financial Data Schedule.
- ------------------------ * To be filed by Amendment. ** Previously filed.


                                                                     EXHIBIT 1.1



                                                               H&D DRAFT 8/20/97








                                   3,550,000 SHARES




                       THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.



                                     COMMON STOCK





                                UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT

                          DATED  ____________________, 1997




                                  TABLE OF CONTENTS


SECTION 1.  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES....................................2

  A. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF THE COMPANY............................2

    Compliance with Registration Requirements.................................2
    Offering Materials Furnished to Underwriters..............................3
    Distribution of Offering Material By the Company..........................3
    The Underwriting Agreement................................................3
    Authorization of the Common Shares........................................3
    No Applicable Registration or Other Similar Rights........................3
    No Material Adverse Change................................................3
    Independent Accountants...................................................4
    Preparation of the Financial Statements...................................4
    Incorporation and Good Standing of the Company............................4
    Capitalization and Other Capital Stock Matters............................4
    Stock Exchange Listing....................................................5
    Non-Contravention of Existing Instruments; No Further 
      Authorizations or Approvals Required....................................5
    No Material Actions or Proceedings........................................6
    Intellectual Property Rights..............................................6
    All Necessary Permits, etc................................................6
    Title to Properties.......................................................6
    Tax Law Compliance........................................................7
    Compliance with Environmental Laws........................................7
    ERISA Compliance..........................................................8
      Company Not an "Investment Company......................................8
    Insurance.................................................................8
    No Price Stabilization or Manipulation....................................9
    Related Party Transactions................................................9
    No Unlawful Contributions or Other Payments...............................9
    Company's Accounting System...............................................9

  B.  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS..............9

    The Underwriting Agreement................................................9
    The Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney...............................9
    Title to Common Shares to be Sold; All Authorizations Obtained...........10
    Delivery of the Common Shares to be Sold.................................10
    Non-Contravention; No Further Authorizations or Approvals Required.......10
    No Registration or Other Similar Rights..................................10
    No Further Consents, etc.................................................11
    Disclosure Made by Such Selling Stockholder in the Prospectus............11
    No Price Stabilization or Manipulation...................................11
    Confirmation of Company Representations and Warranties...................11

SECTION 2.  PURCHASE, SALE AND DELIVERY OF THE COMMON SHARES12
    The Firm Common Shares...................................................12
    The First Closing Date...................................................12
    The Optional Common Shares; the Second Closing Date......................12



    Public Offering of the Common Shares.....................................13
    Payment for the Common Shares............................................13
    Delivery of the Common Shares............................................13
    Delivery of Prospectus to the Underwriters...............................14

SECTION 3.  ADDITIONAL COVENANTS.............................................14

  A.  COVENANTS OF THE COMPANY...............................................14

    Representative's Review of Proposed Amendments and Supplements...........14
    Securities Act Compliance................................................14
    Amendments and Supplements to the Prospectus and Other Securities Act 
      Matters................................................................15
    Copies of any Amendments and Supplements to the Prospectus...............15
    Blue Sky Compliance......................................................15
    Use of Proceeds..........................................................15
    Transfer Agent...........................................................16
    Earnings Statement.......................................................16
    Periodic Reporting Obligations...........................................16
    Agreement Not To Offer or Sell Additional Securities.....................16
    Future Reports to the Representatives....................................16

  B.  COVENANTS OF THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS..................................17

    Agreement Not to Offer or Sell Additional Securities.....................17
    Delivery of Forms W-8 and W-9............................................17

SECTION 4.  PAYMENT OF EXPENSES..............................................17

SECTION 5.  CONDITIONS OF THE OBLIGATIONS OF THE UNDERWRITERS................18
    Accountants' Comfort Letter..............................................18
    Compliance with Registration Requirements; No Stop Order; No 
      Objection from NASD....................................................18
    No Material Adverse Change...............................................19
    Opinion of Counsel for the Company.......................................19
    Opinion of Counsel for the Underwriters..................................19
    Officers' Certificate....................................................19
    Bring-down Comfort Letter................................................20
    Opinion of Counsel for the Selling Stockholders..........................20
    Selling Stockholders' Certificate........................................20
    Selling Stockholders' Documents..........................................20
    Lock-Up Agreement from Certain Stockholders of the Company Other Than 
    Selling Stockholders.....................................................20
    Additional Documents.....................................................21

SECTION 6.  REIMBURSEMENT OF UNDERWRITERS' EXPENSES..........................21

SECTION 7.  EFFECTIVENESS OF THIS AGREEMENT..................................21

SECTION 8.  INDEMNIFICATION..................................................22
    Indemnification of the Underwriters......................................22



    Indemnification of the Company, its Directors and Officers and the 
      Selling Stockholders...................................................23
    Notifications and Other Indemnification Procedures.......................24
      Settlements............................................................25
    Indemnification of a Qualified Independent Underwriter...................25

SECTION 9.  CONTRIBUTION.....................................................25

SECTION 10. DEFAULT OF ONE OR MORE OF THE SEVERAL UNDERWRITERS...............27

SECTION 11. TERMINATION OF THIS AGREEMENT....................................27

SECTION 12. REPRESENTATIONS AND INDEMNITIES TO SURVIVE DELIVERY..............28

SECTION 13. NOTICES..........................................................28

SECTION 14. SUCCESSORS.......................................................29

SECTION 15. PARTIAL UNENFORCEABILITY.........................................29

SECTION 16. GOVERNING LAW PROVISIONS.........................................29

SECTION 17. FAILURE OF ONE OR MORE OF THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS TO 
             SELL AND DELIVER COMMON SHARES..................................29

SECTION 18. GENERAL PROVISIONS...............................................30



                                UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT


                                                             _____________, 1997


MONTGOMERY SECURITIES
DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE SECURITIES CORPORATION
SMITH BARNEY, INC.
LEGG MASON WOOD WALKER, INCORPORATED
As Representatives of the several Underwriters
c/o MONTGOMERY SECURITIES
600 Montgomery Street
San Francisco, California  94111


Ladies and Gentlemen:

         INTRODUCTORY.  The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc., a Delaware
corporation (the "Company"), proposes to issue and sell to the several
underwriters named in Schedule A (the "Underwriters") an aggregate of 3,550,000
shares (the "Firm Common Shares") of its Common Stock, par value $.10 per share
(the "Common Stock").  In addition, the stockholders of the Company named in
Schedule B (collectively, the "Selling Stockholders") have severally granted to
the Underwriters an option to purchase up to an additional 532,500 shares (the
"Optional Common Shares") of Common Stock, as provided in Section 2, each
Selling Stockholder selling up to the amount set forth opposite such Selling
Stockholder's name in Schedule B.  The Firm Common Shares and, if and to the
extent such option is exercised, the Optional Common Shares are collectively
called the "Common Shares." Montgomery Securities, Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette
Securities Corporation, Smith Barney, Inc. and Legg Mason Wood Walker,
Incorporated have agreed to act as representatives of the several Underwriters
(in such capacity, the "Representatives") in connection with the offering and
sale of the Common Shares.

    The Company has prepared and filed with the Securities and Exchange
Commission (the "Commission") a registration statement on Form S-1 (File
No. 333-31535), which contains a form of prospectus to be used in connection
with the public offering and sale of the Common Shares.  Such registration
statement, as amended, including the financial statements, exhibits and
schedules thereto, in the form in which it was declared effective by the
Commission under the Securities Act of 1933 and the rules and regulations
promulgated thereunder (collectively, the "Securities Act"), including any
information deemed to be a part thereof at the time of effectiveness pursuant to
Rule 430A or Rule 434 under the Securities Act, is called the "Registration
Statement."  Any registration statement filed by the Company pursuant to
Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act is called the "Rule 462(b) Registration
Statement," and from and after the date and time of filing of the Rule 462(b)
Registration Statement the term "Registration Statement" shall include the
Rule 462(b) Registration Statement.  Such prospectus, in the form first used by
the Underwriters to confirm sales of the Common Shares, is called the
"Prospectus"; provided, however, if the Company has, with the consent of
Montgomery Securities, elected to rely upon Rule 434 under the Securities Act,
the term "Prospectus" shall mean the Company's prospectus subject to completion
(each, a "preliminary prospectus") dated ____________, 1997 (such preliminary
prospectus is called the 




"Rule 434 preliminary prospectus"), together with the applicable term sheet (the
"Term Sheet") prepared and filed by the Company with the Commission under
Rules 434 and 424(b) under the Securities Act and all references in this
Agreement to the date of the Prospectus shall mean the date of the Term Sheet. 
All references in this Agreement to the Registration Statement, the Rule 462(b)
Registration Statement, a preliminary prospectus, the Prospectus or the Term
Sheet, or any amendments or supplements to any of the foregoing, shall include
any copy thereof filed with the Commission pursuant to its Electronic Data
Gathering, Analysis and Retrieval System ("EDGAR"). 

    The Company and each of the Selling Stockholders hereby confirms their
respective agreements with the Underwriters as follows:

         SECTION 1.  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

    A. REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF THE COMPANY .  The Company hereby
represents, warrants and covenants to each Underwriter as follows: 

         (a)  COMPLIANCE WITH REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS.  The Registration
    Statement and any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement have been declared
    effective by the Commission under the Securities Act.  The Company has
    complied to the Commission's satisfaction with all requests of the
    Commission for additional or supplemental information.  No stop order
    suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or any
    Rule 462(b) Registration Statement is in effect and no proceedings for such
    purpose have been instituted or are pending or, to the best knowledge of
    the Company, are contemplated or threatened by the Commission.     

         Each preliminary prospectus and the Prospectus when filed complied in
    all material respects with the Securities Act and, if filed by electronic
    transmission pursuant to EDGAR (except as may be permitted by
    Regulation S-T under the Securities Act), was identical to the copy thereof
    delivered to the Underwriters for use in connection with the offer and sale
    of the Common Shares.  Each of the Registration Statement, any Rule 462(b)
    Registration Statement and any post-effective amendment thereto, at the
    time it became effective and at all subsequent times until either the
    consummation of the exercise of the purchase option with respect to the
    Optional Common Shares or the expiration of such option without exercise,
    complied and will comply in all material respects with the Securities Act
    and did not and will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or
    omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to
    make the statements therein not misleading.  The Prospectus, as amended or
    supplemented, as of its date and at all subsequent times, did not and will
    not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
    material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in the
    light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.  The
    representations and warranties set forth in the two immediately preceding
    sentences do not apply to statements in or omissions from the Registration
    Statement, any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement, or any post-effective
    amendment thereto, or the Prospectus, or any amendments or supplements
    thereto, made in reliance upon and in conformity with information relating
    to any Underwriter furnished to the Company in writing by the
    Representatives expressly for use therein.  There are no contracts or other
    documents required to be described in the Prospectus or to be filed as
    exhibits to the Registration Statement which have not been described or
    filed as required.   



         (b)  OFFERING MATERIALS FURNISHED TO UNDERWRITERS.  The Company has
    delivered (i) to counsel for the Representatives one complete manually
    signed copy of the Registration Statement and of each consent and
    certificate of experts filed as a part thereof, and (ii) to each
    Representative conformed copies of the Registration Statement (without
    exhibits) and preliminary prospectuses and the Prospectus, as amended or
    supplemented, in such quantities and at such places as such Representative
    has reasonably requested for each of the Underwriters.        

         (c)  DISTRIBUTION OF OFFERING MATERIAL BY THE COMPANY.  The Company
    has not distributed and will not distribute, prior to the later of the
    Second Closing Date (as defined below) and the completion of the
    Underwriters' distribution of the Common Shares, any offering material in
    connection with the offering and sale of the Common Shares other than a
    preliminary prospectus, the Prospectus or the Registration Statement. 

         (d)  THE UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT.  This Agreement has been duly
    authorized, executed and delivered by, and is a valid and binding agreement
    of, the Company, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as rights
    to indemnification hereunder may be limited by applicable law and except as
    the enforcement hereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency,
    reorganization, moratorium or other similar laws relating to or affecting
    the rights and remedies of creditors or by general equitable principles.

         (e)  AUTHORIZATION OF THE COMMON SHARES.  The Common Shares to be
    purchased by the Underwriters from the Company have been duly authorized
    for issuance and sale pursuant to this Agreement and, when issued and
    delivered by the Company pursuant to this Agreement, will be validly
    issued, fully paid and nonassessable.    

         (f)  NO APPLICABLE REGISTRATION OR OTHER SIMILAR RIGHTS.  There are no
    persons with registration or other similar rights to have any equity or
    debt securities registered for sale under the Registration Statement or
    included in the offering contemplated by this Agreement, except for such
    rights as have been duly waived.

         (g)  NO MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE.  Except as otherwise disclosed in the
    Prospectus, subsequent to the respective dates as of which information is
    given in the Prospectus: (i) there has been no material adverse change, or
    any development that would reasonably be expected to result in a material
    adverse change, in the condition, financial or otherwise, or in the
    earnings, business, operations or prospects, whether or not arising from
    transactions in the ordinary course of business, of the Company (any such
    change is called a "Material Adverse Change"); (ii) the Company has not
    incurred any material liability or obligation, indirect, direct or
    contingent, not in the ordinary course of business nor entered into any
    material transaction or agreement not in the ordinary course of business;
    and (iii) there has been no dividend or distribution of any kind declared,
    paid or made by the Company on any class of capital stock or repurchase or
    redemption by the Company of any class of capital stock.      

         (h)  INDEPENDENT ACCOUNTANTS.  Arthur Andersen LLP, who have expressed
    their opinion with respect to the financial statements (which term as used
    in this Agreement includes the related notes thereto) and supporting
    schedules filed with the Commission as a part of the Registration Statement
    and included in the Prospectus, are independent public or certified public
    accountants as required by the Securities Act.



         (i)  PREPARATION OF THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.  The financial
    statements filed with the Commission as a part of the Registration
    Statement and included in the Prospectus present fairly the financial
    position of the Company as of and at the dates indicated and the results of
    its operations and cash flows for the periods specified.  The supporting
    schedules included in the Registration Statement present fairly the
    information required to be stated therein.  Such financial statements and
    supporting schedules have been prepared in conformity with generally
    accepted accounting principles as applied in the United States applied on a
    consistent basis throughout the periods involved, except as may be
    expressly stated in the related notes thereto.  No other financial
    statements or supporting schedules are required to be included in the
    Registration Statement.  The financial data set forth in the Prospectus
    under the captions "Prospectus Summary--Summary Financial Data," "Selected
    Financial Data" and "Capitalization" fairly present the information set
    forth therein on a basis consistent with that of the audited financial
    statements contained in the Registration Statement.  The assumptions used
    in the preparation of the pro forma financial information included in the
    Registration Statement are reasonable and the adjustments used therein are
    appropriate to give effect to the transactions and circumstances referred
    to therein.

         (j)  INCORPORATION AND GOOD STANDING OF THE COMPANY. The Company has
    been duly incorporated and is validly existing as a corporation in good
    standing under the laws of the State of Delaware and has corporate power
    and authority to own, lease and operate its properties and to conduct its
    business as described in the Prospectus and to enter into and perform its
    obligations under this Agreement.  The Company is duly qualified as a
    foreign corporation to transact business and is in good standing in each
    other jurisdiction in which such qualification is required, whether by
    reason of the ownership or leasing of property or the conduct of business,
    except for such jurisdictions where the failure to so qualify or to be in
    good standing would not, individually or in the aggregate, result in a
    Material Adverse Change.  The Company does not own or control, directly or
    indirectly, any corporation, association or other entity.   

         (k)  CAPITALIZATION AND OTHER CAPITAL STOCK MATTERS.  After giving
    effect to the Stock Split and the Series B Conversion (each as defined in
    the Registration Statement) and the filing of the Amended and Restated
    Certificate of Incorporation filed as Exhibit 3.1 to the Registration
    Statement, all of which will occur prior to the First Closing Date, (i) the
    authorized, issued and outstanding capital stock of the Company is as set
    forth in the Prospectus under the caption "Capitalization", and other than
    for subsequent issuances, if any, pursuant to the exercise of outstanding
    options or warrants disclosed in the Prospectus); (ii) the Common Stock
    (including the Common Shares) conforms in all material respects to the
    description thereof contained in the Prospectus; (iii) all of the issued
    and outstanding shares of Common Stock (including the shares of Common
    Stock owned by Selling Stockholders) have been duly authorized and validly
    issued, are fully paid and nonassessable and have been issued in compliance
    with federal and state securities laws, and none of the outstanding shares
    of Common Stock were issued in violation of any preemptive rights, rights
    of first refusal or other similar rights to subscribe for or purchase
    securities of the Company; (iv) there are no authorized or outstanding
    options, warrants, preemptive rights, rights of first refusal or other
    rights to purchase, or equity or debt securities convertible into or
    exchangeable or exercisable for, any capital stock of the Company other
    than those accurately described in the Prospectus (other than the grant of
    stock options under employee benefit plans of the Company in the ordinary
    course of 



    business subsequent to the date of as which stock option information is
    presented in the Prospectus); and (v) the description of the Company's
    stock option, stock bonus and other stock plans or arrangements, and the
    options or other rights granted thereunder, set forth in the Prospectus
    accurately and fairly presents the information required to be shown with
    respect to such plans, arrangements, options and rights.   

         (l)  STOCK EXCHANGE LISTING.   The Common Shares have been approved
    for listing on the New York Stock Exchange, subject only to official notice
    of issuance.     

         (m)  NON-CONTRAVENTION OF EXISTING INSTRUMENTS; NO FURTHER
    AUTHORIZATIONS OR APPROVALS REQUIRED.   The Company is not in violation of
    its Certificate of Incorporation or By-laws or in default (or, with the
    giving of notice or lapse of time, would be in default) ("Default") under
    any indenture, mortgage, loan or credit agreement, note, contract,
    franchise, lease or other instrument to which the Company is a party or by
    which it may be bound, or to which any of the property or assets of the
    Company is subject (each, an "Existing Instrument"), except for such
    Defaults as would not, individually or in the aggregate, result in a
    Material Adverse Change.  The Company's execution, delivery and performance
    of this Agreement and consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby
    and by the Prospectus (i) have been duly authorized by all necessary
    corporate action and will not result in any violation of the provisions of
    the Certificate of Incorporation or By-laws of the Company, (ii) will not
    conflict with or constitute a breach of, or Default or a Debt Repayment
    Triggering Event (as defined below) under, or result in the creation or
    imposition of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any property or assets
    of the Company pursuant to, or require the consent of any other part to,
    any Existing Instrument, except for such conflicts, breaches, Defaults,
    liens, charges or encumbrances as would not, individually or in the
    aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Change and (iii) will not result in
    any violation of any law, administrative regulation or administrative or
    court decree applicable to the Company.  No consent, approval,
    authorization or other order of, or registration or filing with, any court
    or other governmental or regulatory authority or agency, is required for
    the Company's execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement and
    consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and by the Prospectus,
    except such as have been obtained or made by the Company and are in full
    force and effect under the Securities Act, and such as may be required
    under applicable state securities or blue sky laws and from the National
    Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD").  As used herein, a
    "Debt Repayment Triggering Event" means any event or condition which gives,
    or with the giving of notice or lapse of time would give, the holder of any
    note, debenture or other evidence of indebtedness (or any person acting on
    such holder's behalf) the right to require the repurchase, redemption or
    repayment of all or a portion of such indebtedness by the Company.

         (n)  NO MATERIAL ACTIONS OR PROCEEDINGS.  Except as otherwise
    disclosed in the Prospectus, there are no legal or governmental actions,
    suits or proceedings pending or, to the best of the Company's knowledge,
    threatened (i) against or affecting the Company, (ii) which has as the
    subject thereof any officer or director of, or property owned or leased by,
    the Company or (iii) relating to environmental or discrimination matters,
    where in any such case (A) there is a reasonable possibility that such
    action, suit or proceeding might be determined adversely to the Company and
    (B) any such action, suit or proceeding, if so determined adversely, would
    reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Change or adversely
    affect the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this 



    Agreement.  No material labor dispute with the employees of the Company
    exists or, to the best of the Company's knowledge, is threatened or
    imminent.        

         (o)  INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS.  The Company owns or possesses
    sufficient trademarks, trade names, patent rights, copyrights, licenses,
    approvals, trade secrets and other similar rights (collectively,
    "Intellectual Property Rights") reasonably necessary to conduct its
    business as now conducted; and the expected expiration of any of such
    Intellectual Property Rights would not result in a Material Adverse Change. 
    The Company has not received any notice of infringement or conflict with
    asserted Intellectual Property Rights of others, which infringement or
    conflict, if the subject of an unfavorable decision, would result in a
    Material Adverse Change.   

         (p)  ALL NECESSARY PERMITS, ETC.  The Company possesses such valid and
    current certificates, authorizations or permits issued by the appropriate
    state, federal or foreign regulatory agencies or bodies necessary to
    conduct its business (other than any the absence of which would not,
    individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a
    Material Adverse Change), and the Company has not received any notice of
    proceedings relating to the revocation or modification of, or non-
    compliance with, any such certificate, authorization or permit which,
    singly or in the aggregate, if the subject of an unfavorable decision,
    ruling or finding, could result in a Material Adverse Change.     

         (q)  TITLE TO PROPERTIES.  Except as otherwise disclosed in the
    Prospectus, the Company has good and marketable title to all the properties
    and assets reflected as owned in the financial statements referred to in
    Section 1(A) (i) above, in each case free and clear of any security
    interests, mortgages, liens, encumbrances, equities, claims and other
    defects, except such as do not materially and adversely affect the value of
    such property and do not materially interfere with the use made or proposed
    to be made of such property by the Company.  The real property,
    improvements, equipment and personal property held under lease by the
    Company are held under valid and enforceable leases, with such exceptions
    as are not material and do not materially interfere with the use made or
    proposed to be made of such real property, improvements, equipment or
    personal property by the Company.    

         (r)  TAX LAW COMPLIANCE.  The Company has filed all necessary federal,
    state, local and foreign income and franchise tax returns and has paid all
    taxes required to be paid by it and, if due and payable, any related or
    similar assessment, fine or penalty levied against it except as may be
    being contested in good faith and by appropriate proceedings.  The Company
    has made adequate charges, accruals and reserves in the applicable
    financial statements referred to in Section 1 (A) (i)  above in respect of
    all federal, state, local and foreign income and franchise taxes for all
    periods as to which the tax liability of the Company has not been finally
    determined.      

         (s)  COMPLIANCE WITH ENVIRONMENTAL LAWS.  Except as would not,
    individually or in the aggregate, result in a Material Adverse Change
    (i) the Company is not in violation of any federal, state, local or foreign
    law or regulation relating to pollution or protection of human health or
    the environment (including, without limitation, ambient air, surface water,
    groundwater, land surface or subsurface strata) or wildlife, including
    without limitation, laws and regulations relating to emissions, discharges,
    releases or threatened releases of chemicals, pollutants, contaminants,
    wastes, toxic substances, hazardous substances, petroleum and petroleum
    products (collectively, "Materials of Environmental Concern"), or otherwise
    relating to the manufacture, processing, distribution, use, treatment,
    storage, 



    disposal, transport or handling of Materials of Environment Concern
    (collectively, "Environmental Laws"), which violation includes, but is not
    limited to, noncompliance with any permits or other governmental
    authorizations required for the operation of the business of the Company
    under applicable Environmental Laws, or noncompliance with the terms and
    conditions thereof, nor has the Company  received any written
    communication, whether from a governmental authority, citizens group,
    employee or otherwise, that alleges that the Company is in violation of any
    Environmental Law; (ii) there is no claim, action or cause of action filed
    with a court or governmental authority, no investigation with respect to
    which the Company has received written notice, and no written notice by any
    person or entity alleging potential liability for investigatory costs,
    cleanup costs, governmental responses costs, natural resources damages,
    property damages, personal injuries, attorneys' fees or penalties arising
    out of, based on or resulting from the presence, or release into the
    environment, of any Material of Environmental Concern at any location
    owned, leased or operated by the Company, now or in the past (collectively,
    "Environmental Claims"), pending or, to the best of the Company's
    knowledge, threatened against the Company or any person or entity whose
    liability for any Environmental Claim the Company has retained or assumed
    either contractually or by operation of law; and (iii) to the best of the
    Company's knowledge, there are no past or present actions, activities,
    circumstances, conditions, events or incidents, including, without
    limitation, the release, emission, discharge, presence or disposal of any
    Material of Environmental Concern, that reasonably could result in a
    violation of any Environmental Law or form the basis of a potential
    Environmental Claim against the Company or against any person or entity
    whose liability for any Environmental Claim the Company has retained or
    assumed either contractually or by operation of law.    

         (t)  ERISA COMPLIANCE.  The Company and any "employee benefit plan"
    (as defined under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
    amended, and the regulations and published interpretations thereunder
    (collectively, "ERISA")) established or maintained by the Company or any of
    its "ERISA Affiliates" (as defined below) are in compliance in all material
    respects with ERISA.  "ERISA Affiliate" means, with respect to the Company,
    any member of any group of organizations described in
    Sections 414(b),(c),(m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
    amended, and the regulations and published interpretations thereunder (the
    "Code") of which the Company is a member.  No "reportable event" (as
    defined under ERISA) has occurred or is reasonably expected to occur with
    respect to any "employee benefit plan" established or maintained by the
    Company or any of its ERISA Affiliates.  No "employee benefit plan"
    established or maintained by the Company or any of its ERISA Affiliates, if
    such "employee benefit plan" were terminated, would have any "amount of
    unfunded benefit liabilities" (as defined under ERISA).  Neither the
    Company nor any of its ERISA Affiliates has incurred or reasonably expects
    to incur any liability under (i) Title IV of ERISA with respect to
    termination of, or withdrawal from, any "employee benefit plan" or
    (ii) Sections 412, 4971, 4975 or 4980B of the Code.  Each "employee benefit
    plan" established or maintained by the Company or any of its ERISA
    Affiliates that is intended to be qualified under Section 401(a) of the
    Code is so qualified and nothing has occurred, whether by action or failure
    to act, which would cause the loss of such qualification.

         (u)  COMPANY NOT AN "INVESTMENT COMPANY."  The Company has been
    advised of the rules and requirements under the Investment Company Act
    of 1940, as amended (the "Investment Company Act").  The Company is not,
    and after receipt of payment for the 




    Common Shares will not be, an "investment company" within the meaning of
    Investment Company Act and will conduct its business in a manner so that it
    will not become subject to the Investment Company Act.        

         (v)  INSURANCE.  The Company is insured by recognized, financially
    sound and reputable institutions with policies in such amounts and with
    such deductibles and covering such risks as the Company reasonably deems
    adequate and customary for its business including, but not limited to,
    policies covering real and personal property owned or leased by the Company
    against theft, damage, destruction, and acts of vandalism.  The Company has
    no reason to believe that it will not be able (i) to renew its existing
    insurance coverage as and when such policies expire or (ii) to obtain
    comparable coverage from similar institutions as may be necessary or
    appropriate to conduct its business as now conducted and at a cost that
    would not result in a Material Adverse Change.  The Company has not been
    denied any insurance coverage which it has sought or for which it has
    applied.    

         (w)  NO PRICE STABILIZATION OR MANIPULATION.  The Company has not
    taken and will not take, directly or indirectly, any action designed to or
    that might be reasonably expected to cause or result in stabilization or
    manipulation of the price of the Common Stock to facilitate the sale or
    resale of the Common Shares.    

         (x)  RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS.  There are no business relationships
    or related-party transactions involving the Company or any other person
    required to be described in the Prospectus which have not been described as
    required.       

         (y)  NO UNLAWFUL CONTRIBUTIONS OR OTHER PAYMENTS.  Neither the Company
    nor, to the best of the Company's knowledge, any employee or agent of the
    Company, has made any contribution or other payment to any official of, or
    candidate for, any federal, state or foreign office in violation of any law
    or of the character required to be disclosed in the Prospectus. 

         (z)  COMPANY'S ACCOUNTING SYSTEM.  The Company maintains a system of
    accounting controls sufficient to provide reasonable assurances that
    (i) transactions are executed in accordance with management's general or
    specific authorization; (ii)  transactions are recorded as necessary to
    permit preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
    accepted accounting principles as applied in the United States and to
    maintain accountability for assets; (iii) access to assets is permitted
    only in accordance with management's general or specific authorization; and
    (iv) the recorded accountability for assets is compared with existing
    assets at reasonable intervals and appropriate action is taken with respect
    to any differences.        

         Any certificate signed by an officer of the Company and delivered to
the Representatives or to counsel for the Underwriters shall be deemed to be a
representation and warranty by the Company to each Underwriter as to the matters
set forth therein.

    B.  REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES OF THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.  Each
Selling Stockholder represents, warrants and covenants to each Underwriter as
follows:

         (a)  THE UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT.  This Agreement has been duly
    authorized, executed and delivered by or on behalf of such Selling
    Stockholder and is a valid and 




    binding agreement of such Selling Stockholder, enforceable in accordance
    with its terms, except as rights to indemnification hereunder may be
    limited by applicable law and except as the enforcement hereof may be
    limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other
    similar laws relating to or affecting the rights and remedies of creditors
    or by general equitable principles.

         (b)  THE CUSTODY AGREEMENT AND POWER OF ATTORNEY.  Each of the
    (i) Custody Agreement signed by such Selling Stockholder and American Stock
    Transfer and Trust Company, as custodian (the "Custodian"), relating to the
    deposit of the Common Shares to be sold by such Selling Stockholder (the
    "Custody Agreement") and (ii) Power of Attorney appointing certain
    individuals named therein as such Selling Stockholder's attorneys-in-fact
    (each, an "Attorney-in-Fact") to the extent set forth therein relating to
    the transactions contemplated hereby and by the Prospectus (the "Power of
    Attorney"), of such Selling Stockholder has been duly authorized, executed
    and delivered by such Selling Stockholder and is a valid and binding
    agreement of such Selling Stockholder, enforceable in accordance with its
    terms, except as rights to indemnification thereunder may be limited by
    applicable law and except as the enforcement thereof may be limited by
    bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other similar laws
    relating to or affecting the rights and remedies of creditors or by general
    equitable principles.      

         (c)  TITLE TO COMMON SHARES TO BE SOLD; ALL AUTHORIZATIONS OBTAINED. 
    Such Selling Stockholder has, and on the First Closing Date and the Second
    Closing Date (as defined below) will have, good and valid title to all of
    the Common Shares which may be sold by such Selling Stockholder pursuant to
    this Agreement on such date, free and clear of any security interest,
    mortgage, lien, encumbrance or other claim, and the legal right and power,
    and all authorizations and approvals required by law and, to the extent
    applicable, under its charter or by-laws, partnership agreement, trust
    agreement or other organizational documents to enter into this Agreement
    and its Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney, to sell, transfer and
    deliver all of the Common Shares which may be sold by such Selling
    Stockholder pursuant to this Agreement and to comply with its other
    obligations hereunder and thereunder.   

         (d)  DELIVERY OF THE COMMON SHARES TO BE SOLD.  Delivery of the Common
    Shares which are sold by such Selling Stockholder pursuant to this
    Agreement will pass good and valid title to such Common Shares, free and
    clear of any security interest, mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance or
    other claim.     

         (e)  NON-CONTRAVENTION; NO FURTHER AUTHORIZATIONS OR APPROVALS
    REQUIRED.  The execution and delivery by such Selling Stockholder of, and
    the performance by such Selling Stockholder of its obligations under, this
    Agreement, the Custody Agreement and the Power of Attorney will not
    contravene or conflict with, result in a breach of, or constitute a Default
    under, or require the consent of any other party to, to the extent
    applicable, the charter or by-laws, partnership agreement, trust agreement
    or other organizational documents of such Selling Stockholder or any other
    agreement or instrument to which such Selling Stockholder is a party or by
    which it is bound or under which it is entitled to any right or benefit,
    any provision of applicable law or any judgment, order, decree or
    regulation applicable to such Selling Stockholder of any court, regulatory
    body, administrative agency, governmental body or arbitrator having
    jurisdiction over such Selling Stockholder.  No consent, approval,
    authorization or other order of, or registration 




    or filing with, any court or other governmental authority or agency, is
    required for the consummation by such Selling Stockholder of the
    transactions contemplated in this Agreement, except such as have been
    obtained or made and are in full force and effect under the Securities Act
    and such as may be required under applicable state securities or blue sky
    laws and from the NASD.   

         (f)  NO REGISTRATION OR OTHER SIMILAR RIGHTS.  Such Selling
    Stockholder does not have any registration or other similar rights to have
    any equity or debt securities registered for sale by the Company under the
    Registration Statement or included in the offering contemplated by this
    Agreement, except for such rights as have been duly waived.  

         (g)  NO FURTHER CONSENTS, ETC.   Except for the waiver by certain
    other holders of Common Stock of certain registration rights (which waivers
    have been obtained and are in full force and effect) no consent, approval
    or waiver is required under any instrument or agreement to which such
    Selling Stockholder is a party or by which it is bound or under which it is
    entitled to any right or benefit, in connection with the offering, sale or
    purchase by the Underwriters of any of the Common Shares which may be sold
    by such Selling Stockholder under this Agreement or the consummation by
    such Selling Stockholder of any of the other transactions contemplated
    hereby.   

         (h)  DISCLOSURE MADE BY SUCH SELLING STOCKHOLDER IN THE PROSPECTUS. 
    All information furnished by or on behalf of such Selling Stockholder in
    writing expressly for use in the Registration Statement and Prospectus is,
    and on the First Closing Date and the Second Closing Date will be, true,
    correct, and complete in all material respects, and does not, and on the
    First Closing Date and the Second Closing Date will not, contain any untrue
    statement of a material fact or omit to state any material fact necessary
    to make such information not misleading.  Such Selling Stockholder confirms
    as accurate the number of shares of Common Stock set forth opposite such
    Selling Stockholder's name in the Prospectus under the caption "Security
    Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management" (both prior to and
    after giving effect to the sale of the Common Shares).        

         (i)  NO PRICE STABILIZATION OR MANIPULATION.  Such Selling Stockholder
    has not taken and will not take, directly or indirectly, any action
    designed to or that might be reasonably expected to cause or result in
    stabilization or manipulation of the price of the Common Stock to
    facilitate the sale or resale of the Common Shares.      

         (j)  CONFIRMATION OF COMPANY REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.  Such
    Selling Stockholder is not aware that the Registration Statement or
    Prospectus includes any untrue statement of a material fact or omits to
    state any material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make
    the statements therein not misleading.  It is agreed the aggregate
    liability of a Selling Stockholder to the Underwriters (A) for a breach of
    this representation and (B) under Section 8(a) hereof shall not exceed the
    amount of the proceeds (net of the applicable underwriting discount)
    received by such Selling Stockholder with respect to the Shares purchased
    by the Underwriters from such Selling Stockholder hereunder; and that no
    Selling Stockholder shall be liable to an Underwriter for a breach of this
    representation until the Underwriters shall have first made a demand for
    payment on the Company with respect to any damages alleged to result from
    the breach of this representation and the Company shall have either
    rejected such demand or failed to make such requested payment within 60
    days after receipt thereof.   




         Any certificate signed by or on behalf of any Selling Stockholder and
delivered to the Representatives or to counsel for the Underwriters shall be
deemed to be a representation and warranty by such Selling Stockholder to each
Underwriter as to the matters covered thereby.


         SECTION 2.  PURCHASE, SALE AND DELIVERY OF THE COMMON SHARES. 

         THE FIRM COMMON SHARES.  The Company agrees to issue and sell to the
several Underwriters the Firm Common Shares upon the terms herein set forth.  On
the basis of the representations, warranties and agreements herein contained,
and upon the terms but subject to the conditions herein set forth, the
Underwriters agree, severally and not jointly, to purchase from the Company the
respective number of Firm Common Shares set forth opposite their names on
SCHEDULE A (subject to the provisions of Section 10 hereof).  The purchase price
per Firm Common Share to be paid by the several Underwriters to the Company
shall be $___ per share.

         THE FIRST CLOSING DATE.  Delivery of certificates for the Firm Common
Shares to be purchased by the Underwriters and payment therefor shall be made at
the offices of Montgomery Securities, 600 Montgomery Street, San Francisco,
California  (or such other place as may be agreed to by the Company and the
Representatives) at 6:00 a.m. San Francisco time, on ___ [THE FOURTH FULL
BUSINESS DAY AFTER THE DATE OF THIS AGREEMENT, UNLESS THE PRICING OCCURS AT A
TIME EARLIER THAN 4:30 P.M., EAST COAST TIME, IN WHICH CASE THE THIRD FULL
BUSINESS DAY AFTER THE DATE OF THIS AGREEMENT] or such other time and date not
later than 10:30 a.m. San Francisco time, on ___ [TEN BUSINESS DAYS FOLLOWING
THE ORIGINAL CONTEMPLATED FIRST CLOSING DATE] as the Representatives shall
designate by notice to the Company (the time and date of such closing are called
the "First Closing Date").  The Company hereby acknowledges that circumstances
under which the Representatives may provide notice to postpone the First Closing
Date as originally scheduled include, but are in no way limited to, any
determination by the Company or the Representatives to recirculate to the public
copies of an amended or supplemented Prospectus or a delay as contemplated by
the provisions of Section 10.

         THE OPTIONAL COMMON SHARES; THE SECOND CLOSING DATE.  In addition, on
the basis of the representations, warranties and agreements herein contained,
and upon the terms but subject to the conditions herein set forth, the Selling
Stockholders hereby grant an option to the several Underwriters to purchase,
severally and not jointly, up to an aggregate of 532,500 Optional Common Shares
from the Selling Stockholders at the purchase price per share to be paid by the
Underwriters for the Firm Common Shares.  The option granted hereunder is for
use by the Underwriters solely in covering any over-allotments in connection
with the sale and distribution of the Firm Common Shares.  The option granted
hereunder may be exercised at any time (but not more than once) upon notice by
the Representatives to the Selling Stockholders (with a copy to the Company), 
which notice may be given at any time within 30 days from the date of this
Agreement.  Such notice shall set forth (i) the aggregate number of Optional
Common Shares as to which the Underwriters are exercising the option, (ii) the
names and denominations in which the certificates for the Optional Common Shares
are to be registered and (iii) the time, date and place at which such
certificates will be delivered (which time and date may be simultaneous with,
but not earlier than, the First Closing Date; and in such case the term "First
Closing Date" shall refer to the time and date of delivery of certificates for
the Firm Common Shares and the Optional Common Shares). Such time and date of
delivery, if subsequent to the First Closing Date, is called the "Second Closing
Date" and shall be determined by the Representatives and shall not be earlier
than three nor later than five full business days after delivery of such notice
of exercise.  If any Optional Common 





Shares are to be purchased, (a) each Underwriter agrees, severally and not
jointly, to purchase the number of Optional Common Shares (subject to such
adjustments to eliminate fractional shares as the Representatives may determine)
that bears the same proportion to the total number of Optional Common Shares to
be purchased as the number of Firm Common Shares set forth on SCHEDULE A
opposite the name of such Underwriter bears to the total number of Firm Common
Shares and (b) each Selling Stockholder agrees, severally and not jointly, to
sell the number of Optional Common Shares (subject to such adjustments to
eliminate fractional shares as the Representatives may determine) that bears the
same proportion to the total number of Optional Common Shares to be sold as the
number of Optional Common Shares set forth in SCHEDULE B opposite the name of
such Selling Stockholder bears to the total number of Optional Common Shares. 
The Representatives may cancel the option at any time prior to its expiration by
giving written notice of such cancellation to the Selling Stockholders (with a
copy to the Company).   

         PUBLIC OFFERING OF THE COMMON SHARES.  The Representatives hereby
advise the Company and the Selling Stockholders that the Underwriters intend to
offer for sale to the public, as described in the Prospectus, their respective
portions of the Common Shares as soon after this Agreement has been executed and
the Registration Statement has been declared effective as the Representatives,
in their sole judgment, has determined is advisable and practicable.

         PAYMENT FOR THE COMMON SHARES.  Payment for the Common Shares to be
sold by the Company shall be made at the First Closing Date by wire transfer of
immediately available funds to the order of the Company.  Payment for the Common
Shares to be sold by the Selling Stockholders shall be made, if applicable, at
the Second Closing Date by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the
order of the Custodian.           

         It is understood that the Representatives have been authorized, for
their own account and the accounts of the several Underwriters, to accept
delivery of and receipt for, and make payment of the purchase price for, the
Firm Common Shares and any Optional Common Shares the Underwriters have agreed
to purchase.  Montgomery Securities, individually and not as a Representative of
the Underwriters, may (but shall not be obligated to) make payment for any
Common Shares to be purchased by any Underwriter whose funds shall not have been
received by the Representatives by the First Closing Date or the Second Closing
Date, as the case may be, for the account of such Underwriter, but any such
payment shall not relieve such Underwriter from any of its obligations under
this Agreement.         

         Each Selling Stockholder hereby agrees that (i) it will pay all stock
transfer taxes, stamp duties and other similar taxes, if any, payable upon the
sale or delivery of the Common Shares to be sold by such Selling Stockholder to
the several Underwriters, or otherwise in connection with the performance of
such Selling Stockholder's obligations hereunder and (ii) the Custodian is
authorized to deduct for such payment any such amounts from the proceeds to such
Selling Stockholder hereunder and to hold such amounts for the account of such
Selling Stockholder with the Custodian under the Custody Agreement.       

         DELIVERY OF THE COMMON SHARES.  The Company shall deliver, or cause to
be delivered, to the Representatives for the accounts of the several
Underwriters certificates for the Firm Common Shares at the First Closing Date,
against the irrevocable release of a wire transfer of immediately available
funds for the amount of the purchase price therefor.  The Selling Stockholders
shall deliver, or cause to be delivered, to the Representatives for the accounts
of the several Underwriters, certificates for the Optional Common Shares the
Underwriters have elected to purchase from them at the Second Closing Date,
against the irrevocable release of a wire transfer of immediately available
funds for the amount of the purchase price therefor.  The certificates for the
Common Shares shall be in definitive form and registered in such names and
denominations as the 





Representatives shall have requested at least two full business days prior to
the First Closing Date (or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be) and
shall be made available for inspection on the business day preceding the First
Closing Date (or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be) at a location in
New York City as the Representatives may designate.  Time shall be of the
essence, and delivery at the time and place specified in this Agreement is a
further condition to the obligations of the Underwriters.       

         DELIVERY OF PROSPECTUS TO THE UNDERWRITERS.  Not later than 12:00 p.m.
on the second business day following the date the Common Shares are released by
the Underwriters for sale to the public, the Company shall deliver or cause to
be delivered copies of the Prospectus in such quantities and at such places as
the Representatives shall request.      


         SECTION 3.  ADDITIONAL COVENANTS

    A.  COVENANTS OF THE COMPANY.  The Company further covenants and agrees
with each Underwriter as follows:      

         (a)  REPRESENTATIVE'S REVIEW OF PROPOSED AMENDMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTS. 
    During such period beginning on the date hereof and ending on the later of
    the First Closing Date or such date, as in the opinion of counsel for the
    Underwriters, the Prospectus is no longer required by law to be delivered
    in connection with sales by an Underwriter or dealer (the "Prospectus
    Delivery Period"), prior to amending or supplementing the Registration
    Statement (including any registration statement filed under Rule 462(b)
    under the Securities Act) or the Prospectus, the Company shall furnish to
    the Representatives for review a copy of each such proposed amendment or
    supplement, and the Company shall not file any such proposed amendment or
    supplement to which the Representatives reasonably object.    

         (b)  SECURITIES ACT COMPLIANCE.  After the date of this Agreement, the
    Company shall promptly advise the Representatives in writing (i) of the
    receipt of any comments of, or requests for additional or supplemental
    information from, the Commission, (ii) of the time and date of any filing
    of any post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement or any
    amendment or supplement to any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus,
    (iii) of the time and date that any post-effective amendment to the
    Registration Statement becomes effective and (iv) of the issuance by the
    Commission of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of the
    Registration Statement or any post-effective amendment thereto or of any
    order preventing or suspending the use of any preliminary prospectus or the
    Prospectus, or of any proceedings to remove, suspend or terminate from
    listing or quotation the Common Stock from any securities exchange upon
    which the it is listed for trading or included or designated for quotation,
    or of the threatening or initiation of any proceedings for any of such
    purposes.  If the Commission shall enter any such stop order at any time,
    the Company will use its best efforts to obtain the lifting of such order
    at the earliest possible moment.  Additionally, the Company agrees that it
    shall comply with the provisions of Rules 424(b), 430A and 434, as
    applicable, under the Securities Act and will use its reasonable efforts to
    confirm that any filings made by the Company under such Rule 424(b) were
    received in a timely manner by the Commission.      

         (c)  AMENDMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTS TO THE PROSPECTUS AND OTHER SECURITIES
    ACT MATTERS. If, during the Prospectus Delivery Period, any event shall
    occur or condition exist as a result of which it is necessary to amend or
    supplement the Prospectus in order to make the 



    statements therein, in the light of the circumstances when the Prospectus
    is delivered to a purchaser, not misleading, or if in the opinion of the
    Representatives or counsel for the Underwriters it is otherwise necessary
    to amend or supplement the Prospectus to comply with law, the Company
    agrees to promptly prepare (subject to Section 3(A)(a) hereof), file with
    the Commission and furnish at its own expense to the Underwriters and to
    dealers, amendments or supplements to the Prospectus so that the statements
    in the Prospectus as so amended or supplemented will not, in the light of
    the circumstances when the Prospectus is delivered to a purchaser, be
    misleading or so that the Prospectus, as amended or supplemented, will
    comply with law.      

         (d)  COPIES OF ANY AMENDMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTS TO THE PROSPECTUS.  The
    Company agrees to furnish the Representatives, without charge, during the
    Prospectus Delivery Period, as many copies of the Prospectus and any
    amendments and supplements thereto as the Representatives may request.

         (e)  BLUE SKY COMPLIANCE.  The Company shall cooperate with the
    Representatives and counsel for the Underwriters to qualify or register the
    Common Shares for sale under (or obtain exemptions from the application of)
    the Blue Sky or state securities laws of those jurisdictions designated by
    the Representatives, shall comply with such laws and shall continue such
    qualifications, registrations and exemptions in effect so long as required
    for the distribution of the Common Shares.  The Company shall not be
    required to qualify as a foreign corporation or to take any action that
    would subject it to general service of process in any such jurisdiction
    where it is not presently qualified or where it would be subject to
    taxation as a foreign corporation. The Company will advise the
    Representatives promptly of the suspension of the qualification or
    registration of (or any such exemption relating to) the Common Shares for
    offering, sale or trading in any jurisdiction or any initiation or threat
    of any proceeding for any such purpose, and in the event of the issuance of
    any order suspending such qualification, registration or exemption, the
    Company shall use its best efforts to obtain the withdrawal thereof at the
    earliest possible moment.

         (f)  USE OF PROCEEDS.  The Company shall apply the net proceeds from
    the sale of the Common Shares sold by it in the manner described under the
    caption "Use of Proceeds" in the Prospectus.       
         
         (g)  TRANSFER AGENT.  The Company shall engage and maintain, at its
    expense, a registrar and transfer agent for the Common Stock.     

              h)  EARNINGS STATEMENT.  As soon as practicable, the Company will
    make generally available to its security holders and to the Representatives
    in the manner specified by Rule 158(b) under the Securities Act an earnings
    statement (which need not be audited) covering the twelve-month period
    ending November 1, 1998 that satisfies the provisions of Section 11(a) of
    the Securities Act and Rule 158(a) under the Securities Act.       

         (j)  PERIODIC REPORTING OBLIGATIONS.  During the Prospectus Delivery
    Period the Company shall file, on a timely basis, with the Commission and
    the New York Stock Exchange all reports and documents required to be filed
    under the Exchange Act. Additionally, the Company shall file with the
    Commission all reports on Form SR as may be required under Rule 463 under
    the Securities Act.  




         (k)  AGREEMENT NOT TO OFFER OR SELL ADDITIONAL SECURITIES.  During the
    period of 180 days following the date of the Prospectus, the Company will
    not, without the prior written consent of Montgomery Securities (which
    consent may be withheld at the sole discretion of Montgomery Securities),
    directly or indirectly, sell, offer, contract or grant any option to sell,
    pledge, transfer, establish an open "put equivalent position" within the
    meaning of Rule 16a-1(h) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
    amended (the "Exchange Act"), or otherwise dispose of or transfer, or
    announce the offering of, or file any registration statement under the
    Securities Act in respect of, any shares of Common Stock, options or
    warrants to acquire shares of the Common Stock or securities exchangeable
    or exercisable for or convertible into shares of Common Stock (other than
    as contemplated by this Agreement with respect to the Common Shares);
    PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the Company may (i) file one or more Registration
    Statements on Form S-8 covering shares of Common Stock issuable pursuant to
    any stock option or stock purchase plan described in the Prospectus and
    (ii) issue shares of its Common Stock or options to purchase its Common
    Stock, or Common Stock upon exercise of options, pursuant to any stock
    option or stock purchase plan described in the Prospectus, but only if the
    holders of such shares, options, or shares issued upon exercise of such
    options, agree in writing not to sell, offer, dispose of or otherwise
    transfer any such shares or options during such 180 day period without the
    prior written consent of Montgomery Securities (which consent may be
    withheld at the sole discretion of the Montgomery Securities).    

         (l)  FUTURE REPORTS TO THE REPRESENTATIVES.  During the period of five
    years hereafter the Company will furnish to each Representative (i) as soon
    as practicable after the end of each fiscal year, copies of the Annual
    Report of the Company containing the balance sheet of the Company as of the
    close of such fiscal year and statements of income, stockholders' equity
    and cash flows for the year then ended and the opinion thereon of the
    Company's independent public or certified public accountants; (ii) as soon
    as practicable after the filing thereof, copies of each proxy statement,
    Annual Report on Form 10-K, Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, Current Report
    on Form 8-K or other report filed by the Company with the Commission, the
    NASD or any securities exchange; and (iii) as soon as available, copies of
    any report or communication of the Company mailed generally to holders of
    its capital stock.    

    B.  COVENANTS OF THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.   Each Selling Stockholder
further covenants and agrees with each Underwriter:   

         (a)  AGREEMENT NOT TO OFFER OR SELL ADDITIONAL SECURITIES.   Such
    Selling Stockholder shall enter into an agreement in the form of EXHIBIT C
    hereto relating to restrictions on the disposition by such Selling
    Stockholder of any shares of Common Stock, options or warrants to acquire
    shares of Common Stock, or securities exchangeable or exercisable for or
    convertible into shares of Common Stock for a period commencing on the date
    hereof and continuing through the close of trading on the date 180 days
    after the date of the Prospectus.  
         
         (b)  DELIVERY OF FORMS W-8 AND W-9 .  To deliver to the
    Representatives prior to the First Closing Date a properly completed and
    executed United States Treasury Department Form W-8 (if the Selling
    Stockholder is a non-United States person) or Form W-9 (if the Selling
    Stockholder is a United States Person).




         Montgomery Securities, on behalf of the several Underwriters, may, in
its sole discretion, waive in writing the performance by the Company or any
Selling Stockholder of any one or more of the foregoing covenants or extend the
time for their performance. 


         SECTION 4.  PAYMENT OF EXPENSES.  The Company agrees to pay all costs,
fees and expenses incurred in connection with the performance of its obligations
hereunder and in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby, including
without limitation (i) all expenses incident to the issuance and delivery of the
Common Shares (including all printing and engraving costs), (ii) all fees and
expenses of the registrar and transfer agent of the Common Stock, (iii) all
necessary issue, transfer and other stamp taxes in connection with the issuance
and sale of the Common Shares to the Underwriters, (iv) all fees and expenses of
the Company's counsel, independent public or certified pubic accountants and
other advisors, (v) all costs and expenses incurred in connection with the
preparation, printing, filing, shipping and distribution of the Registration
Statement (including financial statements, exhibits, schedules, consents and
certificates of experts), each preliminary prospectus and the Prospectus, and
all amendments and supplements thereto, and this Agreement, (vi) all filing
fees, attorneys' fees and expenses incurred by the Company or the Underwriters
in connection with qualifying or registering (or obtaining exemptions from the
qualification or registration of) all or any part of the Common Shares for offer
and sale under the Blue Sky laws, and, if requested by the Representatives,
preparing and printing a "Blue Sky Survey" or memorandum, and any supplements
thereto, advising the Underwriters of such qualifications, registrations and
exemptions, (vii) the filing fees incident to, and the reasonable fees and
expenses of counsel for the Underwriters in connection with, the NASD's review
and approval of the Underwriters' participation in the offering and distribution
of the Common Shares, (viii)  the fees and expenses associated with listing the
Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange, and (ix) all other fees, costs and
expenses referred to in Item 13 of Part II of the Registration Statement. 
Except as provided in this Section 4, Section 6, Section 8 and Section 9 hereof,
the Underwriters shall pay their own expenses, including the fees and
disbursements of their counsel.        

         The Selling Stockholders further agree with each Underwriter to pay
(directly or by reimbursement) all fees and expenses incident to the performance
of their obligations under this Agreement which are not otherwise specifically
provided for herein, including but not limited to (i) fees and expenses of
counsel and other advisors for such Selling Stockholders, (ii) fees and expenses
of the Custodian and (iii) expenses and taxes incident to the sale and delivery
of the Common Shares to be sold by such Selling Stockholders to the Underwriters
hereunder (which taxes, if any, may be deducted by the Custodian under the
provisions of Section 2 of this Agreement).      

         This Section 4 shall not affect or modify any separate, valid
agreement relating to the allocation of payment of expenses between the Company,
on the one hand, and the Selling Stockholders, on the other hand.         

         SECTION 5.  CONDITIONS OF THE OBLIGATIONS OF THE UNDERWRITERS.  The
obligations of the several Underwriters to purchase and pay for the Common
Shares as provided herein on the First Closing Date and, with respect to the
Optional Common Shares, the Second Closing Date, shall be subject to the
accuracy of the representations and warranties on the part of the Company and
the Selling Stockholders set forth in Sections 1(A) and 1(B) hereof as of the
date hereof and as of the First Closing Date as though then made and, with
respect to the Optional Common Shares, as of the Second Closing Date as though
then made, to the timely performance by the Company and the 




Selling Stockholders of their respective covenants and other obligations
hereunder, and to each of the following additional conditions:  

         (a)  ACCOUNTANTS' COMFORT LETTER. On the date hereof, the
    Representatives shall have received from Arthur Andersen LLP, independent
    public or certified public accountants for the Company, a letter dated the
    date hereof addressed to the Underwriters, in form and substance reasonably
    satisfactory to the Representatives, containing statements and information
    of the type ordinarily included in accountants' "comfort letters" to
    underwriters, delivered according to Statement of Auditing Standards No. 72
    (or any successor bulletin), with respect to the audited and unaudited
    financial statements and certain financial information contained in the
    Registration Statement and the Prospectus (and each Representative shall
    have a conformed copy of such accountants' letter).    

         (b)  COMPLIANCE WITH REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS; NO STOP ORDER; NO
    OBJECTION FROM NASD.  For the period from and after effectiveness of this
    Agreement and prior to the First Closing Date and, with respect to the
    Optional Common Shares, the Second Closing Date:    

              (i)  the Company shall have filed the Prospectus with the
    Commission (including the information required by Rule 430A under the
    Securities Act) in the manner and within the time period required by Rule
    424(b) under the Securities Act; or the Company shall have filed a
    post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement containing the
    information required by such Rule 430A, and such post-effective amendment
    shall have become effective; or, if the Company elected to rely upon
    Rule 434 under the Securities Act and obtained the Representative's consent
    thereto, the Company shall have filed a Term Sheet with the Commission in
    the manner and within the time period required by such Rule 424(b);     

              (ii)  no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the
    Registration Statement, any Rule 462(b) Registration Statement, or any
    post-effective amendment to the Registration Statement, shall be in effect
    and no proceedings for such purpose shall have been instituted or
    threatened by the Commission; and    

              (iii)  the NASD shall have raised no objection to the fairness
    and reasonableness of the underwriting terms and arrangements.   

         (c)  NO MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE.  For the period from and after the
    date of this Agreement and prior to the First Closing Date and, with
    respect to the Optional Common Shares, the Second Closing Date, in the
    judgment of the Representatives there shall not have occurred any Material
    Adverse Change.       

         (d)  OPINION OF COUNSEL FOR THE COMPANY.  On each of the First Closing
    Date and the Second Closing Date the Representatives shall have received
    the opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan LLP, counsel for the Company,
    dated as of such Closing Date, in substantially the form attached as
    EXHIBIT A (and each Representative shall have received a conformed copy of
    such counsel's legal opinion).

         (e)  OPINION OF COUNSEL FOR THE UNDERWRITERS.  On each of the First
    Closing Date and the Second Closing Date the Representatives shall have
    received the favorable opinion of Hale and Dorr LLP, counsel for the
    Underwriters, dated as of such Closing Date, with respect to 




    matters such as may be reasonably requested by the Representatives (and
    each Representative shall have received a conformed copy of such counsel's
    legal opinion).     

         (f)  OFFICERS' CERTIFICATE.  On each of the First Closing Date and the
    Second Closing Date the Representatives shall have received a written
    certificate executed by the Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer
    or President of the Company and the Chief Financial Officer or Chief
    Accounting Officer of the Company, dated as of such Closing Date, to the
    effect set forth in subsections (b)(ii) of this Section 5, and further to
    the effect that:     

              (i)  for the period from and after the date of this Agreement and
    prior to such Closing Date, there has not occurred any Material Adverse
    Change;   

              (ii)  the representations and warranties of the Company set forth
    in Section 1(A) of this Agreement are true and correct with the same force
    and effect as though expressly made on and as of such Closing Date; and

              (iii)  the Company has complied with all the agreements and
    satisfied all the conditions on its part to be performed or satisfied at or
    prior to such Closing Date.   

         (g)  BRING-DOWN COMFORT LETTER.  On each of the First Closing Date and
    the Second Closing Date the Representatives shall have received from Arthur
    Andersen LLP, independent public or certified public accountants for the
    Company, a letter dated such date, in form and substance satisfactory to
    the Representatives, to the effect that they reaffirm the statements made
    in the letter furnished by them pursuant to subsection (a) of this
    Section 5, except that the specified date referred to therein for the
    carrying out of procedures shall be no more than five business days prior
    to the First Closing Date or Second Closing Date, as the case may be (and
    each Representative shall have received a conformed copy of such
    accountants' letter). 

         (h)  OPINION OF COUNSEL FOR THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.  On the Second
    Closing Date the Representatives shall have received the opinion of Stroock
    & Stroock & Lavan LLP, special counsel for the Selling Stockholders, dated
    as of the Second Closing Date, in substantially the form attached as
    EXHIBIT B (and each Representative shall have received a conformed copy of
    such counsel's legal opinion).      

         (i)  SELLING STOCKHOLDERS' CERTIFICATE.  On each of the First Closing
    Date and the Second Closing Date the Representatives shall received a
    written certificate executed by the Attorney-in-Fact of each Selling
    Stockholder, dated as of such Closing Date, to the effect that:    

              (i)  the representations and warranties of such Selling
    Stockholder set forth in Section 1(B) of this Agreement are true and
    correct with the same force and effect as though expressly made by such
    Selling Stockholder on and as of such Closing Date; and       

              (ii)  such Selling Stockholder has complied with all the
    agreements and satisfied all the conditions on its part to be performed or
    satisfied at or prior to such Closing Date.  

         (j)  SELLING STOCKHOLDERS' DOCUMENTS. On the date hereof, the Company
    and the Selling Stockholders shall have furnished for review by the
    Representatives copies of the Powers of Attorney and Custody Agreements
    executed by each of the Selling Stockholders and such 




    further information, certificates and documents as the Representatives may
    reasonably request.      

         (k)  LOCK-UP AGREEMENT FROM CERTAIN STOCKHOLDERS OF THE COMPANY OTHER
    THAN SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.  On the date hereof, the Company shall have
    furnished to the Representatives an agreement in the form of EXHIBIT C-1 or
    EXHIBIT C-2 hereto, as applicable, from each director, officer and each
    beneficial owner of Common Stock (as defined and determined according to
    Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act, except that a one hundred eighty day
    period shall be used rather than the sixty day period set forth therein),
    and such agreement shall be in full force and effect on each of the First
    Closing Date and the Second Closing Date.    

         (l)  ADDITIONAL DOCUMENTS.  On or before each of the First Closing
    Date and the Second Closing Date, the Representatives and counsel for the
    Underwriters shall have received such information, documents and opinions
    as they may reasonably require for the purposes of enabling them to pass
    upon the issuance and sale of the Common Shares as contemplated herein, or
    in order to evidence the accuracy of any of the representations and
    warranties, or the satisfaction of any of the conditions or agreements,
    herein contained.   


         If any condition specified in this Section 5 is not satisfied when and
as required to be satisfied, this Agreement may be terminated by the
Representatives by notice to the Company at any time on or prior to the First
Closing Date and, with respect to the Optional Common Shares, at any time prior
to the Second Closing Date, which termination shall be without liability on the
part of any party to any other party, except that Section 4, Section 6,
Section 8 and Section 9 shall at all times be effective and shall survive such
termination.       

         SECTION 6.  REIMBURSEMENT OF UNDERWRITERS' EXPENSES.  If this
Agreement is terminated by the Representatives pursuant to Section 5 or Section
11, or if the sale to the Underwriters of the Common Shares on the First Closing
Date is not consummated because of any refusal, inability or failure on the part
of the Company to perform any agreement herein or to comply with any provision
hereof, the Company agrees to reimburse the Representatives and the other
Underwriters (or such Underwriters as have terminated this Agreement with
respect to themselves), severally, upon demand for all out-of-pocket expenses
that shall have been reasonably incurred by the Representatives and the
Underwriters in connection with the proposed purchase and the offering and sale
of the Common Shares, including but not limited to fees and disbursements of
counsel, printing expenses, travel expenses, postage, facsimile and telephone
charges.           

         SECTION 7.  EFFECTIVENESS OF THIS AGREEMENT.  This Agreement shall not
become effective until the later of (i) the execution of this Agreement by the
parties hereto and (ii) notification by the Commission to the Company and the
Representatives of the effectiveness of the Registration Statement under the
Securities Act.         

         Prior to such effectiveness, this Agreement may be terminated by any
party by notice to each of the other parties hereto, and any such termination
shall be without liability on the part of (a) the Company or the Selling
Stockholders to any Underwriter, except that the Company shall be obligated to
reimburse the expenses of the Representatives and the Underwriters pursuant to
Section 4 hereof, (b) of any Underwriter to the Company or the Selling
Stockholders, or (c) of any party hereto to any other party except that the
provisions of Section 8 and Section 9 shall at all times be effective and shall
survive such termination.




         SECTION 8.  INDEMNIFICATION.  

         (a)  INDEMNIFICATION OF THE UNDERWRITERS.  The Company and each of the
    Selling Stockholders, jointly and severally, agree to indemnify and hold
    harmless each Underwriter, its officers and employees, and each person, if
    any, who controls any Underwriter within the meaning of the Securities Act
    and the Exchange Act against any loss, claim, damage, liability or expense,
    as incurred, to which such Underwriter or such controlling person may
    become subject, under the Securities Act, the Exchange Act or other federal
    or state statutory law or regulation, or at common law or otherwise
    (including in settlement of any litigation, if such settlement is effected
    with the written consent of the Company), insofar as such loss, claim,
    damage, liability or expense (or actions in respect thereof as contemplated
    below) arises out of or is based (i) upon any untrue statement or alleged
    untrue statement of a material fact contained in the Registration
    Statement, or any amendment thereto, including any information deemed to be
    a part thereof pursuant to Rule 430A or Rule 434 under the Securities Act,
    or the omission or alleged omission therefrom of a material fact required
    to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
    misleading; or (ii) upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement
    of a material fact contained in any preliminary prospectus or the
    Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto), or the omission or
    alleged omission therefrom of a material fact necessary in order to make
    the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which they
    were made, not misleading; or (iii) in whole or in part upon any inaccuracy
    in the representations and warranties of the Company or the Selling
    Stockholders contained herein; or (iv) in whole or in part upon any failure
    of the Company or the Selling Stockholders to perform their respective
    obligations hereunder or under law; or (v) any act or failure to act or any
    alleged act or failure to act by any Underwriter in connection with, or
    relating in any manner to, the Common Stock or the offering contemplated
    hereby, and which is included as part of or referred to in any loss, claim,
    damage, liability or action arising out of or based upon any matter covered
    by clause (i) or (ii) above, PROVIDED that the Company shall not be liable
    under this clause (v) to the extent that a court of competent jurisdiction
    shall have determined by a final judgment that such loss, claim, damage,
    liability or action resulted directly from any such acts or failures to act
    undertaken or omitted to be taken by such Underwriter through its gross
    negligence or willful misconduct; and to reimburse each Underwriter and
    each such controlling person for any and all expenses (including the fees
    and disbursements of counsel chosen by Montgomery Securities) as such
    expenses are reasonably incurred by such Underwriter or such controlling
    person in connection with investigating, defending, settling, compromising
    or paying any such loss, claim, damage, liability, expense or action;
    PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the foregoing indemnity agreement shall not apply
    to any loss, claim, damage, liability or expense to the extent, but only to
    the extent, arising out of or based upon any untrue statement or alleged
    untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in reliance upon and
    in conformity with written information furnished to the Company by or on
    behalf of the Representatives expressly for use in the Registration
    Statement, any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus (or any amendment
    or supplement thereto); and PROVIDED, further, that with respect to any
    preliminary prospectus, the foregoing indemnity agreement shall not inure
    to the benefit of any Underwriter from whom the person asserting any loss,
    claim, damage, liability or expense purchased Common Shares, or any person
    controlling such Underwriter, if copies of the Prospectus were timely
    delivered to the Underwriter pursuant to Section 2 and a copy of the
    Prospectus (as then amended or supplemented if the 




    Company shall have furnished any amendments or supplements thereto) was not
    sent or given by or on behalf of such Underwriter to such person, if
    required by law so to have been delivered, at or prior to the written
    confirmation of the sale of the Common Shares to such person, and if the
    Prospectus (as so amended or supplemented) would have cured the defect
    giving rise to such loss, claim, damage, liability or expense; and
    PROVIDED, further, that no Selling Stockholder shall be liable under this
    Section 8(a) for an amount in excess of the proceeds (net of the applicable
    underwriting discount) received by such Selling Stockholder with respect to
    any Shares purchased by the Underwriters from such Selling Stockholder
    hereunder; and PROVIDED, further that no Selling Stockholder shall be
    required to provide indemnification hereunder until the Underwriters or
    controlling persons seeking indemnification shall have first made a demand
    for payment on the Company with respect to any such loss, claim, damage,
    liability or expense and the Company shall have either rejected such demand
    or failed to make such requested payment within 60 days after receipt
    thereof.  The indemnity agreement set forth in this Section 8(a) shall be
    in addition to any liabilities that the Company and the Selling
    Stockholders may otherwise have.   

         (b)  INDEMNIFICATION OF THE COMPANY, ITS DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS AND
    THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS.  Each Underwriter agrees, severally and not
    jointly, to indemnify and hold harmless the Company, each of its directors,
    each of its officers who signed the Registration Statement, the Selling
    Stockholders and each person, if any, who controls the Company or any
    Selling Stockholder within the meaning of the Securities Act or the
    Exchange Act, against any loss, claim, damage, liability or expense, as
    incurred, to which the Company, or any such director, officer, Selling
    Stockholder or controlling person may become subject, under the Securities
    Act, the Exchange Act, or other federal or state statutory law or
    regulation, or at common law or otherwise (including in settlement of any
    litigation, if such settlement is effected with the written consent of such
    Underwriter), insofar as such loss, claim, damage, liability or expense (or
    actions in respect thereof as contemplated below) arises out of or is based
    upon any untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact contained in
    the Registration Statement, any preliminary prospectus or the Prospectus
    (or any amendment or supplement thereto), or arises out of or is based upon
    the omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required
    to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not
    misleading, in each case to the extent, but only to the extent, that such
    untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged
    omission was made in the Registration Statement, any preliminary
    prospectus, the Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto), in
    reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the
    Company by or on behalf of the Representatives expressly for use therein;
    and to reimburse the Company, or any such director, officer, Selling
    Stockholder or controlling person for any legal and other expense
    reasonably incurred by the Company, or any such director, officer, Selling
    Stockholder or controlling person in connection with investigating,
    defending, settling, compromising or paying any such loss, claim, damage,
    liability, expense or action. The Company and each of the Selling
    Stockholders, hereby acknowledges that the only information that has been
    furnished to the Company by or on behalf of the Representatives expressly
    for use in the Registration Statement, any preliminary prospectus or the
    Prospectus (or any amendment or supplement thereto) are the statements set
    forth (A) in the last paragraph on the inside front cover page of the
    Prospectus concerning stabilization by the Underwriters and (B) in the
    table in the first paragraph and in the second and fifth paragraph and the
    last sentence of the ninth paragraph under the caption "Underwriting" in
    the Prospectus; and the Underwriters confirm that such statements are 




    correct. The indemnity agreement set forth in this Section 8(b) shall be in
    addition to any liabilities that each Underwriter may otherwise have.      

         (c)  NOTIFICATIONS AND OTHER INDEMNIFICATION PROCEDURES.  Promptly
    after receipt by an indemnified party under this Section 8 of notice of the
    commencement of any action, such indemnified party will, if a claim in
    respect thereof is to be made against an indemnifying party under this
    Section 8, notify the indemnifying party in writing of the commencement
    thereof, but the omission so to notify the indemnifying party will not
    relieve it from any liability which it may have to any indemnified party
    for contribution or otherwise than under the indemnity agreement contained
    in this Section 8 or to the extent it is not prejudiced as a proximate
    result of such failure.  In case any such action is brought against any
    indemnified party and such indemnified party seeks or intends to seek
    indemnity from an indemnifying party, the indemnifying party will be
    entitled to participate in, and, to the extent that it shall elect, jointly
    with all other indemnifying parties similarly notified, by written notice
    delivered to the indemnified party promptly after receiving the aforesaid
    notice from such indemnified party, to assume the defense thereof with
    counsel reasonably satisfactory to such indemnified party; PROVIDED,
    HOWEVER, if the defendants in any such action include both the indemnified
    party and the indemnifying party and the indemnified party shall have
    reasonably concluded that a conflict may arise between the positions of the
    indemnifying party and the indemnified party in conducting the defense of
    any such action or that there may be legal defenses available to it and/or
    other indemnified parties which are different from or additional to those
    available to the indemnifying party, the indemnified party or parties shall
    have the right to select separate counsel to assume such legal defenses and
    to otherwise participate in the defense of such action on behalf of such
    indemnified party or parties.  Upon receipt of notice from the indemnifying
    party to such indemnified party of such indemnifying party's election so to
    assume the defense of such action and approval by the indemnified party of
    counsel, the indemnifying party will not be liable to such indemnified
    party under this Section 8 for any legal or other expenses subsequently
    incurred by such indemnified party in connection with the defense thereof
    unless (i) the indemnified party shall have employed separate counsel in
    accordance with the proviso to the next preceding sentence (it being
    understood, however, that the indemnifying party shall not be liable for
    the expenses of more than one separate counsel (together with local
    counsel), approved by the indemnifying party (Montgomery Securities in the
    case of Section 8(b) and Section 9, representing the indemnified parties
    who are parties to such action) or (ii) the indemnifying party shall not
    have employed counsel satisfactory to the indemnified party to represent
    the indemnified party within a reasonable time after notice of commencement
    of the action, in each of which cases the fees and expenses of counsel
    shall be at the expense of the indemnifying party.     

         (d)  SETTLEMENTS.  The indemnifying party under this Section 8 shall
    not be liable for any settlement of any proceeding effected without its
    written consent, but if settled with such consent or if there be a final
    judgment for the plaintiff, the indemnifying party agrees to indemnify the
    indemnified party against any loss, claim, damage, liability or expense by
    reason of such settlement or judgment. Notwithstanding the foregoing
    sentence, if at any time an indemnified party shall have requested an
    indemnifying party to reimburse the indemnified party for fees and expenses
    of counsel as contemplated by Section 8(c) hereof, the indemnifying party
    agrees that it shall be liable for any settlement of any proceeding
    effected without its written consent if (i) such settlement is entered into
    more than 30 days after receipt by such indemnifying party of the aforesaid
    request and (ii) such indemnifying 




    party shall not have reimbursed the indemnified party in accordance with
    such request prior to the date of such settlement.  No indemnifying party
    shall, without the prior written consent of the indemnified party, effect
    any settlement, compromise or consent to the entry of judgment in any
    pending or threatened action, suit or proceeding in respect of which any
    indemnified party is or could have been a party and indemnity was or could
    have been sought hereunder by such indemnified party, unless such
    settlement, compromise or consent includes an unconditional release of such
    indemnified party from all liability on claims that are the subject matter
    of such action, suit or proceeding.     

         (E)  INDEMNIFICATION OF A QUALIFIED INDEPENDENT UNDERWRITER.  Without
    limitation and in addition to its obligations under the other subsections
    of this Section 8, the Company agrees to indemnify and hold harmless
    Montgomery Securities and each person, if any, who controls Montgomery
    Securities within the meaning of the Securities Act or the Exchange Act
    from and against any loss, claim, damage, liabilities or expense, as
    incurred arising out of or based upon Montgomery Securities acting as a
    "qualified independent underwriter" (within the meaning of Rule 2720 to the
    NASD's Conduct Rules) in connection with the offering contemplated by this
    Agreement, and agrees to reimburse each such indemnified person for any
    legal or other expense reasonably incurred by them in connection with
    investigating, defending, settling, compromising or paying any such loss,
    claim, damage, liability, expense or action; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the
    Company shall not be liable in any such case to the extent that any such
    loss, claim, damage, liability or expense results from the gross negligence
    or willful misconduct of Montgomery Securities.


         SECTION 9.  CONTRIBUTION.  If the indemnification provided for in
Section 8 is for any reason held to be unavailable to or otherwise insufficient
to hold harmless an indemnified party in respect of any losses, claims, damages,
liabilities or expenses referred to therein, then each indemnifying party shall
contribute to the aggregate amount paid or payable by such indemnified party, as
incurred, as a result of any losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses
referred to therein (i) in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the
relative benefits received by the Company and the Selling Stockholders, on the
one hand, and the Underwriters, on the other hand, from the offering of the
Common Shares pursuant to this Agreement or (ii) if the allocation provided by
clause (i) above is not permitted by applicable law, in such proportion as is
appropriate to reflect not only the relative benefits referred to in clause (i)
above but also the relative fault of the Company and the Selling Stockholders,
on the one hand, and the Underwriters, on the other hand, in connection with the
statements or omissions or inaccuracies in the representations and warranties
herein which resulted in such losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses,
as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.  The relative benefits
received by the Company and the Selling Stockholders, on the one hand, and the
Underwriters, on the other hand, in connection with the offering of the Common
Shares pursuant to this Agreement shall be deemed to be in the same respective
proportions as the total net proceeds from the offering of the Common Shares
pursuant to this Agreement (before deducting expenses) received by the Company
and the Selling Stockholders, and the total underwriting discount received by
the Underwriters, in each case as set forth on the front cover page of the
Prospectus (or, if Rule 434 under the Securities Act is used, the corresponding
location on the Term Sheet) bear to the aggregate initial public offering price
of the Common Shares as set forth on such cover. The relative fault of the
Company and the Selling Stockholders, on the one hand, and the Underwriters, on
the other hand, shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether
any such untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or omission or
alleged omission to state a material fact or any such 




inaccurate or alleged inaccurate representation or warranty relates to
information supplied by the Company or the Selling Stockholders, on the one
hand, or the Underwriters, on the other hand, and the parties' relative intent,
knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such
statement or omission.       

         The amount paid or payable by a party as a result of the losses,
claims, damages, liabilities and expenses referred to above shall be deemed to
include, subject to the limitations set forth in Section 8(c), any legal or
other fees or expenses reasonably incurred by such party in connection with
investigating or defending any action or claim.  The provisions set forth in
Section 8(c) with respect to notice of commencement of any action shall apply if
a claim for contribution is to be made under this Section 9; PROVIDED, HOWEVER,
that no additional notice shall be required with respect to any action for which
notice has been given under Section 8(c) for purposes of indemnification. 

         The Company, the Selling Stockholders and the Underwriters agree that
it would not be just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 9
were determined by pro rata allocation (even if the Underwriters were treated as
one entity for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation which does not
take account of the equitable considerations referred to in this Section 9. 

         Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 9, no Underwriter shall
be required to contribute any amount in excess of the underwriting commissions
received by such Underwriter in connection with the Common Shares underwritten
by it and distributed to the public.  No person guilty of fraudulent
misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act)
shall be entitled to contribution from any person who was not guilty of such
fraudulent misrepresentation.  The Underwriters' obligations to contribute
pursuant to this Section 9 are several, and not joint, in proportion to their
respective underwriting commitments as set forth opposite their names in
SCHEDULE A.  For purposes of this Section 9, each officer and employee of an
Underwriter and each person, if any, who controls an Underwriter within the
meaning of the Securities Act and the Exchange Act shall have the same rights to
contribution as such Underwriter, and each director of the Company, each officer
of the Company who signed the Registration Statement, and each person, if any,
who controls the Company or any Selling Stockholder with the meaning of the
Securities Act and the Exchange Act shall have the same rights to contribution
as the Company.

         SECTION 10. DEFAULT OF ONE OR MORE OF THE SEVERAL UNDERWRITERS.  If,
on the First Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be, any
one or more of the several Underwriters shall fail or refuse to purchase Common
Shares that it or they have agreed to purchase hereunder on such date, and the
aggregate number of Common Shares which such defaulting Underwriter or
Underwriters agreed but failed or refused to purchase does not exceed 10% of the
aggregate number of the Common Shares to be purchased on such date, the other
Underwriters shall be obligated, severally, in the proportions that the number
of Firm Common Shares set forth opposite their respective names on SCHEDULE A
bears to the aggregate number of Firm Common Shares set forth opposite the names
of all such non- defaulting Underwriters, or in such other proportions as may be
specified by the Representatives with the consent of the non-defaulting
Underwriters, to purchase the Common Shares which such defaulting Underwriter or
Underwriters agreed but failed or refused to purchase on such date. If, on the
First Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be, any one or
more of the Underwriters shall fail or refuse to purchase Common Shares and the
aggregate number of Common Shares with respect to which such default occurs
exceeds 10% of the aggregate number of Common Shares to be purchased on such
date, and arrangements satisfactory to the Representatives and the Company for
the purchase of such Common Shares are not made within 48 hours after such
default, this Agreement shall 




terminate without liability of any party to any other party except that the
provisions of Section 4, Section 6, Section 8 and Section 9 shall at all times
be effective and shall survive such termination.  In any such case either the
Representatives or the Company shall have the right to postpone the First
Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be, but in no event for
longer than seven days in order that the required changes, if any, to the
Registration Statement and the Prospectus or any other documents or arrangements
may be effected. 

         As used in this Agreement, the term "Underwriter" shall be deemed to
include any person substituted for a defaulting Underwriter under this
Section 10.  Any action taken under this Section 10 shall not relieve any
defaulting Underwriter from liability in respect of any default of such
Underwriter under this Agreement.           

         SECTION 11. TERMINATION OF THIS AGREEMENT.  Prior to the First Closing
Date this Agreement may be terminated by the Representatives by notice given to
the Company if at any time (i) trading or quotation in any of the Company's
securities shall have been suspended or limited by the Commission or by the New
York Stock Exchange, or trading in securities generally on either the Nasdaq
Stock Market or the New York Stock Exchange shall have been suspended or
limited, or minimum or maximum prices shall have been generally established on
any of such stock exchanges by the Commission or the NASD; (ii) a general
banking moratorium shall have been declared by any of federal, New York,
Delaware or California authorities; (iii) there shall have occurred any outbreak
or escalation of national or international hostilities or any crisis or
calamity, or any change in the United States or international financial markets,
or any substantial change or development involving a prospective substantial
change in United States' or international political, financial or economic
conditions, as in the judgment of the Representatives is material and adverse
and makes it impracticable to market the Common Shares in the manner and on the
terms described in the Prospectus or to enforce contracts for the sale of
securities; or (iv) in the judgment of the Representatives there shall have
occurred any Material Adverse Change. Any termination pursuant to this
Section 11 shall be without liability on the part of (a) the Company or the
Selling Stockholders to any Underwriter, except that the Company shall be
obligated to reimburse the expenses of the Representatives and the Underwriters
to the extent provided in Sections 4 and 6 hereof, (b) any Underwriter to the
Company or the Selling Stockholders, or (c) of any party hereto to any other
party except that the provisions of Section 8 and Section 9 shall at all times
be effective and shall survive such termination.


         SECTION 12. REPRESENTATIONS AND INDEMNITIES TO SURVIVE DELIVERY.  The
respective indemnities, agreements, representations, warranties and other
statements of the Company, of its officers , of the Selling Stockholders and of
the several Underwriters set forth in or made pursuant to this Agreement will
remain in full force and effect, regardless of any investigation made by or on
behalf of any Underwriter or the Company or any of its or their partners,
officers or directors or any controlling person, or the Selling Stockholders, as
the case may be, and will survive delivery of and payment for the Common Shares
sold hereunder and any termination of this Agreement.           

         SECTION 13. NOTICES.    All communications hereunder shall be in
writing and shall be mailed, hand delivered or telecopied and confirmed to the
parties hereto as follows:

If to the Representative:    

    Montgomery Securities    
    600 Montgomery Street    




    San Francisco, California  94111   
    Facsimile:  415-249-5558      
    Attention:  Richard A. Smith

   with a copy to:      

    Montgomery Securities    
    600 Montgomery Street    
    San Francisco, California  94111   
    Facsimile:  (415) 249-5553    
    Attention:  David A. Baylor, Esq.

If to the Company:      

    The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.     
    1 Dodge Drive
    West Caldwell, NJ  07006 
    Facsimile:  973-227-0321 
    Attention:  General Counsel

If to the Selling Stockholders:   

    American Stock Transfer and Trust Company    
    [address]      
    Facsimile:  ______________    
    Attention:  ______________

Any party hereto may change the address for receipt of communications by giving
written notice to the others.          

         SECTION 14.  SUCCESSORS.  This Agreement will inure to the benefit of
and be binding upon the parties hereto, including any substitute Underwriters
pursuant to Section 10 hereof, and to the benefit of the employees, officers and
directors and controlling persons referred to in Section 8 and Section 9, and in
each case their respective successors, and no other person will have any right
or obligation hereunder.  The term "successors" shall not include any purchaser
of the Common Shares as such from any of the Underwriters merely by reason of
such purchase.          

         SECTION 15.  PARTIAL UNENFORCEABILITY.  The invalidity or
unenforceability of any Section, paragraph or provision of this Agreement shall
not affect the validity or enforceability of any other Section, paragraph or
provision hereof.  If any Section, paragraph or provision of this Agreement is
for any reason determined to be invalid or unenforceable, there shall be deemed
to be made such minor changes (and only such minor changes) as are necessary to
make it valid and enforceable.         

         SECTION 16.  GOVERNING LAW PROVISIONS.  THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE
GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE INTERNAL LAWS OF THE STATE OF
NEW YORK APPLICABLE TO AGREEMENTS MADE AND TO BE PERFORMED IN SUCH STATE. 




         SECTION 17.  FAILURE OF ONE OR MORE OF THE SELLING STOCKHOLDERS TO
SELL AND DELIVER COMMON SHARES.  If one or more of the Selling Stockholders
shall fail to sell and deliver to the Underwriters the Common Shares to be sold
and delivered by such Selling Stockholders pursuant to this Agreement at the
Second Closing Date, then the Underwriters shall have the right, by written
notice from the Representatives to the Company and the Selling Stockholders, to
postpone the Second Closing Date, but in no event for longer than seven days in
order that the required changes, if any, to the Registration Statement and the
Prospectus or any other documents or arrangements may be effected.        

         SECTION 18.  GENERAL PROVISIONS.  This Agreement constitutes the
entire agreement of the parties to this Agreement and supersedes all prior
written or oral and all contemporaneous oral agreements, understandings and
negotiations with respect to the subject matter hereof.  This Agreement may be
executed in two or more counterparts, each one of which shall be an original,
with the same effect as if the signatures thereto and hereto were upon the same
instrument.  This Agreement may not be amended or modified unless in writing by
all of the parties hereto, and no condition herein (express or implied) may be
waived unless waived in writing by each party whom the condition is meant to
benefit.  The Table of Contents and the Section headings herein are for the
convenience of the parties only and shall not affect the construction or
interpretation of this Agreement.
         
         Each of the parties hereto acknowledges that it is a sophisticated
business person who was adequately represented by counsel during negotiations
regarding the provisions hereof, including, without limitation, the
indemnification provisions of Section 8 and the contribution provisions of
Section 9, and is fully informed regarding said provisions.  Each of the parties
hereto further acknowledges that the provisions of Sections 8 and 9 hereto
fairly allocate the risks in light of the ability of the parties to investigate
the Company, its affairs and its business in order to assure that adequate
disclosure has been made in the Registration Statement, any preliminary
prospectus and the Prospectus (and any amendments and supplements thereto), as
required by the Securities Act and the Exchange Act.

         If the foregoing is in accordance with your understanding of our
agreement, kindly sign and return to the Company and the Custodian the enclosed
copies hereof, whereupon this instrument, along with all counterparts hereof,
shall become a binding agreement in accordance with its terms.             
              

                   Very truly yours,

                   THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
                     STORES, INC.



                   By:__________________________
                        Ezra Dabah
                        Chief Executive Officer





                   SELLING STOCKHOLDERS



                   By:__________________________
                        (Attorney-in-fact)


         The foregoing Underwriting Agreement is hereby confirmed and accepted
by the Representatives in San Francisco, California as of the date first above
written.

MONTGOMERY SECURITIES
DONALDSON, LUFKIN & JENRETTE
  SECURITIES CORPORATION
SMITH BARNEY, INC.
LEGG MASON WOOD WALKER, INCORPORATED

Acting as Representatives of the
several Underwriters named in
the attached Schedule A.

By MONTGOMERY SECURITIES



By:


                        
- -------------------------
Richard A. Smith,
                                 Authorized Signatory




                                      SCHEDULE A




UNDERWRITERS                      NUMBER OF
                                       FIRM COMMON SHARES
                                       TO BE PURCHASED

                              Montgomery Securities___
Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette Securities Corporation___
                                Smith Barney, Inc. ___
               Legg Mason Wood Walker, Incorporated___

                                                                       3,550,000
                                                                      ----------
                                      SCHEDULE B

SELLING STOCKHOLDER                              MAXIMUM 
                                            NUMBER OF 
                                            OPTIONAL COMMON 
                                            SHARES TO BE SOLD

The SK Equity Fund, L.P.
[address]
                                  Attention:          
SK Investment Fund, L.P.
[address]
                                  Attention:          
Barry Feinberg
                                       [address]      
                                          Total: 
                                                 __________
                                                 __________
                                                   532,500



                                                                       EXHIBIT A


         Opinion of counsel for the Company to be delivered pursuant to
Section 5(e) of the Underwriting Agreement.           

         [SS&L TO ADD INTRODUCTORY LANGUAGE]

         References to the Prospectus in this EXHIBIT A include any supplements
thereto at the Closing Date.      

         (i)     The Company has been duly incorporated and is validly existing
    as a corporation in good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware. 
      

         (ii)    The Company has corporate power and authority to own, lease
    and operate its properties and to conduct its business as described in the
    Prospectus and to enter into and perform its obligations under the
    Underwriting Agreement.   

         (iii)   The Company is duly qualified as a foreign corporation to
    transact business and is in good standing in each jurisdiction in which it
    owns or leases real property, except for such jurisdictions where the
    failure to so qualify or to be in good standing would not, individually or
    in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse
    Change.        

         (iv)    To the best knowledge of such counsel, the Company does not
    own or control, directly or indirectly, any corporation, association or
    other entity.    

         (v)     The authorized, issued and outstanding capital stock of the
    Company (including the Common Stock) conforms to the descriptions thereof
    set forth in the Prospectus.  All of the outstanding shares of Common Stock
    (including the shares of Common Stock owned by Selling Stockholders) have
    been duly authorized and validly issued, are fully paid and nonassessable
    and, to the best of such counsel's knowledge, have been issued pursuant to
    exemptions from the registration and qualification requirements of federal
    and state securities laws.  The form of certificate used to evidence the
    Common Stock is in due and proper form and complies with all applicable
    requirements of the Certificate of Incorporation and by-laws of the Company
    and the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.  The description
    of the Company's stock option, stock bonus and other stock plans or
    arrangements, and the options or other rights granted and exercised
    thereunder, set forth in the Prospectus fairly summarizes, in all material
    respects, the information presented.              

         (vi)  No stockholder of the Company or any other person has any
    preemptive right, right of first refusal or other similar right to
    subscribe for or purchase securities of the Company arising (i) by
    operation of the Certificate of Incorporation or By-laws of the Company or
    the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware or (ii) to the best
    knowledge of such counsel, otherwise.

         (vii)  The Underwriting Agreement has been duly authorized, executed
    and delivered by the Company.




         (viii)  The Common Shares to be purchased by the Underwriters from the
    Company have been duly authorized for issuance and sale pursuant to the
    Underwriting Agreement and, when issued and delivered by the Company
    pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement against payment of the consideration
    set forth therein, will be validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

         (ix)    The Registration Statement has been declared effective by the
    Commission under the Securities Act.  To the best knowledge of such
    counsel, no stop order suspending the effectiveness of the Registration
    Statement has been issued under the Securities Act and no proceedings for
    such purpose have been instituted or are pending or are contemplated or
    threatened by the Commission.  Any required filing of the Prospectus and
    any supplement thereto pursuant to Rule 424(b) under the Securities Act has
    been made in the manner and within the time period required by such Rule
    424(b).                  

         (x)     The Registration Statement, the Prospectus and each
    post-effective amendment or supplement to the Registration Statement and
    the Prospectus, as of their respective effective or issue dates (other than
    the financial statements and other financial data and supporting schedules
    included therein or in exhibits to or excluded from the Registration
    Statement, as to which no opinion need be rendered) comply as to form in
    all material respects with the applicable requirements of the Securities
    Act.           

         (xi)    The Common Shares have been approved for listing on the the New
    York Stock Exchange.               

         (xii)  The statements (i) in the Prospectus under the captions
    "Management's Discussion and Analysis and Results of Operations--Liquidity
    and Capital Resources" (fifth and seventh paragraphs only),
    "Business--Trademarks and Service Marks," "Management--Employment
    Agreements," "Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and
    Management" (last four paragraphs only), "Certain Relationships and Related
    Transactions," "Description of Capital Stock," and "Shares Eligible for
    Future Sale," and (ii) in Item 14 and Item 15 of the Registration
    Statement, insofar as such statements constitute matters of law, summaries
    of legal matters, the Company's Certificate of Incorporation or By-law
    provisions, documents or legal proceedings, or legal conclusions, has been
    reviewed by such counsel and fairly present and summarize, in all material
    respects, the matters referred to therein.     

         (xiii)  To the best knowledge of such counsel, there are no legal or
    governmental actions, suits or proceedings pending or threatened which are
    required to be disclosed in the Registration Statement, other than those
    disclosed therein.    

         (xiv)   To the best knowledge of such counsel, there are no Existing
    Instruments required to be described or referred to in the Registration
    Statement or to be filed as exhibits thereto other than those described or
    referred to therein or filed or incorporated by reference as exhibits
    thereto; and the descriptions thereof fairly summarize such Existing
    Instruments in all material respects.         


         (xv)    No consent, approval, authorization or other order of, or
    registration or filing with, any court or other governmental authority or
    agency, is required for the 



    Company's execution, delivery and performance of the Underwriting Agreement
    and consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby and by the
    Prospectus, except as required under the Securities Act, applicable state
    securities or blue sky laws and from the NASD.

         (xvi)  The execution and delivery of the Underwriting Agreement by the
    Company and the performance by the Company of its obligations thereunder
    (other than performance by the Company of its obligations under the
    indemnification section of the Underwriting Agreement, as to which no
    opinion need be rendered) (i) have been duly authorized by all necessary
    corporate action on the part of the Company; (ii) will not result in any
    violation of the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation or By-laws
    of the Company; (iii) will not constitute a breach of, or Default or a Debt
    Repayment Triggering Event under, or result in the creation or imposition
    of any lien, charge or encumbrance upon any property or assets of the
    Company pursuant to, (A) the Company's revolving credit facility with
    Foothill Capital Corporation, or (B) to the best knowledge of such counsel,
    any other material Existing Instrument; or (iv) to the best knowledge of
    such counsel, will not result in any violation of any law, administrative
    regulation or administrative or court decree applicable to the Company.

         (xvii)  The Company is not, and after receipt of payment for the
    Common Shares will not be, an "investment company" within the meaning of
    Investment Company Act.            

         (xviii)  To the best knowledge of such counsel, there are no persons
    with registration or other similar rights to have any equity or debt
    securities registered for sale under the Registration Statement or included
    in the offering contemplated by the Underwriting Agreement, except for such
    rights as have been duly waived.     

         In addition, such counsel shall state that they have participated in
    conferences with officers and other representatives of the Company,
    representatives of the independent public or certified public accountants
    for the Company and with representatives of the Underwriters at which the
    contents of the Registration Statement and the Prospectus, and any
    supplements or amendments thereto, and related matters were discussed and,
    although such counsel is not passing upon and does not assume any
    responsibility for the accuracy, completeness or fairness of the statements
    contained in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus (other than as
    specified above), or any supplements or amendments thereto, on the basis of
    the foregoing, nothing has come to their attention which would lead them to
    believe that either the Registration Statement, at the time the
    Registration Statement became effective, contained an untrue statement of a
    material fact or omitted to state a material fact required to be stated
    therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading or that
    the Prospectus, as of its date or at the First Closing Date or the Second
    Closing Date, as the case may be, contained an untrue statement of a
    material fact or omitted to state a material fact necessary in order to
    make the statements therein, in the light of the circumstances under which
    they were made, not misleading (it being understood that such counsel need
    express no belief as to the financial statements or schedules or other
    financial or statistical data, included in the Registration Statement or
    the Prospectus or any amendments or supplements thereto).




         In rendering such opinion, such counsel may rely (A) to the extent
they deem proper and specified in such opinion, upon the opinion (which shall be
dated the First Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be,
shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the Underwriters, shall expressly
state that the Underwriters may rely on such opinion as if it were addressed to
them and shall be furnished to the Representatives) of the Company's General
Counsel or other counsel of good standing whom they believe to be reliable and
who are satisfactory to counsel for the Underwriters; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that
such counsel shall further state that they believe that they and the
Underwriters are justified in relying upon such opinion of the Company's General
Counsel or other counsel, and (B) as to matters of fact, to the extent they deem
proper, on certificates of responsible officers of the Company and public
officials.

    [Form of opinion will be appropriately modified if offering involves a Rule
462(b) Registration Statement or a post-effective amendment to the Registration
Statement]




                                                                       EXHIBIT B

THE FINAL OPINION IN DRAFT FORM SHOULD BE ATTACHED AS EXHIBIT B AT THE TIME THIS
AGREEMENT IS EXECUTED.       


         The opinion of such counsel pursuant to Section 5(h) shall be rendered
to the Representatives at the request of the Company and shall so state therein.
References to the Prospectus in this EXHIBIT B include any supplements thereto
at the Closing Date.    
         
         (i)     The Underwriting Agreement has been duly authorized, executed
    and delivered by or on behalf of such Selling Stockholder.        

         (ii)    The execution and delivery by such Selling Stockholder of, and
    the performance by such Selling Stockholder of its obligations under, the
    Underwriting Agreement and its Custody Agreement and its Power of Attorney
    will not contravene or conflict with, result in a breach of, or constitute
    a default under, the charter or by-laws, partnership agreement, trust
    agreement or other organizational documents, as the case may be, of such
    Selling Stockholder, or, to the best of such counsel's knowledge, violate
    or contravene any provision of applicable law or regulation, or violate,
    result in a breach of or constitute a default under the terms of any other
    agreement or instrument to which such Selling Stockholder is a party or by
    which it is bound, or any judgment, order or decree applicable to such
    Selling Stockholder of any court, regulatory body, administrative agency,
    governmental body or arbitrator having jurisdiction over such Selling
    Stockholder.         

         (iii)   Such Selling Stockholder (i) to the knowledge of such counsel,
    has good and valid title to all of the Common Shares which may be sold by
    such Selling Stockholder under the Underwriting Agreement and (ii) has the
    legal right and power, and all authorizations and approvals required under
    its charter and by-laws, partnership agreement, trust agreement or other
    organizational documents, as the case may be, to enter into the
    Underwriting Agreement and its Custody Agreement and its Power of Attorney,
    to sell, transfer and deliver all of the Common Shares which may sold by
    such Selling Stockholder under the Underwriting Agreement and to comply
    with its other obligations under the Underwriting Agreement, its Custody
    Agreement and its Power of Attorney.              

         (iv)    Each of the Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney of such
    Selling Stockholder has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by
    such Selling Stockholder and is a valid and binding agreement of such
    Selling Stockholder, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as
    rights to indemnification thereunder may be limited by applicable law and
    except as the enforcement thereof may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency,
    reorganization, moratorium or other similar laws relating to or affecting
    creditors' rights generally or by general equitable principles.

         (v)     Assuming that the Underwriters purchase the Common Shares
    which are sold by such Selling Stockholder pursuant to the Underwriting
    Agreement for value, in good faith and without notice of any adverse claim,
    the delivery of such Common Shares pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement
    will pass good and valid title to such Common 




    Shares, free and clear of any security interest, mortgage, pledge, lien
    encumbrance or other claim.        

         (vi)    To the best of such counsel's knowledge, no consent, approval,
    authorization or other order of, or registration or filing with, any court
    or governmental authority or agency, is required for the consummation by
    such Selling Stockholder of the transactions contemplated in the
    Underwriting Agreement, except as required under the Securities Act,
    applicable state securities or blue sky laws, and from the NASD.

                 In rendering such opinion, such counsel may rely (A) to the
extent they deem proper and specified in such opinion, upon the opinion (which
shall be dated the First Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as the case
may be, shall be satisfactory in form and substance to the Underwriters, shall
expressly state that the Underwriters may rely on such opinion as if it were
addressed to them and shall be furnished to the Representatives) of other
counsel of good standing whom they believe to be reliable and who are
satisfactory to counsel for the Underwriters; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that such
counsel shall further state that they believe that they and the Underwriters are
justified in relying upon such opinion of other counsel, and (B) as to matters
of fact, to the extent they deem proper, on certificates of the Selling
Stockholders and public officials.




                                                                       EXHIBIT C

                                                                  Exhibit 3.1
       


              AMENDED AND RESTATED CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
    
                                    OF
    
                 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.




    THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC., a corporation organized and
existing under the laws of the State of Delaware (the "Corporation"), DOES
HEREBY CERTIFY as follows:

    The Corporation was originally incorporated under the name "THE 
CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES II, INC." and the date of filing of its 
original Certificate of Incorporation with the Secretary of State of the 
State of Delaware was June 3, 1988.  The Certificate of Incorporation was 
subsequently amended on July 29, 1988 and pursuant to such amendment the 
Corporation was renamed The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.  The 
Certificate of Incorporation was subsequently amended and restated on June 
28, 1996.  The Certificate of Incorporation was subsequently amended and 
restated on December 31, 1996.  

    The Board of Directors of the Corporation, at a meeting duly called and 
held on  _________ __, 1997, at which a quorum was present, adopted 
resolutions setting forth the Amended and Restated Certificate of 
Incorporation herein contained (the "Certificate of Incorporation"), 
declaring its advisability and calling a meeting of stockholders of the 
Corporation entitled to vote in respect thereof for the consideration of such 
Certificate of Incorporation, in accordance with applicable provisions of 
Sections 242 and 245 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware. 
 The Certificate of Incorporation was duly adopted on __________ __, 1997 by 
a vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding stock entitled to vote 
thereon, in accordance with the applicable provisions of Sections 242 and 245 
of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.

    The text of the Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation shall read
in its entirety as follows:

                                    ARTICLE ONE

    The name of the corporation is THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
(the "Corporation").

                                    ARTICLE TWO

    The address of the Corporation's registered office in the State of 
Delaware is 15 East North Street, in the City of Dover, County of Kent.  The 
name of its registered agent at such address is United Corporate Services, 
Inc.

                                    ARTICLE THREE

    The nature of the business and of the purposes to be conducted and 
promoted by the Corporation are to conduct any lawful business, to promote 
any lawful purpose and to engage in any lawful act or activity for which a 
corporation may be organized under the General Corporation Law of the State 
of Delaware.

                                    ARTICLE FOUR

    The Corporation shall have authority, to be exercised by the Board of 
Directors, to issue (i) 100,000,000 shares of common stock of the par value 
of $0.10 per share (the "Common Stock") and (ii) 1,000,000 shares of 
preferred stock of the par value of $1.00 per share (the "Preferred Stock").  
The Preferred Stock may be issued (A) in one or more series and with such 
designations, powers, preferences, rights, and such qualifications, 
limitations or restrictions thereof, as the Board of Directors shall fix by 
resolution or resolutions which are permitted by Section 151 of the General 
Corporation Law of the State of Delaware for any such series of Preferred 
Stock, and (B) in such number of shares in each such series as the Board of 
Directors shall, by resolution, fix, provided that the aggregate number of 
all shares of Preferred Stock issued shall not exceed the number of shares of 
Preferred Stock authorized hereby.

    Each holder of Common Stock shall at every meeting of stockholders of the 
Corporation be entitled to one vote in person or by proxy on each matter 
submitted to a vote of stockholders for each share of Common Stock held by 
such holder as of the record date for such meeting.  Subject to the rights, 
if any, of the holders of the Preferred Stock, the holders of the Common 
Stock shall be entitled to the entire voting power, all dividends declared 
and paid by the Corporation and all assets of the Corporation available for 
distribution to stockholders in the event of any liquidation,

                                          1



dissolution or winding up of the Corporation. 

    
                                    ARTICLE FIVE

    The number of directors which shall constitute the whole Board of 
Directors of the Corporation shall be not less than three nor more than 12 
and the exact number shall be fixed from time to time by the Board of 
Directors pursuant to a resolution adopted by a majority of the directors 
then in office; provided, however, that such maximum number of directors may 
be increased from time to time to reflect the rights, if any, of holders of 
Preferred Stock to elect directors in accordance with the terms of the 
resolution or resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors providing for the 
issue of such shares of Preferred Stock.  The number of directors may be 
increased or decreased only by action of the Board of Directors.  The 
directors, other than those who may be elected by the holders of any series 
of Preferred Stock, will be classified with respect to the time for which 
they severally hold office into three classes, as nearly equal in number as 
possible, designated Class I, Class II and Class III.  The directors first 
appointed to Class I will hold office for a term expiring at the annual 
meeting of stockholders of the Corporation to be held in 1998; the directors 
first appointed to Class II will hold office for a term expiring at the 
annual meeting of stockholders of the Corporation to be held in 1999; and the 
directors first appointed to Class III will hold office for a term expiring 
at the annual meeting of stockholders of the Corporation to be held in 2000, 
with the members of each class to hold office until their successors are 
elected and qualified.  At each succeeding annual meeting of the stockholders 
of the Corporation, the successors of the class of directors whose terms 
expire at that meeting will be elected by plurality vote of all votes cast at 
such meeting to hold office for a term expiring at the annual meeting of 
stockholders held in the third year following the year of their election and 
to hold office until their successors are elected and qualified.  Election of 
directors of the Corporation need not be by written ballot unless requested 
by the Chairman of the Board of Directors or by the holders of a majority of 
the voting power of the outstanding shares of stock entitled to vote in the 
election of directors and present in person or represented by proxy at a 
meeting of the stockholders at which directors are to be elected.

                                    ARTICLE SIX

    Subject to the rights, if any, of the holders of any Preferred Stock, the 
power to fill vacancies on the Board of Directors (whether by reason of 
resignation, removal, death, an increase in the number of directors or 
otherwise) shall be vested solely in the Board of Directors, and vacancies 
may be filled by the affirmative vote of a majority of the directors then in 
office, even if less than a quorum, or by the sole remaining director, unless 
all directorships are vacant, in which case the stockholders shall fill the 
then existing vacancies.  Any director chosen by the Board of Directors to 
fill a vacancy (including a vacancy resulting from an increase in the number 
of directors) shall hold office for the remainder of the full term of the 
class of directors in which the vacancy occurred (or in which the new 
directorship was created) and until that director's successor shall be 
elected and shall have qualified.  No decrease in the number of directors 
constituting the Board of Directors may shorten the term of any incumbent 
director.

                                    ARTICLE SEVEN

    Special meetings of the stockholders of the Corporation for any purpose 
or purposes may be called at any time by the Chairman of the Board of 
Directors or by the Secretary of the Corporation within ten calendar days 
after receipt of a written request from a majority of the total number of 
directors which the Corporation would have if there were no vacancies.  Such 
special meetings may not be called by any other person or persons.

                                    ARTICLE EIGHT

    Any action required by the General Corporation Law of the State of 
Delaware to be taken at an annual or special meeting of stockholders of the 
Corporation, and any action which otherwise may be taken at any annual or 
special meeting of stockholders of the Corporation, shall be taken only at a 
duly called meeting of the stockholders of the Corporation and, 
notwithstanding Section 228 of the General Corporation Law of the State of 
Delaware, no such action shall be taken by written consent or consents 
without a meeting of the stockholders of the Corporation.

                                          2




                                    ARTICLE NINE

    Except as otherwise provided by law, at any annual or special meeting of 
the stockholders of the Corporation, only such business shall be conducted or 
considered as shall have been properly brought before the meeting.  Except as 
otherwise provided herein, in order to have been properly brought before the 
meeting, such business must have been either (A) specified in the written 
notice of the meeting, or any supplement thereto, given to the stockholders 
of record on the record date for such meeting by or at the direction of the 
Board of Directors; (B) brought before the meeting at the direction of the 
Chairman of the Board, the President or the Board of Directors; or (C) 
specified in a written notice given by or on behalf of a stockholder of 
record on the record date for such meeting entitled to vote thereat or a duly 
authorized proxy for such stockholder, in accordance with all requirements 
set forth in this Article Nine.  A notice referred to in clause (C) of the 
preceding sentence must be delivered personally to, or mailed to and received 
at, the principal executive office of the Corporation, addressed to the 
attention of the Secretary, not less than 45 days nor more than 60 days prior 
to the meeting; provided, however, that in the event that less than 55 days' 
notice or prior public disclosure of the date of the meeting was given or 
made to stockholders, notice by the stockholder to be timely must be so 
received not later than the close of business on the tenth day following the 
day on which such notice of the date of the meeting was mailed or such public 
disclosure was made, whichever first occurred.  Such notice referred to in 
clause (C) of the second sentence of this Article Nine shall set forth: (i) a 
full description of each such item of business proposed to be brought before 
the meeting and the reasons for conducting such business at such meeting; 
(ii) the name and address of the person proposing to bring such business 
before the meeting; (iii) the class and number of shares held of record, held 
beneficially and represented by proxy by such person as of the record date 
for the meeting (if such date has then been made publicly available) and as 
of the date of such notice; (iv) if any item of such business involves a 
nomination for director, all information regarding each such nominee that 
would be required to be set forth in a definitive proxy statement filed with 
the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") pursuant to Section 
14 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or any successor 
thereto (the "Exchange Act"), and the written consent of each such nominee to 
serve if elected; (v) any material interest of the stockholder in such item 
of business; and (vi) all other information that would be required to be 
filed with the Commission if, with respect to the business proposed to be 
brought before the meeting, the person proposing such business was a 
participant in a solicitation subject to Section 14 of the Exchange Act.  No 
business shall be brought before any meeting of stockholders of the 
Corporation otherwise than as provided in this Article Nine.  The Board of 
Directors may require a proposed nominee for director to furnish such other 
information as may be required to be set forth in a stockholder's notice of 
nomination which pertains to the nominee or which may be reasonably required 
to determine the eligibility of such proposed nominee to serve as a director 
of the Corporation.  The chairman of the meeting may, if the facts warrant, 
determine that a nomination or stockholder proposal was not made in 
accordance with the foregoing procedure, and if the chairman should so 
determine, the chairman shall so declare to the meeting and the defective 
nomination or proposal shall be disregarded.

                                    ARTICLE TEN

    The Bylaws of the Corporation, as amended and restated on the date 
hereof, are hereby adopted by the Board of Directors.  In furtherance and not 
in limitation of the powers conferred by statute, the Board of Directors is 
expressly authorized to make, repeal, alter, amend and rescind the Bylaws of 
the Corporation, by the affirmative vote of a majority of the total number of 
directors which the Corporation would have if there were no vacancies.

    Notwithstanding anything contained in this Certificate of Incorporation 
to the contrary, Sections 6(b), 6(j) and 6(l) of Article I of the Bylaws, 
Sections 2(b), 2(c) and 2(d) of Article II of the Bylaws and Article VI of 
the Bylaws may not be amended or repealed by the stockholders, and no 
provision inconsistent therewith may be adopted by the stockholders, without 
the affirmative vote of the holders of at least 75% of the voting power of 
the outstanding shares of stock entitled to vote in the election of 
directors, voting as a single class.

                                    ARTICLE ELEVEN

    To the fullest extent that the General Corporation Law of the State of 
Delaware, as it exists on the date hereof or as it may hereafter be amended, 
permits the limitation or elimination of the liability of directors, no 
director of the Corporation shall be personally liable to the Corporation or 
its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a 
director. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a director shall be liable to the 
extent provided by applicable law (1) for any breach of the director's duty 
of loyalty to the Corporation or its stockholders, (2) for acts or omissions 
not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing 
violation of law, (3) under Section 174 of the General Corporation Law of the 
State of Delaware or any successor provision thereto, or (4) for any 
transaction from which the director derived any improper personal benefit.  
The provisions of this Article Eleven are not intended to, and shall not, 
limit, supersede or modify any other defense available to a director under 
applicable law.  Neither the amendment or repeal of this Article Eleven, nor 
the adoption of any provision of this Certificate of Incorporation 
inconsistent with this Article Eleven, shall adversely affect any right or 
protection of a director of the Corporation existing at the time of such 
amendment, repeal or adoption. 

                                          3


                                    ARTICLE TWELVE

    The Corporation shall, to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145 of 
the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, as the same may be 
amended and supplemented, or by any successor provision thereto ("Section 
145"), indemnify any and all persons whom it shall have power to indemnify 
under Section 145 from and against any and all of the expenses, liabilities 
or other matters referred to in or covered by Section 145.  The Corporation 
shall advance expenses to the fullest extent permitted by Section 145.  Such 
right to indemnification and advancement of expenses shall continue as to a 
person who has ceased to be a director, officer, employee or agent and shall 
inure to the benefit of the heirs, executors and administrators of such 
person.  The indemnification and advancement of expenses provided for herein 
shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights which any person may have 
or hereafter acquire under any statute, Bylaw, agreement, vote of 
stockholders or disinterested directors or otherwise.  Without limiting the 
generality or the effect of the foregoing, the Corporation may enter into one 
or more agreements with any person which provide for indemnification greater 
than or different from that provided in this Article Twelve or Section 145.  
Neither the amendment or repeal of this Article Twelve, nor the adoption of 
any provision of this Certificate of Incorporation inconsistent with this 
Article Twelve, shall adversely affect any right or protection of any person 
existing at the time of such amendment, repeal or adoption.

    The Corporation shall have power to purchase and maintain insurance on 
behalf of any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of 
the Corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as a 
director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, 
joint venture, trust or other enterprise against any liability asserted 
against him and incurred by him in any such capacity, or arising out of his 
status as such, whether or not the Corporation would have the power to 
indemnify him against such liability under the provisions hereof or under 
Section 145 of the General Corporation Law or any other applicable law.

                                    ARTICLE THIRTEEN

    Subject to the rights, if any, of the holders of any Preferred Stock to 
elect additional directors or to remove directors so elected, a duly elected 
director of the Corporation may be removed from such position by the 
stockholders only for cause and only in the manner specified in this Article 
Thirteen.  Any such removal may be effected only by the affirmative vote of 
the holders of a majority of the voting power of the outstanding shares of 
stock entitled to vote in the election of directors, voting as a single 
class.  Except as may be provided by applicable law, cause for removal will 
be deemed to exist only if the director whose removal is proposed has been 
convicted of a felony or adjudicated by a court of competent jurisdiction to 
be liable to the Corporation or its stockholders for misconduct as a result 
of (a) a breach of such director's duty of loyalty to the Corporation, (b) 
any act or omission by such director not in good faith or which involves a 
knowing violation of law or (c) any transaction from which such director 
derived an improper personal benefit, and such conviction or adjudication is 
no longer subject to direct appeal.  

                                    ARTICLE FOURTEEN
    
    Whenever a compromise or arrangement is proposed between this Corporation 
and its creditors or any class of them and/or between this Corporation and 
its stockholders or any class of them, any court of equitable jurisdiction 
within the State of Delaware may, on the application in a summary way of this 
Corporation or any creditor or stockholder thereof or on the application of 
any receiver or receivers appointed for this Corporation under the provisions 
of Section 291 of Title 8 of the Delaware Code or on the application of 
trustees in dissolution or of any receiver or receivers appointed for this 
Corporation under the provisions of Section 279 of Title 8 of the Delaware 
Code order a meeting of the creditors or class of creditors, and/or of the 
stockholders or class of stockholders, of this Corporation, as the case may 
be, to be summoned in such manner as the said court directs.  If a majority 
in number representing three-fourths in value of the creditors or class of 
creditors, and/or of the stockholders or class of stockholders, of this 
Corporation, as the case may be, agree to any compromise or arrangement and 
to any reorganization of this Corporation as a consequence of such compromise 
or arrangement, the said compromise or arrangement and the said 
reorganization shall, if sanctioned by the court to which the said 
application has been made, be binding on all the creditors or class of 
creditors, and/or on all the stockholders or class of stockholders, of this 
Corporation, as the case may be, and also on this Corporation. 

                                    ARTICLE FIFTEEN

    The Board of Directors of the Corporation, in determining whether the 
interests of the Corporation, its subsidiaries and its stockholders will be 
served by any offer of another person to (i) make a tender or exchange offer 
for any equity security of the Corporation or any subsidiary of the 
Corporation, (ii) merge or consolidate the Corporation or any of its 
subsidiaries with or into another institution, or (iii) purchase or otherwise 
acquire all or substantially all of the properties and assets of the 
Corporation or any of its subsidiaries, may take into account factors in 
addition to potential economic benefits to stockholders.  Such factors may 
include (a) comparison of the proposed consideration to be received by 
stockholders in relation to the then current market price of the capital 
stock, the estimated current value of the Corporation in a freely negotiated 
transaction, and the estimated future value of the Corporation as an 
independent entity; (b) the impact of such a transaction on the customers, 
suppliers and employees of the Corporation, and its effect on the communities 
in which the Corporation conducts business; and (c) the ability of the 
Corporation to fulfill its objectives under applicable statutes and 
regulations.  The term "offer" as used in this Article Fifteen includes every 
offer to buy or acquire, solicitation of an offer to sell, tender offer for, 
or request or invitation for tender of, a security or interest in a security 
for value.

                                          4


                                    ARTICLE SIXTEEN

    Any amendment, alteration, change or repeal of any provision contained in 
Article Five, Six, Seven, Eight, Nine, Ten or Thirteen or this Article 
Sixteen of this Certificate of Incorporation, or the adoption of any 
provision inconsistent therewith, may be effected only by the affirmative 
vote of the holders of 75% of the voting power of the outstanding shares of 
stock entitled to vote in the election of directors, voting as a single 
class, and all rights conferred on stockholders herein are granted subject to 
any provision of the General Corporation Laws of the State of Delaware, as 
amended.

    This Certificate of Incorporation was duly adopted in accordance with the 
provisions of Section 242 and Section 245 of the General Corporation Law of 
the State of Delaware.

    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Corporation has caused this Certificate to be 
signed by Ezra Dabah, its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and attested 
by Steven Balasiano, its Secretary this __ day of __________, 1997.


                               THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.


                               By: _____________________________
                                   Ezra Dabah
                                   Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

Attest:


__________________________
Steven Balasiano
Secretary







                                          5


                                                             Exhibit 3.2

                              AMENDED AND RESTATED BYLAWS
                                           
                                          OF

                       THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
                               (A Delaware Corporation)

                                      ARTICLE I

                                    STOCKHOLDERS

1.  CERTIFICATES REPRESENTING STOCK.

    (a)  Every holder of stock in the Corporation shall be entitled to have a 
certificate signed by, or in the name of, the Corporation by the Chairman of 
the Board of Directors, if any, or by the President or a Vice President and 
by the Treasurer or an Assistant Treasurer or the Secretary or an Assistant 
Secretary of the Corporation, representing the number of shares owned by such 
person in the Corporation.  If such certificate is countersigned by a 
transfer agent other than the Corporation or its employee or by a registrar 
other than the Corporation or its employee, any other signature on the 
certificate may be a facsimile.  In case any officer, transfer agent, or 
registrar who has signed or whose facsimile signature has been placed upon a 
certificate shall have ceased to be such officer, transfer agent or registrar 
before such certificate is issued, it may be issued by the Corporation with 
the same effect as if such person were such officer, transfer agent or 
registrar at the date of issue.

    (b)  Whenever the Corporation shall be authorized to issue more than one 
class of stock or more than one series of any class of stock, and whenever 
the Corporation shall issue any shares of its stock as partly paid stock, the 
certificates representing shares of any such class or series or of any such 
partly paid stock shall set forth thereon the statements prescribed by the 
General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware (the "DGCL").  Any 
restrictions on the transfer or registration of transfer of any shares of 
stock of any class or series shall be noted conspicuously on the certificate 
representing such shares.

    (c)  The Corporation may issue a new certificate of stock in place of any 
certificate theretofore issued by it, alleged to have been lost, stolen or 
destroyed, and the Board of Directors may require the owner of any lost, 
stolen or destroyed certificate, or such person's legal representative, to 
give the Corporation a bond sufficient to indemnify the Corporation and its 
transfer agent or agents and registrar or registrars against any claim that 
may be made against it on account of the alleged loss, theft or destruction 
of any such certificate or the issuance of any such new certificate.

2.  FRACTIONAL SHARE INTERESTS.

    The Corporation may, but shall not be required to, issue fractions of a 
share.

3.  STOCK TRANSFERS.

    Upon compliance with provisions restricting the transfer or registration 
of transfer of shares of stock, if any, transfers or registration of 
transfers of shares of stock of the Corporation shall be made only on the 
stock ledger of the Corporation by the registered holder thereof, or by such 
person's attorney thereunto authorized by power of attorney duly executed and 
filed with the Secretary of the Corporation or with a transfer agent or a 
registrar, if any, and on surrender of the certificate or certificates for 
such shares of stock properly endorsed and the payment of all taxes due 
thereon.

4.  RECORD DATE FOR STOCKHOLDERS. 

    (a)  In order that the Corporation may determine the stockholders 
entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of stockholders or any 
adjournment thereof, the Board of Directors may fix a record date, which 
record date shall not precede the date upon which the resolution fixing the 
record date is adopted by the Board of Directors, and which record date shall 

                                       1




not be more than sixty nor less than ten days before the date of such 
meeting.  If no record date has been fixed by the Board of Directors, the 
record date for determining stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at 
a meeting of stockholders shall be at the close of business on the day next 
preceding the day on which notice is given, or, if notice is waived, at the 
close of business on the day next preceding the day on which the meeting is 
held.  A determination of stockholders of record entitled to notice of or to 
vote at a meeting of stockholders shall apply to any adjournment of the 
meeting; provided, however, that the Board of Directors may fix a new record 
date for the adjourned meeting.

    (b)  In order that the Corporation may determine the stockholders 
entitled to receive payment of any dividend or other distribution or 
allotment of any rights or the stockholders entitled to exercise any rights 
in respect of any change, conversion or exchange of stock, or for the purpose 
of any other lawful action, the Board of Directors may fix a record date, 
which record date shall not precede the date upon which the resolution fixing 
the record date is adopted, and which record date shall be not more than 
sixty days prior to such action.  If no record date has been fixed, the 
record date for determining stockholders for any such purpose shall be at the 
close of business on the day on which the Board of Directors adopts the 
resolution relating thereto.

5.  MEANING OF CERTAIN TERMS. 

    As used herein in respect of the right to notice of a meeting of 
stockholders or a waiver thereof or to participate or vote thereat or to 
consent or dissent in writing in lieu of a meeting, as the case may be, the 
term "share" or "shares" or "share of stock" or "shares of stock" or 
"stockholder" or "stockholders" refers to an outstanding share or shares of 
stock and to a holder or holders of record of outstanding shares of stock 
when the Corporation is authorized to issue only one class of shares of 
stock, and said reference is also intended to include any outstanding share 
or shares of stock and any holder or holders of record of outstanding shares 
of stock of any class upon which or upon whom the Amended and Restated 
Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation (the "Certificate of 
Incorporation") confers such rights where there are two or more classes or 
series of shares of stock or upon which or upon whom the DGCL confers such 
rights notwithstanding that the Certificate of Incorporation may provide for 
more than one class or series of shares of stock, one or more of which are 
limited or denied such rights thereunder; provided, however, that no such 
right shall vest in the event of an increase or a decrease in the authorized 
number of shares of stock of any class or series which is otherwise denied 
voting rights under the provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation, 
including any preferred stock which is denied voting rights under the 
provisions of the resolution or resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors 
with respect to the issuance thereof.

6.  STOCKHOLDER MEETINGS.

    (a)  Annual Meetings.  An annual meeting of the stockholders of the 
Corporation shall be held within 150 days after the end of each fiscal year 
of the Corporation, commencing with the fiscal year ending December 31, 1997, 
for the purpose of electing directors and transacting such other business as 
may properly come before the meeting.

    (b)  Special Meetings.  Special meetings of the stockholders of the 
Corporation for any purpose or purposes may be called at any time by the 
Chairman of the Board of Directors or by the Secretary of the Corporation 
within ten calendar days after receipt of a written request from a majority 
of the total number of directors which the Corporation would have if there 
were no vacancies.  Such special meetings may not be called by any other 
person or persons.

    (c)  Time and Place of Meetings.  Subject to the provisions of Section 
6(a), each meeting of stockholders shall be held on such date, at such hour, 
and at such place, either within or without the State of Delaware, as fixed 
by the Board of Directors from time to time or in the notice of the meeting 
or, in the case of an adjourned meeting, as announced at the meeting at which 
the adjournment is taken. Whenever the Board of Directors shall fail to fix 
such place, the meeting shall be held at the registered office of the 
Corporation in the State of Delaware. 

    (d)  Notice of Meetings; Waiver of Notice.  Written notice of all 
meetings shall be given, stating the place, date and hour of the meeting.  
The notice of an annual meeting shall state that the meeting is called for 
the election of Directors and for the transaction of other business which may 
properly come before the meeting, and shall (if any other action which could 
be taken at a special meeting is to be taken at such annual meeting), state 
such other action or actions as are known at the time of such notice.  The 
notice of a special meeting shall in all instances state the purpose or 
purposes for which the meeting is called. If any action is proposed to be 
taken which would, if taken, entitle stockholders to receive payment for 
their shares of stock, the notice shall include a statement of that purpose 


                                       2



and to that effect. Except as otherwise provided by the DGCL, a copy of the 
notice of any meeting shall be given, personally or by mail, not less than 
ten days nor more than sixty days before the date of the meeting, unless the 
lapse of the prescribed period of time shall have been waived, and directed 
to each stockholder at such person's address as it appears on the records of 
the Corporation.  Notice by mail shall be deemed to be given when deposited, 
with postage thereon prepaid, in the United States mail.  If a meeting is 
adjourned to another time, not more than thirty days after the date of the 
meeting at which the adjournment is taken, and/or to another place, and if an 
announcement of the adjourned time and place is made at the meeting at which 
the adjournment is taken, it shall not be necessary to give notice of the 
adjourned meeting unless the Board of Directors, after adjournment, fixes a 
new record date for the adjourned meeting.  Notice need not be given to any 
stockholder who submits a written waiver of notice before or after the time 
stated therein.  Attendance of a person at a meeting of stockholders shall 
constitute a waiver of notice of such meeting, except when the stockholder 
attends a meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of 
the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not 
lawfully called or convened.  Neither the business to be transacted at, nor 
the purpose of, any regular or special meeting of the stockholders need be 
specified in any written waiver of notice.

    (e)  Quorum and Manner of Acting.  Subject to the provisions of these 
Amended and Restated Bylaws (the "Bylaws"), the Certificate of Incorporation 
and any provision of the DGCL as to the vote that is required for a specified 
action, the presence in person or by proxy of the holders of a majority of 
the outstanding shares of the Corporation entitled to vote at any meeting of 
stockholders shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business, and 
the vote in person or by proxy of the holders of a majority of the shares 
constituting such quorum shall be binding on all stockholders of the 
Corporation.  A majority of the shares present in person or by proxy and 
entitled to vote may, regardless of whether or not they constitute a quorum, 
adjourn the meeting to another time and place.  Any business which might have 
been transacted at the original meeting may be transacted at any adjourned 
meeting at which a quorum is present.  When a quorum is present to organize a 
meeting, it is not broken by the subsequent withdrawal of any stockholders.

    (f)  Voting.  Each stockholder entitled to vote in accordance with the 
terms of the Certificate of Incorporation and of these Bylaws, or, with 
respect to the issuance of preferred stock, in accordance with the terms of a 
resolution or resolutions of the Board of Directors, shall be entitled to one 
vote, in person or by proxy, for each share of stock entitled to vote held by 
such stockholder.  In the election of Directors, a plurality of the votes 
present at the meeting shall elect. Any other action shall be authorized by a 
majority of the votes cast except where the DGCL, the Certificate of 
Incorporation or these Bylaws prescribe a different percentage of votes 
and/or a different exercise of voting power.  Voting by ballot shall not be 
required for corporate action except as otherwise provided by the DGCL or by 
the Certificate of Incorporation.
    
    (g)  Judges of Election.  The Board of Directors, in advance of any 
meeting of stockholders, may, but need not, appoint one or more inspectors of 
election or judges of the vote, as the case may be, to act at the meeting or 
any adjournment thereof. If an inspector or inspectors or judge or judges are 
not appointed by the Board of Directors, the chairman of the meeting may, but 
need not, appoint one or more inspectors or judges.  In case any person who 
may be appointed as an inspector or judge fails to appear or act, the vacancy 
may be filled by appointment made by the chairman of the meeting.  Each 
inspector or judge, if any, before entering upon the discharge of such 
person's duties, shall take and sign an oath faithfully to execute the duties 
of inspector or judge at such meeting with strict impartiality and according 
to the best of his or her ability.  The inspectors or judges, if any, shall 
determine the number of shares of stock outstanding and the voting power of 
each, the shares of stock represented at the meeting, the existence of a 
quorum and the validity and effect of proxies and ballots, receive votes, 
ballots or consents, hear and determine all challenges and questions arising 
in connection with the right to vote, count and tabulate all votes, ballots 
or consents, determine the result, and do such other acts as are proper to 
conduct the election or vote with fairness to all stockholders.  On request 
of the person presiding at the meeting, the inspector or inspectors or judge 
or judges, if any, shall make a report in writing of any challenge, question 
or matter determined by such person or persons and execute a certificate of 
any fact so found.

    (h)  List of Stockholders.  A complete list of the stockholders entitled 
to vote at each meeting of stockholders of the Corporation, arranged in 
alphabetical order, and showing the address and number of shares registered 
in the name of each stockholder, shall be prepared and made available for 
examination during regular business hours by any stockholder for any purpose 
germane to the meeting.  The list shall be available for such examination at 
the place where the meeting is to be held for a period of not less than ten 
days prior to the meeting and during the whole time of the meeting.  The 
stock ledger shall be the only evidence as to who are the stockholders 
entitled to examine the stock ledger, the list required by this Section 6(h) 
or the books of the Corporation, or to vote at any meeting of stockholders.


                                       3




    (i)  Conduct of Meeting.  At every meeting of stockholders, the chairman 
of the meeting shall be the Chairman of the Board or, in the absence of such 
officer, the President or, in the absence of both such officers, such person 
as shall have been designated by the Chairman of the Board or, if such 
officer has not so designated any person, by the President or, if such 
officer has not so designated any person, by resolution adopted by the Board 
of Directors.  The chairman of the meeting shall have sole authority to 
prescribe the agenda and rules of order for the conduct of such meeting of 
stockholders and to determine all questions arising thereat relating to the 
order of business and the conduct of the meeting, except as otherwise 
required by law.  The Secretary of the Corporation or, in such person's 
absence, an Assistant Secretary, shall act as secretary of every meeting, but 
if neither the Secretary nor an Assistant Secretary is present the chairman 
for the meeting shall appoint a secretary of the meeting.

    (j)  Stockholder Proposals and Nominations.  Except as otherwise provided 
by law, at any annual or special meeting of the stockholders of the 
Corporation, only such business shall be conducted as shall have been 
properly brought before the meeting.  Except as otherwise provided herein, in 
order to have been properly brought before the meeting, such business must 
have been either (A) specified in the written notice of the meeting, or any 
supplement thereto, given to the stockholders of record on the record date 
for such meeting by or at the direction of the Board of Directors; (B) 
brought before the meeting at the direction of the Chairman of the Board, the 
President or the Board of Directors; or (C) specified in a written notice 
given by or on behalf of a stockholder of record on the record date for such 
meeting entitled to vote thereat or a duly authorized proxy for such 
stockholder, in accordance with all requirements set forth in this Section 
6(j).  A notice referred to in clause (C) of the preceding sentence must be 
delivered personally to, or mailed to and received at, the principal 
executive office of the Corporation, addressed to the attention of the 
Secretary, not less than 45 days nor more than 60 days prior to the meeting; 
provided, however, that in the event that less than 55 days' notice or prior 
public disclosure of the date of the meeting was given or made to 
stockholders, notice by the stockholder to be timely must be so received not 
later than the close of business on the tenth day following the day on which 
such notice of the date of the meeting was mailed or such public disclosure 
was made, whichever first occurred.  Such notice referred to in clause (C) of 
the first sentence of this Section 6(j) shall set forth: (i) a full 
description of each such item of business proposed to be brought before the 
meeting and the reasons for conducting such business at such meeting; (ii) 
the name and address of the person proposing to bring such business before 
the meeting; (iii) the class and number of shares held of record, held 
beneficially and represented by proxy by such person as of the record date 
for the meeting (if such date has then been made publicly available) and as 
of the date of such notice; (iv) if any item of such business involves a 
nomination for director, all information regarding each such nominee that 
would be required to be set forth in a definitive proxy statement filed with 
the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") pursuant to Section 
14 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or any successor 
thereto (the "Exchange Act"), and the written consent of each such nominee to 
serve if elected; (v) any material interest of the stockholder in such item 
of business; and (vi) all other information that would be required to be 
filed with the Commission if, with respect to the business proposed to be 
brought before the meeting, the person proposing such business was a 
participant in a solicitation subject to Section 14 of the Exchange Act.  No 
business shall be brought before any meeting of stockholders of the 
Corporation otherwise than as provided in this Section 6(j).  The Board of 
Directors may require a proposed nominee for director to furnish such other 
information as may be required to be set forth in a stockholder's notice of 
nomination which pertains to the nominee or which may be reasonably required 
to determine the eligibility of such proposed nominee to serve as a director 
of the Corporation.  The chairman of the meeting may, if the facts warrant, 
determine that a nomination or stockholder proposal was not made in 
accordance with the foregoing procedure, and if the chairman should so 
determine, the chairman shall so declare to the meeting and the defective 
nomination or proposal shall be disregarded.

    (k)  Proxy Representation.  Every stockholder may authorize another 
person or persons to act for such stockholder by proxy in all matters in 
which a stockholder is entitled to participate, whether by waiving notice of 
any meeting, voting or participating at a meeting.  Every proxy must be 
signed by the stockholder or by such person's attorney-in-fact.  No proxy 
shall be voted or acted upon after three years from its date unless such 
proxy provides for a longer period.  A duly executed proxy shall be 
irrevocable if it states that it is irrevocable and, if, and only as long as, 
it is coupled with an interest sufficient in law to support an irrevocable 
power. A proxy may be made irrevocable regardless of whether the interest 
with which it is coupled is an interest in the stock itself or an interest in 
the Corporation generally.

    (l)  Stockholder Action Without Meetings.  Any action required by the 
DGCL to be taken at an annual or special meeting of stockholders of the 
Corporation, and any action which otherwise may be taken at any annual or 
special meeting of stockholders of the Corporation, shall be taken only at a 
duly called meeting of the stockholders of the Corporation and, 
notwithstanding Section 228 of the DGCL, no such action shall be taken by 
written consent or consents without a meeting of the stockholders of the 
Corporation.


                                       4


                                      ARTICLE II
                                      DIRECTORS

1.  FUNCTIONS AND DEFINITION. 

    The business and affairs of the Corporation shall be managed by or under 
the direction of the Board of Directors of the Corporation.  The term "Whole 
Board" herein refers to the total number of directors which the Corporation 
would have if there were no vacancies.

2.  QUALIFICATIONS, NUMBER AND VACANCIES. 

    (a)  Qualifications.  A director need not be a stockholder, a citizen of 
the United States, or a resident of the State of Delaware.

    (b)  Number.  The number of directors which shall constitute the Whole 
Board shall be not less than three nor more than 12 and the exact number 
shall be fixed from time to time by the Board of Directors pursuant to a 
resolution adopted by a majority of the directors then in office; provided, 
however, that such maximum number of directors may be increased from time to 
time to reflect the rights, if any, of holders of Preferred Stock to elect 
directors in accordance with the terms of the resolution or resolutions 
adopted by the Board of Directors providing for the issue of such shares of 
Preferred Stock.  The number of directors may be increased or decreased only 
by action of the Board of Directors.

    (c)  Vacancies.  Subject to the rights, if any, of the holders of any 
Preferred Stock, the power to fill vacancies on the Board of Directors 
(whether by reason of resignation, removal, an increase in the number of 
directors or otherwise) shall be vested solely in the Board of Directors, and 
vacancies may be filled by the affirmative vote of a majority of the 
directors then in office, although less than a quorum, or by the sole 
remaining director, unless all directorships are vacant, in which case the 
stockholders shall fill the then existing vacancies.  Any director chosen by 
the Board of Directors to fill a vacancy (including a vacancy resulting from 
an increase in the number of directors) shall hold office for the remainder 
of the full term of the class of directors in which the vacancy occurred (or 
in which the new directorship was created) and until that director's 
successor shall be elected and shall have qualified.  No decrease in the 
number of directors constituting the Board of Directors may shorten the term 
of any incumbent director.

    (d)  Election.  The directors, other than those who may be elected by the 
holders of any series of Preferred Stock, will be classified with respect to 
the time for which they severally hold office in accordance with the 
Certificate of Incorporation.  At the annual meeting of stockholders, the 
stockholders will elect by a plurality vote the directors to succeed those 
whose terms expire at such meeting. Any director may resign at any time upon 
written notice to the Corporation.

    (e)  Nominations.  Nominations for the election of Directors may be made 
the Board of Directors or by any stockholder entitled to vote for the 
election of Directors who complies with the provisions of Section 6(j) of 
Article I of these Bylaws and Article Nine of the Certificate of 
Incorporation of the Corporation.

3.  MEETINGS.

    (a)  Time.  Regular meetings of the Board of Directors shall be held at 
such time as the Board of Directors shall fix.  Special meetings shall be 
held at such time as may be specified in the notice thereof.

    (b)  First Meeting.  The first meeting of each newly elected Board of 
Directors may be held immediately after each annual meeting of the 
stockholders at the same place at which the meeting is held, and no notice of 
such meeting shall be necessary to call the meeting, provided a quorum shall 
be present.  In the event such first meeting is not so held immediately after 
the annual meeting of the stockholders, it may be held at such time and place 
as shall be specified in the notice given as provided for special meetings of 
the Board of Directors, or at such time and place as shall be fixed by the 
consent in writing of all of the directors.

    (c)  Place.  Meetings of the Board of Directors, both regular and 
special, shall be held at such place within or without the State of Delaware 
as shall be fixed by the Board of Directors.

                                       5

    (d)  Call.  No call shall be required for regular meetings for which the 
time and place have been fixed.  Special meetings may be called by or at the 
direction of the Chairman of the Board, the President or a majority of the 
directors.

    (e)  Notice Or Actual Or Constructive Waiver.  No notice shall be 
required for regular meetings of the Board of Directors for which the time 
and place have been fixed.  Written, oral or any other mode of notice of the 
time and place shall be given for special meetings at least twenty-four hours 
prior to the meeting; notice may be given by telephone or telefax (in which 
case it is effective when given), by overnight courier or messenger (in which 
case it is effective when received) or by mail (in which case it is effective 
seventy-two hours after mailing by prepaid first class mail).  The notice of 
any meeting need not specify the purpose of the meeting. Any requirement of 
furnishing a notice shall be waived by any director who signs a written 
waiver of such notice before or after the time stated therein.  Attendance of 
a director at a meeting of the Board of Directors shall constitute a waiver 
of notice of such meeting, except when the director attends a meeting for the 
express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the 
transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or 
convened.

    (f)  Quorum And Action.  A majority of the Whole Board shall constitute a 
quorum except when a vacancy or vacancies prevents such majority, whereupon a 
majority of the directors in office shall constitute a quorum, provided that 
such majority shall constitute at least one-third (1/3) of the Whole Board.  
Any director may participate in a meeting of the Board of Directors by means 
of a conference telephone or similar communications equipment by means of 
which all directors participating in the meeting can hear each other, and 
such participation in a meeting of the Board of Directors shall constitute 
presence in person at such meeting.  A majority of the directors present, 
whether or not a quorum is present, may adjourn a meeting to another time and 
place. Except as herein otherwise provided, and except as otherwise provided 
by the DGCL, the act of the Board of Directors shall be the act by vote of a 
majority of the directors present at a meeting, a quorum being present.  The 
quorum and voting provisions herein stated shall not be construed as 
conflicting with any provisions of the DGCL, the Certificate of Incorporation 
and these Bylaws which govern a meeting of directors held to fill vacancies 
and newly created directorships in the Board of Directors.

    (g)  Chairman Of The Meeting.  The Chairman of the Board, if present and 
acting, shall preside at all meetings of the Board of Directors.  Otherwise, 
the President, if present and acting, shall preside, or in the absence of the 
President, any other director chosen by the Board of Directors shall preside.

4.  REMOVAL OF DIRECTORS. 

    Any or all of the directors may be removed only in accordance with 
Article Thirteen of the Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation.

5.  COMMITTEES. 

    The Board of Directors may, by resolution passed by a majority of the 
Whole Board, designate one or more committees, each committee to consist of 
one or more of the directors of the Corporation.  The Board may designate one 
or more directors as alternate members of any committee, who may replace any 
absent or disqualified member at any meeting of such committee.  Except as 
otherwise provided by law, any such committee, to the extent provided in the 
resolution of the Board of Directors, shall have and may exercise the powers 
of the Board of Directors in the management of the business and affairs of 
the Corporation, and may authorize the seal of the Corporation to be affixed 
to all papers which may require it.  In the absence or disqualification of 
any member of any such committee or committees, the members thereof present 
at any meeting and not disqualified from voting, whether or not they 
constitute a quorum, may unanimously appoint another member of the Board of 
Directors to act at the meeting in the place of any such absent or 
disqualified member.

6.  ACTION IN WRITING. 

    Any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of the Board 
of Directors or any committee thereof may be taken without a meeting if all 
members of the Board of Directors or such committee, as the case may be, 
consent thereto in writing, and the writing or writings are filed with the 
minutes of proceedings of the Board of Directors or committee.

                                       6



                                     ARTICLE III

                                       OFFICERS

1.  OFFICERS. 

    The Board of Directors may elect or appoint a Chairman of the Board of 
Directors, a President, one or more Vice Presidents (which may be denominated 
with additional descriptive titles), a Secretary, one or more Assistant 
Secretaries, a Treasurer, one or more Assistant Treasurers, and such other 
officers as it may determine.  The Board of Directors shall designate from 
among such elected officers a chief executive officer, a chief operating 
officer, a chief financial officer and a principal accounting officer, and 
may from time to time make, or provide for, other designations it deems 
appropriate.  The Board of Directors may also appoint, or provide for the 
appointment of, such other officers and agents as may from time to time 
appear necessary or advisable in the conduct of the affairs of the 
Corporation. Any number of offices may be held by the same person, except 
that no person may at the same time be both the President and the Secretary.

2.  TERM OF OFFICE AND REMOVAL. 

    Unless otherwise provided in the resolution of election or appointment, 
each officer shall hold office until the meeting of the Board of Directors 
following the next annual meeting of stockholders and until such officer's 
successor has been elected and qualified or until the earlier death, 
retirement, resignation or removal of such officer.  The Board of Directors 
may remove any officer for cause or without cause.

3.  AUTHORITY AND DUTIES. 

    All officers, as between themselves and the Corporation, shall have such 
authority and perform such duties in the management of the Corporation as may 
be provided in these Bylaws, or, to the extent not so provided, by the Board 
of Directors.

4.  THE CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS. 

    The Chairman of the Board may be, but shall not be required to be, the 
Chief Executive Officer of the Corporation.  In addition, the Chairman of the 
Board of Directors, if present and acting, shall preside at all meetings of 
the stockholders and all meetings of the Board of Directors.
   
5.  THE PRESIDENT. 

    The President may be, but shall not be required to be, the chief 
operating officer and/or chief financial officer of the Corporation.  In the 
absence of the Chairman of the Board of Directors, the President shall 
preside at all meetings of the stockholders and all meetings of the Board of 
Directors.  Except to the extent otherwise provided in these Bylaws, the 
President shall have general authority to execute any and all documents in 
the name of the Corporation and to supervise and control all of the business 
and affairs of the Corporation.  In the absence of the President, his duties 
shall be performed and his powers may be exercised by the chief financial 
officer of the Corporation or by such other officer as shall be designated by 
the Board of Directors.

6.  VICE PRESIDENTS. 

    Any Vice President that may have been appointed and shall perform such 
other duties as the Board of Directors shall prescribe.

7.  THE SECRETARY. 

    The Secretary shall keep in safe custody the seal of the Corporation and 
affix it to any instrument when authorized by the Board of Directors, and 
shall perform such other duties as may be prescribed by the Board of 
Directors, the Chairman of the Board, the President or the chief financial 
officer.  The Secretary (or in such officer's absence, an Assistant 
Secretary, but if neither is present another person selected by the chairman 
for the meeting) shall have the duty to record the proceedings of the 
meetings of the stockholders and Board of Directors in a book to be kept for 
that purpose.


                                       7


8.  THE TREASURER. 

    The Treasurer shall have the care and custody of the corporate funds, and 
other valuable effects, including securities, and shall keep full and 
accurate accounts of receipts and disbursements in books belonging to the 
Corporation and shall deposit all moneys and other valuable effects in the 
name and to the credit of the Corporation in such depositories as may be 
designated by the Board of Directors.  The Treasurer shall disburse the funds 
of the Corporation as may be ordered by the Board of Directors, taking proper 
vouchers for such disbursements, and shall render to the President and 
directors, at the regular meetings of the Board of Directors, or whenever 
they may require it, an accounting of all transactions as Treasurer and of 
the financial condition of the Corporation.  If required by the Board of 
Directors, the Treasurer shall give the Corporation a bond for such term, in 
such sum and with such surety or sureties as shall be satisfactory to the 
Board of Directors for the faithful performance of the duties of such office 
and for the restoration to the Corporation, in case of such person's death, 
resignation, retirement or removal from office, of all books, papers, 
vouchers, money and other property of whatever kind in such person's 
possession or under such person's control belonging to the Corporation.

                                      ARTICLE IV
                                    CORPORATE SEAL
                                         AND
                                   CORPORATE BOOKS

    The corporate seal shall be in such form as the Board of Directors shall 
prescribe.  The books of the Corporation may be kept within or without the 
State of Delaware, at such place or places as the Board of Directors may, 
from time to time, determine.

                                      ARTICLE V
                                     FISCAL YEAR

    The fiscal year of the Corporation shall be fixed, and shall be subject 
to change, by the Board of Directors.

                                      ARTICLE VI
                                      INDEMNITY

1.  INDEMNIFICATION.

    (a)  Any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party 
to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether 
civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or 
in the right of the Corporation) by reason of the fact that he or she is or 
was a director, officer, employee or agent of the Corporation or is or was 
serving at the request of the Corporation as a director, officer, employee or 
agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other 
enterprise (including employee benefit plans) (hereinafter an "indemnitee"), 
shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Corporation to the fullest 
extent authorized by the DGCL, as the same exists or may hereafter be amended 
(but, in the case of any such amendment, only to the extent that such 
amendment permits the Corporation to provide broader indemnification than 
permitted prior thereto), against expenses (including attorneys' fees), 
judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably 
incurred by such indemnitee in connection with such action, suit or 
proceeding, if the indemnitee acted in good faith and in a manner he or she 
reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the 
Corporation, and with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no 
reasonable cause to believe such conduct was unlawful. The termination of the 
proceeding, whether by judgment, order, settlement, conviction or upon a plea 
of nolo contendere or its equivalent, shall not, in and of itself, create a 
presumption that the person did not act in good faith and in a manner which 
he or she reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests 
of the Corporation and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, 
had reasonable cause to believe such conduct was unlawful.

    (b)  Any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party 
to any threatened, pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of 
the Corporation to procure a judgment in its favor by reason of the fact that 
he or she is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the 
Corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a 
director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, 
joint venture, trust or other enterprise (including employee benefit plans), 
shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Corporation to the fullest 

                                       8



extent authorized by the DGCL, as the same exists or may hereafter be amended 
(but, in the case of any such amendment, only to the extent that such 
amendment permits the Corporation to provide broader indemnification than 
permitted prior thereto), against expenses (including attorneys' fees) 
actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection with the defense 
or settlement of such action or suit if he or she acted in good faith and in 
a manner he or she reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best 
interests of the Corporation and except that no indemnification shall be made 
in respect of any claim, issue or matter as to which such person shall have 
been adjudged to be liable to the Corporation unless and only to the extent 
that the court in which such suit or action was brought, shall determine, 
upon application, that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of 
all the circumstances of the case, such person is fairly and reasonably 
entitled to indemnity for such expenses which such court shall deem proper.

2.  ADVANCEMENT OF EXPENSES.

    All reasonable expenses incurred by or on behalf of the indemnitee in 
connection with any suit, action or proceeding may be advanced to the 
indemnitee by the Corporation.

3.  INDEMNIFICATION NOT EXCLUSIVE.

    The indemnification and advancement of expenses provided for in this 
Article V shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights which any person 
may have or hereafter acquire under any statute, the Certificate of 
Incorporation, a Bylaw of the Corporation, agreement, vote of stockholders or 
disinterested directors or otherwise.

4.  CONTINUATION OF INDEMNIFICATION.

    The right to indemnification and advancement of expenses provided by this 
Article V shall continue as to a person who has ceased to be a director, 
officer, employee or agent and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, 
executors and administrators of such person.

                                     ARTICLE VII

                                      AMENDMENTS

1.  BY THE STOCKHOLDERS.

    These Bylaws may be amended by the stockholders only (i) at a meeting 
called for that purpose and (ii) in a manner not inconsistent with any 
provision of law or the Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation.

2.  BY THE DIRECTORS.

    These Bylaws may be amended by the affirmative vote of a majority of the 
Whole Board, in any manner not inconsistent with any provision of law or the 
Certificate of Incorporation of the Corporation.

                                       9

                                                                  Exhibit 9.1
    
                     AMENDED AND RESTATED STOCKHOLDERS AGREEMENT

    AMENDED AND RESTATED STOCKHOLDERS AGREEMENT dated as of September ___, 
1997 among THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC., a Delaware corporation 
(the "Company"), each of the Persons listed on Schedule 1 and a signatory 
hereto (each a "Management Stockholder" and, collectively, the "Management 
Stockholders"), THE SK EQUITY FUND, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership 
("SK"), SK INVESTMENT FUND, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership ("SKIF"), 
and BARRY FEINBERG ("Feinberg") (each of the Management Stockholders, SK, 
SKIF and Feinberg, and their permitted Transferees, a "Stockholder" and, 
collectively, the "Stockholders").

                                       RECITALS

                                            A.   The Company and the 
Stockholders entered into a Stockholders Agreement dated June 28, 1996 (the 
"Original Stockholders Agreement"), setting forth  certain rights and 
obligations of the Company and the Stockholders with respect to various 
matters, in order to ensure a degree of continuity of management and 
ownership of and certain rights in respect of the Company by imposing certain 
restrictions and obligations on the ownership, retention and disposition of 
the capital stock of the Company.

    B.   As of the date hereof, the Management Stockholders own an aggregate 
of 9,893,400 shares of the Company's Common Stock.

    C.   As of the date hereof, SK owns 7,458,445 shares of the Company's 
Common Stock, SKIF owns 108,108 shares of Common Stock and Feinberg owns 
93,336 shares of Common Stock, all of which shares were issued upon 
conversion of shares of the Company's Series B Common Stock previously owned 
by such holders, in accordance with the terms set forth in the Company's 
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation.

    D.   The Company and the Stockholders have now agreed that, in connection 
with the Company's initial public offering, it is desirable and in the best 
interest of the Company that the Original Stockholders Agreement be amended 
and restated in its entirety to read as hereinafter set forth.

    E.   NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree that the Original 
Stockholders Agreement is hereby amended and restated in its entirety, 
effective as of the Effective Date (as defined below), to read in its 
entirety as follows: 




                                           
                                   I.  DEFINITIONS

    1.1. Definitions. (a) In addition to the terms defined elsewhere herein, 
the following terms have the following meanings when used herein with initial 
capital letters: 

    "Affiliate" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person directly 
or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under common control with, such 
Person.  For the purposes of this definition, "control" when used with 
respect to any Person, means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the 
power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of such 
Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or 
otherwise; and the terms "controlling" and "controlled" have meanings 
correlative to the foregoing.

    "Agreement" means this Agreement, as the same may be amended from time to 
time.

    "Board of Directors" means the Board of Directors of the Company.

    "Business Day" means any day except a Saturday, Sunday or other day on 
which commercial banks in the City of New York are authorized by law to 
close.  

    "Charter" means the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of 
the Company as amended from time to time.

    "Change of Control" means when any Person becomes the "beneficial owner" 
(as determined pursuant to Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act) of 
50% or more of either (A) the then outstanding shares of Common Stock of the 
Company or (B) the combined voting power of the then outstanding voting 
securities of the Company entitled to vote generally in the election of 
directors.

    "Common Stock" means the Common Stock, par value $0.10 per share, of the 
Company.

    "Designated Management Stockholders" means Ezra Dabah, Stanley Silver and 
any trust to which Ezra Dabah or Stanley Silver Transferred shares of Common 
Stock after the date of the Original Stockholders Agreement.

    "Director" means a member of the Board of Directors of the Company.  

    "Duly Endorsed" means duly endorsed in blank by the Person in whose name 
a certificate representing a security is registered or accompanied by a duly 
executed instrument of assignment separate from the certificate.

    "Effective Date" means the date of consummation of the Company's initial 
public offering under the Securities Act.

    "Management Permitted Transferee" means with respect to any Management 
Stockholder, (i) any spouse or lineal descendant of such Management 
Stockholder, (ii) any trust all of the beneficial interests in which is held 
by such Management Stockholder and/or such Management Stockholder's spouse 
and/or lineal descendants, and (iii) any other Management Stockholder;
 

                                          2



provided, however, that each such Transferee will be a Management Permitted 
Transferee for purposes of this Agreement only if such Transferee shall have 
executed and delivered to the Company an instrument reasonably satisfactory 
to the SK Holders pursuant to which the Transferee shall have agreed to be 
bound by the terms of this Agreement applicable to its Transferor. 

    "Management Stockholder Group" means each of the Management Stockholders 
or any Management Permitted Transferee.

    "Person" means an individual, corporation, partnership, trust, 
association or any other entity or organization, including without limitation 
a government or political subdivision or an agency or instrumentality thereof.

    "pro rata" means, with respect to any offer including Common Stock, an 
offer based on the relative percentages of Common Stock  then held by all of 
the holders of Common Stock to whom such offer is made.

    "Public Offering" means any primary or secondary public offering of 
Common Stock pursuant to an effective registration statement under the 
Securities Act, other than pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-4 
or Form S-8 or any successor or similar form.

    "Purchase Agreement" means the Purchase Agreement dated as of June 28, 
1996 among the Company, SK and SKIF and Feinberg.

    "Relinquishment Time" means the time at which the SK Holders own less 
than 25% of the shares of Common Stock owned by SK and SKIF as of the 
Effective Date (as adjusted to give effect to any stock dividend, stock 
split, recapitalization or similar event affecting the then-outstanding 
Common Stock).

    "Rule 144" means Rule 144 under the Securities Act, as such rule may be 
amended from time to time.

    "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

    "SK Holder" means SK, SKIF, Feinberg or any permitted Transferee thereof. 
 For purposes of this Agreement, any action or consent contemplated to be 
taken or given by the SK Holders will be effective if taken or given, as the 
case may be, by the SK Holder which owns the largest portion of the Common 
Stock owned by all SK Holders as of the relevant time.  

    "Third Party" means a prospective purchaser of Securities in an 
arm's-length transaction in which such purchaser is not the Company, an 
Affiliate of the Company or an Affiliate of any Stockholder.

     "Transferee" means any Person to whom any Stockholder Transfers (as 
defined in Section 2.1) any Common Stock other than in a sale pursuant to an 
effective registration statement under the Securities Act or a public sale 
pursuant to Rule 144.

                                          3



     (b)  Except as otherwise provided herein, any right or action that may 
be taken at the election of the Management Stockholder Group will be taken by 
a representative of the Management Stockholder Group (the "Management Group 
Representative") on behalf of the entire Management Stockholder Group.  The 
initial Management Group Representative will be Ezra Dabah.  Upon the death 
or permanent disability (or during any period of temporary disability) of 
Ezra Dabah, the Management Stockholder Group may designate a successor 
Management Group Representative upon vote of the members thereof holding a 
majority of the Common Stock held by the Management Stockholder Group; 
provided, however, that (i) if no such successor is so designated within 30 
calendar days from such death or permanent disability, such successor will be 
a member of the Management Stockholder Group designated by the SK Holders, 
until a successor is designated by the Management Stockholder Group and (ii) 
in the event that no Person is acting as the Management Group Representative 
as of the time any action is otherwise to be taken hereunder by the 
Management Group Representative or the Management Stockholder Group, such 
action may be taken on behalf of the entire Management Stockholder Group by 
written action or consent of the holders of a majority of shares of Common 
Stock then held by the members of the Management Stockholder Group.  Any 
change in the Management Group Representative will become effective upon 
notice in accordance with Section 4.3.  

                  II.  RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS WITH RESPECT TO TRANSFER

    2.1  Restrictions on Transfers by Designated Management Stockholders.  
None of the Designated Management Stockholders may offer, sell, assign, grant 
a participation in, pledge or otherwise transfer ("Transfer") any shares of 
Common Stock (other than shares of Common Stock acquired upon exercise of 
stock options) during the period of 20 months from the Effective Date without 
the prior written consent of the SK Holders and the Company; provided, 
however, that the restrictions in this Section 2.1 will not apply (i) to 
Transfers to any Management Permitted Transferee, (ii) to Transfers made 
pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act, 
(iii) to Transfers in "brokers' transactions" or transactions directly with a 
"market maker" pursuant to Rule 144 (a "Rule 144 Transfer"), (iv) to 
Transfers in connection with a sale of 100% of the outstanding Common Stock 
to a Third Party or (v) to Transfers pursuant to Section 2.7. 

    2.2  Restrictive Legend.  (a) Each certificate representing Common Stock 
owned by any Stockholder will include the following legend (in addition to 
such legends as may be appropriate under the securities laws): 

     "THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE ARE SUBJECT TO CERTAIN 
     RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER AS SET FORTH IN THE AMENDED AND RESTATED 
     STOCKHOLDERS AGREEMENT, DATED AS OF SEPTEMBER ___, 1997, AS FROM TIME TO
     TIME AMENDED, A COPY OF WHICH MAY BE OBTAINED FROM THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
     RETAIL STORES, INC."

     (b)  Each certificate representing Common Stock owned by any Stockholder 
or any Transferee thereof (other than shares that have been sold pursuant to 
an effective registration statement under the Securities Act or in accordance 
with Rule 144 under the Securities Act) will (unless otherwise permitted by 


                                          4



the provisions of Section 2.2(c)) include a legend substantially as follows:

     "THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED 
     UNDER THE UNITED STATES SECURITIES ACT OF 1933 OR ANY STATE SECURITIES 
     LAWS.  THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD OR TRANSFERRED IN THE ABSENCE OF 
     SUCH REGISTRATION OR AN EXEMPTION THEREFROM."

Each holder of Common Stock represented by a certificate which bears the 
legend described above, by its acceptance or purchase thereof, agrees that 
prior to the effectiveness of any proposed Transfer of any such Common Stock 
(except pursuant to an effective registration statement) such holder will 
give written notice to the Company of such proposed Transfer, briefly 
describing the proposed Transfer.  Such notice will, unless waived by the 
Company, be accompanied by a written opinion, addressed to the Company, of 
counsel for such holder stating that in the opinion of such counsel (which 
opinion will be reasonably satisfactory to the Company) such proposed 
Transfer does not require registration of such Common Stock under the 
Securities Act or the securities laws of any state.

     (c)  Any Stockholder may, upon providing evidence (which, if required by 
the Company, may include an opinion of counsel) reasonably satisfactory to 
the Company, that such Securities either are not "restricted securities" (as 
defined in Rule 144) or may be sold pursuant to Rule 144(k), exchange the 
certificate representing such Securities for a new certificate that does not 
bear a legend relating to restrictions under the securities laws.
     
     2.3  Tag-Along Rights.  (a) If, at any time prior to when the SK Holders 
collectively own 30% or less of the Common Stock owned collectively by the SK 
Holders as of the Effective Date, any Designated Management Stockholder (a 
"Selling Management Stockholder") proposes to Transfer (other than pursuant 
to a Public Offering or a Rule 144 Transfer or pursuant to Section 2.7 or to 
a Management Stockholder Permitted Transferee) any of its Common Stock (other 
than shares acquired upon exercise of stock options) representing more than 
1% of the outstanding Common Stock either to (i) any Third Party pursuant to 
a bona fide offer to purchase or (ii) the Company (in the case of clause (i) 
and (ii), a "Tag-Along Offer"), the Selling Management Stockholder will 
provide written notice of such Tag-Along Offer to the Company and each of the 
SK Holders in the manner set forth in this Section 2.3; provided, however, 
that nothing in this Section 2.3 will affect the restrictions on Transfers by 
the Management Stockholders contained in Section 2.1.  Such written notice 
will identify the proposed purchaser, the number of shares of Common Stock 
proposed to be purchased from the Selling Management Stockholder (or if 
greater, the number of shares of Common Stock such Person is willing to 
purchase (the "Desired Shares")), the Tag-Along Ratio (as defined in Section 
2.3(d)) that would apply if all the SK Holders become Co-Selling Stockholders 
(as defined below), the consideration offered and all other material terms 
and conditions of the Tag-Along Offer.  If the offer price consists in part 
or in whole of consideration other than cash, the Selling Management 
Stockholder will provide such information, to the extent reasonably available 

     
                                     5



to the Selling Management Stockholder, relating to such consideration as any 
SK Holder may reasonably request in order to evaluate such non-cash 
consideration.
                          
     (b)  The SK Holders will have the right, exercisable as set forth below, 
to accept the Tag-Along Offer for up to the number of shares of Common Stock 
determined pursuant to Section 2.3(d).  The SK Holders will, within ten 
Business Days after receipt of the written notice from the Selling Management 
Stockholder, provide the Selling Management Stockholder with an irrevocable 
written notice specifying the number of shares of Common Stock the SK Holders 
wish to Transfer, not to exceed the number of Desired Shares, and the 
allocation of such shares among the SK Holders and will simultaneously 
provide a copy of such notice to the Company.  If the SK Holders do not 
accept the Tag-Along Offer within ten Business Days following receipt of 
written notice from the Selling Management Stockholder, the SK Holders will 
be deemed to have waived any and all rights under this Section 2.3 with 
respect to the Transfer of Common Stock pursuant to such Tag-Along Offer but 
nothing herein will affect the SK Holders' rights in respect of any other 
transaction or proposed transaction.
    
     (c)  Not less than seven Business Days prior to the proposed date of any 
sale pursuant to a Tag-Along Offer, the Selling Management Stockholders will 
notify the SK Holders which have accepted the Tag-Along Offer (each, a 
"Co-Selling Stockholder") of such proposed date.  Not less than two Business 
Days prior to such proposed date of sale, the Co-Selling Stockholders will 
deliver to an Escrow Agent (the costs of which Escrow Agent will be borne by 
the Selling Management Stockholder and the Co-Selling Stockholders in 
proportion to the shares of Common Stock Transferred by such Selling 
Management Stockholder and Co-Selling Stockholders in connection with such 
Tag-Along Offer) the Duly Endorsed certificate or certificates representing 
the Common Stock to be Transferred by the Co-Selling Stockholders and all 
other documents reasonably required to be executed in connection with such 
Tag-Along Offer.

    (d)  Each Co-Selling Stockholder will have the right to Transfer (and the 
Selling Management Stockholder will, to the extent necessary, reduce the 
amount or number of shares of Common Stock to be Transferred by the Selling 
Management Stockholder by a corresponding amount), pursuant to the Tag-Along 
Offer, a number of shares of Common Stock equal to the product of the Desired 
Shares multiplied by a fraction (the "Tag-Along Ratio"), the numerator of 
which will be the aggregate amount or number of shares of Common Stock owned 
by such Co-Selling Stockholder and the denominator of which will be the 
aggregate number of shares of Common Stock owned by the Selling Management 
Stockholder and all Co-Selling Stockholders. 

    (e)  The Selling Management Stockholder will have 90 Business Days from 
the end of the ten Business Day period  referred to in paragraph (b) above in 
which to consummate the Transfer of Common Stock owned by such Selling 
Management Stockholder and the Co-Selling Stockholders as contemplated by the 
Tag-Along Offer at the price and on the terms contained in such notice.  If, 
at the end of such 90 Business Day period, the Selling Management Stockholder 
has not completed such Transfer, the right of the Selling Management 
Stockholder to effect such Transfer will terminate, and the Common Stock of 
the Selling Management Stockholders subject to such proposed Transfer will 


                                          6



to the Selling Management to all the restrictions on sale or other 
disposition and other provisions contained in this Agreement.

    (f)  Immediately after the consummation of the Transfer of Common Stock 
pursuant to the Tag-Along Offer, the Escrow Agent will notify the Co-Selling 
Stockholders thereof and will remit to each Co-Selling Stockholder the total 
sales price attributable to the Common Stock of such Co-Selling Stockholder 
sold pursuant thereto less a pro rata portion of the expenses incurred in 
connection with such sale.

    (g)  Notwithstanding anything contained in this Section 2.3, there will 
be no liability on the part of the Selling Management Stockholders to any 
Stockholder (including any Co-Selling Stockholder) if the Transfer of Common 
Stock by the Selling Management Stockholder and any Co-Selling Stockholder 
pursuant to Section 2.3 is not consummated for whatever reason.  The 
Management Stockholders, in their sole discretion, will determine whether to 
effect a sale of Common Stock to any Person pursuant to this Section 2.3.

    (h)  In connection with any Transfer of Common Stock as to which the SK 
Holders have Tag-Along rights pursuant to this Section 2.3, the Transferee of 
such Common Stock will not be required to execute a counterpart of this 
Agreement or become subject to this Agreement.

    (i)  No failure to exercise any rights or take any other action in 
respect of any Tag-Along Offer will affect any SK Holder's rights in respect 
of any subsequent Tag-Along Offer or other rights hereunder.

    2.4. Restrictions on Transfers by SK Holders.  (a) Notwithstanding any 
other provision of this Agreement to the contrary, without the prior written 
consent of the Company and the Management Group Representative, the SK 
Holders will not Transfer any of the Common Stock held by them to any of the 
following Persons:  (a) any Direct Competitor of the Company, (b) Bain 
Capital, (c) The Sprout Group, (d) any Person who serves or who has 
designated a representative to serve on the board of directors of any Direct 
Competitor of the Company, or (e) any Person who does not agree in writing to 
comply with and be bound by this Agreement.  For purposes of this Section 
2.4, a "Direct Competitor of the Company" means (i) The Gap, Inc. or any 
Person under common control with The Gap, Inc. (provided that at the time of 
such Transfer, The Gap, Inc. continues to own and operate its GapKids 
division), (ii) The Limited, Inc. or any Person under common control with The 
Limited, Inc. (provided that at the time of such Transfer, The Limited, Inc. 
continues to own and operate its Limited Too division), (iii) Gymboree or 
Baby Superstore or any Person under common control with Gymboree or Baby 
Superstore, as the case may be, or (iv) any Person whose principal business 
activity is the sale of children's apparel and who derives more than 50% of 
its gross revenues from the retail sales of children's apparel.

     (b)  Each of the SK Holders will provide the Company and the Management 
Group Representative with ten Business Days' prior written notice of its 
intent to pursue or to enter into discussions concerning a sale of any Common 
Stock held by the SK Holders to a Third Party.

                                          7



     2.5. Improper Transfer.  (a) Any attempt to Transfer any Common Stock 
not in compliance with this Agreement will be null and void and neither the 
Company nor any transfer agent of the Company will register, or otherwise 
recognize in the Company's records, any such improper Transfer.  Any cost or 
loss incurred as a result of any such attempt to transfer shall be borne by 
the Stockholder who attempted to Transfer.

     (b)  No Stockholder will enter into any transaction or series of 
transactions for the purpose or with the effect of, directly or indirectly, 
denying or impairing the rights or obligations of any Person under this 
Agreement, and any such transaction will be null and void and, to the extent 
that such transaction requires any action by the Company, it will not be 
registered or otherwise recognized in the Company's records or otherwise.

     2.6. Transferees.  Except as expressly provided otherwise in this 
Agreement, any and all provisions of this Agreement which apply to the 
Stockholders will apply with equal force to any Transferee (other than any 
Transferees of Management Stockholders other than the Designated Management 
Stockholders.)

    2.7. Certain Transfer Rights for Designated Management Stockholders.  (a) 
Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 2.1 or 2.3, any Designated 
Management Stockholder (other than Stanley Silver) may transfer to a Third 
Party at any time up to 20% of the Common Stock held by such Designated 
Management Stockholder in accordance with the provisions of paragraphs (e), 
(f), (g) and (h) of this Section 2.7. 

    (b)  Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 2.1 or 2.3, at any time 
after the death or permanent disability of Ezra Dabah, Ezra Dabah or Ezra 
Dabah's heirs and successors (the "Dabah Estate"), the wife or any lineal 
descendant of Ezra Dabah to whom he Transfers shares (a "Dabah Family 
Member"), any of the trusts set forth on Schedule 2.9(b) and any trusts 
established by Ezra Dabah which is a Management Permitted Transferee and to 
whom he Transfers shares of his Common Stock after June 28, 1996  (each, a 
"Dabah Trust" and, together with Ezra Dabah, the Dabah Estate and any Dabah 
Family Member, a "Dabah Transferor") shall collectively have the right to 
Transfer to a Third Party up to 100% of the Common Stock held collectively by 
the Dabah Transferors, in accordance with the provisions of paragraphs (e), 
(f), (g) and (h) of this Section 2.7.

    (c)  Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 2.1 or 2.3, at any time 
after the termination of Ezra Dabah's employment without cause (as defined in 
his employment agreement) following a Change of Control or Ezra Dabah's 
resignation from the Company for good reason (as so defined therein) 
following a Change of Control, the Dabah Transferors shall collectively have 
the right to Transfer to a Third Party up to 100% of the Common Stock held 
collectively by the Dabah Transferors, in accordance with the provisions of 
paragraphs (e), (f), (g) and (h) of this Section 2.7; provided, however, that 
the Dabah Transferors shall not have the right to Transfer such shares to a 
Third Party pursuant to this paragraph (c) in the event that Ezra Dabah 
directly Transferred Shares of Common Stock to a Third Party which Transfer 
resulted, in whole or in part, in such Change of Control. 

                                          8



    (d)  Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 2.1 or 2.3, at any time 
after the death, permanent disability or termination of employment without 
cause (as defined in his employment agreement) of Stanley Silver, Stanley 
Silver or Stanley Silver's heirs and successors (the "Silver Estate"), as the 
case may be, the wife or any lineal descendant of Stanley Silver to whom he 
Transfers shares (a "Silver Family Member") and any trust established by 
Stanley Silver which is a Management Permitted Transferee (a "Silver Trust" 
and, together with Stanley Silver, the Silver Estate and any Silver Family 
Member, a "Stanley Transferor") shall collectively have the right to Transfer 
to a Third Party up to 100% of the Common Stock held collectively by the 
Silver Transferors, in accordance with the provisions of paragraphs  (e), 
(f), (g) and (h) of this Section 2.7.

    (e)  Prior to consummating any Transfer (excluding Transfers of the types 
described in clauses (i), (ii), (iii) or (iv) of the proviso to Section 2.1 
or Transfers of shares representing less than 1% of the outstanding Common 
Stock) pursuant to this Section 2.7 (a "Third Party Sale"), the Dabah 
Transferors or the Silver Transferors (each, a "Transferor," collectively, 
the "Transferors"), as the case may be, will deliver to the Company a written 
notice (a "Company ROFR Offer Notice"), specifying (i) the aggregate amount 
of cash consideration (the "Offer Price") for which the Transferor proposes 
to sell shares in such proposed Third Party Sale, (ii) the identity of the 
purchaser in such Third Party Sale and (iii) any other material terms of the 
proposed Third Party Sale.  If the Company delivers to the Transferor a 
written notice (a "Company ROFR Acceptance Notice") within 10 calendar days 
following the delivery of the Company ROFR Offer Notice (such 10 calendar day 
period being referred to herein as the "Company ROFR Acceptance Period") 
stating that the Company is willing to purchase all of the offered shares at 
the Offer Price, the Transferor will sell all (but not less than all) of the 
offered shares to the Company at the Offer Price, and the Company will 
purchase such offered shares from the Transferor, on the terms and subject to 
the conditions set forth below (the "Company ROFR Purchase").  

    (f)  If the Company does not accept the offer during the Company ROFR 
Acceptance Period pursuant to the Company ROFR Offer Notice, then such 
Transferor will deliver to the SK Holders a written notice (an "SK ROFR Offer 
Notice"), specifying (i) the Offer Price for which the Transferor proposed to 
sell its shares in such proposed Third Party Sale (ii) the identity of the 
purchaser in such Third Party Sale and (iii) any other material terms of the 
proposed Third Party Sale.  If the SK Holders deliver to the Transferor a 
written notice (an "SK ROFR Acceptance Notice") within 10 calendar days 
following the delivery of the SK ROFR Offer Notice (such 10 calendar day 
period being referred to herein as the "SK ROFR Acceptance Period") stating 
that the SK Holders are willing to purchase all of the offered shares at the 
Offer Price, the Transferor will sell all (but not less than all) of the 
offer shares to the SK Holders at the Offer Price, and the SK Holders will 
purchase such offered shares from the Transferor, on the terms and subject to 
the conditions set forth below (the "SK ROFR Purchase").

    (g)  The consummation of any Company ROFR Purchase or SK ROFR Purchase, 
as the case may be, pursuant to this Section 2.7 (the "ROFR Closing") will 
occur not later than 60 calendar days following the delivery of a Company 
ROFR Acceptance Notice or SK ROFR Acceptance Notice, as the case may be (the 
intervening period being referred to herein as the "ROFR Closing Period"), at

                                          9



such time and place as may be reasonably designated by the Company or the SK 
Holders, as the case may be.  At the ROFR Closing, (i) such Transferor will 
deliver to the Company or the SK Holders, as the case may be, duly endorsed 
certificates evidencing all of the shares of Common Stock to be purchased by 
the Company or the SK Holders, as the case may be, and (ii) the Company or 
the SK Holders, as the case may be, will deliver to such Transferor by wire 
transfer to an account designated by such Transferor an amount in immediately 
available funds equal to the Offer Price.

    (h)  If the Company or the SK Holders, as the case may be, do not accept 
the offer during the Company ROFR Acceptance Period or the SK ROFR Acceptance 
Period, as the case may be, pursuant to the Company ROFR Offer Notice or the 
SK ROFR Offer Notice, as the case may be, then such Transferor may Transfer 
to a Third Party the shares so offered at a price no less than 95% of, and on 
terms no less favorable to the transferee than the price and other terms set 
forth in the original Company ROFR Offer Notice or SK ROFR Offer Notice, as 
the case may be, at any time within 90 days after the expiration of the 
Company ROFR Acceptance Period or the SK ROFR Acceptance Period, as the case 
may be.

    (i)  In the event that the Company does not accept a Company ROFR Offer 
Notice during the Company ROFR Acceptance Period in any case where the 
Company ROFR Offer Notice was given as a result of an event described in 
paragraph (b) of this Section 2.7, each of the Dabah Transferors agrees that, 
if the stockholders of the Company thereafter are given the opportunity to 
vote on a proposed sale of the Company or substantially all of the Company's 
assets to a third party,  the Dabah Transferors shall vote all shares of the 
Company's common stock in favor of such proposed sale, if so requested by the 
SK Holders.

                               III.  CERTAIN ARRANGEMENTS

    3.1. Board of Directors.  (a) Prior to consummation of the Company's 
initial public offering, the Stockholders will (i) elect those individuals 
set forth on Exhibit 3.1A as Directors of the Company, (ii) approve the 
adoption of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation in the form 
of Exhibit 3.1B and (iii) cause the Board of Directors to adopt the By-laws 
in the form of Exhibit 3.1C.  Thereafter and until the Relinquishment Time, 
each Stockholder will vote all shares of Common Stock as to which such 
Stockholder has voting rights for the election as Directors of the Company of 
(x) John Megrue and David Oddi, or, if either of them shall cease to be 
affiliated with SK, a substitute for such person designated from time to time 
by the SK Holders and acceptable to the Management Group Representative (it 
being agreed that any partner, principal, officer or professional employee of 
Saunders Karp & Co., L.P.  will be deemed acceptable to the Management Group 
Representative so long as at least one partner or principal of Saunders Karp 
& Megrue, L.P.  is a Director of the Company) (the Directors serving pursuant 
to this clause (x) being called the "SK Directors"), and (y) three persons 
designated from time to time by the Management Group Representative.

     (b)  Each of the Stockholders further agrees to vote all the shares of 
Common Stock with respect to which it has voting rights, and to cause all 
persons designated by it as Directors to vote, (i) in favor of the removal 
from the Board of Directors, at the request of the SK Holders or the 


                                          10



Management Group Representative upon notice to the other Stockholders, of any 
person or persons designated by the SK Holders or the Management Group 
Representative, as the case may be, and to elect to the unexpired term of 
each Director so removed another person  designated by the SK Holders or the 
Management Group Representative, as the case may be, and (ii) in the event of 
any vacancy on the Board of Directors by reason of death, resignation or 
otherwise, to elect to such unexpired term another person designated in 
accordance with Section 3.1(a) by the Stockholder that designated the 
Director who previously served as such.

      (c)  The Company agrees that, until the Relinquishment Time, the 
Company shall take all necessary steps to cause one member of the 
Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors and, if permitted by the 
rules of the New York Stock Exchange, one member of the Audit Committee of 
the Board of Directors to be a director nominated by the SK Holders pursuant 
to clause (x) of Section 3.1.

     (d)  The Company and the Stockholders acknowledge their mutual intention 
that two additional directors not affiliated with the Company or with the SK 
Holders ("Outside Directors") shall be elected to the Board of Directors as 
promptly as practicable after the Effective Date, in accordance with the 
rules of the New York Stock Exchange.  The Outside Directors shall be 
selected by Ezra Dabah and shall be approved by the SK Holders (such approval 
not to be unreasonably withheld).

     3.2. Limitation on Certain Board Actions.  (a) Notwithstanding any other 
provision of the Charter, the By-Laws or applicable law, without the prior 
approval of at least one SK Director, the Company will not: 

         (i)  amend its Charter or By-laws; or 

         (ii) other than as contemplated by any Employment Agreements in effect 
     on the Effective Date or by the Company's 1996 Stock Option Plan or 1997 
     Stock Option Plan, make or enter into, or amend or modify in any 
     respect, any term or provision of any contract, commitment, arrangement 
     or transaction involving the transfer of money, property or anything 
     else of value or provision of services to or by any Stockholder or any 
     Affiliate thereof, other than transactions entered into in the ordinary 
     course of business on arm's-length terms with a transaction value of 
     less than $20,000; provided, however, that the Company may make or enter 
     into any contract or arrangement for the employment of any relative or 
     Affiliate on an arm's-length basis in accordance with the following: (i) 
     the Company shall provide the SK Directors prior written notice of its 
     intent to extend an employment offer to a relative or Affiliate 
     including the terms of the offer, (ii) the offer of employment shall be 
     for a position with the Company below the level of Vice President, (iii) 
     the position shall provide for total cash compensation (salary and 
     bonus) of $75,000 or less and offer perquisites and benefits identical 
     to those offered to similarly situated employees, and (iv) the Company 
     shall obtain one SK Director's prior written consent before offering any 
     promotion to such relative or Affiliate to a position of Vice President 
     or above or to a position that provides for total cash compensation

                                          11



     (salary and bonus) in excess of $75,000 or offers perquisites and
     benefits not offered to similarly situated employees.

     For purposes of this Section 3.2(a), an SK Director shall be deemed to 
have approved any matter listed above in this Section 3.2(a) if (i) such 
matter received the affirmative vote of a majority of the Directors at a 
meeting duly called and held and (ii) neither of the SK Directors attended 
(in person or by telephone) such meeting (the "First Meeting") and the notice 
of meeting specifically referred to such matter; provided, however, if an SK 
Director advised the Company in writing prior to such meeting that he desired 
to discuss the matter at a later meeting, such matter shall not be deemed 
approved unless neither of the SK Directors attended (in person or by 
telephone) a second meeting and the notice of such second meeting 
specifically referred to the same such matter referred to in the notice of 
the First Meeting.

     (b)  Notwithstanding any other provision of the Charter, the By-Laws or 
applicable law, without the prior approval of at least two-thirds of the 
members of the Board of Directors, the Company will not: 

          (i)  agree to acquire, purchase or lease, except operating leases, 
     any assets which are material, individually or in the aggregate, to the 
     business of the Company (other than purchases of inventory in the 
     ordinary course of business); 

          (ii) other than (x) as provided for in the Loan and Security 
     Agreement between the Company and Foothill Capital Corporation, as amended
     (the "Foothill Agreement"), or any future amendment thereto or (y) pursuant
     to any refinancing of the indebtedness under the Foothill Agreement 
     (whether or not Foothill Capital Corporation is a party to such 
     refinancing), incur any indebtedness for borrowed money in excess of 
     $2,000,000 or guarantee any such indebtedness or sell any debt 
     securities of the Company in a principal amount in excess of $2,000,000 
     or guarantee any debt securities of any Person (other than debt 
     securities of a wholly-owned subsidiary in a principal amount not 
     exceeding $2,000,000); 

          (iii) voluntarily mortgage, pledge or encumber all or substantially
     all of the Company's assets or business, other than as collateral for 
     indebtedness under the Foothill Agreement or any refinancing thereof;

          (iv) establish any committees of the Board of Directors (other than
     the Audit Committee, the Compensation Committee or the Stock Option 
     Committee) or delegate authority to any committees (other than the 
     authority delegated as of the Effective Date to the aforementioned 
     committees);

         (v)  change the number of Directors;

         (vi) authorize any delegation by the Board of Directors to any 
     committee of a power not possessed by the Board of Directors, or any
     authorization of any Committee to undertake any action which the 
     Board of Directors is not authorized to undertake;


                                          12




         (vii) make any investments (other than certificates of deposit issued
    by domestic banks and short-term liquid investments having maturities not
    longer than 90 days) at any one time outstanding in excess of $2,000,000,
    individually or in the aggregate;


         (viii) commence any case, proceeding or other action relating to 
    bankruptcy or reorganization of the Company; or

         (ix) distribute income or assets or declare any dividends.

     3.3. Board Observers.  Until the Relinquishment Time, the SK Holders 
will have the right, by written notice to the Company, to select two 
individuals to observe and be present at meetings of the Board of Directors 
(the "Board Observers") in the manner set forth in this Section 3.3.  The 
Board Observers will be obligated to execute reasonable confidentiality 
undertakings and will be entitled (a) to be given notice by the Secretary of 
the Company, at the same time as the SK Directors of the time and place at 
which such meeting is to be held; (b) to be present at all meetings of the 
Board of Directors except those in which the Board of Directors meets in 
executive session; (c) to receive copies of the minutes of the Board of 
Directors; and (d) receive copies of any reports, memoranda or other 
documents distributed to the Board of Directors at the same time such 
materials are given to the Directors.

    3.4. Financial Information.  The Company will transmit to the SK Holders 
copies of all monthly management and financial reports, annual operating 
budgets and any other financial or other information concerning the Company's 
operations at the same time such financial and other information is given to 
the Directors.  In addition, the Company will promptly provide the SK Holders 
all other information concerning the Company as may be reasonably requested 
by the SK Holders from time to time to the extent such information can be 
provided without interfering with the Company's business.  

    3.5. Confidentiality.  In the event that any SK Holder proposes to make 
any investments in any Direct Competitor of the Company, such SK Holder will 
provide prior written notice to the Company of such proposed investment and 
in connection therewith will enter into an appropriate confidentiality 
agreement with the Company containing terms mutually agreed upon by the 
Company and such SK Holder. 

                                  IV. MISCELLANEOUS

    4.1. Headings.  The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of 
reference only and will not control or affect the meaning or construction of 
any provisions hereof.  

    4.2. Entire Agreement; After-Acquired Securities.  (a) This Agreement 
constitutes the entire agreement between the parties with respect to the 
subject matter of this Agreement.  This Agreement supersedes all prior 
agreements and understandings, both oral and written, among the parties with 
respect to the subject matter of this Agreement. This Agreement is not 


                                          13



intended to confer upon any Person other than the parties hereto and thereto 
any rights or remedies hereunder or thereunder.

     (b)  Subject to Section 4.6, all capital stock or other equity 
securities of the Company issued to or acquired by any Stockholder following 
the date of this Agreement ("After-Acquired Securities") will be subject to 
the terms and provisions of this Agreement as if such After-Acquired 
Securities were outstanding on the date hereof.

     4.3. Notices.  Any notice, request, instruction or other document 
required or permitted to be given hereunder by any party hereto to another 
party hereto will be in writing and will be given to such party by certified 
mail at its address set forth in Exhibit 4.3 attached hereto, with, in the 
case of the Company, a copy sent to the Company's Secretary, at the Company's 
principal executive offices or, in the case of a Transfer permitted 
hereunder, to the address of the permitted Transferee specified by it upon 
notice given in accordance with the terms hereof, or to such other address as 
the party to whom notice is to be given may provide in a written notice to 
the party giving such notice, a copy of which written notice will be on file 
with the Secretary of the Company.  Each such notice, request or other 
communication will be effective (a) if given by certified mail, 96 hours 
after such communication is deposited in the mails with certified postage 
prepaid addressed as aforesaid, (b) one Business Day after being furnished to 
a nationally recognized overnight courier for next Business Day delivery, and 
(c) on the date sent if sent by electronic facsimile transmission, receipt 
confirmed.

     4.4. Governing Law.  This Agreement will be governed by, and construed 
in accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without regard to the 
conflict of laws rules of such state, provided, however, that to the extent 
any of the respective rights or obligations of the parties relate to matters 
of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware (the "GCL"), the 
provisions of the GCL shall govern in respect thereof.

     4.5. Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provisions 
of this Agreement in any jurisdiction will not affect the validity, legality 
or enforceability of the remainder of this Agreement in such jurisdiction or 
the validity, legality or enforceability of this Agreement, including any 
such provision, in any other jurisdiction, it being intended that all rights 
and obligations of the parties hereunder will be enforceable to the fullest 
extent permitted by law.

     4.6. Termination; Termination of Rights.  This Agreement may be 
terminated at any time by an instrument in writing signed by (i) the SK 
Holders owning a majority of the Common Stock then held by the SK Holders and 
entitled to the benefits of this Agreement, (ii) the Stockholders, other than 
the SK Holders, owning a majority of the Common Stock then held by such 
Stockholders and entitled to the benefits of this Agreement and (iii) the 
Company.  At such time as any Stockholder owns 25% or less of the Common 
Stock owned by such Stockholder on the Effective Date, all of such 
Stockholder's rights hereunder, including without limitation such 
Stockholder's rights under Article II, will terminate; provided, however, 
that all of such Stockholder's obligations hereunder will remain in full 
force and effect.  This Agreement will terminate automatically when no

                                          14



Stockholder owns more than 25% of the Common Stock owned by such Stockholder 
on the Effective Date. 

     4.7. Successors, Assigns and Transferees.  The provisions of this 
Agreement will be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto 
and their respective heirs, successors, assigns and permitted Transferees.  
Except as expressly contemplated hereby, neither this Agreement nor any 
provision hereof will be construed so as to confer any right or benefit upon 
any Person other than the parties to this Agreement and their respective 
successors and assigns.

     4.8. Amendments; Waivers.  (a) No failure or delay on the part of any 
party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder will operate as a 
waiver thereof, nor will any single or partial exercise thereof preclude any 
other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power 
or privilege.  The rights and remedies herein provided will be cumulative and 
not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

     (b)  Neither this Agreement nor any term or provision hereof may be 
amended or waived except by an instrument in writing signed, by (i) the SK 
Holders owning a majority of the Common Stock then held by the SK Holders and 
entitled to the benefits of this Agreement, (ii) the Stockholders, other than 
the SK Holders, owning a majority of the Common Stock then held by such 
Stockholders and entitled to the benefits of this Agreement and (iii) the 
Company.

     4.9. Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed in any number of 
counterparts, each of which will be an original with the same effect as if 
the signatures thereto and hereto were upon the same instrument.  

     4.10. Remedies.  The parties hereby acknowledge that money damages would 
not be adequate compensation for the damages that a party would suffer by 
reason of a failure of any other party to perform any of the obligations 
under this Agreement.  Therefore, each party hereto agrees that specific 
performance is the only appropriate remedy under this Agreement and hereby 
waives the claim or defense that any other party has an adequate remedy at 
law.

     4.11. Consent to Jurisdiction.  Each of the Stockholders and the Company 
irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of either (i) any court 
located in the Borough of Manhattan or the United States Federal Court 
sitting in the Southern District of New York or (ii) any court located in the 
State of Delaware or the United States District Court for the District of 
Delaware (and any appellate court therefrom), over any suit, action or 
proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement.  Each of the 
Stockholders and the Company consents to process being served in any such 
suit, action or proceeding by serving a copy thereof upon the agent for 
service of process provided that to the extent lawful and possible, written 
notice of such service will also be mailed to such Stockholders or the any 
lawful manner a judgment obtained in one jurisdiction in any other 
jurisdiction.  Each of the Stockholders and the Company waives any right it 
may have to assert the doctrine of forum non conveniens or to object to venue 
to the extent any proceeding is brought in accordance with this Section 4.11. 
 EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO 
TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS 
AGREEMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

                                          15




    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of 
the date first above written.
                                           
                                 ---------------------------------------------
                                  Ezra Dabah
                                  
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Renee Dabah
         
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Ivette Dabah
         
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Stanley Silverstein
         
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Stanley Silver
         
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Barbara Dabah
         
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Joseph Krusch
         
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Elliott F. Krusch

                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Helissa T. Meizlish
                                  
                                  --------------------------------------------
                                  Sherry Schirippa

                                  Gila Dweck Grantor Trust
                                  By:   --------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee


                                         -16-

         
                                  Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 8/25/88 f/b/o Morris Dabah Jr.
 
                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 8/25/88 f/b/o Michael Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 8/25/88 f/b/o Mac Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as Custodians
                                  under the UGMA f/b/o Joia Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Custodian

                                  Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as Custodians
                                  under the UGMA f/b/o Yaacov Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Custodian

                                  Edward Tawil as Trustee
                                  u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Morris Dabah Jr.

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee


                                          -17-



    
                                  Edward Tawil as Trustee
                                  u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Michael Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Edward Tawil as Trustee
                                  u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Mac Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Edward Tawil as Trustee
                                  u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Stephen Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 8/31/92 f/b/o Stephen Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Nina Miner

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Renee Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee
                                          -18-

    
                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Flori Silverstein

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Michael Leventhal

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Leslie Kule

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Samuel Miner

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Eva Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Joia Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                          -19-


  
                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Moshe Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Chana Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Yaacov Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Sarah Silverstein

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Benjamin Reines

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Jacqueline Reines

                                  By:------------------------------------------ 
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                          -20-


                                  Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Eva Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Joia Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Moshe Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Chana Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                                  u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Yaacov Dabah

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  Name:     
                                  Title:    Trustee

                                  THE SK EQUITY FUND, L.P.
                                  By: SKM PARTNERS, L.P., General Partner

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  its General Partner

                                          -21-



                                  SK INVESTMENT FUND, L.P.
                                  By: SKM PARTNERS, L.P., General Partner

                                  By:------------------------------------------
                                  its General Partner

                                  ---------------------------------------------
                                  Barry Feinberg

                                          -22-



                                      Schedule 1
                               Management Stockholders
 
1.  Ezra Dabah 
2.  Renee Dabah 
3.  Barbara Dabah 
4.  Ivette Dabah
5.  Stanley Silver
6.  Stanley Silverstein
7.  Joseph G. Krusch
8.  Elliot F. Krusch
9.  Helissa T. Meizlish
10. Sherry Schirippa
11. Gila Dweck Grantor Trust
12. Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as custodians under the UGMA, F/B/O Joia Dabah.
13. Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as custodians under the UGMA, F/B/O Yaacov Dabah.
14. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees, U/A/D 8/25/88, F/B/O Mac Dabah.  
15. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees, U/A/D 8/25/88, F/B/O Michael Dabah.
16. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees, U/A/D 8/25/88, F/B/O Morris Dabah, Jr.
17. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees U/A/D 8/31/92, F/B/O Stephen Dabah.
18. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Michael Dabah.
19. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Morris Dabah, Jr.
20. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Mac Dabah.
21. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Stephen Dabah.
22. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Nina Miner.
23. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Renee Dabah.

-23- 24. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Flori Silverstein. 25. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Michael Leventhal. 26. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Leslie Kule. 27. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Samuel Miner. 28. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Eva Dabah. 29. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Joia Dabah. 30. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Moshe Dabah. 31. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Chana Dabah. 32. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Yaacov Dabah. 33. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Sarah Silverstein. 34. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Benjamin Reines. 35. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Jacqueline Reines. 36. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Eva Dabah. 37. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Joia Dabah. 38. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Moshe Dabah. 39. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Chana Dabah. 40. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Yaacov Dabah.
-24- Exhibit 3.1A Initial Directors of the Company Ezra Dabah Stanley Silver Stanley Silverstein John F. Megrue David Oddi -25- Exhibit 3.1B Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation [to be attached] -26- Exhibit 3.1C Amended and Restated ByLaws [to be attached] -27- Exhibit 4.3 Addresses for Notice [to be inserted] -28-


                                                                    Exhibit 10.1

                           1996 STOCK OPTION PLAN
                                      OF
                    THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.

    1.  PURPOSE.  The purpose of this Stock Option Plan is to advance the
interests of the Corporation by encouraging and enabling the acquisition of a
larger personal proprietary interest in the Corporation by key employees of the
Corporation and its Subsidiaries upon whose judgment and keen interest the
Corporation is largely dependent for the successful conduct of its operations
and by providing such key employees with incentives to put forth maximum efforts
for the success of the Corporation's business.  It is anticipated that the
acquisition of such proprietary interest in the Corporation and such incentives
will stimulate the efforts of such key employees on behalf of the Corporation
and its Subsidiaries and strengthen their desire to remain with the Corporation
and its Subsidiaries.  It is also expected that such incentives and the
opportunity to acquire such a proprietary interest will enable the Corporation
and its Subsidiaries to attract desirable personnel.

    2.  DEFINITIONS.  When used in this Plan, unless the context otherwise 
requires:

         (a)  "Board of Directors" or "Board" shall mean the Board of Directors
    of the Corporation, as constituted at any time.

         (b)  "Cause" shall mean, with respect to the holder of an Option, (i)
    a breach by the holder of any of the material provisions of any employment
    agreement between the holder and the Corporation or a Subsidiary that the
    holder fails to remedy or cease within ten days after notice thereof to the
    holder; (ii) any conduct, action or behavior by the holder that has or may
    reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the reputation
    of the Corporation or its Subsidiaries or on the holder's reputation or
    that is not befitting of an executive officer of the Corporation or a
    Subsidiary; (iii) the commission by the holder of an act involving moral
    turpitude or dishonesty, whether or not in connection with the holder's
    employment by the Corporation or a Subsidiary; (iv) the holder shall have
    committed any act of fraud or embezzlement against the Corporation or a
    Subsidiary or engaged in any other willful misconduct in connection with
    his duties; or (v) the holder shall have been convicted of a felony (other
    than a felony relating to motor vehicle laws).  Notwithstanding the
    foregoing, no Cause shall be deemed to exist with respect to the holder's
    acts described in (ii) above unless the Corporation shall have given prior
    written notice to the holder specifying the Cause with reasonable
    particularity and, within 30 days after such notice, the holder shall not
    have cured or eliminated the problem or thing giving rise to such Cause.

         (c)  "Chairman of the Board" shall mean the person who at the time
    shall be Chairman of the Board of Directors.

         (d)  "Committee" shall mean the Committee hereinafter described in
    Section 3.

         (e)  "Corporation" shall mean The Children's Place Retail Stores,
    Inc., a Delaware corporation.

         (f)  "Disability" shall mean, with respect to the holder of an Option,
    the holder's 




    inability, as a result of physical or mental incapacity or infirmity, to
    perform the duties of his employment for (i) a continuous period of at
    least 120 days, or (ii) periods aggregating at least 180 days during any
    period of 12 consecutive months. 

         (g)  "Eligible Persons" shall mean those persons described in Section
    4 who are potential recipients of Options.

         (h)  "Fair Market Value" on a specified date shall mean the average of
    the high and low sales prices at which a Share is traded on the stock
    exchange, if any, on which Shares are primarily traded or, if the Shares
    are not then traded on a stock exchange, the average of the high and low
    sales prices of a Share as reported on the NASDAQ Market or, if the Shares
    are not then traded on the NASDAQ Market, the average of (i) the average of
    the high and low bid prices and (ii) the average of the high and low asked
    prices, at which a Share is traded on the over-the-counter market, but if
    no Shares were traded on such date, then on the last previous date on which
    a Share was so traded, or, if none of the above are applicable, the value
    of a Share as established by the Committee for such date using any
    reasonable method of valuation; provided, however, that in no event shall
    the Committee set the value of a Share at less than $321.25, subject to a
    proportionate adjustment in the event of a split-up, conversion, exchange,
    reclassification or substitution of Shares or a recapitalization or other
    change in the corporate structure or outstanding shares.  

         (i)  "Code" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

         (j)  "Options" shall mean the Stock Options granted pursuant to this
    Plan.

         (k)  "Plan" shall mean this 1996 Stock Option Plan of The Children's
    Place Retail Stores, Inc., as adopted by the Board of Directors and
    approved by stockholders as of
    June 27, 1996, as such Plan from time to time may be amended.

         (l)  "President" shall mean the person who at the time shall be the
    President of the Corporation.

         (m)  "Share" shall mean a share of Series A Common Stock, par value
    $.10 per share, of the Corporation.

         (n)  "Subsidiary" shall mean any corporation 50% or more of whose
    stock having general voting power is owned by the Corporation, or by
    another Subsidiary as herein defined, of the Corporation. 

    3.  COMMITTEE.  The Plan shall be administered by a Committee consisting of
Ezra Dabah and Stanley B. Silver; provided, however, that from and after the
effective date of an initial public offering of Shares by the Corporation, the
Committee shall consist of two or more directors of the Corporation appointed by
the Board of Directors, each of which Committee members shall be a "Non-Employee
Director" within the meaning of Rule 16b-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of
1934, as amended from time to time (the "Exchange Act").  

    4.  PARTICIPANTS.  All key executive officers of the Corporation or a
Subsidiary, as determined by the Committee, shall be eligible to receive Options
under the Plan.  The parties to whom Options are granted under this Plan, and
the number of Shares subject to each such Option, shall be determined by the
Committee in its sole discretion, subject, however, to the 




terms and conditions of this Plan.  Executive officers to whom Options may be
granted include key executive officers who are also directors of the Corporation
or a Subsidiary.  

    5.  SHARES.  Subject to the provisions of Section 14 hereof, the Committee
may grant Options with respect to an aggregate of up to 14,527 Shares, all of
which Shares may be either Shares held in treasury or authorized but unissued
Shares.  If the Shares that would be issued or transferred pursuant to any
Option are not issued or transferred and cease to be issuable or transferable
for any reason, the number of Shares subject to such Option will no longer be
charged against the limitation provided for herein and may again be made subject
to Options; provided, that the counting of Shares subject to Options granted
under the Plan against the number of Shares available for further Options shall
in all cases conform to the requirements of Rule 16b-3 under the Exchange Act.  

    6.   GRANT OF OPTIONS.  The number of any Options to be granted to any
Eligible Person shall be determined by the Committee in its sole discretion.  At
the time an Option is granted, the Committee may, in its sole discretion,
designate whether such Option (a) is to be considered as an incentive stock
option within the meaning of Section 422 of the Code, or (b) is not to be
treated as an incentive stock option for purposes of this Plan and the Code.  

    Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, to the
extent that the aggregate Fair Market Value (determined as of the date an Option
is granted) of the Shares with respect to which Options which are designated as
(or deemed to be) incentive stock options granted to an employee (and any
incentive stock options granted to such employee under any other incentive stock
option plan maintained by the Corporation or any Subsidiary that meets the
requirements of Section 422 of the Code) first become exercisable in any
calendar year exceeds $100,000, such Options shall be treated as Options which
are not incentive stock options.  Options with respect to which no designation
is made by the Committee shall be deemed to be incentive stock options to the
extent that the $100,000 limitation described in the preceding sentence is met. 
This paragraph shall be applied by taking Options into account in the order in
which they are granted.

    Nothing herein contained shall be construed to prohibit the issuance of
Options at different times to the same person.

    A certificate of Option signed by the Chairman of the Board or the
President or a Vice President of the Corporation, attested by the Treasurer or
an Assistant Treasurer, or Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the
Corporation and bearing the seal of the Corporation affixed thereto, shall be
issued to each person to whom an Option is granted.  The certificate of Option
for an Option shall be legended to indicate whether or not the Option is an
incentive stock option.

The certificate for an Option which is an incentive stock option and for an
Option which is not an incentive stock option shall be in the form attached
hereto as Annex 1 and Annex 2, respectively, or in such other form as may be
determined by the Committee from time to time.

    7.  PURCHASE PRICE.  The purchase price per Share for the Shares purchased
pursuant to the exercise of an Option shall be fixed by the Committee at the
time of grant of the Option; provided, however, that the purchase price per
Share for the Shares to be purchased pursuant to the exercise of an incentive
stock option shall not in any event be less than 100% of the Fair Market Value
of a Share on the date of grant of the Option, except as provided in Section 9.
 
    8.  DURATION OF OPTIONS.  The duration of each Option shall be ten years
from the date upon which the Option is granted, except as provided in Sections 9
and 13. 



    9.  TEN PERCENT STOCKHOLDERS.  Notwithstanding any other provision of this
Plan to the contrary, no Option which is intended to qualify as an incentive
stock option may be granted under this Plan to any employee who, at the time the
Option is granted, owns Shares possessing more than 10 percent of the total
combined voting power or value of all classes of stock of the Corporation,
unless the exercise price under such Option is at least 110% of the Fair Market
Value of a Share on the date such Option is granted and the duration of such
Option is no more than five years.


    10.  EXERCISE OF OPTIONS.  Unless the Committee determines otherwise at the
time of grant, and except as otherwise provided herein, 20% of the Shares
subject to an Option may be purchased on or after the date which is six months
after the Option's date of grant; and an additional 20% of the Shares subject to
an Option may be purchased on or after each of the first, second, third and
fourth anniversaries, respectively, of the date of grant. 

    Notwithstanding the foregoing, all or any part of any remaining unexercised
Options granted to any person may be exercised, subject to the timing provisions
of Section 13 hereof, in the following circumstances:  (a) upon the holder's
retirement from the Corporation and all Subsidiaries on or after his 65th
birthday, (b) upon the Disability or death of the holder, (c) upon a Change in
Control (as hereinafter defined) while the holder is in the employ of the
Corporation or (d) upon the occurrence of such special circumstance or event as
in the opinion of the Committee merits special consideration.

    For purposes of the Plan, a "Change in Control" shall mean any of the
following events:  (i) the sale to any purchaser of (A) all or substantially all
of the assets of the Corporation or (B) capital stock representing more than 50%
of the stock of the Corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of
directors of the Corporation; (ii) the merger or consolidation of the
Corporation with another corporation if, immediately after such merger or
consolidation, less than a majority of the combined voting power of the then
outstanding securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors
of the surviving or resulting corporation in such merger or consolidation is
held, directly or indirectly, in the aggregate by the holders immediately prior
to such transaction of the outstanding securities of the Corporation; (iii) the
filing of a report on Schedule 13D or Schedule 14D-1 (or any successor schedule,
form, or report or item therein), each promulgated pursuant to the Exchange Act,
disclosing that any person (as the term "person" is used in Section 13(d)(3) or
Section 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act) has become the beneficial owner (as the
term "beneficial owner" is defined under Rule 13d-3 or any successor rule or
regulation promulgated under the Exchange Act) of securities representing 50% or
more of the combined voting power of the voting stock of the Corporation; or
(iv) the filing by the Corporation of a report or proxy statement with the
Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Exchange Act disclosing in
response to Form 8-K or Schedule 14A (or any successor schedule, form, or report
or item therein) that a change in control of the Corporation has occurred or
will occur in the future pursuant to any then existing contract or transaction. 
Notwithstanding the foregoing, a Change in Control shall not be deemed to occur
for purposes of the Plan as a result of an event described above if a majority
of the individuals who are members of the Board prior to such event specifically
determines that a Change in Control should not be deemed to have occurred. 
 
    An Option shall be exercised by the delivery of a written notice duly
signed by the holder thereof to such effect, together with the Option
certificate and the full purchase price of the Shares purchased pursuant to the
exercise of the Option, to the Chairman of the Board or an officer of the
Corporation appointed by the Chairman of the Board for the purpose of receiving
the same.  Payment of the full purchase price shall be made as follows: in cash;
by check 



payable to the order of the Corporation; by delivery to the Corporation of
Shares which shall be valued at their Fair Market Value on the date of exercise
of the Option (provided, that a holder may not use any Shares which the holder
has beneficially owned for less than six months); or by such other methods as
the Committee may permit from time to time.  

    Within a reasonable time after the exercise of an Option, the Corporation
shall cause to be delivered to the person entitled thereto, a certificate for
the Shares purchased pursuant to the exercise of the Option.  If the Option
shall have been exercised with respect to less than all of the Shares subject to
the Option, the Corporation shall also cause to be delivered to the person
entitled thereto a new Option certificate in replacement of the certificate
surrendered at the time of the exercise of the Option, indicating the number of
Shares with respect to which the Option remains available for exercise, or the
original Option certificate shall be endorsed to give effect to the partial
exercise thereof.

    Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or of any Option, no Option
granted pursuant to the Plan may be exercised at any time when the Option or the
granting or exercise thereof violates any law or governmental order or
regulation.

    11.  CONSIDERATION FOR OPTIONS.  The Corporation shall obtain such
consideration for the grant of an Option as the Committee in its discretion may
determine.

    12.  NON-TRANSFERABILITY OF OPTIONS.  Options and all other rights
thereunder shall be non-transferable and non-assignable by the holder thereof
except to the extent that the estate of a deceased holder of an Option may be
permitted to exercise them.  Options may be exercised or surrendered during the
holder's lifetime only by the holder thereof.

    13.  TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT.  All or any part of any Option, to the
extent unexercised, shall terminate immediately  upon the termination for any
reason of the holder's employment with the Corporation or any Subsidiary, except
that the holder shall have three months after such termination of employment to
exercise any unexercised Option that he could have exercised on the day on which
such employment terminated (including Options which accelerate in exercisability
pursuant to Section 10 hereof); provided, however, that such exercise must be
accomplished prior to the expiration of the term of such Option. 
Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the termination of employment is due to
Disability or to death, the holder or the representative of the estate of a
deceased holder shall have the privilege of exercising the Options which are
unexercised at the time of such Disability or death; provided, however, that
such exercise must be accomplished prior to the expiration of the term of such
Option and within one year after the holder's Disability or death, as the case
may be.  If the employment of any holder of an Option with the Corporation or a
Subsidiary shall be terminated for Cause, all unexercised Options of such holder
shall terminate immediately upon such termination of the holder's employment
with the Corporation and all Subsidiaries, and a holder of Options whose
employment with the Corporation and Subsidiaries is so terminated, shall have no
right after such termination to exercise any unexercised Option he might have
exercised prior to the termination of his employment with the Corporation and
Subsidiaries.

    14.  ADJUSTMENT PROVISION.  If prior to the complete exercise of any Option
there shall be declared and paid a stock dividend upon the Shares or if the
Shares shall be split up, converted, exchanged, reclassified, or in any way
substituted for, then the Option, to the extent that it has not been exercised,
shall entitle the holder thereof upon the future exercise of the Option to such
number and kind of securities or cash or other property subject to the terms of
the Option to which he would have been entitled had he actually owned the Shares
subject to the unexercised portion of the Option at the time of the occurrence
of such stock dividend, split-up, 




conversion, exchange, reclassification or substitution, and the aggregate
purchase price upon the future exercise of the Option shall be the same as if
the originally optioned Shares were being purchased thereunder.

    Any fractional shares or securities issuable upon the exercise of the
Option as a result of such adjustment shall be payable in cash based upon the
Fair Market Value of such shares or securities at the time of such exercise.  If
any such event should occur, the number of Shares with respect to which Options
remain to be issued, or with respect to which Options may be reissued, shall be
adjusted in a similar manner.

    Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, in the event of a
recapitalization, merger, consolidation, rights offering, separation,
reorganization or liquidation, or any other change in the corporate structure or
outstanding shares, the Committee shall make such adjustments to the number of
Shares and the class of shares available hereunder or to any outstanding Options
as shall be necessary to prevent dilution or enlargement of rights.

    15.  ISSUANCE OF SHARES AND COMPLIANCE WITH SECURITIES ACT.  Any holder of
an Option shall make such representations and furnish such information as may,
in the opinion of counsel for the Corporation, be appropriate to permit the
Corporation, in the light of the then existence or non-existence with respect to
such Shares of an effective Registration Statement under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended from time to time (the "Securities Act"), to issue the Shares
in compliance with the provisions of the Securities Act or any comparable act. 
The Corporation shall have the right, in its sole discretion, to legend any
Shares which may be issued pursuant to the exercise of any Option, or may issue
stop transfer orders in respect thereof.

    16.  INCOME TAX WITHHOLDING.  If the Corporation or a Subsidiary shall be
required to withhold any amounts by reason of any Federal, State or local tax
rules or regulations in respect of the issuance of Shares pursuant to the
exercise of any Option, the Corporation or the Subsidiary shall be entitled to
deduct and withhold such amounts from any cash payments to be made to the holder
of such Option.  In any event, the holder shall make available to the
Corporation or Subsidiary, promptly when requested by the Corporation or such
Subsidiary, sufficient funds to meet the requirements of such withholding; and
the Corporation or Subsidiary shall be entitled to take and authorize such steps
as it may deem advisable in order to have such funds made available to the
Corporation or Subsidiary out of any funds or property due or to become due to
the holder of such Option.

    17.  ADMINISTRATION AND AMENDMENT OF THE PLAN.  Except as hereinafter
provided, the Board of Directors or the Committee may at any time withdraw or
from time to time amend the Plan as it relates to, and the terms and conditions
of, any Option not theretofore granted, and the Board of Directors or the
Committee, with the consent of the affected holder of an Option, may at any time
withdraw or from time to time amend the Plan as it relates to, and the terms and
conditions of, any outstanding Option.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, any
amendment by the Board of Directors or the Committee which would increase the
number of Shares issuable under the Plan or change the class of Eligible Persons
shall be subject to the approval of the stockholders of the Corporation within
one year of such amendment.

    Determinations of the Committee as to any question which may arise with
respect to the interpretation of the provisions of the Plan and Options shall be
final.  The Committee may authorize and establish such rules, regulations and
revisions thereof not inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan, as it may
deem advisable to make the Plan and Options effective or provide for their
administration, and may take such other action with regard to the Plan and 




Options as it shall deem desirable to effectuate their purpose.

    The Plan is intended to comply with Rule l6b-3 under the Exchange Act.  Any
provision inconsistent with such Rule shall be inoperative and shall not affect
the validity of the Plan.

    18.  NO RIGHT OF EMPLOYMENT.  Nothing contained herein or in an Option
shall be construed to confer on any employee any right to be continued in the
employ of the Corporation or any Subsidiary or derogate from any right of the
Corporation and any Subsidiary to retire, request the resignation of or
discharge or otherwise cease its service arrangement with any employee, at any
time, with or without cause.

    19.  FINAL ISSUANCE DATE.  No Option shall be granted under the Plan after
June 26, 2006.

    20.  CONFLICT.  If there is any conflict between the terms of any Option
Certificate and the terms of the Plan, the terms of the Plan shall control.







                                                                        ANNEX 1
                                                                        -------

                                 OPTION CERTIFICATE
                                          
                               INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION
                                  (Non-Assignable)


                                                      ___________ Shares



                            To Purchase Common Stock of
                                          
                      THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
                                          
                         Issued Pursuant to the l996 Stock
              Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.



         THIS CERTIFIES that on ________________, l9__, 
_________________________________ (the "Holder") was granted an option
("Option") to purchase at the Option price of $________ per share all or any
part of ____________________ fully paid and non-assessable shares ("Shares") of
the Common Stock of THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. ("Corporation"), a
Delaware corporation, upon and subject to the following terms and conditions.

         This Option shall expire on _________________, ____.

         This Option may be exercised or surrendered during the Holder's
lifetime only by the Holder.  This Option shall not be transferable by the
Holder otherwise than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.

         Except as otherwise provided pursuant to the 1996 Stock Option Plan of
The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Plan"), 20% of the Shares subject
to this Option may be purchased on or after the date which is six months after
this Option's date of grant and an 




additional 20% of the Shares subject to this Option may be purchased on or after
each of the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries, respectively, of this
Option's date of grant.  In no event, however, may this Option be exercised
after the Option's expiration date.

         The Option and this Option certificate are issued pursuant to and are
subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Plan, the terms and conditions
of which are hereby incorporated as though set forth at length, and a copy of
which is attached hereto.  


         WITNESS the seal of the Corporation and the signatures of its duly
authorized officers.


Dated: _______________________, l9__.


(SEAL)                            THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
                                       STORES, INC.


                                  By: _________________________
ATTEST:


By:_____________________________










                                         -2-


                                                                         ANNEX 2
                                                                         -------

                                 OPTION CERTIFICATE
                                          
                             NON-QUALIFIED STOCK OPTION
                                  (Non-Assignable)


                                                      ___________ Shares



                            To Purchase Common Stock of
                                          
                      THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
                                          
                         Issued Pursuant to the l996 Stock
              Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.



         THIS CERTIFIES that on ________________, l9__, 
_________________________________ (the "Holder") was granted an option
("Option"), which is not an incentive stock option, to purchase at the Option
price of $_________ per share all or any part of ____________________ fully paid
and non-assessable shares ("Shares") of the Common Stock of THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
RETAIL STORES, INC. ("Corporation"), a Delaware corporation, upon and subject to
the following terms and conditions.

         This Option shall expire on _________________, ____.

         This Option may be exercised or surrendered during the Holder's
lifetime only by the Holder.  This Option shall not be transferable by the
Holder otherwise than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.






         Except as otherwise provided pursuant to the 1996 Stock Option Plan of
The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Plan"), 20% of the Shares subject
to this Option may be purchased on or after the date which is six months after
this Option's date of grant and an additional 20% of the Shares subject to this
Option may be purchased on or after each of the first, second, third and fourth
anniversaries, respectively, of this Option's date of grant.  In no event,
however, may this Option be exercised after the Option's expiration date.

         The Option and this Option certificate are issued pursuant to and are
subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Plan, the terms and conditions
of which are hereby incorporated as though set forth at length, and a copy of
which is attached hereto.  

         WITNESS the seal of the Corporation and the signatures of its duly
authorized officers.


Dated: _______________________, l9__.


(SEAL)                                      THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
                                                 STORES, INC.



                                            By: _________________________

ATTEST:


By:_____________________________











                                         -2-


                                                                   Exhibit 10.2


                              1997 STOCK OPTION PLAN
                                         OF
                       THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.

     1.  Purpose.  The purpose of this Stock Option Plan is to advance the
interests of the Corporation by encouraging and enabling the acquisition of a
larger personal proprietary interest in the Corporation by employees and
directors of the Corporation and its Subsidiaries by providing such employees
and directors with incentives to put forth maximum efforts for the success of
the Corporation's business.  It is anticipated that the acquisition of such
proprietary interest in the Corporation and such incentives will stimulate the
efforts of such employees and directors on behalf of the Corporation and its
Subsidiaries and strengthen their desire to remain with the Corporation and its
Subsidiaries.  It is also expected that such incentives and the opportunity to
acquire such a proprietary interest will enable the Corporation and its
Subsidiaries to attract desirable personnel and directors.

     2.  Definitions.  When used in this Plan, unless the context otherwise
requires:

         (a)  "Board of Directors" or "Board" shall mean the Board of Directors 
of the Corporation, as constituted at any time.

         (b)  "Cause" shall mean, with respect to the holder of an Option, 
(i) a breach by the holder of any of the material provisions of any employment
agreement between the holder and the Corporation or a Subsidiary that the holder
fails to remedy or cease within ten days after notice thereof to the holder;
(ii) any conduct, action or behavior by the holder that has or may reasonably be
expected to have a material adverse effect on the reputation of the Corporation
or its Subsidiaries or on the holder's reputation or that is not befitting of an
executive officer, employee or director of the Corporation or a Subsidiary;
(iii) the commission by the holder of an act involving moral turpitude or
dishonesty, whether or not in connection with the holder's employment by, or
service as a director of, the Corporation or a Subsidiary; (iv) the holder shall
have committed any act of fraud or embezzlement against the Corporation or a
Subsidiary or engaged in any other willful misconduct in connection with his
duties; or (v) the holder shall have been convicted of a felony (other than a
felony relating to motor vehicle laws).  Notwithstanding the foregoing, no Cause
shall be deemed to exist with respect to the holder's acts described in (ii)
above unless the Corporation shall have given prior written notice to the holder
specifying the Cause with reasonable particularity and, within 30 days after
such notice, the holder shall not have cured or eliminated the problem or thing
giving rise to such Cause.

         (c)  "Chairman of the Board" shall mean the person who at the time 
shall be Chairman of the Board of Directors.

         (d) "Code" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

         (e)  "Committee" shall mean the Committee hereinafter described in 
Section 3.
     
         (f)  "Corporation" shall mean The Children's Place Retail Stores, 
Inc., a Delaware corporation.

         (g)  "Disability" shall mean, with respect to the holder of an 
Option, the holder's 



inability, as a result of physical or mental incapacity or infirmity, to 
perform the duties of his employment for (i) a continuous period of at least 
120 days, or (ii) periods aggregating at least 180 days during any period of 
12 consecutive months. 

         (h)  "Eligible Director" shall mean a director of the Corporation 
who is not also an employee of the Corporation or a Subsidiary and is not an 
employee, partner or principal of Saunders Karp & Megrue, L.P. or any of its 
affiliates.

         (i)  "Eligible Persons" shall mean those persons described in 
Section 4 who are potential recipients of Options.

         (j)  "Fair Market Value" on a specified date shall mean the average 
of the high and low sales prices at which a Share is traded on the stock 
exchange, if any, on which Shares are primarily traded or, if the Shares are not
then traded on a stock exchange, the average of the high and low sales prices of
a Share as reported on the NASDAQ Market or, if the Shares are not then traded
on the NASDAQ Market, the average of (i) the average of the high and low bid
prices and (ii) the average of the high and low asked prices, at which a Share
is traded on the over-the-counter market, but if no Shares were traded on such
date, then on the last previous date on which a Share was so traded, or, if none
of the above are applicable, the value of a Share as established by the
Committee for such date using any reasonable method of valuation. 

         (k)  "Initial Pubic Offering Price" shall mean the price per Share at 
which Shares are offered to the public in the Corporation's initial public 
offering, as set forth on the cover page of the prospectus relating
thereto.

         (l)  "Options" shall mean the Stock Options granted pursuant to this 
Plan.

         (m)  "Plan" shall mean this 1997 Stock Option Plan of The Children's 
Place Retail Stores, Inc., as adopted by the Board of Directors and approved 
by stockholders as of ___________, 1997, as such Plan from time to time
may be amended.

         (n)  "President" shall mean the person who at the time shall be the 
President of the Corporation.

         (o)  "Share" shall mean a share of Series A Common Stock, par value 
$.10 per share, of the Corporation.

         (p)  "Subsidiary" shall mean any corporation 50% or more of whose 
stock having general voting power is owned by the Corporation, or by another
Subsidiary as herein defined, of the Corporation. 

     3.  Committee.  The Plan shall be administered by a Committee consisting of
Ezra Dabah and Stanley B. Silver; provided, however, that from and after the
effective date of the initial public offering of Shares by the Corporation, the
Committee shall consist of two or more directors of the Corporation appointed by
the Board of Directors.

     4.  Participants.  All employees and directors of the Corporation or a
Subsidiary, as determined by the Committee, shall be eligible to receive Options
under the Plan.  The parties to whom Options are granted under this Plan, and
the number of Shares subject to each such Option, shall be determined by the
Committee in its sole discretion, subject, however, to the terms and conditions
of this Plan.  Each Eligible Director also shall be granted Options in
accordance with Section 7.

                                       2





     5.  Shares.  Subject to the provisions of Section 15 hereof, the Committee
may grant Options with respect to an aggregate of up to 1,000,000 Shares, all of
which Shares may be either Shares held in treasury or authorized but unissued
Shares.  The maximum number of Shares which may be the subject of Options
granted under the Plan during any calendar year to any individual shall not
exceed 250,000 Shares.  If the Shares that would be issued or transferred
pursuant to any Option are not issued or transferred and cease to be issuable or
transferable for any reason, the number of Shares subject to such Option will no
longer be charged against the limitation provided for herein and may again be
made subject to Options.  Notwithstanding the preceding, with respect to any
Option granted to any individual who is a "covered employee" within the meaning
of Section 162(m) of the Code that is cancelled, the number of shares subject to
such Option shall continue to count against the maximum number of shares which
may be the subject of Options granted to such individual.  For purposes of the
preceding sentence, if, after grant, the exercise price of an Option is reduced,
such reduction shall be treated as a cancellation of such Option and the grant
of a new Option, and both the cancellation of the Option and the new Option
shall be counted against the maximum number of shares for which Options may be
granted to the holder of such Option.

     6.  Grant of Options.  The number of any Options to be granted to any
Eligible Person shall be determined by the Committee in its sole discretion.  At
the time an Option is granted, the Committee may, in its sole discretion,
designate whether such Option (a) is to be considered as an incentive stock
option within the meaning of Section 422 of the Code, or (b) is not to be
treated as an incentive stock option for purposes of this Plan and the Code.  No
Option which is intended to qualify as an incentive stock option may be granted
to any individual who, at the time of such grant, is not an employee of the
Corporation or a Subsidiary.  

     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, to the
extent that the aggregate Fair Market Value (determined as of the date an Option
is granted) of the Shares with respect to which Options which are designated as
(or deemed to be) incentive stock options granted to an employee (and any
incentive stock options granted to such employee under any other incentive stock
option plan maintained by the Corporation or any Subsidiary that meets the
requirements of Section 422 of the Code) first become exercisable in any
calendar year exceeds $100,000, such Options shall be treated as Options which
are not incentive stock options.  Options with respect to which no designation
is made by the Committee shall be deemed to be incentive stock options to the
extent that the $100,000 limitation described in the preceding sentence is met. 
This paragraph shall be applied by taking Options into account in the order in
which they are granted.

     Nothing herein contained shall be construed to prohibit the issuance of
Options at different times to the same person.

     A certificate of Option signed by the Chairman of the Board or the
President or a Vice President of the Corporation, attested by the Treasurer or
an Assistant Treasurer, or Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the
Corporation and bearing the seal of the Corporation affixed thereto, shall be
issued to each person to whom an Option is granted.  The certificate of Option
for an Option shall be legended to indicate whether or not the Option is an
incentive stock option.  The certificate for an Option which is an incentive
stock option, for an Option which is not an incentive stock option and for an
Option granted to an Eligible Director pursuant to Section 7 shall be in the
form attached hereto as Annex 1, Annex 2 and Annex 3, respectively, or in such
other form as may be determined by the Committee from time to time.

     7.  Grants of Options to Eligible Directors.  Notwithstanding any other
provision of this Plan to the contrary, Options which are not incentive stock
options shall be granted to each Eligible Director in accordance with this
Section 7.  Each Eligible Director who is a member of the Board as of the
consummation of the initial public offering of Shares by the Corporation


                                       3





shall be granted an Option upon such consummation to purchase ____ Shares at a
purchase price per Share equal to the Initial Public Offering Price.  Each
Eligible Director who is initially elected to the Board after the consummation
of the initial public offering of Shares by the Corporation shall be granted an
Option on the date of his initial election to the Board to purchase Shares at a
purchase price per Share equal to the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date
of grant of such Option.  On the last day of each fiscal year of the Corporation
(beginning with the fiscal year commencing on a date following the initial
public offering of Shares by the Corporation) each member of the Board who is an
Eligible Director on such date shall be granted an additional Option to purchase
____ shares at a purchase price per Share equal to the Fair Market Value of a
Share on the date of grant of such Option; provided, however, that with respect
to any such Eligible Director who is initially elected to the Board during such
a fiscal year, the Option granted to such Eligible Director on the last day of
the fiscal year during which he was initially elected to the Board shall be for
a number of Shares equal to _________ multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of
which shall be the number of days during the fiscal year during which such
Eligible Director was a member of the Board and the denominator of which shall
be 365, which number of Shares shall be rounded up to the next whole number of
Shares.  Except as otherwise provided in Sections 11 and 14, one-third of the
Shares subject to an Option granted pursuant to this Section 7 may be purchased
on or after each of the first, second and third anniversaries, respectively, of
the date of grant, but prior to the expiration of the Option.

     8.  Purchase Price.  The purchase price per Share for the Shares purchased
pursuant to the exercise of an Option (other than an Option granted pursuant to
Section 7) shall be fixed by the Committee at the time of grant of the Option;
provided, however, that the purchase price per Share for the Shares to be
purchased pursuant to the exercise of an incentive stock option shall not in any
event be less than 100% of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant
of the Option, except as provided in Section 10.
 
     9.  Duration of Options.  The duration of each Option shall be ten years
from the date upon which the Option is granted, except as provided in Sections
10 and 14. 

    10.  Ten Percent Stockholders.  Notwithstanding any other provision of this
Plan to the contrary, no Option which is intended to qualify as an incentive
stock option may be granted under this Plan to any employee who, at the time the
Option is granted, owns Shares possessing more than 10 percent of the total
combined voting power or value of all classes of stock of the Corporation,
unless the exercise price under such Option is at least 110% of the Fair Market
Value of a Share on the date such Option is granted and the duration of such
Option is no more than five years.

    11.  Exercise of Options.  Unless the Committee determines otherwise at the
time of grant, and except as otherwise provided herein, 20% of the Shares
subject to an Option may be purchased on or after December 31st of the year in
which such Option is granted and an additional 20% of the Shares subject to such
Option may be purchased on or after each of the first, second, third and fourth
anniversaries, respectively, of the date of grant, but prior to the expiration
of the Option; provided, however, that in no event, other than the holder's
death, may an Option be exercised during the six-month period commencing on the
date of grant. 

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, all or any part of any remaining unexercised
Options granted to any person (including Options granted pursuant to Section 7)
may be exercised, subject to the timing provisions of Section 14 hereof, in the
following circumstances (but in no event, other than the holder's death, during
the six-month period commencing on the date of grant):  (a) upon the holder's
retirement from the Corporation and all Subsidiaries on or after his 65th
birthday, (b) upon the Disability or death of the holder, (c) upon a Change in
Control (as hereinafter defined) while the holder is in the employ or service 
of the Corporation or (d) upon


                                       4




the occurrence of such special circumstance or event as in the opinion of the 
Committee merits special consideration.

     For purposes of the Plan, a "Change in Control" shall mean any of the
following events:  (i) the sale to any purchaser of (A) all or substantially all
of the assets of the Corporation or (B) capital stock representing more than 50%
of the stock of the Corporation entitled to vote generally in the election of
directors of the Corporation; (ii) the merger or consolidation of the
Corporation with another corporation if, immediately after such merger or
consolidation, less than a majority of the combined voting power of the then
outstanding securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors
of the surviving or resulting corporation in such merger or consolidation is
held, directly or indirectly, in the aggregate by the holders immediately prior
to such transaction of the outstanding securities of the Corporation; (iii) the
filing of a report on Schedule 13D or Schedule 14D-1 (or any successor schedule,
form, or report or item therein), each promulgated pursuant to the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), disclosing that any
person (as the term "person" is used in Section 13(d)(3) or Section 14(d)(2) of
the Exchange Act) has become the beneficial owner (as the term "beneficial
owner" is defined under Rule 13d-3 or any successor rule or regulation
promulgated under the Exchange Act) of securities representing 50% or more of
the combined voting power of the voting stock of the Corporation; or (iv) the
filing by the Corporation of a report or proxy statement with the Securities and
Exchange Commission pursuant to the Exchange Act disclosing in response to Form
8-K or Schedule 14A (or any successor schedule, form, or report or item therein)
that a change in control of the Corporation has occurred or will occur in the
future pursuant to any then existing contract or transaction.  Notwithstanding
the foregoing, a Change in Control shall not be deemed to occur for purposes of
the Plan as a result of an event described above if a majority of the
individuals who are members of the Board prior to such event specifically
determines that a Change in Control should not be deemed to have occurred. 
 
     An Option shall be exercised by the delivery of a written notice duly
signed by the holder thereof to such effect, together with the Option
certificate and the full purchase price of the Shares purchased pursuant to the
exercise of the Option, to the Chairman of the Board or an officer of the
Corporation appointed by the Chairman of the Board for the purpose of receiving
the same.  Payment of the full purchase price shall be made as follows: in cash;
by check payable to the order of the Corporation; by delivery to the Corporation
of Shares which shall be valued at their Fair Market Value on the date of
exercise of the Option (provided, that a holder may not use any Shares which the
holder has beneficially owned for less than six months); or by such other
methods as the Committee may permit from time to time, including, without
limitation, by a "cashless" exercise method through a registered broker-dealer
or by furnishing a promissory note to the Corporation, bearing interest at a
rate determined by the Committee (but not less than such rate as shall preclude
the imputation of interest under the Code) and containing such other terms as
shall be determined by the Committee. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with
respect to a holder of an Option who is subject to Section 16 of the Exchange
Act, payment of the purchase price by delivery to the Corporation of Shares
previously owned by such holder shall be conditioned upon approval by the Board,
in advance of the exercise of the Option, of the use of such payment method, and
any such holder who wishes to use such payment method shall notify the
Corporation, in writing, prior to the exercise of the Option, of such holder's
intention to use such payment method.  

     Within a reasonable time after the exercise of an Option, the Corporation
shall cause to be delivered to the person entitled thereto, a certificate for
the Shares purchased pursuant to the exercise of the Option.  If the Option
shall have been exercised with respect to less than all of the Shares subject to
the Option, the Corporation shall also cause to be delivered to the person
entitled thereto a new Option certificate in replacement of the certificate
surrendered at the time of the exercise of the Option, indicating the number of
Shares with respect to which the Option remains available for exercise, or the 
original Option certificate shall be endorsed to give effect

                                       5





to the partial exercise thereof.

     Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or of any Option, no Option
granted pursuant to the Plan may be exercised at any time when the Option or the
granting or exercise thereof violates any law or governmental order or
regulation.

    12.  Consideration for Options.  The Corporation shall obtain such
consideration for the grant of an Option as the Committee in its discretion may
determine.

    13.  Non-transferability of Options.  Options and all other rights
thereunder shall be non-transferable and non-assignable by the holder thereof
except to the extent that the estate of a deceased holder of an Option may be
permitted to exercise them.  Options may be exercised or surrendered during the
holder's lifetime only by the holder thereof.

    14.  Termination of Employment or Service.  All or any part of any Option,
to the extent unexercised, shall terminate immediately  upon the termination for
any reason of the holder's employment or service with the Corporation or any
Subsidiary, except that the holder shall have three months after such
termination of employment or service to exercise any unexercised Option that he
could have exercised on the day on which such employment or service terminated
(including Options which accelerate in exercisability pursuant to Section 11
hereof); provided, however, that such exercise must be accomplished prior to the
expiration of the term of such Option.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the
termination of employment or service is due to Disability or to death, the
holder or the representative of the estate of a deceased holder shall have the
privilege of exercising the Options which are unexercised at the time of such
Disability or death; provided, however, that such exercise must be accomplished
prior to the expiration of the term of such Option and within one year after the
holder's Disability or death, as the case may be.  If the employment or service
of any holder of an Option with the Corporation or a Subsidiary shall be
terminated for Cause, all unexercised Options of such holder shall terminate
immediately upon such termination of the holder's employment or service with the
Corporation and all Subsidiaries, and a holder of Options whose employment or
service with the Corporation and Subsidiaries is so terminated, shall have no
right after such termination to exercise any unexercised Option he might have
exercised prior to the termination of his employment or service with the
Corporation and Subsidiaries.

    15.  Adjustment Provision.  If prior to the complete exercise of any Option
there shall be declared and paid a stock dividend upon the Shares or if the
Shares shall be split up, converted, exchanged, reclassified, or in any way
substituted for, then the Option, to the extent that it has not been exercised,
shall entitle the holder thereof upon the future exercise of the Option to such
number and kind of securities or cash or other property subject to the terms of
the Option to which he would have been entitled had he actually owned the Shares
subject to the unexercised portion of the Option at the time of the occurrence
of such stock dividend, split-up, conversion, exchange, reclassification or
substitution, and the aggregate purchase price upon the future exercise of the
Option shall be the same as if the originally optioned Shares were being
purchased thereunder.

     Any fractional shares or securities issuable upon the exercise of the
Option as a result of such adjustment shall be payable in cash based upon the
Fair Market Value of such shares or securities at the time of such exercise.  If
any such event should occur, the number of Shares with respect to which Options
remain to be issued, or with respect to which Options may be reissued, shall be
adjusted in a similar manner.

     Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, in the event of a
recapitalization, merger, consolidation, rights offering, separation,
reorganization or liquidation, or any other change in the corporate structure or
outstanding shares, the Committee shall make such


                                       6





adjustments to the number of Shares and the class of shares available 
hereunder or to any outstanding Options as shall be necessary to prevent 
dilution or enlargement of rights.

    16.  Issuance of Shares and Compliance with Securities Act.  Any holder of
an Option shall make such representations and furnish such information as may,
in the opinion of counsel for the Corporation, be appropriate to permit the
Corporation, in the light of the then existence or non-existence with respect to
such Shares of an effective Registration Statement under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended from time to time (the "Securities Act"), to issue the Shares
in compliance with the provisions of the Securities Act or any comparable act. 
The Corporation shall have the right, in its sole discretion, to legend any
Shares which may be issued pursuant to the exercise of any Option, or may issue
stop transfer orders in respect thereof.

    17.  Income Tax Withholding.  If the Corporation or a Subsidiary shall be
required to withhold any amounts by reason of any Federal, State or local tax
rules or regulations in respect of the issuance of Shares pursuant to the
exercise of any Option, the Corporation or the Subsidiary shall be entitled to
deduct and withhold such amounts from any cash payments to be made to the holder
of such Option.  In any event, the holder shall make available to the
Corporation or Subsidiary, promptly when requested by the Corporation or such
Subsidiary, sufficient funds to meet the requirements of such withholding; and
the Corporation or Subsidiary shall be entitled to take and authorize such steps
as it may deem advisable in order to have such funds made available to the
Corporation or Subsidiary out of any funds or property due or to become due to
the holder of such Option.

    18.  Administration and Amendment of the Plan.  Except as hereinafter
provided, the Board of Directors or the Committee may at any time withdraw or
from time to time amend the Plan as it relates to, and the terms and conditions
of, any Option not theretofore granted, and the Board of Directors or the
Committee, with the consent of the affected holder of an Option, may at any time
withdraw or from time to time amend the Plan as it relates to, and the terms and
conditions of, any outstanding Option.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, any
amendment by the Board of Directors or the Committee which would increase the
number of Shares issuable under the Plan or to any individual or change the
class of Eligible Persons shall be subject to the approval of the stockholders
of the Corporation within one year of such amendment.

     Determinations of the Committee as to any question which may arise with
respect to the interpretation of the provisions of the Plan and Options shall be
final.  The Committee may authorize and establish such rules, regulations and
revisions thereof not inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan, as it may
deem advisable to make the Plan and Options effective or provide for their
administration, and may take such other action with regard to the Plan and
Options as it shall deem desirable to effectuate their purpose.

    19.  No Right of Employment or Service.  Nothing contained herein or in an
Option shall be construed to confer on any employee or director any right to be
continued in the employ or service of the Corporation or any Subsidiary or
derogate from any right of the Corporation and any Subsidiary to retire, request
the resignation of or discharge or otherwise cease its service arrangement with
any employee or director, at any time, with or without Cause.

    20.  Final Issuance Date.  No Option shall be granted under the Plan after
______, 2007.

    21.  Conflict.  If there is any conflict between the terms of any Option
Certificate and the terms of the Plan, the terms of the Plan shall control.


                                       7




                                                                 Annex 1
                                                                  
                                                       Form of Incentive
                                                            Stock Option

                             OPTION CERTIFICATE

                           INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION
                              (Non-Assignable)


                                             ___________ Shares



                          To Purchase Common Stock of

                    THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.

                     Issued Pursuant to the l997 Stock
               Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.



          THIS CERTIFIES that on ________________, l9__, 
_________________________________ (the "Holder") was granted an option
("Option") to purchase at the Option price of $_____ per share all or any
part of ____________________ fully paid and non-assessable shares ("Shares") of
the Common Stock of THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. ("Corporation"), a
Delaware corporation, upon and subject to the following terms and conditions.

          This Option shall expire on _________________, ____.

          This Option may be exercised or surrendered during the Holder's
lifetime only by the Holder.  This Option shall not be transferable by the
Holder otherwise than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.


 
          Except as otherwise provided pursuant to the 1997 Stock Option Plan of
The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Plan"), 20% of the Shares subject
to this Option may be purchased on or after December 31, 19__ and an additional
20% of the Shares subject to this Option may be purchased on or after each of
the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries, respectively, of this
Option's date of grant.  In no event, however, may this Option be exercised (i)
during the six-month period commencing on the date of grant (except in the case
of the Holder's death), or (ii) after the Option's expiration date.

          The Option and this Option certificate are issued pursuant to and are
subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Plan, the terms and conditions
of which are hereby incorporated as though set forth at length, and a copy of
which is attached hereto.  

          WITNESS the seal of the Corporation and the signatures of its duly
authorized officers.


Dated: _______________________, l9__.


(SEAL)                             THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
                                        STORES, INC.



                                   By: _________________________
ATTEST:


By:_____________________________



                                          2



                                                                        Annex 2

                                                                        Form of 
                                                                  Non-Qualified
                                                                   Stock Option


                                  OPTION CERTIFICATE

                               NON-QUALIFIED STOCK OPTION
                                   (Non-Assignable)


                                                       ___________ Shares



                              To Purchase Common Stock of

                         THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.

                          Issued Pursuant to the l997 Stock
                  Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.



          THIS CERTIFIES that on ________________, l9__, 
_________________________________ (the "Holder") was granted an option
("Option"), which is not an incentive stock option, to purchase at the Option
price of $_____ per share all or any part of ____________________ fully paid
and non-assessable shares ("Shares") of the Common Stock of THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
RETAIL STORES, INC. ("Corporation"), a Delaware corporation, upon and subject to
the following terms and conditions.

          This Option shall expire on _________________, ____.

          This Option may be exercised or surrendered during the Holder's
lifetime only by the Holder.  This Option shall not be transferable by the
Holder otherwise than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.


 
          Except as otherwise provided pursuant to the 1997 Stock Option Plan of
The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Plan"), 20% of the Shares subject
to this Option may be purchased on or after December 31, 19__ and an additional
20% of the Shares subject to this Option may be purchased on or after each of
the first, second, third and fourth anniversaries, respectively, of this
Option's date of grant.  In no event, however, may this Option be exercised (i)
during the six-month period commencing on the date of grant (except in the case
of the Holder's death), or (ii) after the Option's expiration date.

          The Option and this Option certificate are issued pursuant to and are
subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Plan, the terms and conditions
of which are hereby incorporated as though set forth at length, and a copy of
which is attached hereto.  

          WITNESS the seal of the Corporation and the signatures of its duly
authorized officers.


Dated: _______________________, l9__.


(SEAL)                             THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
                                        STORES, INC.



                                   By: _________________________
ATTEST:


By:_____________________________



                                           2





                                                                        Annex 3

                                                               Form of Eligible
                                                              Director's Option


                              OPTION CERTIFICATE

                           NON-QUALIFIED STOCK OPTION
                                (Non-Assignable)


                                                              Shares
                                                    ----------

                                       
                          To Purchase Common Stock of

                     THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.

                        Issued Pursuant to the l997 Stock
               Option Plan of The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.



          THIS CERTIFIES that on ________________, l9__, 
_________________________________ (the "Holder") was granted an option
("Option"), which is not an incentive stock option, to purchase at the Option
price of $          per share all or any part of ____________________ fully paid
and non-assessable shares ("Shares") of the Common Stock of THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
RETAIL STORES, INC. ("Corporation"), a Delaware corporation, upon and subject to
the following terms and conditions.

          This Option shall expire on _________________, ____.

          This Option may be exercised or surrendered during the Holder's
lifetime only by the Holder.  This Option shall not be transferable by the
Holder otherwise than by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.




 
          Except as otherwise provided pursuant to the 1997 Stock Option Plan of
The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Plan"), one-third of the Shares
subject to this Option may be purchased on or after each of the first, second
and third anniversaries, respectively, of this Option's date of grant.  In no
event, however, may this Option be exercised (i) during the six-month period
commencing on the date of grant (except in the case of the Holder's death), or
(ii) after the Option's expiration date.

          The Option and this Option certificate are issued pursuant to and are
subject to all of the terms and conditions of the Plan, the terms and conditions
of which are hereby incorporated as though set forth at length, and a copy of
which is attached hereto.  

          WITNESS the seal of the Corporation and the signatures of its duly
authorized officers.


Dated:                        , l9  .
      ------------------------    --


(SEAL)                                     THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
                                                STORES, INC.



                                           By:
                                              -------------------------
ATTEST:


By:
   -----------------------------


                                          2





                                                                   Exhibit 10.3
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                    MERRILL LYNCH
                                       --------
                                       SPECIAL
                                       --------

                                  PROTOTYPE DEFINED

                                  CONTRIBUTION PLAN

                                  ADOPTION AGREEMENT

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                                     401(k) PLAN
                                 EMPLOYEE THRIFT PLAN
                                 PROFIT-SHARING PLAN

                            Letter Serial Number: D359287b
                         National Office Letter Date: 6/29/93
                                           
This Prototype Plan and Adoption Agreement are important legal instruments with
legal and tax implications for which the Sponsor, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner
& Smith, Incorporated, does not assume responsibility.  The Employer is urged to
consult with its own attorney with regard to the adoption of this Plan and its
suitability to its circumstances.



Adoption of Plan

The Employer named below hereby establishes or restates a profit-sharing plan 
that includes a /X/ 401(k); / / profit-sharing and/or / / thrift plan feature 
(the "Plan") by adopting the Merrill Lynch Special Prototype Defined 
Contribution Plan and Trust as modified by the terms and provisions of this 
Adoption Agreement. 

Employer and Plan Information

Employer Name:*                The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.

Business Address:              1 Dodge Drive

                               W. Caldwell, NJ  07006

Telephone Number:              (201) 227-8900

Employer Taxpayer ID Number:   31-1241495

Employer Taxable Year ends on: January 31st

Plan Name:                     The Children's Place 401(k) Savings & Investment
                               Plan

Plan Number:                   001

401(k) Profit- Thrift Sharing Effective Date of Adoption or Restatement: 01/01/97 ---/---/--- ---/---/--- Original Effective Date: 09/01/90 ---/---/--- ---/---/--- If this Plan is a continuation or an amendment of a prior plan, all optional forms of benefits provided in the prior plan must be provided under this Plan to any Participant who had an account balance, whether or not vested, in the prior plan. _______________ * If there are any Participating Affiliates in this Plan, list below the proper name of each Participating Affiliate.
-2- ARTICLE I. Definitions A. "Compensation" (1) With respect to each Participant, except as provided below, Compensation shall mean the (select all those applicable for each column): 401(k) and/ Profit or Thrift Sharing /X/ / / (a) amount reported in the "Wages Tips and Other Compensation" Box on Form W-2 for the applicable period selected in Item 5 below. / / / / (b) compensation for Code Section 415 safe-harbor purposes (as defined in Section 3.9.1 (H)(i) of basic plan document #03) for the applicable period selected in Item 5 below. / / / / (c) amount reported pursuant to Code Section 3401(a) for the applicable period selected in Item 5 below. / / / / (d) all amounts received (under either option (a) or (b) above) for personal services rendered to the Employer but excluding (select one): / / overtime / / bonuses / / commissions / / amounts in excess of $ / / other (specify) _________. (2) Treatment of Elective Contributions (select one): /X/ (a) For purposes of contributions, Compensation shall include Elective Deferrals and amounts excludable from the gross income of the Employee under Code Section 125, Code Section 402(e)(3), Code Section 402(h) or Code Section 403(b) ("elective contributions"). (b) For purposes of contributions, Compensation shall not include "elective contributions." (3) CODA Compensation (select one): -3- /X/ (a) For purposes of the ADP and ACP Tests, Compensation shall include "elective contributions." (b) For purposes of the ADP and ACP Tests, Compensation shall not include "elective contributions." (4) With respect to Contributions to an Employer Contributions Account, Compensation shall include all Compensation (select one): /X/ (a) during the Plan Year in which the Participant enters the Plan. / / (b) after the Participant's Entry Date. (5) The applicable period for determining Compensation shall be (select one): / / (a) the Plan Year. / / (b) the Limitation Year. / / (c) the consecutive 12-month period ending on _________. B. "Disability" (1) Definition Disability shall mean a condition which results in the Participant's (select one): / / (a) inability to engage in any substantial gainful activity by reason of any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or which has lasted or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than months. /X/ (b) total and permanent inability to meet the requirements of the Participant's customary employment which can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than 12 months; / / (c) qualification for Social Security disability benefits. / / (d) qualification for benefits under the Employer's long-term disability plan. (2) Contributions Due to Disability (select one): -4- /X/ (a) No contributions to an Employer Contributions Account will be made on behalf of a Participant due to his or her Disability. / / (b) Contributions to an Employer Contributions Account will be made on behalf of a Participant due to his or her Disability provided that: the Employer elected option (a) or (c) above as the definition of Disability, contributions are not made on behalf of a Highly compensa- ted Employee, the contribution is based on the Compensation each such Participant would have received for the Limitation Year if the Participant had been paid at the rate of Compensation paid immediately before his or her Disability, and contributions made on behalf of such Participant will be nonforfeitable when made. C. "Early Retirement" is (select one): / / (1) not permitted. / / (2) permitted if a Participant terminates Employment before Normal Retirement Age and has (select one): /X/ (a) attained age 55. / / (b) attained age ___ and completed ___ Years of Service. / / (c) attained age ___ and completed ___ Years of Service as a Participant. D. "Eligible Employees" (select one): / / (1) All Employees are eligible to participate in the Plan. /X/ (2) The following Employees are not eligible to participate in the Plan (select all those applicable): /X/ (a) Employees included in a unit of Employees covered by a collective bargaining agreement between the Employer or a Participating Affiliate and the Employee representatives (not including any organization more than half of whose members are Employees who are owners, officers, or executives of the Employer or Participating Affiliate) in the negotiation of which retirement benefits were the subject of good faith bargaining, unless the bargaining agreement provides for participation in the Plan. -5- /X/ (b) non-resident aliens who received no earned income from the Employer or a Participating Affiliate which constitutes income from sources within the United States. / / (c) Employees of an Affiliate. / / (d) Employees employed in or by the following specified division, plant, location, job category or other identifiable individual or group of Employees: ____________. If item (c) or (d) above is checked, certain employees who are not Eligible Employees shall become Participants under the following circumstances: If, in any calendar quarter, there is no day on which the percentage test described in Internal Revenue Code section 410(b) is met, additional Employees shall become Participants (or, if an Employee previously became a Participant, shall resume participation) as of the beginning of the Plan Year, or if later, the date such Employee would have become a Participant under Article I, Section E, below. Said Employees shall become Participants in order of decreasing length of service beginning with such Employees having the longest service as of the end of such calendar quarter, until the percentage test is met. E. "Entry Date" Entry Date shall mean (select as applicable): 401(k) and/or Profit- Thrift Sharing / / / / (1) If the initial Plan Year is less than twelve months, the day of ______ and thereafter: / / / / (2) the first day of the Plan Year following the date the Employee meets the eligibility requirements. If the Employer elects this option (2) establishing only one Entry Date, the eligibility "age and service" requirements elected in Article II must be no more than age 20-1/2 and 6 months of service. / / / / (3) the first day of the month following the date the Employee -6- meets the eligibility requirements. / / / / (4) the first day of the Plan Year and the first day of the seventh month of the Plan Year following the date the Employee meets the eligibility requirements. /X/ / / (5) the first day of the Plan Year, the first day of the fourth month of the Plan Year, the first day of the seventh month of the Plan Year, and the first day of the tenth month of the Plan Year following the date the Employee meets the eligibility requirements. / / / / (6) other: provided that the Entry Date or Dates selected are no later than any of the options above. F. "Hours of Service" Hours of Service for the purpose of determining a Participant's Period of Severance and Year of Service shall be determined on the basis of the method specified below: (1) Eligibility Service: For purposes of determining whether a Participant has satisfied the eligibility requirements, the following method shall be used (select one): 401(k) and/or Profit- Thrift Sharing / / / / (a) elapsed time method /X/ / / (b) hourly records method (2) Vesting Service: A Participant's nonforfeitable interest shall be determined on the basis of the method specified below (select one): / / (a) elapsed time method /X/ (b) hourly records method / / (c) If this item (c) is checked, the Plan only provides for contributions that are always 100% vested and this item (2) will not apply. -7- (3) Hourly Records: For the purpose of determining Hours of Service under the hourly record method (select one): /X/ (a) only actual hours for which an Employee is paid or entitled to payment shall be counted. / / (b) an Employee shall be credited with 45 Hours of Service if such Employee would be credited with at least 1 Hour of Service during the week. G. "Integration Level" /X/ (1) This Plan is not integrated with Social Security. / / (2) This Plan is integrated with Social Security. The Integration Level shall be (select one): / / (a) the Taxable Wage Base. / / (b) $_______ (a dollar amount less than the Taxable Wage Base). / / (c) ______% of the Taxable Wage Base (not to exceed 100%). / / (d) the greater of $10,000 or 20% of the Taxable Wage Base. H. "Limitation Compensation" For purposes of Code Section 415, Limitation Compensation shall be compensation as determined for purposes of (select one): / / (1) Code Section 415 Safe-Harbor as defined in Section 3.9.1(H)(i) of basic plan document #03. /X/ (2) the "Wages, Tips and Other Compensation" Box on Form W-2. / / (3) Code Section 3401(a) Federal Income Tax Withholding. I. "Limitation Year" For purposes of Code Section 415, the Limitation Year shall be (select one): /X/ (1) the Plan Year. / / (2) the twelve consecutive month period ending on the ____ day of the month of ________. J. "Net Profits" are (select one): -8- /X/ (1) not necessary for any contribution. / / (2) necessary for (select all those applicable): / / (a) Profit-Sharing Contributions. / / (b) Matching 401(k) Contributions. / / (c) Matching Thrift Contributions. K. "Normal Retirement Age" Normal Retirement Age shall be (select one): /X/ (1) attainment of age 65 (not more than 65) by the Participant. / / (2) attainment of age ____ (not more than 65) by the Participant or the anniversary (not more than the 5th) of the first day of the Plan Year in which the Eligible Employee became a Participant, whichever is later. / / (3) attainment of age ____ (not more than 65) by the Participant or the anniversary (not more than the 5th) of the first day on which the Eligible Employee performed an Hour of Service, whichever is later. L. "Participant Directed Assets" are: 401(k) and/or Profit- Thrift Sharing /X/ / / (1) permitted. (2) not permitted. M. "Plan Year" The Plan Year shall end on the 31st day of December. N. "Predecessor Service" Predecessor service will be credited (select one): /X/ (1) only as required by the Plan. -9- / / (2) to include, in addition to the Plan requirements and subject to the limitations set forth below, service with the following predecessor employer(s) determined as if such predecessors were the Employer: Service with such predecessor employer applies [select either or both (a) and/or (b); (c) is only available in addition to (a) and/or (b)]: / / (a) for purposes of eligibility to participate; / / (b) for purposes of vesting; / / (c) except for the following service: _________. O. "Valuation Date'' Valuation Date shall mean (select one for each column, as applicable): 401(k) and/or Profit- Thrift Sharing (1) the last business day of each month. (2) the last business day of each quarter within the Plan Year. (3) the last business day of each semi-annual period within the Plan Year. (4) the last business day of the Plan Year. /X/ / / (5) other: DAILY. ARTICLE II. Participation Participation Requirements An Eligible Employee must meet the following requirements to become a Participant (select one or more for each column, as applicable): -10- 401(k) and/or Profit- Thrift Sharing / / / / (1) Performance of one Hour of Service. / / / / (2) Attainment of age ___ (maximum 20 1/2) and completion of ___ (not more than 1/2) Years of Service. If this item is selected, no Hours of Service shall be counted. /X/ / / (3) Attainment of age 21 (maximum 21) and completion of 1 Year(s) of Service. If more than one Year of Service is selected, the immediate 100% vesting schedule must be selected in Article VII of this Adoption Agreement. / / / / (4) Attainment of age ___ (maximum 21) and completion of Years of Service. If more than one Year of Service is selected, the immediate 100% vesting schedule must be selected in Article VII of this Adoption Agreement. / / / / (5) Each Employee who is an Eligible Employee on ___ will be deemed to have satisfied the participation requirements on the effective date without regard to such Eligible Employee's actual age and/or service. ARTICLE III. 401(k) Contributions and Account Allocation A. Elective Deferrals If selected below, a Participant's Elective Deferrals will be (select all applicable): /X/ (1) a dollar amount or a percentage of Compensation, as specified by the Participant on his or her 401(k) Election form, which may not exceed 15% of his or her Compensation. / / (2) with respect to bonuses, such dollar amount or percentage as specified by the Participant on his or her 401(k) Election form with respect to such bonus. B. Matching 401(k) Contributions If selected below, the Employer may make Matching 401(k) Contributions for each Plan Year (select one): / / (1) Discretionary Formula: -11- Discretionary Matching 401(k) Contribution equal to such a dollar amount or percentage of Elective Deferrals, as determined by the Employer, which shall be allocated (select one): / / (a) based on the ratio of each Participant's Elective Deferral for the Plan Year to the total Elective Deferrals of all Participants for the Plan Year. If inserted, Matching 401(k) Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $_______ for each Participant or ________% of each Participant's Compensation. / / (b) in an amount not to exceed _____% of each Participant's first ____% of Compensation contributed as Elective Deferrals for the Plan Year. If any Matching 401(k) Contribution remains, it is allocated to each such Participant in an amount not to ___exceed % of the next ___% of each Participant's Compensation contributed as Elective Deferrals for the Plan Year. Any remaining Matching 401(k) Contribution shall be allocated to each such Participant in the ratio that such Participant's Elective Deferral for the Plan Year bears to the total Elective Deferrals of all such Participants for the Plan Year. If inserted, Matching 401(k) Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $______ for each Participant or ____% of each Participant's Compensation. /X/ (2) Nondiscretionary Formula: A nondiscretionary Matching 401(k) Contribution for each Plan Year equal to (select one): / / (a) _____% of each Participant's Compensation contributed as Elective Deferrals. If inserted, Matching 401(k) Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $_______ for each Participant or _______% of each Participant's Compensation. /X/ (b) 50% of the first 5% of the Participant's Compensation contributed as Elective Deferrals and ___% of the next ___% of the Participant's Compensation contributed as Elective Deferrals. If inserted, Matching 401(k) Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $_____ for each Participant or ____% of each Participant's Compensation. -12- C. Participants Eligible for Matching 401(k) Contribution Allocation The following Participants shall be eligible for an allocation to their Matching 401(k) Contributions Account (select all those applicable): / / (1) Any Participant who makes Elective Deferrals. / / (2) Any Participant who satisfies those requirements elected by the Employer for an allocation to his or her Employer Contributions Account as provided in Article IV Section C. /x/ (3) Solely with respect to a Plan in which Matching 401(k) Contributions are made quarterly (or on any other regular interval that is more frequent than annually) any Participant whose 401(k) Election is in effect throughout such entire quarter (or other interval). D. Qualified Matching Contributions If selected below, the Employer may make Qualified Matching Contributions for each Plan Year (select all those applicable): (1) In its discretion, the Employer may make Qualified Matching Contributions on behalf of (select one): / / (a) all Participants who make Elective Deferrals in that Plan Year. /x/ (b) only those Participants who are Nonhighly Compensated Employees and who make Elective Deferrals for that Plan Year. (2) Qualified Matching Contributions will be contributed and allocated to each Participant in an amount equal to: / / (a) ___% of the Participant's Compensation contributed as Elective Deferrals. If inserted, Qualified Matching Contributions shall not exceed ___% of the Participant's Compensation. /x/ (b) Such an amount, determined by the Employer, which is needed to meet the ACP Test. (3) In its discretion, the Employer may elect to designate all or any part of Matching 401(k) Contributions as Qualified Matching Contributions that -13- are taken into account as Elective Deferrals -- included in the ADP Test and excluded from the ACP Test -- on behalf of (select one): / / (a) all Participants who make Elective Deferrals for that Plan Year. /x/ (b) Only Participants who are Nonhighly Compensated Employees who make Elective Deferrals for that Plan Year. E. Qualified Nonelective Contributions If selected below, the Employer may make Qualified Nonelective Contributions for each Plan Year (select all those applicable): (1) In its discretion, the Employer may make Qualified Nonelective Contributions on behalf of (select one): / / (a) all Eligible Participants. /x/ (b) only Eligible Participants who are Nonhighly Compensated Employees. (2) Qualified Nonelective Contributions will be contributed and allocated to each Eligible Participant in an amount equal to (select one): / / (a) ___% (no more than 15%) of the Compensation of each Eligible Participant eligible to share in the allocation. /x/ (b) Such an amount determined by the Employer, which is needed to meet either the ADP Test or ACP Test. (3) At the discretion of the Employer, as needed and taken into account as Elective Deferrals included in the ADP Test on behalf of (select one): / / (a) all Eligible Participants. /x/ (b) only those Eligible Participants who are Nonhighly Compensated Employees. F. Elective Deferrals used in ACP Test (select one): /x/ (1) At the discretion of the Employer, Elective Deferrals may be used to satisfy the ACP Test. -14- / / (2) Elective Deferrals may not be used to satisfy the ACP Test. G. Making and modifying a 401(k) Election An Eligible Employee shall be entitled to increase, decrease or resume his or her Elective Deferral percentage with the following frequency during the Plan Year (select one): / / (1) annually. / / (2) semi-annually. /x/ (3) quarterly. / / (4) monthly. / / (5) other (specify): ______. Any such increase, decrease or resumption shall be effective as of the first payroll period coincident with or next following the first day of each period set forth above. A Participant may completely discontinue making Elective Deferrals at any time effective for the payroll period after written notice is provided to the Administrator. ARTICLE IV. Profit-Sharing Contributions and Account Allocation A. Profit-Sharing Contributions If selected below, the following contributions for each Plan Year will be made: Contributions to Employer Contributions Accounts (select one): / / (a) Such an amount, if any, as determined by the Employer. / / (b) ___ % of each Participant's Compensation. B. Allocation of Contributions to Employer Contributions Accounts (select one): / / (1) Non-Integrated Allocation The Employer Contributions Account of each Participant eligible to share in the allocation for a Plan Year shall be credited with a portion of the contribution, plus any forfeitures if forfeitures are reallocated to Participants, equal to the ratio that the Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year bears to the Compensation for that Plan Year of all Participants entitled to share in the contribution. -15- / / (2) Integrated Allocation Contributions to Employer Contributions Accounts with respect to a Plan Year, plus any forfeitures if forfeitures are reallocated to Participants, shall be allocated to the Employer Contributions Account of each eligible Participant as follows: (a) First, in the ratio that each such eligible Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year bears to the Compensation for that Plan Year of all eligible Participants but not in excess of 3% of each Participant's Compensation. (b) Second, any remaining contributions and forfeitures will be allocated in the ratio that each eligible Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year in excess of the Integration Level bears to all such Participants' excess Compensation for the Plan Year but not in excess of 3%. (c) Third, any remaining contributions and forfeitures will be allocated in the ratio that the sum of each Participant's Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration Level bears to the sum of all Participants' Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration Level, but not in excess of the Maximum Profit-Sharing Disparity Rate (defined below). (d) Fourth, any remaining contributions or forfeitures will be allocated in the ratio that each Participant's Compensation for that year bears to all Participants' Compensation for that year. The Maximum Profit-Sharing Disparity Rate is equal to the lesser of: (a) 2.7% or (b) The applicable percentage determined in accordance with the following table: If the Integration Level is (as a % of the applicable the Taxable Wage Base ("TWB")). percentage is: 20% (or $10,000 if greater) or less of the TWB 2.7% More than 20% (but not less than $10,001) but not more -16- than 80% of the TWB 1.3% More than 80% but not less than 100% of the TWB 2.4% 100% of the TWB 2.7% C. Participants Eligible for Employer Contribution Allocation The following Participants shall be eligible for an allocation to their Employer Contributions Account (select all those applicable): / / (1) Any Participant who was employed during the Plan Year. / / (2) In the case of a Plan using the hourly record method for determining Vesting Service, any Participant who was credited with a Year of Service during the Plan Year. / / (3) Any Participant who was employed on the last day of the Plan Year. / / (4) Any Participant who was on a leave of absence on the last day of the Plan Year. / / (5) Any Participant who during the Plan Year died or became Disabled while an Employee or terminated employment after attaining Normal Retirement Age. / / (6) Any Participant who was credited with at least 501 Hours of Service whether or not employed on the last day of the Plan Year. / / (7) Any Participant who was credited with at least 1,000 Hours of Service and was employed on the last day of the Plan Year. ARTICLE V. Thrift Contributions THIS ARTICLE V IS NOT APPLICABLE A. Employee Thrift Contributions If selected below, Employee Thrift Contributions, which are required for Matching Thrift Contributions, may be made by a Participant in an amount equal to (select one): -17- / / (1) A dollar amount or a percentage of the Participant's Compensation which may not be less than ___% nor may not exceed ___% of his or her Compensation. / / (2) An amount not less than __ % of and not more __ than % of each Participant's Compensation. B. Making and modifying an Employee Thrift Contribution Election A Participant shall be entitled to increase, decrease or resume his or her Employee Thrift Contribution percentage with the following frequency during the Plan Year (select one): / / (1) annually. / / (2) semi-annually. / / (3) quarterly. / / (4) monthly. / / (5) other (specify): ________. Any such increase, decrease or resumption shall be effective as of the first payroll period coincident with or next following the first day of each period set forth above. A Participant may completely discontinue making Employee Thrift Contributions at any time effective for the payroll period after written notice is provided to the Administrator. C. Thrift Matching Contributions If selected below, the Employer will make Matching Thrift Contributions for each Plan Year (select one): / / (1) Discretionary Formula: A discretionary Matching Thrift Contribution equal to such a dollar amount or percentage as determined by the Employer, which shall be allocated (select one): / / (a) based on the ratio of each Participant's Employee Thrift Contribution for the Plan Year to the total Employee Thrift Contributions of all Participants for the Plan Year. If inserted, Matching Thrift Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $_____ for each Participant or ___ % of each Participant's Compensation. / / (b) in an amount not to exceed ____% of each Participant's first ___% of Compensation contributed as Employee Thrift Contributions for the Plan Year. If any Matching Thrift Contribution remains, it is allocated to -18- each such Participant in an amount not to exceed ____% of the next ___% of each Participant's Compensation contributed as Employee Thrift Contributions for the Plan Year. Any remaining Matching Thrift Contribution shall be allocated to each such Participant in the ratio that such Participant's Employee Thrift Contributions for the Plan Year bears to the total Employee Thrift Contributions of all such Participants for the Plan Year. If inserted, Matching Thrift Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $______ for each Participant or ___% of each Participant's Compensation. / / (2) Nondiscretionary Formula: A nondiscretionary Matching Thrift Contribution for each Plan Year equal to (select one): / / (a) ___% of each Participant's Compensation contributed as Employee Thrift Contributions. If inserted, Matching Thrift Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $_______ for each Participant or ___% of each Participant's Compensation. / / (b) ___% of the first ___% of the Participant's Compensation contributed as Employee Thrift Contributions and ___% of the next ___% of the Participant's Compensation contributed as Employee Thrift Contributions. If inserted, Matching Thrift Contributions shall be subject to a maximum amount of $_______ for each Participant or ___% of each Participant's Compensation. D. Qualified Matching Contributions If selected below, the Employer may make Qualified Matching Contributions for each Plan Year (select all those applicable): (1) In its discretion, the Employer may make Qualified Matching Contributions on behalf of (select one): / / (a) all Participants who make Employee Thrift Contributions. / / (b) only those Participants who are Nonhighly Compensated Employees and who make Employee Thrift Contributions. -19- (2) Qualified Matching Contributions will be contributed and allocated to each Participant in an amount equal to: / / (a) ___% of the Participant's Employee Thrift Contributions. If inserted, Qualified Matching Contributions shall not exceed ___% of the Participant's Compensation. / / (b) such an amount, determined by the Employer, which is needed to meet the ACP Test. ARTICLE VI. Participant Contributions Participant Voluntary Nondeductible Contributions Participant Voluntary Nondeductible Contributions are (select one): / / (a) permitted. /x/ (b) not permitted. ARTICLE VII. Vesting A. Employer Contribution Accounts (1) A Participant shall have a vested percentage in his or her Profit-Sharing Contributions, Matching 401(k) Contributions and/or Matching Thrift Contributions, if applicable, in accordance with the following schedule (Select one): Matching 401(k) and/or Matching Thrift Profit-Sharing Contributions Contributions - --------------- -------------- / / / / (a) 100% vesting immediately upon participation. /x/ / / (b) 100% after 5 (not more than 5) years of Vesting Service. / / / / (c) Graded vesting schedule: -20- ____% ____% after 1 year of Vesting Service; ____% ____% after 2 years of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 20%) after 3 years of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 40%) after 4 years of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 60%) after 5 years of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 80%) after 6 years of Vesting Service; 100% after 7 years of Vesting Service. (2) Top Heavy Plan Matching 401(k) and/or Matching Thrift Profit-Sharing Contributions Contributions - --------------- -------------- Vesting Schedule (Select one): / / / / (a) 100% vesting immediately upon participation. /x/ / / (b) 100% after 3 (not more than 3) years of Vesting Service. / / / / (c) Graded vesting schedule: ____% ____% after 1 year of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 20%) after 2 years of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 40%) after 3 years of Vesting Service; -21- ____% ____% (not less than 60%) after 4 years of Vesting Service; ____% ____% (not less than 80%) after 5 years of Vesting Service; 100% after 6 years of Vesting Service Top Heavy Ratio: (a) If the adopting Employer maintains or has ever maintained a qualified defined benefit plan, for purposes of establishing present value to compute the top-heavy ratio, any benefit shall be discounted only for mortality and interest based on the following: Interest Rate: 8% Mortality Table: UP '84 (b) For purposes of computing the top-heavy ratio, the valuation date shall be the last business day of each Plan Year. B. Allocation Of Forfeitures Forfeitures shall be (select one from each applicable column): Matching 401(k) and/or Matching Thrift Profit-Sharing Contributions Contributions - --------------- -------------- /x/ / / (1) used to reduce Employer contributions for succeeding Plan Year. / / / / (2) allocated in the succeeding Plan Year in the ratio which the Compensation of each Participant for the Plan Year bears to the total Compensation of all Participants entitled to share in the Contributions. If the Plan is integrated with Social Security, forfeitures shall be allocated in accordance with the formula elected by the Employer. -22- C. Vesting Service For purposes of determining Years of Service for Vesting Service [select (1) or (2) and/or (3)]: / / (1) All Years of Service shall be included. /x/ (2) Years of Service before the Participant attained age 18 shall be excluded. / / (3) Service with the Employer prior to the effective date of the Plan shall be excluded. ARTICLE VIII. Deferral of Benefit Distributions, In-Service Withdrawals and Loans A. Deferral of Benefit Distributions 401(k) and/ Profit- or Thrift Sharing ----------- ------- / / / / If this item is checked, a Participant's vested benefit in his or her Employer Accounts shall be payable as soon as practicable after the earlier of: (1) the date the Participant terminates Employment due to Disability or (2) the end of the Plan Year in which a terminated Participant attains Early Retirement Age, if applicable, or Normal Retirement Age. B. In-Service Distributions /x/ (1) In-service distributions may be made from any of the Participant's vested Accounts, at any time upon or after the occurrence of the following events (select all applicable): /x/ (a) a Participant's attainment of age 59-1/2. /x/ (b) due to hardships as defined in Section 5.9 of the Plan. / / (2) In-service distributions are not permitted. C. Loans are: 401(k) and/ Profit- -23- or Thrift Sharing ----------- ------- /x/ / / (1) permitted. / / / / (2) not permitted. ARTICLE IX. Group Trust / / If this item is checked, the Employer elects to establish a Group Trust consisting of such Plan assets as shall from time to time be transferred to the Trustee pursuant to Article X of the Plan. The Trust Fund shall be a Group Trust consisting of assets of this Plan plus assets of the following plans of the Employer or of an Affiliate: ARTICLE X. MISCELLANEOUS A. Identification of Sponsor The address and telephone number of the Sponsor's authorized representative is 800 Scudders Mill Road, Plainsboro, New Jersey 08536; (609) 282-2272. This authorized representative can answer inquiries regarding the adoption of the Plan, the intended meaning of any Plan provisions, and the effect of the opinion letter. The Sponsor will inform the adopting Employer of any amendments made to the Plan or the discontinuance or abandonment of the Plan. B. Plan Registration 1. Initial Registration This Plan must be registered with the Sponsor, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, in order to be considered a Prototype Plan by the Sponsor. Registration is required so that the Sponsor is able to provide the Administrator with documents, forms and announcements relating to the administration of the Plan and with Plan amendments and other documents, all of which relate to administering the Plan in accordance with applicable law and maintaining compliance of the Plan with the law. The Employer must complete and sign the Adoption Agreement. Upon receipt of the Adoption Agreement, the Plan will be registered as a Prototype Plan of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated. The Adoption Agreement will be -24- countersigned by an authorized representative and a copy of the countersigned Adoption Agreement will be returned to the Employer. 2. Registration Renewal Annual registration renewal is required in order for the Employer to continue to receive any and all necessary updating documents. There is an annual registration renewal fee in the amount set forth with the initial registration material. The adopting Employer authorizes Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, to debit the account established for the Plan for payment of agreed upon annual fee; provided, however, if the assets of an account are invested solely in Participant-Directed Assets, a notice for this annual fee will be sent to the Employer annually. The Sponsor reserves the right to change this fee from time to time and will provide written notice in advance of any change. C. Prototype Replacement Plan This Adoption Agreement is a replacement prototype plan for the (1) Merrill Lynch Special Prototype Defined Contribution Plan and Trust - 401(k) Plan #03-004 and (2) Merrill Lynch Asset Management, Inc., Special Prototype Defined Contribution Plan and Trust - 401(k) Plan Adoption Agreement #03-004. D. Reliance The adopting Employer may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is qualified under Code Section 401. In order to obtain reliance, the Employer must apply to the appropriate Key District Director of the Internal Revenue Service for a determination letter with respect to the Plan. -25- EMPLOYER'S SIGNATURE Name of Employer: The Children's Place ------------------------- By: -------------------------------------- Authorized Signature Seth Udasin ------------------------- Print Name Chief Financial Officer ------------------------- Title Dated: , 19 ----------------------- -- TO BE COMPLETED BY MERRILL LYNCH: Sponsor Acceptance: Subject to the terms and conditions of the Prototype Plan and this Adoption Agreement, this Adoption Agreement is accepted by Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated as the Prototype Sponsor. Authorized Signature: ------------------------- -26- TRUSTEE(S) SIGNATURE This Trustee Acceptance is to be completed only if the Employer appoints one-or more Trustees and does not appoint a Merrill Lynch Trust Company as Trustee. The undersigned hereby accept all of the terms, conditions, and obligations of appointment as Trustee under the Plan. If the Employer has elected a Group Trust in this Adoption Agreement, the undersigned Trustee(s) shall be the Trustee(s) of the Group Trust. AS TRUSTEE: - ------------------------------ ------------------------------ (Signature) (print or type name) - ------------------------------ ------------------------------ (Signature) (print or type name) - ------------------------------ ------------------------------ (Signature) (print or type name) - ------------------------------ ------------------------------ (Signature) (print or type name) Dated: , 19 ----------------------- -- -27- THE MERRILL LYNCH TRUST COMPANIES AS TRUSTEE This Trustee Acceptance and designation of Investment Committee are to be completed only when a Merrill Lynch Trust Company is appointed as Trustee. To be completed by the Employer: Designation Of Investment Committee The Investment Committee for the Plan is (print or type names): Name: Seth Udasin ---------------------- Name: Steven Balasiano ---------------------- Name: Laurel Anderson ---------------------- Name: ---------------------- To be completed by Merrill Lynch Trust Company: Acceptance By Trustee: The undersigned hereby accept all of the terms, conditions, and obligations of appointment as Trustee under the Plan. If the Employer has elected a Group Trust in this Adoption Agreement, the undersigned Trustee(s) shall be the Trustee(s) of the Group Trust. SEAL MERRILL LYNCH TRUST COMPANY [ ] By: ------------------------- Dated: , 19 ----------------------- -- -28- THE MERRILL LYNCH TRUST COMPANIES AS ONE OF THE TRUSTEES This Trustee Acceptance is to be completed only if, in addition to a Merrill Lynch Trust Companies as Trustee, the Employer appoints an additional Trustee of a second trust fund. The undersigned hereby accept all of the terms, conditions, and obligations of appointment as Trustee under the Plan. If the Employer has elected a Group Trust in this Adoption Agreement, the undersigned Trustee(s) shall be the Trustee(s) of the Group Trust. as TRUSTEE - ------------------------------ ------------------------------ (Signature) (print or type name) Dated: , 19 ----------------------- -- SEAL MERRILL LYNCH TRUST COMPANY [ ] ---------------------------- Dated: , 19 ----------------------- -- Designation Of Investment Committee The Investment Committee for the Plan is (print or type names): Name: ------------------------------------------------------ Name: ------------------------------------------------------ Name: ------------------------------------------------------ Name: ------------------------------------------------------ -29- Intellectual Property Set forth below is a list of all the trademarks and trade names owned by The Children's Place. In the event that you create a new mark or design, it is imperative that we do a trademark and/or copyright search to assure that the mark is available for our use. Using an unauthorized mark can potentially cause the Company unnecessary cost and expense. 1. Authentic Tiny Sweats & Design 2. Authentic Tiny Tee & Design 3. Authentic Tiny Tee 4. Authentic Tiny Tank & Design 5. The Place (Trademark/Service Mark) 6. The Children's Place plus Design 7. The Children's Place 8. The Children's Place (in stylized letters) 9. The Children's Outlet 10. The Children's Outlet (New York) 11. Pure Sweats 12. TP Co. 13. Not So Basic Stuff 14. Rattles 15. The Children's Market 16. The Children's Market (Illinois) 17. Sunshine Stuff 18. Baby Place -30- 19. TCP (stylized) - Jewelry Pending Application 1. Simple Sizing 2. TCP (stylized) - Clothing 3. TCP (stylized) - backpacks and handbags 4. The Children's Place Outlet 5. Place - Clothing 6. Design of the letter P in a circle - clothing -31-


                                                                  Exhibit 10.6


                                 AMENDED AND RESTATED
                             LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT


                                    by and between


                       THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.


                                         and


                             FOOTHILL CAPITAL CORPORATION


                              Dated as of July 31, 1997





                                  TABLE OF CONTENTS


                                                                            Page

1.   DEFINITIONS AND CONSTRUCTION..........................................   1
     1.1  Definitions......................................................   1
     1.2  Accounting Terms.................................................   9
     1.3  Code.............................................................  10
     1.4  Construction.....................................................  10
     1.5  Schedules and Exhibits...........................................  10

2.   LOAN AND TERMS OF PAYMENT.............................................  10
     2.1  Revolving Advances...............................................  10
     2.2  Letters of Credit and Letter of Credit Guarantees................  11
     2.3  Intentionally Omitted............................................  12
     2.4  Overadvances.....................................................  12
     2.5  Interest:  Rates, Payments, and Calculations.....................  13
     2.6  Crediting Payments; Application of Collections...................  14
     2.7  Statements of Obligations........................................  14
     2.8  Fees.............................................................  14

3.   CONDITIONS; TERM OF AGREEMENT.........................................  15
     3.1  Conditions Precedent to Initial Advance, L/C, or L/C Guaranty....  15
     3.2  Conditions Precedent to All Advances, L/Cs, or L/C Guarantees....  16
     3.3  Term; Automatic Renewal..........................................  16
     3.4  Effect of Termination............................................  16
     3.5  Early Termination by Borrower....................................  17

4.   CREATION OF SECURITY INTEREST.........................................  17
     4.1  Grant of Security Interest.......................................  17
     4.2  Negotiable Collateral............................................  17
     4.3  Collection of Accounts, General Intangibles, Negotiable 
            Collateral.....................................................  17
     4.4  Delivery of Additional Documentation Required....................  18
     4.5  Power of Attorney................................................  18
     4.6  Right to Inspect.................................................  18

5.   REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES........................................  19
     5.1  No Prior Encumbrances............................................  19
     5.2  Eligible Accounts................................................  19
     5.3  Eligible Inventory...............................................  19
     5.4  Location of Inventory and Equipment..............................  19
     5.5  Inventory Records................................................  19
     5.6  Location of Chief Executive Office; FEIN.........................  19

                                      -i-




                                                                            Page

     5.7  Due Organization and Qualification...............................  19
     5.8  Due Authorization; No Conflict...................................  20
     5.9  Litigation.......................................................  20
     5.10 No Material Adverse Change in Financial Condition................  20
     5.11 Ability to Meet Obligations......................................  20
     5.12 Employee Benefits................................................  20
     5.13 Environmental Condition..........................................  21
     5.14 Reliance by Foothill; Cumulative.................................  21

6.   AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS.................................................  21
     6.1  Accounting System................................................  22
     6.2  Collateral and Financial Reports.................................  22
     6.3  Schedules of Accounts............................................  22
     6.4  Financial Statements, Reports, Certificates......................  22
     6.5  Tax Returns......................................................  23
     6.6  Designation of Inventory.........................................  23
     6.7  Store Openings and Closings and Rent Reports.....................  23
     6.8  Landlord Waivers.................................................  24
     6.9  Title to Equipment...............................................  24
     6.10 Maintenance of Equipment.........................................  24
     6.11 Taxes............................................................  24
     6.12 Insurance........................................................  24
     6.13 Financial Covenants..............................................  25
     6.14 No Setoffs or Counterclaims......................................  26
     6.15 Location of Inventory and Equipment..............................  26
     6.16 Compliance with Laws.............................................  26
     6.17 Employee Benefits................................................  27

7.   NEGATIVE COVENANTS....................................................  27
     7.1  Indebtedness.....................................................  27
     7.2  Liens............................................................  28
     7.3  Restrictions on Fundamental Changes..............................  28
     7.4  Extraordinary Transactions and Disposal of Assets................  28
     7.5  Change Name......................................................  28
     7.6  Guarantee........................................................  28
     7.7  Restructure......................................................  28
     7.8  Prepayments......................................................  28
     7.9  Change of Control................................................  28
     7.10 Capital Expenditures.............................................  28
     7.11 Consignments.....................................................  29
     7.12 Distributions....................................................  29
     7.13 Accounting Methods...............................................  29
     7.14 Advances, Investments and Loans..................................  29

                                     -ii-




     7.15 Transactions with Affiliates.....................................  29
     7.16 Suspension.......................................................  29
     7.17 Compensation.....................................................  29
     7.18 Use of Proceeds..................................................  29
     7.19 Change in Location of Chief Executive Office; Inventory and 
            Equipment with Bailees.........................................  30

8.   EVENTS OF DEFAULT.....................................................  30

9.   FOOTHILL'S RIGHTS AND REMEDIES........................................  32
     9.1  Rights and Remedies..............................................  32
     9.2  Remedies Cumulative..............................................  34

10.  TAXES AND EXPENSES REGARDING THE COLLATERAL...........................  34

11.  WAIVERS; INDEMNIFICATION..............................................  34
     11.1 Demand; Protest; etc.............................................  34
     11.2 Foothill's Liability for Collateral..............................  35
     11.3 Indemnification..................................................  35

12.  NOTICES...............................................................  35

13.  CHOICE OF LAW AND VENUE; JURY TRIAL WAIVER............................  36

14.  DESTRUCTION OF BORROWER'S DOCUMENTS...................................  37

15.  GENERAL PROVISIONS....................................................  37
     15.1 Effectiveness....................................................  37
     15.2 Successors and Assigns...........................................  37
     15.3 Section Headings.................................................  37
     15.4 Interpretation...................................................  37
     15.5 Severability of Provisions.......................................  38
     15.6 Amendments in Writing............................................  38
     15.7 Counterparts; Telefacsimile Execution............................  38
     15.8 Revival and Reinstatement of Obligations.........................  38
     15.9 Integration......................................................  38

                                    -iii-




                                                                            Page

     SCHEDULES

     Schedule E-1     Eligible Inventory
     Schedule P-1     Permitted Liens
     Schedule 5.13    Environmental Condition
     Schedule 6.15    Location of Inventory and Equipment

                                     -iv-



               AMENDED AND RESTATED LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT


     This AMENDED AND RESTATED LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT, is entered into 
as of July 31, 1997, between FOOTHILL CAPITAL CORPORATION, a California 
corporation ("Foothill"), with a place of business located at 11111 Santa 
Monica Boulevard, Suite 1500, Los Angeles, California 90025-3333, and THE 
CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC., a Delaware corporation ("Borrower"), 
with its chief executive office located at One Dodge Drive, West Caldwell, 
New Jersey 07006.

     A.   Borrower and Foothill entered into that certain Loan and Security 
Agreement, dated as of April 12, 1995 (as amended by Amendments One through 
Five dated June 1, 1995, August 29, 1995, December 1, 1995, February 15, 
1996, and May 1, 1996, respectively, the "1995 Loan Agreement").

     B.   Borrower and Foothill wish to amend and restate in its entirety the 
1995 Loan Agreement, as provided in this Agreement.

     The parties agree that the 1995 Loan Agreement is restated as follows:

     1.   DEFINITIONS AND CONSTRUCTION.

          1.1  Definitions.  As used in this Agreement, the following terms
shall have the following definitions:

          "Account Debtor" means any Person who is or who may become obligated
under, with respect to, or on account of an Account.

          "Accounts" means all currently existing and hereafter arising
accounts, contract rights, Revolving Accounts, and all other forms of
obligations owing to Borrower arising out of the sale or lease of goods or the
rendition of services by Borrower, irrespective of whether earned by
performance, and any and all credit insurance, guaranties, or security therefor.

          "Affiliate" means, as applied to any Person, any other Person 
directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by, or under common control 
with, that Person.  For purposes of this definition, "control" as applied to 
any Person means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to 
direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of that Person, 
whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract, or otherwise.

          "Agreement" means this Amended and Restated Loan and Security 
Agreement and any extensions, riders supplements, notes, amendments, or 
modifications to or in connection with this Amended and Restated Loan and 
Security Agreement.

          "Authorized Officer" means any officer of Borrower.

                                          1


          "Bankruptcy Code" means the United States Bankruptcy Code (11 
U.S.C. Section  101 et seq.), as amended, and any successor statute.

          "Borrower" has the meaning set forth in the preamble to this 
Agreement.

          "Borrower's Books" means all of Borrower's books and records 
including:  ledgers; records indicating, summarizing, or evidencing 
Borrower's properties or assets (including the Collateral) or liabilities; 
all information relating to Borrower's business operations or financial 
condition; and all computer programs, disc or tape files, printouts, runs, or 
other computer prepared information, and the equipment containing such 
information.

          "Borrower's Cost" means Borrower's retail selling price for 
Inventory multiplied by Borrower's weighted cost of goods sold for the 
rolling twelve (12) month period ending on the last day of the Fiscal Month 
immediately prior to the date of calculation expressed as a percentage of 
Borrower's Net Sales for such period.

          "Borrowing Base" has the meaning set forth in Section 2.1.

          "Business Day" means any day which is not a Saturday, Sunday, or 
other day on which national banks are authorized or required to close.

          "Change of Control" shall be deemed to have occurred at such time 
as Borrower's existing shareholders cease to be the "beneficial owners" (as 
defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934), directly or 
indirectly, of more than 50% of the total voting power of all classes of 
stock then outstanding of Borrower normally entitled to vote in the election 
of directors.

          "Closing Date" means the date of the initial advance or the date of 
the initial issuance of an L/C or an L/C Guaranty, whichever occurs first.

          "Code" means the California Uniform Commercial Code.

          "Collateral" means each of the following: the Accounts; Borrower's 
Books; the Equipment; the General Intangibles; the Inventory; the Negotiable 
Collateral; any money, or other assets of Borrower which now or hereafter 
come into the possession, custody, or control of Foothill; and the proceeds 
and products, whether tangible or intangible, of any of the foregoing 
including proceeds of insurance covering any or all of the Collateral, and 
any and all Accounts, Borrower's Books, Equipment, General Intangibles, 
Inventory, Negotiable Collateral, money, deposit accounts, or other tangible 
or intangible property resulting from the sale, exchange, collection, or 
other disposition of any of the foregoing, or any portion thereof or interest 
therein, and the proceeds thereof. 

          "Consolidated Current Assets" means, as of any date of 
determination, the aggregate amount of all current assets of Borrower and its 
subsidiaries calculated on a 

                                          2


consolidated basis that would, in accordance with GAAP, be classified on a 
balance sheet as current assets.

          "Consolidated Current Liabilities" means, as of any date of 
determination, the aggregate amount of all current liabilities of Borrower 
and its subsidiaries, calculated on a consolidated basis that would, in 
accordance with GAAP, be classified on a balance sheet as current 
liabilities.  For purposes of this definition, all advances outstanding under 
this Agreement shall be deemed to be current liabilities without regard to 
whether they would be deemed to be so under GAAP.

          "Daily Balance" means the amount of an Obligation owed at the end 
of a given day.

          "EBITDA" for a period means the consolidated net income of the 
Borrower and its Subsidiaries (excluding extraordinary items) for the period 
(a) plus all interest expense, income tax expense, depreciation and 
amortization (including amortization of any goodwill or other intangibles) 
for the period, (b) less gains and losses attributable to any fixed asset 
sales in the period and (c) plus or minus any other non-cash charges which 
have been subtracted or added in calculating consolidated net income for the 
period.

          "Eligible Accounts" means those Accounts created by Borrower in the 
ordinary course of business that arise out of Borrower's sale of goods or 
rendition of services, that strictly comply with all of Borrower's 
representations and warranties to Foothill, and that are and at all times 
shall continue to be reasonably acceptable to Foothill in all respects; 
provided, however, that standards of eligibility may be fixed and revised 
from time to time by Foothill in Foothill's reasonable credit judgment.  
Eligible Accounts shall not include the following:

               (a)  Accounts that the Account Debtor has failed to pay within 
ninety (90) days of invoice date and all Accounts owed by an Account Debtor 
that has failed to pay fifty percent (50%) or more of its Accounts owed to 
Borrower within ninety (90) days of invoice date;

               (b)  Accounts with respect to which the Account Debtor is an 
officer, employee, Affiliate, or agent of Borrower;

               (c)  Accounts with respect to which the Account Debtor is not 
a resident of the United States;

               (d)  Accounts with respect to which the Account Debtor is the 
United States or any department, agency, or instrumentality of the United 
States;

               (e)  Accounts with respect to which Borrower is or may become 
liable to the Account Debtor for goods sold or services rendered by the 
Account Debtor to Borrower, to the extent of such liability;

               (f)  Accounts with respect to which the Account Debtor 
disputes liability or makes any claim with respect thereto, or is subject to 
any Insolvency Proceeding, or becomes insolvent, or goes out of business; and

                                          3




               (g)  Accounts the collection of which Foothill, in its 
reasonable credit judgment, believes to be doubtful by reason of the Account 
Debtor's financial condition.

          "Eligible Inventory" means Inventory consisting of first quality 
finished goods held for sale in the ordinary course of Borrower's business, 
that is reasonably acceptable to Foothill in all respects, that is located at 
Borrower's premises identified on Schedule E-1 or that is in transit to 
Borrower if: (a) title to such Inventory has been transferred to Borrower, 
(b) the Inventory is insured to Foothill's reasonable satisfaction and (c) 
documentation regarding such Inventory is reasonably acceptable to Foothill, 
and such Inventory strictly complies with all of Borrower's representations 
and warranties to Foothill.  If Eligible Inventory is in transit to Borrower 
and has been acquired pursuant to a Foothill L/C or L/C Guarantee, the L/C or 
L/C Guarantee must have been drawn upon.  Eligible Inventory shall not 
include slow moving Inventory (as determined in Foothill's reasonable 
business judgment based upon industry practices), or obsolete items, 
restrictive or custom items, raw materials, work-in-process, components that 
are not part of finished goods, spare parts, packaging and shipping 
materials, supplies used or consumed in Borrower's business, Inventory 
subject to a security interest or lien in favor of any third Person, bill and 
hold goods, Inventory that is not subject to Foothill's perfected security 
interests, defective goods (except for minor defects that do not affect 
saleability), "seconds," and Inventory acquired on consignment.

          "Equipment" means all of Borrower's present and hereafter acquired 
machinery, machine tools, motors, equipment, furniture, furnishings, 
fixtures, vehicles (including motor vehicles and trailers), tools, parts, 
dies, jigs, goods (other than consumer goods, farm products, or Inventory), 
wherever located, and any interest of Borrower in any of the foregoing, and 
all attachments, accessories, accessions, replacements, substitutions, 
additions, and improvements to any of the foregoing, wherever located.

          "ERISA" means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, 
as amended from time to time, or any predecessor, successor, or superseding 
laws of the United States of America, together with all regulations 
promulgated thereunder.

          "ERISA Affiliate" means any trade or business (whether or not 
incorporated) which, within the meaning of Section 414 of the IRC, is: (i) 
under common control with Borrower; (ii) treated, together with Borrower, as 
a single employer; (iii) treated as a member of an affiliated service group 
of which Borrower is also treated as a member; or (iv) is otherwise 
aggregated with the Borrower for purposes of the employee benefits 
requirements listed in IRC Section 414(m)(4).

          "ERISA Event" means any one or more of the following:  (i) a 
Reportable Event with respect to a Qualified Plan or a Multiemployer Plan; 
(ii) a Prohibited Transaction with respect to any Plan; (iii) a complete or 
partial withdrawal by Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate from a Multiemployer 
Plan; (iv) the complete or partial withdrawal of Borrower or an ERISA 
Affiliate from a Qualified Plan during a plan year in which it was, or was 
treated as, a "substantial employer" as defined in Section 4001(a)(2) of 
ERISA; (v) a failure to make full payment when due of all amounts which, 
under the provisions of any Plan or applicable law,

                                          4



Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate is required to make; (vi) the filing of a 
notice of intent to terminate, or the treatment of a plan amendment as a 
termination, under Sections 4041 or 4041A of ERISA; (vii) an event or 
condition which might reasonably be expected to constitute grounds under 
Section 4042 of ERISA for the termination of, or the appointment of a trustee 
to administer, any Qualified Plan or Multiemployer Plan; (viii) the 
imposition of any liability under Title IV of ERISA, other than PBGC premiums 
due but not delinquent under Section 4007 of ERISA, upon Borrower or any 
ERISA Affiliate; and (ix) a violation of the applicable requirements of 
Sections 404 or 405 of ERISA, or the exclusive benefit rule under Section 
403(c) of ERISA, by any fiduciary or disqualified person with respect to any 
Plan for which Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate may be directly or indirectly 
liable.

          "Event of Default" has the meaning set forth in Section 8.

          "FEIN" means Federal Employer Identification Number.

          "Fiscal Month" means months computed on the retail basis of four 
(4) weeks, five (5) weeks and four (4) weeks per fiscal quarter.

          "Fiscal Year" means a retail year ending on the Saturday closest to 
January 31.

          "Foothill" has the meaning set forth in the preamble to this 
Agreement.

          "Foothill Expenses" means all:  reasonable costs or expenses 
(including taxes, photocopying, notarization, telecommunication and insurance 
premiums) required to be paid by Borrower under any of the Loan Documents 
that are paid or advanced by Foothill; documentation, filing, recording, 
publication, appraisal (including periodic Collateral appraisals), 
environmental audit, and search fees assessed, paid, or incurred by Foothill 
in connection with Foothill's transactions with Borrower; costs and expenses 
incurred by Foothill in the disbursement of funds to Borrower (by wire 
transfer or otherwise); charges paid or incurred by Foothill resulting from 
the dishonor of checks; costs and expenses paid or incurred by Foothill to 
correct any default or enforce any provision of the Loan Documents, or in 
gaining possession of, maintaining, handling, preserving, storing, shipping, 
selling, preparing for sale, or advertising to sell the Collateral, or any 
portion thereof, irrespective of whether a sale is consummated; costs and 
expenses paid or incurred by Foothill in examining Borrower's Books; costs 
and expenses of third party claims or any other suit paid or incurred by 
Foothill in enforcing or defending the Loan Documents; and Foothill's 
reasonable attorneys fees and expenses incurred in advising, structuring, 
drafting, reviewing, administering, amending, terminating, enforcing, 
defending, or concerning the Loan Documents (including attorneys fees and 
expenses incurred in connection with a "workout," a "restructuring," or an 
Insolvency Proceeding concerning Borrower or any guarantor of the 
Obligations), irrespective of whether suit is brought. Foothill Expenses 
payable to third Persons shall not be marked up by Foothill.

                                          5



          "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles as in effect 
from time to time in the United States, consistently applied.

          "General Intangibles" means all of Borrower's present and future 
general intangibles and other personal property (including contract rights, 
rights arising under common law, statutes, or regulations, choses or things 
in action, goodwill, patents, trade names, trademarks, servicemarks, 
copyrights, blueprints, drawings, purchase orders, customer lists, monies due 
or recoverable from pension funds, route lists, rights to payment and other 
rights under any royalty or licensing agreements, infringements, claims, 
computer programs, computer discs, computer tapes, literature, reports, 
catalogs, deposit accounts, insurance premium rebates, tax refunds, and tax 
refund claims), other than goods and Accounts.

          "Hazardous Materials" means all or any of the following: (a) 
substances that are defined or listed in, or otherwise classified pursuant 
to, any applicable laws or regulations as "hazardous substances," "hazardous 
materials," "hazardous wastes," "toxic substances," or any other formulation 
intended to define, list, or classify substances by reason of deleterious 
properties such as ignitability, corrosivity, reactivity, carcinogenicity, 
reproductive toxicity, or "EP toxicity"; (b) oil, petroleum, or petroleum 
derived substances, natural gas, natural gas liquids, synthetic gas, drilling 
fluids, produced waters, and other wastes associated with the exploration, 
development, or production of crude oil, natural gas, or geothermal 
resources; (c) any flammable substances or explosives or any radioactive 
materials; and (d) asbestos in any form or electrical equipment which 
contains any oil or dielectric fluid containing levels of polychlorinated 
biphenyls in excess of fifty (50) parts per million.

          "Indebtedness" means:  (a) all obligations of Borrower for borrowed 
money; (b) all obligations of Borrower evidenced by bonds, debentures, notes, 
or other similar instruments and all reimbursement or other obligations of 
Borrower in respect of letters of credit, letter of credit guaranties, 
bankers acceptances, interest rate swaps, controlled disbursement accounts, 
or other financial products; (c) all obligations under capitalized leases; 
(d) all obligations or liabilities of others secured by a lien or security 
interest on any property or asset of Borrower, irrespective of whether such 
obligation or liability is assumed; and (e) any obligation of Borrower 
guaranteeing or intended to guarantee (whether guaranteed, endorsed, co-made, 
discounted, or sold with recourse to Borrower) any indebtedness, lease, 
dividend, letter of credit, or other obligation of any other Person.

          "Insolvency Proceeding" means any proceeding commenced by or 
against any Person under any provision of the Bankruptcy Code or under any 
other bankruptcy or insolvency law, including assignments for the benefit of 
creditors, formal or informal moratoria, compositions, extensions generally 
with its creditors, or proceedings seeking reorganization, arrangement, or 
other similar relief.

          "Inventory" means all present and future inventory in which 
Borrower has any interest, including but not limited to children's shorts, 
tops, shirts, overalls, and bathing suits and other goods held for sale or 
lease or to be furnished under a contract of service and all of 

                                          6


Borrower's present and future raw materials, work in process, finished goods, 
and packing and shipping materials, wherever located, and any documents of 
title representing any of the above.

          "IPO" means Borrower's initial public offering of shares of its 
Common Stock, $.10 par value, pursuant to that certain S-1 Registration 
Statement filed by Borrower with the Securities and Exchange Commission on 
July 18, 1997, as amended from time to time.

          "IRC" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the 
regulations thereunder.

          "L/C" has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2(a).

          "L/C Guaranty" has the meaning set forth in Section 2.2(a).

          "Libor Supplement" means that certain Libor Supplement to Amended 
and Restated Loan and Security Agreement between Borrower and Foothill dated 
as of July 31, 1997.

          "Loan Documents" means this Agreement, the Lock Box Agreements, the 
Security Agreement (Trademark and Service Marks), any note or notes executed 
by Borrower and payable to Foothill, and any other agreement entered into in 
connection with this Agreement.

          "Lock Box" has the meaning provided in the respective Lock Box 
Agreements.

          "Lock Box Agreements" means those certain Blocked Depository 
Account Agreements, in form and substance satisfactory to Foothill, each of 
which is among Borrower, Foothill, and one of the Lock Box Banks.

          "Lock Box Banks" means First Fidelity Bank, N.A., New Jersey or any 
replacement bank chosen by Borrower and approved by Foothill.

          "Maximum Amount" has the meaning set forth in Section 2.1.

          "Multiemployer Plan" means a multiemployer plan as defined in 
Sections 3(37) or 4001(a)(3) of ERISA or Section 414 of the IRC in which 
employees of Borrower or an ERISA Affiliate participate or to which Borrower 
or any ERISA Affiliate contribute or are required to contribute.

          "Negotiable Collateral" means all of Borrower's present and future 
letters of credit, notes, drafts, instruments, certificated and 
uncertificated securities (including the shares of stock of subsidiaries of 
Borrower), investment property, security entitlements, documents, personal 
property leases (wherein Borrower is the lessor), chattel paper, and 
Borrower's Books relating to any of the foregoing.

          "Net Sales" means Borrower's gross sales less discounts, returns 
and similar adjustments.

          "Obligations" means all loans, advances, debts, principal, interest
(including any interest that, but for the provisions of the Bankruptcy Code,
would have accrued), contingent reimbursement obligations owing to Foothill
under any outstanding L/Cs or L/C Guarantees, premiums, liabilities (including
all amounts charged to Borrower's loan account pursuant to any agreement
authorizing Foothill to charge Borrower's loan account), obligations, fees,
lease payments, guaranties, covenants, and duties owing by 

                                          7



Borrower to Foothill of any kind and description (whether pursuant to or 
evidenced by the Loan Documents, by any note or other instrument, or pursuant 
to any other agreement between Foothill and Borrower, and irrespective of 
whether for the payment of money), whether direct or indirect, absolute or 
contingent, due or to become due, now existing or hereafter arising, and 
including any debt, liability, or obligation owing from Borrower to others 
that Foothill may have obtained by assignment or otherwise, and further 
including all interest not paid when due and all Foothill Expenses that 
Borrower is required to pay or reimburse by the Loan Documents, by law, or 
otherwise.

          "Overadvance" has the meaning set forth in Section 2.4.

          "PBGC" means the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation as defined in 
Title IV of ERISA, or any successor thereto.

          "Permitted Investment" means any Investment permitted under Section 
7.14.

          "Permitted Liens" means: (a) liens and security interests held by 
Foothill; (b) liens for unpaid taxes that are not yet due and payable; (c) 
liens and security interests set forth on Schedule P-1 attached hereto; (d) 
purchase money security interests and liens of lessors under capitalized 
leases to the extent that the acquisition or lease of the underlying asset 
was permitted under Section 7.10, and so long as the security interest or 
lien only secures the purchase price of the asset; (e) easements, rights of 
way, reservations, covenants, conditions, restrictions, zoning variances, and 
other similar encumbrances that do not materially interfere with the use or 
value of the property subject thereto; (f) obligations and duties as lessee 
under any lease existing on the date of this Agreement; (g) mechanics', 
materialmen's, warehousemen's, or similar liens; and (h) lease financing of 
Borrower's presently owned Equipment.

          "Person" means and includes natural persons, corporations, limited 
partnerships, general partnerships, joint ventures, trusts, land trusts, 
business trusts, or other organizations, irrespective of whether they are 
legal entities, and governments and agencies and political subdivisions 
thereof.

          "Plan" means an employee benefit plan (as defined in Section 3(3) 
of ERISA) which Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate sponsors or maintains or to 
which Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate makes, is making, or is obligated to 
make contributions, including any Multiemployer Plan or Qualified Plan.

          "Prohibited Transaction" means any transaction described in Section 
406 of ERISA which is not exempt by reason of Section 408 of ERISA, and any 
transaction described in Section 4975(c) of the IRC which is not exempt by 
reason of Section 4975(c) of the IRC.

          "Qualified Plan" means a pension plan (as defined in Section 3(2) of
ERISA) intended to be tax-qualified under Section 401(a) of the IRC which 
Borrower or any ERISA
                                          8





Affiliate sponsors, maintains, or to which any such person makes, is making, 
or is obligated to make, contributions, or, in the case of a 
multiple-employer plan (as described in Section 4064(a) of ERISA), has made 
contributions at any time during the immediately preceding period covering at 
least five (5) plan years, but excluding any Multiemployer Plan.

          "Reference Rate" means the variable rate of interest, per annum, 
most recently announced by Norwest Bank Minnesota, National Association, or 
any successor thereto, as its "base rate," irrespective of whether such 
announced rate is the best rate available from such financial institution.

          "Renewal Date" has the meaning set forth in Section 3.3.

          "Reportable Event" means any event described in Section 4043 (other 
than Subsections (b)(7) and (b)(9)) of ERISA.

          "Revolving Accounts" means any Account arising from an agreement to 
extend credit on an ongoing basis through the use of a device such as a 
credit card or the like, whether or not subject to regulation under Federal 
Reserve Board Regulation Z, or any state statute or regulation on 
truth-in-lending.

          "Tangible Net Worth" means, as of the date any determination 
thereof is to be made, the difference of: (a) Borrower's total stockholder's 
equity; minus (b) the sum of: (i) all intangible assets of Borrower; (ii) all 
of Borrower's prepaid expenses; and (iii) all amounts due to Borrower from 
Affiliates, calculated on a consolidated basis.

          "Unfunded Benefit Liability" means the excess of a Plan's benefit 
liabilities (as defined in Section 4001(a)(16) of ERISA) over the current 
value of such Plan's assets, determined in accordance with the assumptions 
used by the Plan's actuaries for funding the Plan pursuant to Section 412 of 
the IRC for the applicable plan year.

          "Voidable Transfer" has the meaning set forth in Section 15.8.

          "Working Capital" means the result of subtracting Consolidated 
Current Liabilities from Consolidated Current Assets.

          1.2  Accounting Terms.  All accounting terms not specifically 
defined herein shall be construed in accordance with GAAP.  When used herein, 
the term "financial statements" shall include the notes and schedules 
thereto.  Whenever the term "Borrower" is used in respect of a financial 
covenant or a related definition, it shall be understood to mean Borrower on 
a consolidated basis unless the context clearly requires otherwise.

          1.3  Code.  Any terms used in this Agreement which are defined in the
Code shall be construed and defined as set forth in the Code unless otherwise
defined herein.



                                          9




          1.4  Construction.  Unless the context of this Agreement clearly 
requires otherwise, references to the plural include the singular, references 
to the singular include the plural, the term "including" is not limiting, and 
the term "or" has, except where otherwise indicated, the inclusive meaning 
represented by the phrase "and/or."  The words "hereof," "herein," "hereby," 
"hereunder," and similar terms in this Agreement refer to this Agreement as a 
whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement.  Section, 
subsection, clause, schedule, and exhibit references are to this Agreement 
unless otherwise specified.  Any reference in this Agreement or in the Loan 
Documents to this Agreement or any of the Loan Documents shall include all 
alterations, amendments, changes, extensions, modifications, renewals, 
replacements, substitutions, and supplements, thereto and thereof, as 
applicable.

          1.5  Schedules and Exhibits.  All of the schedules and exhibits 
attached to this Agreement shall be deemed incorporated herein by reference.

     2.   LOAN AND TERMS OF PAYMENT.

          2.1  Revolving Advances. (a) Subject to the terms and conditions of 
this Agreement, Foothill agrees to make revolving advances to Borrower in an 
amount not to exceed the Borrowing Base.  For purposes of this Agreement, 
"Borrowing Base" shall mean an amount equal to:

               (1)  an amount equal to ninety percent (90%) of the amount of 
Eligible Accounts; plus

               (2)  an amount equal to thirty percent (30%) of the retail 
selling price of Eligible Inventory, but not to exceed sixty-five percent 
(65%) of Borrower's Cost of such Eligible Inventory; plus

               (3)  an amount equal to thirty percent (30%) of the retail 
selling price of Inventory to be acquired pursuant to outstanding commercial 
L/Cs and L/C Guarantees issued by Foothill, but not to exceed the lower of: 
(a) the amount of the L/C or L/C Guarantee or (b) sixty five percent (65%) of 
Borrower's Cost for such Inventory.  Such L/Cs and L/C Guarantees must not 
allow partial draws unless such draws are for finished goods Inventory 
concurrently transferred to Borrower, and draws thereunder must require 
documentation reflecting the transfer of title to Borrower (in form and 
substance satisfactory to Foothill) of first quality finished goods Inventory 
conforming to Borrower's contract with the seller.

               Provided, however, that the Borrowing Base cannot exceed an
amount equal to Borrower's cash, credit card and check collections for the
immediately preceding sixty (60) days.



                                          10



               (b)  Anything to the contrary in Section 2.1(a) above 
notwithstanding, Foothill may reduce its Borrowing Base percentages based 
upon Eligible Accounts or Eligible Inventory without declaring an Event of 
Default if it determines, in its reasonable discretion, that there is a 
material impairment of the prospect of repayment of all or any portion of the 
Obligations or a material impairment of the value or priority of Foothill's 
security interests in the Collateral.

               (c)  Foothill shall have no obligation to make advances 
hereunder to the extent they would cause the outstanding Obligations to 
exceed Thirty Million Dollars ($30,000,000) ("Maximum Amount").

               (d)  Foothill is authorized to make advances under this 
Agreement based upon telephonic or other instructions received from anyone 
purporting to be an Authorized Officer of Borrower, or without instructions 
if pursuant to Section 2.5(d).  Borrower agrees to establish and maintain a 
single designated deposit account for the purpose of receiving the proceeds 
of the advances requested by Borrower and made by Foothill hereunder.  Unless 
otherwise agreed by Foothill and Borrower, any advance requested by Borrower 
and made by Foothill hereunder shall be made to such designated deposit 
account.  Amounts borrowed pursuant to this Section 2.1 may be repaid and, 
subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, reborrowed at any time 
during the term of this Agreement.

          2.2  Letters of Credit and Letter of Credit Guarantees.

               (a)  Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, 
Foothill agrees to issue commercial or standby letters of credit for the 
account of Borrower (each, an "L/C") or to issue standby letters of credit or 
guarantees of payment (each such letter of credit or guaranty, an "L/C 
Guaranty") with respect to commercial or standby letters of credit issued by 
another Person for the account of Borrower in an aggregate face amount not to 
exceed the lesser of: (i) the Borrowing Base less the amount of advances 
outstanding pursuant to Section 2.1, and (ii) Twenty Million Dollars 
($20,000,000).  Borrower expressly understands and agrees that Foothill shall 
have no obligation to arrange for the issuance by other financial 
institutions of letters of credit that are to be the subject of L/C 
Guarantees.  Borrower and Foothill acknowledge and agree that certain of the 
letters of credit that are to be the subject of L/C Guarantees may be 
outstanding on the Closing Date.  Each such L/C (including those that are the 
subject of L/C Guarantees) shall have an expiry date no later than sixty (60) 
days prior to the date on which this Agreement is scheduled to terminate 
under Section 3.3 (without regard to any potential unexercised, renewal term) 
and all such L/Cs and L/C Guarantees shall 

                                          11




be in form and substance acceptable to Foothill in its sole discretion.  
Foothill shall not have any obligation to issue L/Cs or L/C Guarantees to the 
extent that the face amount of all outstanding L/Cs and L/C Guarantees, plus 
the amount of advances outstanding pursuant to Section 2.1, would exceed the 
Maximum Amount.  The L/Cs and the L/C Guarantees issued under this Section 
2.2 shall be used by Borrower, consistent with this Agreement, to purchase 
Inventory or for the other business purposes. If Foothill is obligated to 
advance funds under an L/C or L/C Guaranty, the amount so advanced 
immediately shall be deemed to be an advance made by Foothill to Borrower 
pursuant to Section 2.1 and, thereafter, shall bear interest at the rates 
then applicable under Section 2.5.

               (b)  Borrower hereby agrees to indemnify, save, defend, and 
hold Foothill harmless from any loss, cost, expense, or liability, including 
payments made by Foothill, expenses, and reasonable attorneys fees incurred 
by Foothill arising out of or in connection with any L/Cs or L/C Guarantees.  
Borrower agrees to be bound by the issuing bank's regulations and 
interpretations of any letters of credit guarantied by Foothill and opened to 
or for Borrower's account or by Foothill's interpretations of any L/C issued 
by Foothill to or for Borrower's account, even though this interpretation may 
be different from Borrower's own, and Borrower understands and agrees that 
Foothill shall not be liable for any error, negligence, or mistakes, whether 
of omission or commission, in following Borrower's instructions or those 
contained in the L/Cs or any modifications, amendments, or supplements 
thereto.  Borrower understands that the L/C Guarantees may require Foothill 
to indemnify the issuing bank for certain costs or liabilities arising out of 
claims by Borrower against such issuing bank.  Borrower hereby agrees to 
indemnify, save, defend, and hold Foothill harmless with respect to any loss, 
cost, expense (including attorneys fees), or liability incurred by Foothill 
under any L/C Guaranty as a result of Foothill's indemnification of any such 
issuing bank. 

               (c)  Borrower hereby authorizes and directs any bank that 
issues a letter of credit guaranteed by Foothill to deliver to Foothill all 
instruments, documents, and other writings and property received by the 
issuing bank pursuant to the letter of credit, and to accept and rely upon 
Foothill's instructions and agreements with respect to all matters arising in 
connection with the letter of credit and the related application.  Borrower 
may or may not be the "applicant" or "account party" with respect to such 
letter of credit.

               (d)  Any and all service charges, commissions, fees, and costs 
incurred by Foothill (without markup by Foothill) relating to the L/Cs 
guaranteed by Foothill shall be considered Foothill Expenses for purposes of 
this Agreement and immediately shall be reimbursable by Borrower to Foothill. 
On the first day of each month, Borrower will pay Foothill a fee equal to 
three quarters of one percent (0.75%) per annum times the average Daily 
Balance of the undrawn L/Cs and L/C Guarantees that were outstanding during 
the immediately preceding month.  Service charges, commissions, fees, and 
costs may be charged to Borrower's loan account at the time the service is 
rendered or the cost is incurred. 

               (e)  Immediately upon the termination of this Agreement, 
Borrower agrees to:  (i) provide cash collateral to be held by Foothill in an 
amount equal to the maximum amount of Foothill's 

                                          12



obligations under L/Cs plus the maximum amount of Foothill's obligations to 
any Person under outstanding L/C Guarantees, (ii) cause to be delivered to 
Foothill releases of all of Foothill's obligations under its outstanding L/Cs 
and L/C Guarantees, or (iii) cause to be issued to Foothill an irrevocable 
back to back letter of credit issued or confirmed by a bank acceptable to 
Foothill in form and substance reasonably acceptable to Foothill.  At 
Foothill's discretion, any proceeds of Collateral received by Foothill after 
the occurrence and during the continuation of an Event of Default may be held 
as the cash collateral required by this Section 2.2(e).

               (f)  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in 
this Agreement, Borrower may allow other Persons to issue letters of credit 
on its behalf.  As a condition to Borrower's establishing new letter of 
credit facilities, the Person issuing letters of credit must enter into an 
Intercreditor Agreement with Foothill, in form and substance reasonably 
satisfactory to Foothill.

          2.3  Intentionally Omitted.

          2.4  Overadvances.  If, at any time or for any reason, the amount 
of Obligations owed by Borrower to Foothill pursuant to Sections 2.1 and 2.2 
is greater than either the dollar or percentage limitations set forth in 
Sections 2.1 or 2.2 (an "Overadvance"), Borrower immediately shall pay to 
Foothill, in cash, the amount of such excess to be used by Foothill first, to 
repay non-contingent Obligations and, thereafter, to be held by Foothill as 
cash collateral to secure Borrower's obligation to repay Foothill for all 
amounts paid pursuant to L/Cs or L/C Guarantees.

          2.5  Interest:  Rates, Payments, and Calculations.

               (a)  Interest Rate.  All Obligations, except for undrawn L/Cs 
and L/C Guarantees, and except for Obligations as to which Borrower has 
elected to have interest charged based upon the Libor Supplement, shall bear 
interest, on the average Daily Balance, at a per annum rate equal to the 
Reference Rate.

               (b)  Default Rate.  All Obligations, except for undrawn L/Cs 
and L/C Guarantees, shall bear interest, from and during the continuance of 
an Event of Default, at a per annum rate equal to three (3.00) percentage 
points above the Reference Rate.  From and during the continuance of an Event 
of Default, the fee provided in Section 2.2(d) shall be increased to a fee 
equal to three percent (3.00%) per annum times the average Daily Balance of 
the undrawn L/Cs and L/C Guarantees that were outstanding during the 
immediately preceding month.

               (c)  [Intentionally Deleted].



                                          13






               (d)  Payments.  Interest hereunder shall be due and payable on 
the first day of each month during the term hereof.  Borrower hereby 
authorizes Foothill, at its option, without prior notice to Borrower, to 
charge such interest, all Foothill Expenses (as and when incurred), and all 
installments or other payments due under any note or other Loan Document to 
Borrower's loan account, which amounts shall thereafter accrue interest at 
the rate then applicable hereunder.  Any interest not paid when due shall be 
compounded by becoming a part of the Obligations, and such interest shall 
thereafter accrue interest at the rate then applicable hereunder.

               (e)  Computation.  The Reference Rate as of this date is eight 
and one-half percent (8.50%) per annum.  In the event the Reference Rate is 
changed from time to time hereafter, the applicable rate of interest 
hereunder automatically and immediately shall be increased or decreased by an 
amount equal to such change in the Reference Rate.  The rates of interest 
charged hereunder shall be based upon the average Reference Rate in effect 
during the month.  All interest and fees chargeable under the Loan Documents 
shall be computed on the basis of a three hundred sixty (360) day year for 
the actual number of days elapsed.

               (f)  Intent to Limit Charges to Maximum Lawful Rate.  In no 
event shall the interest rate or rates payable under this Agreement, plus any 
other amounts paid in connection herewith, exceed the highest rate 
permissible under any law that a court of competent jurisdiction shall, in a 
final determination, deem applicable.  Borrower and Foothill, in executing 
this Agreement, intend to legally agree upon the rate or rates of interest 
and manner of payment stated within it; provided, however, that, anything 
contained herein to the contrary notwithstanding, if said rate or rates of 
interest or manner of payment exceeds the maximum allowable under applicable 
law, then, ipso facto as of the date of this Agreement, Borrower is and shall 
be liable only for the payment of such maximum as allowed by law, and payment 
received from Borrower in excess of such legal maximum, whenever received, 
shall be applied to reduce the principal balance of the Obligations to the 
extent of such excess.

          2.6  Crediting Payments; Application of Collections.  The receipt 
of any wire transfer of funds, check, or other item of payment by Foothill 
(whether from transfers to Foothill, the Lock Box or otherwise) immediately 
shall be applied to provisionally reduce the Obligations, but shall not be 
considered a payment on account unless such wire transfer is of immediately 
available federal funds and is made to the Lock Box or to another appropriate 
deposit account of Foothill or unless and until such check or other item of 
payment is honored when presented for payment.  Should any check or item of 
payment not be honored when presented for payment, then Borrower shall be 
deemed not to have made such payment, and interest shall be recalculated 
accordingly.  Anything to the contrary contained herein notwithstanding, any 
wire transfer, check, or other item of payment shall be deemed received by 
Foothill only if it is received by Foothill on or before 11:00 a.m. Los 
Angeles time.  If any wire transfer, check, or other item of payment is 
received by Foothill after 11:00 a.m. Los

                                          -14-


Angeles time it shall be deemed to have been received by Foothill as of the 
opening of business on the immediately following Business Day.  Prior to the 
occurrence of an Event of Default or Foothill reasonably deeming itself 
insecure, and so long as:  (a) the outstanding balance of the Obligations is 
Thirteen Million Five Hundred Thousand Dollars ($13,500,000) or less, and (b) 
the outstanding balance of the Obligations (other than L/Cs and L/C 
Guarantees) is Five Million Dollars ($5,000,000) or less, monies shall, at 
Borrower's option, be transferred from the Lock Box to Foothill or to 
Borrower's operating account on a daily basis, and if transferred to 
Borrower's operating account such monies will not be applied to the 
Obligations.

          2.7  Statements of Obligations.  Foothill shall render monthly 
statements to Borrower of the Obligations, including principal, interest, 
fees, and including an itemization of all charges and expenses constituting 
Foothill Expenses owing, and such statements shall be conclusively presumed 
to be correct and accurate and constitute an account stated between Borrower 
and Foothill unless, within sixty (60) days after receipt thereof by 
Borrower, Borrower shall deliver to Foothill by registered or certified mail 
at its address specified in Section 12, written objection thereto describing 
the error or errors contained in any such statements.

          2.8  Fees.  Borrower shall pay to Foothill the following fees:

               (a)  Closing Fee.  A one time closing fee of Seventy-Fifty 
Thousand Dollars ($75,000) which is earned, in full, on the Closing Date and 
is due and payable by Borrower to Foothill in connection with this Agreement 
on the Closing Date;

               (b)  Annual Facility Fee.  On the earlier of the first 
anniversary of the Closing Date or the termination of this Agreement for any 
reason, a fee (which shall be fully earned as of the Closing Date) in an 
amount equal to one quarter of one percent (0.25%) of the Maximum Amount, and 
on the second anniversary of the Closing Date and each anniversary 
thereafter, a fee in an amount equal to one-eighth of one percent (0.125%) of 
the Maximum Amount, such fees to be fully earned on each such anniversary;

               (c)  Financial Examination, Documentation, and Appraisal Fees. 
(i) Foothill's customary fee of Six Hundred Fifty Dollars ($650) per day per 
examiner, plus out-of-pocket expenses for each financial analysis and 
examination of Borrower performed by Foothill or its agents.  Prior to the 
occurrence of an Event of Default hereunder or Foothill deeming itself 
insecure, (i) Borrower shall not be required to pay for more than one 
financial analysis and examination during each twelve (12) month period; and 
(ii) Foothill shall not have third party Inventory appraisals conducted more 
than once in each twelve (12) month period, at a cost not to exceed One 
Thousand Dollars ($1,000) per day, plus out-of-pocket expenses; and

               (d)  Collateral Management Fee.  On the first day of each 
month during the term of this Agreement, commencing August 1, 1997 and 
thereafter so long as any Obligations are outstanding, a collateral 
management fee in an amount equal to Two Thousand Dollars ($2,000) per month 
(or a prorated portion thereof for any partial month) during the term hereof, 
such fee to be fully earned on the first day of each month. 


                                          -15-


     3.   CONDITIONS; TERM OF AGREEMENT.

          3.1  Conditions Precedent to Initial Advance, L/C, or L/C Guaranty. 
The obligation of Foothill to make the initial advance or to provide the 
initial L/C or L/C Guaranty is subject to the fulfillment, to the 
satisfaction of Foothill and its counsel, of each of the following conditions 
on or before the Closing Date:

               (a)  Foothill shall have received a fully executed copy of 
this Agreement;

               (b)  Foothill shall have received the Closing Fee;

               (c)  Foothill shall have received a certificate of corporate 
status with respect to Borrower, dated within ten (10) days of the Closing 
Date, by the Secretary of State of the state of incorporation of Borrower, 
which certificate shall indicate that Borrower is in good standing in such 
state;

               (d)  Foothill shall have received a certificate from 
Borrower's Secretary in form and substance satisfactory to Foothill in its 
sole discretion; and

               (e)  all other documents and legal matters in connection with 
the transactions contemplated by this Agreement shall have been delivered or 
executed or recorded and shall be in form and substance satisfactory to 
Foothill and its counsel.

                                          -16-


          3.2  Conditions Precedent to All Advances, L/Cs, or L/C Guarantees. 
The following shall be conditions precedent to all advances, L/Cs, or L/C 
Guarantees hereunder:

               (a)  the representations and warranties contained in this 
Agreement and the other Loan Documents shall be true and correct in all 
material respects on and as of the date of such advance, L/C, or L/C 
Guaranty, as though made on and as of such date (except to the extent that 
such representations and warranties relate solely to an earlier date); 

               (b)  except for good faith disputes by Borrower with one or 
more landlords of its stores, no Event of Default or event which with the 
giving of notice or passage of time would constitute an Event of Default 
shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such advance, L/C, or 
L/C Guaranty, nor shall either result from the making of the advance; and

               (c)  no injunction, writ, restraining order, or other order of 
any nature prohibiting, directly or indirectly, the making of such advance or 
the issuance of such L/C or L/C Guaranty shall have been issued and remain in 
force by any governmental authority against Borrower, Foothill, or any of 
Borrower's Affiliates.

          3.3  Term; Automatic Renewal.  This Agreement shall become 
effective upon the execution and delivery hereof by Borrower and Foothill and 
shall continue in full force and effect for a term ending on the date (the 
"Renewal Date") that is three (3) years from the Closing Date and 
automatically shall be 

                                          -17-


renewed for successive one (1) year periods thereafter, unless sooner 
terminated pursuant to the terms hereof.  Either party may terminate this 
Agreement effective on the Renewal Date or on any anniversary of the Renewal 
Date by giving the other party at least ninety (90) days prior written notice 
by registered or certified mail, return receipt requested.  The foregoing 
notwithstanding, Foothill shall have the right to terminate its obligations 
under this Agreement immediately and without notice upon the occurrence and 
during the continuation of an Event of Default.

          3.4  Effect of Termination.  On the date of termination, all 
Obligations (including contingent reimbursement obligations under any 
outstanding L/Cs or L/C Guarantees) immediately shall become due and payable 
without notice or demand.  No termination of this Agreement, however, shall 
relieve or discharge Borrower of Borrower's duties, Obligations, or covenants 
hereunder, and Foothill's continuing security interests in the Collateral 
shall remain in effect until all Obligations have been fully and finally 
discharged and Foothill's obligation to provide advances hereunder is 
terminated.  If Borrower has sent a notice of termination pursuant to the 
provisions of Section 3.3, but fails to pay all Obligations on the date set 
forth in said notice, then Foothill may, but shall not be required to, renew 
this Agreement for an additional term of one (1) year.  Once all Obligations 
have been fully repaid and this Agreement has been terminated, Foothill will 
promptly deliver to Borrower terminations of its financing statements.

          3.5  Early Termination by Borrower.  The provisions of Section 3.3 
that allow termination of this Agreement by Borrower only on the Renewal Date 
and certain anniversaries thereof notwithstanding, Borrower has the option, 
at any time upon ninety (90) days prior written notice to Foothill, to 
terminate this Agreement by paying to Foothill, in cash, the Obligations 
(including an amount equal to the full amount of the L/Cs or L/C Guarantees 
unless the L/C or L/C Guarantee is replaced by another Person without 
liability to Foothill).

                                          -18-


     4.   CREATION OF SECURITY INTEREST.

          4.1  Grant of Security Interest.  Borrower hereby grants to 
Foothill a continuing security interest in all currently existing and 
hereafter acquired or arising Collateral in order to secure prompt repayment 
of any and all Obligations and in order to secure prompt performance by 
Borrower of each of its covenants and duties under the Loan Documents.  
Foothill's security interests in the Collateral shall attach to all 
Collateral without further act on the part of Foothill or Borrower.  Anything 
contained in this Agreement or any other Loan Document to the contrary 
notwithstanding, and other than:  (a) sales of Inventory to buyers in the 
ordinary course of business, (b) sales of Equipment in any twelve (12) month 
period having an aggregate net book value of One Hundred Thousand Dollars 
($100,000) with the proceeds being applied to the Obligations, and (c) sale 
or disposal of Collateral (other than Inventory) in connection with the 
closing of Borrower's stores, Borrower has no authority, express or implied, 
to dispose of any item or portion of the Collateral.

          4.2  Negotiable Collateral.  In the event that any Collateral, 
including proceeds, is evidenced by or consists of Negotiable Collateral, 
Borrower shall, immediately upon the request of Foothill, endorse and assign 
such Negotiable Collateral to Foothill and deliver physical possession of 
such Negotiable Collateral to Foothill.

          4.3  Collection of Accounts, General Intangibles, Negotiable 
Collateral.  Foothill, Borrower, and the Lock Box Banks shall enter into the 
Lock Box Agreements, in form and substance satisfactory to Foothill in its 
sole discretion, pursuant to which all of Borrower's cash receipts, checks, 
and other items of payment (including, insurance proceeds, proceeds of cash 
sales, rental proceeds, and tax refunds) will be forwarded to Foothill on a 
daily basis.  At any time, Foothill or Foothill's designee may: (a) notify 
customers or Account Debtors of Borrower that the Accounts, General 
Intangibles, or Negotiable Collateral have been assigned to Foothill or that 
Foothill has a security interest therein; and (b) collect the Accounts, 
General Intangibles, and Negotiable Collateral directly and charge the 
collection costs and expenses to Borrower's loan account.  Borrower agrees 
that it will hold in trust for Foothill, as Foothill's trustee, any cash 
receipts, checks, and other items of payment (including, insurance proceeds, 
proceeds of cash sales, rental proceeds, and tax refunds) that it receives 
and immediately will deliver said cash receipts, checks, and other items of 
payment to Foothill in their original form as received by Borrower, except as 
otherwise provided in Section 2.6.

          4.4  Delivery of Additional Documentation Required.  At any time 
upon the request of Foothill, Borrower shall execute and deliver to Foothill 
all financing statements, continuation financing statements, fixture filings, 
security agreements, chattel mortgages, pledges, assignments, endorsements of 
certificates of title, applications for title, affidavits, reports, notices, 
schedules of accounts, letters of authority, and all other documents that 
Foothill may reasonably request, in form satisfactory to Foothill, to perfect 
and continue perfected Foothill's security interests in the Collateral and in 
order to fully consummate all of the transactions contemplated hereby and 
under the other the Loan Documents.

                                          -19-


          4.5  Power of Attorney.  Borrower hereby irrevocably makes, 
constitutes, and appoints Foothill (and any of Foothill's officers, 
employees, or agents designated by Foothill) as Borrower's true and lawful 
attorney, with power to:  (a) if Borrower refuses to, or fails timely to 
execute and deliver any of the documents described in Section 4.4, sign the 
name of Borrower on any of the documents described in Section 4.4; (b) at any 
time that an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or Foothill 
reasonably deems itself insecure (in accordance with Section 1208 of the 
Code), sign Borrower's name on any invoice or bill of lading relating to any 
Account, drafts against Account Debtors, schedules and assignments of 
Accounts, verifications of Accounts, and notices to Account Debtors; (c) send 
requests for verification of Accounts; (d) endorse Borrower's name on any 
checks, notices, acceptances, money orders, drafts, or other item of payment 
or security that may come into Foothill's possession; (e) at any time that an 
Event of Default has occurred and is continuing or Foothill deems itself 
insecure (in accordance with Section 1208 of the Code), notify the post 
office authorities to change the address for delivery of Borrower's mail to 
an address designated by Foothill, to receive and open all mail addressed to 
Borrower, and to retain all mail relating to the Collateral and forward all 
other mail to Borrower; (f) at any time that an Event of Default has occurred 
and is continuing or Foothill deems itself insecure (in accordance with 
Section 1208 of the Code), make, settle, and adjust all claims under 
Borrower's policies of insurance and make all determinations and decisions 
with respect to such policies of insurance; and (g) at any time that an Event 
of Default has occurred and is continuing or Foothill deems itself insecure 
(in accordance with Section 1208 of the Code), settle and adjust disputes and 
claims respecting the Accounts directly with Account Debtors, for amounts and 
upon terms which Foothill determines to be reasonable, and Foothill may cause 
to be executed and delivered any documents and releases which Foothill 
determines to be necessary.  The appointment of Foothill as Borrower's 
attorney, and each and every one of Foothill's rights and powers, being 
coupled with an interest, is irrevocable until all of the Obligations have 
been fully and finally repaid and performed and Foothill's obligation to 
extend credit hereunder is terminated.

          4.6  Right to Inspect.  Foothill (through any of its officers, 
employees, or agents) shall have the right, from time to time hereafter to 
inspect Borrower's Books and to check, test, and appraise the Collateral in 
order to verify Borrower's financial condition or the amount, quality, value, 
condition of, or any other matter relating to, the Collateral.

     5.   REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES. 

          Borrower represents and warrants to Foothill as follows:

          5.1  No Prior Encumbrances.  Borrower has good and indefeasible 
title to the Collateral, free and clear of liens, claims, security interests, 
or encumbrances, except for Permitted Liens.

          5.2  Eligible Accounts.  The Eligible Accounts are, at the time of 
the creation thereof and as of each date on which Borrower includes them in a 
Borrowing Base calculation or certification, bona fide existing obligations 
created by the sale and delivery of Inventory or the rendition of services to 
Account Debtors in the ordinary course of Borrower's business, 


                                          -20-


unconditionally owed to Borrower without defenses, disputes, offsets,
counterclaims, or rights of return or cancellation other than normal returns
or disputes in the normal course of business.  The property giving rise to such
Eligible Accounts has been delivered to the Account Debtor, or to the Account
Debtor's agent for immediate shipment to and unconditional acceptance by the
Account Debtor.  At the time of the creation of an Eligible Account and as of
each date on which Borrower includes an Eligible Account in a Borrowing Base 
calculation or certification, Borrower has not received notice of actual or 
imminent bankruptcy, insolvency, or material impairment of the financial 
condition of any applicable Account Debtor regarding such Eligible Account.

          5.3  Eligible Inventory.  All Eligible Inventory is now and at all 
times hereafter shall be of good and merchantable quality, free from defects, 
except for minor defects arising in the ordinary course of business.

          5.4  Location of Inventory and Equipment.  The Inventory and 
Equipment are not stored with a bailee, warehouseman, or similar party 
(without Foothill's prior written consent) and are located only at the 
locations identified on Schedule 6.15 or in transit, or otherwise permitted 
by Section 6.15.

          5.5  Inventory Records.  Borrower now keeps, and hereafter at all 
times shall keep, correct and accurate records itemizing and describing the 
kind, type, quality, and quantity of the Inventory, and Borrower's cost 
therefor in accordance with the retail method of accounting.

          5.6  Location of Chief Executive Office; FEIN.  The chief executive 
office of Borrower is located at the address indicated in the preamble to 
this Agreement and Borrower's FEIN is 31-1241495.

          5.7  Due Organization and Qualification.  Borrower is duly 
organized and existing and in good standing under the laws of the state of 
its incorporation and qualified and licensed to do business in, and in good 
standing in, any state where the failure to be so licensed or qualified could 
reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the business, 
operations, condition (financial or otherwise), finances, or prospects of 
Borrower or on the value of the Collateral to Foothill.

          5.8  Due Authorization; No Conflict.  The execution, delivery, and 
performance of the Loan Documents are within Borrower's corporate powers, 
have been duly authorized, and are not in conflict with nor constitute a 
breach of any provision contained in Borrower's Certificate of Incorporation, 
or By-laws, nor will they constitute an event of default under any material 
agreement to which Borrower is a party or by which its properties or assets 
may be bound.

          5.9  Litigation.  There are no actions or proceedings pending by or 
against Borrower before any court or administrative agency and Borrower does 
not have knowledge or belief of any pending, threatened, or imminent 
litigation, governmental investigations, or claims, complaints, actions, or 
prosecutions 

                                          -21-


involving Borrower or any guarantor of the Obligations, except for: (a) 
ongoing collection matters in which Borrower is the plaintiff; and (b) 
current matters that, if decided adversely to Borrower, would not materially 
impair the prospect of repayment of the Obligations or materially impair the 
value or priority of Foothill's security interests in the Collateral.

          5.10 No Material Adverse Change in Financial Condition.  All 
financial statements relating to Borrower or any guarantor of the Obligations 
that have been delivered by Borrower to Foothill have been prepared in 
accordance with GAAP and fairly present Borrower's (or such guarantor's, as 
applicable) financial condition as of the date thereof and Borrower's results 
of operations for the period then ended.  There has not been a material 
adverse change in the financial condition of Borrower (or such guarantor, as 
applicable) since the date of the latest financial statements submitted to 
Foothill on or before the Closing Date.

          5.11 Ability to Meet Obligations.  No transfer of property is being 
made by Borrower and no obligation is being incurred by Borrower in 
connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or the other 
Loan Documents with the intent to hinder, delay, or defraud either present or 
future creditors of Borrower, and Borrower is able to meet its obligations as 
they come due.

          5.12 Employee Benefits.  Each Plan is in compliance in all material 
respects with the applicable provisions of ERISA and the IRC.  Each Qualified 
Plan and Multiemployer Plan has been determined by the Internal Revenue 
Service to qualify under Section 401 of the IRC, and the trusts created 
thereunder have been determined to be exempt from tax under Section 501 of 
the IRC, and, to the best knowledge of Borrower, nothing has occurred that 
would cause the loss of such qualification or tax-exempt status.  There are 
no outstanding liabilities under Title IV of ERISA with respect to any Plan 
maintained or sponsored by Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate, nor with respect 
to any Plan to which Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate contributes or is 
obligated to contribute which could reasonably be expected to have a material 
adverse effect on the financial condition of Borrower.  No Plan subject to 
Title IV of ERISA has any Unfunded Benefit Liability which could reasonably 
be expected to have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of 
Borrower.  Neither Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has transferred any 
Unfunded Benefit Liability to a person other than Borrower or an ERISA 
Affiliate or has otherwise engaged in a transaction that could be subject to 
Sections 4069 or 4212(c) of ERISA which could reasonably be expected to have 
a material adverse effect on the financial condition of Borrower.  Neither 
Borrower nor any ERISA Affiliate has incurred nor reasonably expects to incur 
(x) any liability (and no event has occurred which, with the giving of notice 
under Section 4219 of ERISA, would result in such liability) under Sections 
4201 or 4243 of ERISA with respect to a Multiemployer Plan, or (y) any 
liability under Title IV of ERISA (other than premiums due but not delinquent 
under Section 4007 of ERISA) with respect to a Plan, which could, in either 
event, reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the 
financial condition of Borrower.  No application for a funding waiver or an 
extension of any amortization period pursuant to Section 412 of the IRC has 
been made with respect to any Plan.  No ERISA Event has occurred or is 
reasonably expected to occur with respect to any Plan which could reasonably 
be expected to 

                                          -22-


have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of Borrower.  
Borrower and each ERISA Affiliate have complied in all material respects with 
the notice and continuation coverage requirements of Section 4980B of the IRC.

          5.13 Environmental Condition.  Except as set forth on Schedule 
5.13, none of Borrower's properties or assets has ever been used by Borrower 
or, to the best of Borrower's knowledge, by previous owners or operators in 
the disposal of, or to produce, store, handle, treat, release, or transport, 
any Hazardous Materials.  None of Borrower's properties or assets has ever 
been designated or identified in any manner pursuant to any environmental 
protection statute as a Hazardous Materials disposal site, or a candidate for 
closure pursuant to any environmental protection statute.  No lien arising 
under any environmental protection statute has attached to any revenues or to 
any real or personal property owned or operated by Borrower.  Borrower has 
not received a summons, citation, notice, or directive from the Environmental 
Protection Agency or any other federal or state governmental agency 
concerning any action or omission by Borrower resulting in the releasing or 
disposing of Hazardous Materials into the environment.

          5.14 Reliance by Foothill; Cumulative.  Each warranty and 
representation contained in this Agreement automatically shall be deemed 
repeated with each advance or issuance of an L/C or L/C Guaranty and shall be 
conclusively presumed to have been relied on by Foothill regardless of any 
investigation made or information possessed by Foothill.  The warranties and 
representations set forth herein shall be cumulative and in addition to any 
and all other warranties and representations that Borrower now or hereafter 
shall give, or cause to be given, to Foothill.

     6.   AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS.

          Borrower covenants and agrees that, so long as any credit hereunder 
shall be available and until full and final payment of the Obligations, and 
unless Foothill shall otherwise consent in writing, Borrower shall do all of 
the following:

          6.1  Accounting System.  Borrower shall maintain a standard and 
modern system of accounting in accordance with GAAP with ledger and account 
cards or computer tapes, discs, printouts, and records pertaining to the 
Collateral which contain information as from time to time may be requested by 
Foothill.  Borrower also shall keep proper books of account showing all 
sales, claims, and allowances on its Inventory.

          6.2  Collateral and Financial Reports.  Borrower shall deliver to 
Foothill, no later than the thirtieth (30th) day of each month during the 
term of this Agreement, a detailed aging, by total, of the Accounts, a 
reconciliation statement, and a summary aging, by vendor, of all accounts 
payable and any book overdraft.  Borrower shall deliver to Foothill, as 
Foothill may from time to time require, collection reports, sales journals, 
bills of lading, and other documentation respecting shipment arrangements.  
Absent such a request by Foothill, copies of all such documentation shall be 
held by Borrower as custodian for Foothill.

                                          -23-


          6.3  Schedules of Accounts.  With such regularity as Foothill shall 
require, Borrower shall provide Foothill with schedules describing all 
Accounts. Foothill's failure to request such schedules or Borrower's failure 
to execute and deliver such schedules shall not affect or limit Foothill's 
security interests or other rights in and to the Accounts.

          6.4  Financial Statements, Reports, Certificates.  Borrower agrees 
to deliver to Foothill:  (a) as soon as available, but in any event within 
thirty (30) days after the end of each month (or forty-five (45) days after 
the end of fiscal quarter) during each of Borrower's fiscal years, a company 
prepared balance sheet, income statement, and cash flow statement covering 
Borrower's operations during such period; and (b) as soon as available, but 
in any event within ninety (90) days after the end of each of Borrower's 
Fiscal Years, financial statements of Borrower for each such Fiscal Year, 
audited by independent certified public accountants reasonably acceptable to 
Foothill and certified, without any going concern or other material 
qualifications, by such accountants to have been prepared in accordance with 
GAAP, together with a certificate of such accountants addressed to Foothill 
stating that such accountants do not have knowledge of the existence of any 
event or condition constituting an Event of Default, or that would, with the 
passage of time or the giving of notice, constitute an Event of Default.  
Such audited financial statements shall include a balance sheet, profit and 
loss statement, and cash flow statement, and, if prepared, such accountants' 
letter to management.  If Borrower is a parent company of one or more 
subsidiaries, or Affiliates, or is a subsidiary or Affiliate of another 
company, then, in addition to the financial statements referred to above, 
Borrower agrees to deliver financial statements prepared on a consolidating 
basis so as to present Borrower and each such related entity separately, and 
on a consolidated basis.

               Together with the above, Borrower also shall deliver to 
Foothill Borrower's Form 10-Q Quarterly Reports, Form 10-K Annual Reports, 
and Form 8-K Current Reports, and any other filings made by Borrower with the 
Securities and Exchange Commission, if any, as soon as the same are filed, or 
any other information that is provided by Borrower to its public 
shareholders, and any other report reasonably requested by Foothill relating 
to the Collateral and financial condition of Borrower.

               Each month, together with the financial statements provided 
pursuant to Section 6.4(a), Borrower shall deliver to Foothill a certificate 
signed by its chief financial officer to the effect that:  (i) all reports, 
statements, or computer prepared information of any kind or nature delivered 
or caused to be delivered to Foothill hereunder have been prepared in 
accordance with GAAP and fairly present the financial condition of Borrower; 
(ii) Borrower is in timely compliance with all of its covenants and 
agreements hereunder; (iii) the representations and warranties of Borrower 
contained in this Agreement and the other Loan Documents are true and correct 
in all material respects on and as of the date of such certificate, as though 
made on and as of such date (except to the extent that such representations 
and warranties relate solely to an earlier date); and (iv) on the date of 
delivery of such certificate to Foothill there does not exist any condition 
or event that constitutes an Event of Default (or, in each case, to the 
extent of any non-compliance, describing such non-compliance as to which he 
or she may have knowledge and what action Borrower has taken, is taking, or 
proposes to take with respect thereto).

                                          -24-


               Borrower shall have issued written instructions to its 
independent certified public accountants authorizing them to communicate with 
Foothill and to release to Foothill whatever financial information concerning 
Borrower that Foothill may request.  Borrower hereby irrevocably authorizes 
and directs all auditors, accountants, or other third parties to deliver to 
Foothill, at Borrower's expense, copies of Borrower's financial statements, 
papers related thereto, and other accounting records of any nature in their 
possession, and to disclose to Foothill any information they may have 
regarding Borrower's business affairs and financial conditions.

          6.5  Tax Returns.  Borrower agrees to deliver to Foothill copies of 
each of Borrower's future federal income tax returns, and any amendments 
thereto, within thirty (30) days of the filing thereof with the Internal 
Revenue Service.

          6.6  Designation of Inventory.  Borrower shall now and from time to 
time hereafter, but not less frequently than weekly (to be delivered each 
Monday based upon the close of business on the preceding Saturday), execute 
and deliver to Foothill a designation of Inventory specifying the retail 
selling price of Borrower's Inventory, and not less frequently than monthly, 
execute and deliver to Foothill a designation of Inventory specifying 
Borrower's Cost, and further specifying such other information as Foothill 
may reasonably request.  Such designation shall separately report Inventory 
that is subject to a letter of credit issued by any Person other than 
Foothill.  Borrower will not include Inventory in transit in its Inventory 
reports until such Inventory has been paid for by draws under applicable 
letters of credit or has been acquired by Borrower without letter of credit 
financing.

          6.7  Store Openings and Closings and Rent Reports.  Borrower shall 
give Foothill reasonable prior notice of new store openings and closing of 
its stores.  Borrower shall make timely payment of all rents on real property 
leases where Borrower is the lessee within applicable grace periods, and 
shall provide Foothill with a monthly report specifying the status of such 
payments.  In the event that Borrower becomes delinquent in its rent 
payments, then Foothill can establish reserves against the Borrowing Base for 
the amount of any landlord liens arising from such delinquency.

          6.8  Landlord Waivers.  Borrower will use its best efforts to 
obtain landlord waivers from the landlords of its store locations in the 
State of Pennsylvania.

          6.9  Title to Equipment.  Upon Foothill's request, Borrower shall 
within thirty (30) days of such request deliver to Foothill, properly 
endorsed, any and all evidences of ownership of, certificates of title, or 
applications for title to any items of Equipment with a market value of 
Twenty Five Thousand Dollars ($25,000) or more other than Equipment leased or 
to be leased.

          6.10 Maintenance of Equipment.  Borrower shall keep and maintain 
the Equipment in good operating condition and repair (ordinary wear and tear 
excepted), and make all necessary replacements thereto so that the value and 
operating efficiency thereof shall at all times be maintained and preserved.

                                          -25-










          6.11 Taxes.  Except as contested in good faith by Borrower, all 
assessments and taxes, whether real, personal, or otherwise, due or payable 
by, or imposed, levied, or assessed against Borrower or any of its property 
have been paid, and shall hereafter be paid in full, before delinquency or 
before the expiration of any extension period.  Borrower shall make due and 
timely payment or deposit of all federal, state, and local taxes, 
assessments, or contributions required of it by law, and will execute and 
deliver to Foothill, on demand, appropriate certificates attesting to the 
payment thereof or deposit with respect thereto.  Borrower will make timely 
payment or deposit of all tax payments and withholding taxes required of it 
by applicable laws, including those laws concerning F.I.C.A., F.U.T.A., state 
disability, and local, state, and federal income taxes, and will, upon 
request, furnish Foothill with proof satisfactory to Foothill indicating that 
Borrower has made such payments or deposits.

          6.12 Insurance.

               (a)  Borrower, at its expense, shall keep the Collateral 
insured against loss or damage by fire, theft, explosion, sprinklers, and all 
other hazards and risks, and in such amounts, as are ordinarily insured 
against by other owners in similar businesses.  Borrower also shall maintain 
business interruption, public liability, product liability, and property 
damage insurance relating to Borrower's ownership and use of the Collateral, 
as well as insurance against larceny, embezzlement, and criminal 
misappropriation.

               (b)  All such policies of insurance shall be in such form, 
with such companies, and in such amounts as may be reasonably satisfactory to 
Foothill.  All such policies of insurance (except those of public liability 
and property damage) shall contain a 438BFU lender's loss payable 
endorsement, or an equivalent endorsement in a form satisfactory to Foothill, 
showing Foothill as sole loss payee thereof, and shall contain a waiver of 
warranties, and shall specify that the insurer must give at least ten (10) 
days prior written notice to Foothill before canceling its policy for any 
reason.  Borrower shall deliver to Foothill certified copies of such policies 
of insurance and evidence of the payment of all premiums therefor.  All 
proceeds payable under any such policy shall be payable to Foothill to be 
applied on account of the Obligations.

          6.13 Financial Covenants.  Borrower shall maintain:

               (a)  Current Ratio.  A ratio of Consolidated Current Assets 
divided by Consolidated Current Liabilities of at least the following, 
measured on a fiscal quarter-end basis:

                                       Quarters During
                                         Fiscal Year
          Ratio                       Ending on or About
          -----                       ------------------

          1.0-1.0                     October 31, 1997 and
                                      January 31, 1998 only

         1.25-1.0                     April 30, 1998 through
                                      January 31, 1999

         1.50-1.0                     April 30, 1999 and thereafter


                                         -26-




               (b)  Tangible Net Worth.  Tangible Net Worth of not less than 
the following, measured on a fiscal quarter-end basis:

           Tangible                              Quarters
          Net Worth                          Ending on or About
          ---------                          ------------------

          $ 4,000,000                        October 31, 1997
           11,000,000                        January 31, 1998
           10,000,000                        April 30, 1998
           10,000,000                        July 31, 1998
           20,000,000                        October 31, 1998
           25,000,000                        January 31, 1999
           30,000,000                        April 30, 1999
           30,000,000                        July 31, 1999
           40,000,000                        October 31, 1999
          $45,000,000                        January 31, 2000 and thereafter

               (c)  Working Capital.  Working Capital of not less than the 
following, measured on a fiscal quarter-end basis:

                                                 Quarters
          Working Capital                    Ending on or About
          ---------------                    ------------------

          $ 9,000,000                        October 31, 1997
           18,000,000                        January 31, 1998
           15,000,000                        April 30, 1998
           15,000,000                        July 31, 1998
           20,000,000                        October 31, 1998
           25,000,000                        January 31, 1999
           25,000,000                        April 30, 1999
           25,000,000                        July 31, 1999
           30,000,000                        October 31, 1999
          $35,000,000                        January 31, 2000 and thereafter


          6.14 No Setoffs or Counterclaims.  All payments hereunder and under 
the other Loan Documents made by or on behalf of Borrower shall be made 
without setoff or counterclaim and free and clear of, and without deduction 
or withholding for or on account of, any federal, state, or local taxes.

          6.15 Location of Inventory and Equipment.  Borrower shall keep the 
Inventory and Equipment only at the locations identified on Schedule 6.15 and 
additional locations reported to Foothill in accordance with Section 6.7; 
provided, however, that Borrower shall amend Schedule 6.15 not less 
frequently than annually.  For each new location within the continental 
United States, Borrower shall provide any financing statements or fixture 
filings necessary to perfect and continue perfected Foothill's security 
interests in such assets and also uses its best efforts to provide to 
Foothill a landlord's waiver,

                                        -27-




in form and substance satisfactory to Foothill, if such location is in the 
State of Pennsylvania or another state where landlords have a right of 
distraint upon the tenant's property, to the extent that this does not impede 
Borrower's ability to obtain favorable terms from the landlord.

          6.16 Compliance with Laws.  Borrower shall comply with the 
requirements of all applicable laws, rules, regulations, and orders of any 
governmental authority, including the Fair Labor Standards Act and the 
Americans With Disabilities Act, other than laws, rules, regulations, and 
orders the non-compliance with which, individually or in the aggregate, would 
not have and could not reasonably be expected to have a material adverse 
effect on the business, operations, condition (financial or otherwise), 
finances, or prospects of Borrower or on the value of the Collateral to 
Foothill.

          6.17 Employee Benefits.

               (a)  Borrower shall deliver to Foothill a written statement by 
the chief financial officer of Borrower specifying the nature of any of the 
following events and the actions which Borrower proposes to take with respect 
thereto promptly, and in any event within ten (10) days of becoming aware of 
any of them, and when known, any action taken or threatened by the Internal 
Revenue Service, PBGC, Department of Labor, or other party with respect 
thereto:  (i) an ERISA Event with respect to any Plan; (ii) the incurrence of 
an obligation to pay additional premium to the PBGC under Section 
4006(a)(3)(E) of ERISA with respect to any Plan; and (iii) any lien on the 
assets of Borrower arising in connection with any Plan.

               (b)  Borrower shall also promptly furnish to Foothill copies 
prepared or received by Borrower or an ERISA Affiliate of:  (i) at the 
request of Foothill, each annual report (Internal Revenue Service Form 5500 
series) and all accompanying schedules, actuarial reports, financial 
information concerning the financial status of each Plan, and schedules 
showing the amounts contributed to each Plan by or on behalf of Borrower or 
its ERISA Affiliates for the most recent three (3) plan years; (ii) all 
notices of intent to terminate or to have a trustee appointed to administer 
any Plan; (iii) all written demands by the PBGC under Subtitle D of Title IV 
of ERISA; (iv) all notices required to be sent to employees or to the PBGC 
under Section 302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the IRC; (v) all written notices 
received with respect to a Multiemployer Plan concerning (x) the imposition 
or amount of withdrawal liability pursuant to Section 4202 of ERISA, (y) a 
termination described in Section 4041A of ERISA, or (z) a reorganization or 
insolvency described in Subtitle E of Title IV of ERISA; (vi) the adoption of 
any new Plan that is subject to Title IV of ERISA or Section 412 of the IRC 
by Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate; (vii) the adoption of any amendment to 
any Plan that is subject to Title IV of ERISA or Section 412 of the IRC, if 
such amendment results in a material increase in benefits or Unfunded Benefit 
Liability; or (viii) the commencement of contributions by Borrower or any 
ERISA Affiliate to any Plan that is subject to Title IV of ERISA or Section 
412 of the IRC.

                                        -28-




     7.   NEGATIVE COVENANTS.

          Borrower covenants and agrees that, so long as any credit hereunder 
shall be available and until full and final payment of the Obligations, 
Borrower will not do any of the following without Foothill's prior written 
consent:

          7.1  Indebtedness.  Create, incur, assume, permit, guarantee, or 
otherwise become or remain, directly or indirectly, liable with respect to 
any Indebtedness, except:

               (a)  Indebtedness evidenced by this Agreement;

               (b)  Indebtedness set forth in the latest financial statements 
of Borrower submitted to Foothill on or prior to the Closing Date;

               (c)  Indebtedness secured by Permitted Liens;

               (d)  refinancings, renewals, or extensions of Indebtedness 
permitted under clauses (b) and (c) of this Section 7.1 (and continuance or 
renewal of any Permitted Liens associated therewith) so long as: (i) the 
terms and conditions of such refinancings, renewals, or extensions do not 
materially impair the prospects of repayment of the Obligations by Borrower, 
(ii) the net cash proceeds of such refinancings, renewals, or extensions do 
not result in an increase in the aggregate principal amount of the 
Indebtedness so refinanced, renewed, or extended, (iii) such refinancings, 
renewals, refundings, or extensions do not result in a shortening of the 
average weighted maturity of the Indebtedness so refinanced, renewed, or 
extended, and (iv) to the extent that Indebtedness that is refinanced was 
subordinated in right of payment to the Obligations, then the subordination 
terms and conditions of the refinancing Indebtedness must be at least as 
favorable to Foothill as those applicable to the refinanced Indebtedness;

               (e)  Leases, whether operating leases or capital leases of 
existing or after acquired Equipment; and

               (f)  Indebtedness subordinated to the Obligations on terms and 
conditions satisfactory to Foothill.

          7.2  Liens.  Create, incur, assume, or permit to exist, directly or 
indirectly, any lien on or with respect to any of its property or assets, of 
any kind, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, or any income or profits 
therefrom, except for Permitted Liens (including liens that are replacements 
of Permitted Liens to the extent that the original Indebtedness is refinanced 
under Section 7.1(d) and so long as the replacement liens secure only those 
assets or property that secured the original Indebtedness).

                                        -29-


          7.3  Restrictions on Fundamental Changes.  Without Foothill's prior 
written consent, enter into any acquisition, merger, consolidation, 
reorganization, or recapitalization, or liquidate, wind up, or dissolve 
itself (or suffer any liquidation or dissolution), or convey, sell, assign, 
lease, transfer, or otherwise dispose of, in one transaction or a series of 
transactions, all or any substantial part of its business, property, or 
assets, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, or acquire by purchase or 
otherwise all or substantially all of the properties, assets, stock, or other 
evidence of beneficial ownership of any Person.

          7.4  Extraordinary Transactions and Disposal of Assets.  Enter into 
any transaction not in the ordinary and usual course of Borrower's business, 
including the sale, lease, or other disposition of, moving, relocation, or 
transfer, whether by sale or otherwise, of any material portion of Borrower's 
properties or assets (other than sales of Inventory to buyers in the ordinary 
course of Borrower's business as currently conducted).

          7.5  Change Name.  Change Borrower's name, FEIN, business 
structure, or identity, or add any new fictitious name.

          7.6  Guarantee.  Without Foothill's prior written consent, 
guarantee or otherwise become in any way liable with respect to the 
obligations of any third Person except by endorsement or instruments or items 
of payment for deposit to the account of Borrower or which are transmitted or 
turned over to Foothill.

          7.7  Restructure.  Make any change in the principal nature of 
Borrower's business operations, or the date of its fiscal year.

          7.8  Prepayments.  Except in connection with a refinancing 
permitted by Section 7.1(d), prepay any Indebtedness owing to any third 
Person except for the repayment of Borrower's outstanding 12% Senior 
Subordinated Notes Due 2002 from net proceeds of the IPO.

          7.9  Change of Control.  Except for transfers of shares by 
Borrower's existing shareholders to members of their immediate family, cause, 
permit, or suffer, directly or indirectly, any Change of Control.

          7.10 Capital Expenditures.  Make any capital expenditure, or any 
commitment therefor, where the aggregate amount of such capital expenditures 
(other than capital expenditures for the purchase of a new headquarters and 
distribution center for Borrower), made or committed for in each fiscal year 
ending on or about January 31 for each of the years set forth below is in 
excess of the applicable amount set forth below:

               Maximum Capital                     Fiscal Year Ending
                Expenditures                     on or About January 31
               ---------------                   ----------------------

                 $20,000,000                      1998
                  26,000,000                      1999
                 $32,000,000                      2000

          7.11 Consignments.  Consign any Inventory or sell any Inventory on 
bill and hold, sale or return, sale on approval, or other conditional terms 
of sale.

          7.12 Distributions.  Except for:  (a) the repurchase of Warrants to 
purchase shares of Borrowers Series A Common Stock from net proceeds of the 
IPO, and (b) the repayment of $488,000 to Ezra Dabah for his stock 
subscription, make any distribution or declare or pay any dividends (in cash) 
on, or purchase, acquire, redeem, or retire any of Borrower's capital stock, 
of any class, whether now or hereafter outstanding.

                                      -30-


          7.13 Accounting Methods.  Modify or change its method of accounting 
or enter into, modify, or terminate any agreement currently existing, or at 
any time hereafter entered into with any third party accounting firm or 
service bureau for the preparation or storage of Borrower's accounting 
records without said accounting firm or service bureau agreeing to provide 
Foothill information regarding the Collateral or Borrower's financial 
condition.  Borrower waives the right to assert a confidential relationship, 
if any, it may have with any accounting firm or service bureau in connection 
with any information requested by Foothill pursuant to or in accordance with 
this Agreement, and agrees that Foothill may contact directly any such 
accounting firm or service bureau in order to obtain such information.

          7.14 Advances, Investments and Loans.  Make any Investment except:

               (a)  Investments in cash and cash equivalents;

               (b)  so long as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be 
continuing, or would occur as a consequence thereof, Borrower and its 
Subsidiaries may make loans and advances to employees for moving and travel 
expenses and other similar expenses, in each case incurred in the ordinary 
course of business, and may make loans and advances to directors, officers 
and employees, in an aggregate principal amount not to exceed $100,000 at any 
time outstanding (determined without respect to any write-down or write-off 
of any such loans or advances); and

               (c)  Investments in existence on the date hereof and so long 
as no Event of Default shall have occurred and be continuing, or would occur 
as a consequence thereof, extensions, renewals, modifications, restatements 
or replacements thereof so long as the aggregate dollar amount of all such 
extensions, renewals, modifications, restatements, or replacements does not 
exceed the amount of such Investments in existence on the date hereof.

          7.15 Transactions with Affiliates.  Directly or indirectly enter 
into or permit to exist any material transaction with any Affiliate of 
Borrower except for:  (a) transactions that are in the ordinary course of 
Borrower's business, upon fair and reasonable terms, that are fully disclosed 
to Foothill, and that are no less favorable to Borrower than would be 
obtained in arm's length transaction with a non-Affiliate, (b) the employment 
agreement between Borrower and Ezra Dabah, and (c) the advisory agreement 
between Borrower and SKM Investors.

          7.16 Suspension.  Suspend or go out of a substantial portion of its 
business.

          7.17 Compensation.  Pay or accrue fees to outside directors in an 
aggregate amount in excess of Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000) in any year; 
nor pay or accrue total cash compensation, during any year, to officers and 
senior management employees (other than newly hired or promoted senior 
management employees who are not replacements for current employees) in an 
aggregate amount in excess of one hundred fifteen percent (115%) of that paid 
or accrued in the prior year, except for payments or accruals pursuant to 
Borrower's existing bonus plan, a copy of which as previously been provided 
to Foothill.  This Section shall be automatically deleted and of no further 
force and effect upon the closing of the IPO.

          7.18 Use of Proceeds.  Use the proceeds of the advances made 
hereunder for any purpose other than: (a) to pay transactional fees, costs 
and expenses incurred in connection with this Agreement; and (b) consistent 
with the terms and conditions hereof, for its lawful and permitted corporate 
purposes.

          7.19 Change in Location of Chief Executive Office; Inventory and 
Equipment with Bailees.  Borrower covenants and agrees that it will not, 
without thirty (30) days prior written notification to Foothill, relocate its 
chief executive office to a new location and so long as, at the time of such 
written notification, Borrower provides any financing statements or fixture 
filings necessary to perfect and continue perfected Foothill's security

                                        -31-




interests and also provides to Foothill a landlord's waiver in form and 
substance satisfactory to Foothill.  The Inventory and Equipment shall not at 
any time now or hereafter be stored with a bailee, warehouseman, or similar 
party without Foothill's prior written consent.  

     8.   EVENTS OF DEFAULT.

          Any one or more of the following events shall constitute an event 
of default (each, an "Event of Default") under this Agreement:

          8.1  If Borrower fails to pay when due and payable or when declared 
due and payable, any portion of the Obligations (whether of principal, 
interest (including any interest which, but for the provisions of the 
Bankruptcy Code, would have accrued on such amounts), fees and charges due 
Foothill, reimbursement of Foothill Expenses, or other amounts constituting 
Obligations);

          8.2  If Borrower fails or neglects to perform, keep, or observe any 
term, provision, condition, covenant, or agreement contained in this 
Agreement, in any of the Loan Documents, or in any other present or future 
agreement between Borrower and Foothill; provided, however, that Borrower's 
failure or neglect to comply with Sections 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.9, 
6.11, 6.15 and 6.17 shall not constitute an Event of Default hereunder unless 
such failure or neglect continues for five (5) days or more;

          8.3  If there is a material impairment of the prospect of repayment 
of any portion of the Obligations owing to Foothill or a material impairment 
of the value or priority of Foothill's security interests in the Collateral;

          8.4  If any material portion of Borrower's properties or assets is 
attached, seized, subjected to a writ or distress warrant, or is levied upon, 
or comes into the possession of any third Person;

          8.5  If an Insolvency Proceeding is commenced by Borrower;

          8.6  If an Insolvency Proceeding is commenced against Borrower and 
any of the following events occur:  (a) Borrower consents to the institution 
of the Insolvency Proceeding against it; (b) the petition commencing the 
Insolvency Proceeding is not timely controverted; (c) the petition commencing 
the Insolvency Proceeding is not dismissed within forty-five (45) calendar 
days of the date of the filing thereof; provided, however, that, during the 
pendency of such period, Foothill shall be relieved of its obligation to make 
additional advances or issue additional L/Cs or L/C Guarantees hereunder; (d) 
an interim trustee is appointed to take possession of all or a substantial 
portion of the properties or assets of, or to operate all or any substantial 
portion of the business of, Borrower; or (e) an order for relief shall have 
been issued or entered therein;

          8.7  If Borrower is enjoined, restrained, or in any way prevented 
by court order from continuing to conduct all or any material part of its 
business affairs;

                                      -32-



          8.8  If a notice of lien, levy, or assessment is filed of record 
with respect to any of Borrower's properties or assets by the United States 
Government, or any department, agency, or instrumentality thereof, or by any 
state, county, municipal, or governmental agency, or if any taxes or debts 
owing at any time hereafter to any one or more of such entities becomes a 
lien, whether choate or otherwise, upon any of Borrower's properties or 
assets and the same is not paid on the payment date thereof;

          8.9  If (a) an action or proceeding is brought against Borrower 
which is reasonably likely to be decided adversely to Borrower, and such 
adverse decision would materially impair the prospect of repayment of the 
Obligations or materially impair the value or priority of Foothill's security 
interests in the Collateral, or (b) if a judgment or other claim in excess of 
Two Hundred Fifty Thousand Dollars ($250,000) becomes a lien or encumbrance 
upon any material portion of Borrower's properties or assets and shall remain 
outstanding thirty (30) days or longer;

          8.10 If there is a default in an agreement involving Indebtedness 
of Two Hundred Fifty Thousand Dollars ($250,000), or more, or any material 
agreement to which Borrower is a party with one or more third Persons 
resulting in a right by such third Persons, irrespective of whether 
exercised, to accelerate the maturity of Borrower's obligations thereunder;

          8.11 If Borrower makes any payment on account of Indebtedness that 
has been contractually subordinated in right of payment to the payment of the 
Obligations, except to the extent such payment is permitted by the terms of 
the subordination provisions applicable to such Indebtedness or is permitted 
by Section 7.8;

          8.12 If any material misstatement or misrepresentation exists now 
or hereafter in any warranty, representation, statement, or report made to 
Foothill by Borrower or any officer, employee, agent, or director of 
Borrower, or if any such warranty or representation is withdrawn;

          8.13 If the obligation of any guarantor or other third Person under 
any Loan Document is limited or terminated by operation of law or by the 
guarantor or other third Person thereunder, or any such guarantor or other 
third Person becomes the subject of an Insolvency Proceeding; or

          8.14 If (a) with respect to any Plan, there shall occur any of the 
following which could reasonably be expected to have a material adverse 
effect on the financial condition of Borrower:  (i) the violation of any of 
the provisions of ERISA; (ii) the loss by a Plan intended to be a Qualified 
Plan of its qualification under Section 401(a) of the IRC; (iii) the 
incurrence of liability under Title IV of ERISA; (iv) a failure to make full 
payment when due of all amounts which, under the provisions of any Plan or 
applicable law, Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate is required to make; (v) the 
filing of a notice of intent to terminate a Plan under Sections 4041 or 4041A 
of ERISA; (vi) a complete or partial withdrawal of Borrower or an ERISA 
Affiliate from any Plan; (vii) the receipt of a notice by the plan 
administrator of a Plan that the PBGC has instituted proceedings to terminate 
such Plan or appoint a trustee to administer such Plan; (viii) a commencement 
or increase of contributions to, or the adoption of or the amendment of, a 
Plan; and (ix) the assessment against Borrower or any ERISA Affiliate of a 
tax under Section 4980B of the IRC; or (b) the Unfunded Benefit Liability of 
all of the Plans of Borrower and its

                                          33




ERISA Affiliates shall, in the aggregate, exceed Two Hundred Fifty Thousand 
Dollars ($250,000).

     9.   FOOTHILL'S RIGHTS AND REMEDIES.

          9.1  Rights and Remedies.  Upon the occurrence of an Event of 
Default Foothill may, at its election, without notice of its election and 
without demand, do any one or more of the following, all of which are 
authorized by Borrower:

               (a)  Declare all Obligations, whether evidenced by this 
Agreement, by any of the other Loan Documents, or otherwise, immediately due 
and payable;

               (b)  Cease advancing money or extending credit to or for the 
benefit of Borrower under this Agreement, under any of the Loan Documents, or 
under any other agreement between Borrower and Foothill;

               (c)  Terminate this Agreement and any of the other Loan 
Documents as to any future liability or obligation of Foothill, but without 
affecting Foothill's rights and security interests in the Collateral and 
without affecting the Obligations;

               (d)  Settle or adjust disputes and claims directly with 
Account Debtors for amounts and upon terms which Foothill considers 
advisable, and in such cases, Foothill will credit Borrower's loan account 
with only the net amounts received by Foothill in payment of such disputed 
Accounts after deducting all Foothill Expenses incurred or expended in 
connection therewith;

               (e)  Cause Borrower to hold all returned Inventory in trust 
for Foothill, segregate all returned Inventory from all other property of 
Borrower or in Borrower's possession and conspicuously label said returned 
Inventory as the property of Foothill;

               (f)  Without notice to or demand upon Borrower or any 
guarantor, make such payments and do such acts as Foothill considers 
necessary or reasonable to protect its security interests in the Collateral.  
Borrower agrees to assemble the Collateral if Foothill so requires, and to 
make the Collateral available to Foothill as Foothill may designate.  
Borrower authorizes Foothill to enter the premises where the Collateral is 
located, to take and maintain possession of the Collateral, or any part of 
it, and to pay, purchase, contest, or compromise any encumbrance, charge, or 
lien that in Foothill's determination appears to conflict with its security 
interests and to pay all expenses incurred in connection therewith.  With 
respect to any of Borrower's owned premises, Borrower hereby grants Foothill 
a license to enter into possession of such premises and to occupy the same, 
without charge, for up to one hundred twenty (120) days in order to exercise 
any of Foothill's rights or remedies provided herein, at law, in equity, or 
otherwise;

               (g)  Without notice to Borrower (such notice being expressly 
waived), and without constituting a retention of any collateral in 
satisfaction of an obligation (within the

                                      -34-



meaning of Section 9505 of the Code), set off and apply to the Obligations 
any and all (i) balances and deposits of Borrower held by Foothill (including 
any amounts received in the Lock Boxes), or (ii) indebtedness at any time 
owing to or for the credit or the account of Borrower held by Foothill;

               (h)  Hold, as cash collateral, any and all balances and 
deposits of Borrower held by Foothill, and any amounts received in the Lock 
Boxes, to secure the full and final repayment of all of the Obligations;

               (i)  Ship, reclaim, recover, store, finish, maintain, repair, 
prepare for sale, advertise for sale, and sell (in the manner provided for 
herein) the Collateral.  Foothill is hereby granted a license or other right 
to use, without charge, Borrower's labels, patents, copyrights, rights of use 
of any name, trade secrets, trade names, trademarks, service marks, and 
advertising matter, or any property of a similar nature, as it pertains to 
the Collateral, in completing production of, advertising for sale, and 
selling any Collateral and Borrower's rights under all licenses and all 
franchise agreements shall inure to Foothill's benefit;

               (j)  Sell the Collateral at either a public or private sale, 
or both, by way of one or more contracts or transactions, for cash or on 
terms, in such manner and at such places (including Borrower's premises) as 
Foothill determines is commercially reasonable.  It is not necessary that the 
Collateral be present at any such sale;

               (k)  Foothill shall give notice of the disposition of the 
Collateral as follows:

                    (1)  Foothill shall give (i) each holder of a security 
interest in the Collateral who has filed with Foothill a written request for 
notice and (ii) Borrower, a notice in writing of the time and place of public 
sale, or, if the sale is a private sale or some other disposition other than 
a public sale is to be made of the Collateral, then the time on or after 
which the private sale or other disposition is to be made;

                    (2)  The notice shall be personally delivered or mailed, 
postage prepaid, to Borrower as provided in Section 12, at least five (5) 
days before the date fixed for the sale, or at least five (5) days before the 
date on or after which the private sale or other disposition is to be made; 
no notice needs to be given prior to the disposition of any portion of the 
Collateral that is perishable or threatens to decline speedily in value or 
that is of a type customarily sold on a recognized market.  Notice to Persons 
other than Borrower claiming an interest in the Collateral shall be sent to 
such addresses as they have furnished to Foothill;

                    (3)  If the sale is to be a public sale, Foothill also 
shall give notice of the time and place by publishing a notice one time at 
least five (5) days before the date of the sale in a newspaper of general 
circulation in the county in which the sale is to be held;

               (l)  Foothill may credit bid and purchase at any public sale; 
and

                                       -35-





               (m)  Any deficiency that exists after disposition of the 
Collateral as provided above will be paid immediately by Borrower.  Any 
excess will be returned, without interest and subject to the rights of third 
Persons, by Foothill to Borrower.

          9.2  Remedies Cumulative.  Foothill's rights and remedies under 
this Agreement, the Loan Documents, and all other agreements shall be 
cumulative. Foothill shall have all other rights and remedies not 
inconsistent herewith as provided under the Code, by law, or in equity.  No 
exercise by Foothill of one right or remedy shall be deemed an election, and 
no waiver by Foothill of any Event of Default shall be deemed a continuing 
waiver.  No delay by Foothill shall constitute a waiver, election, or 
acquiescence by it.

     10.  TAXES AND EXPENSES REGARDING THE COLLATERAL.

          If Borrower fails to pay any monies (whether taxes, rents, 
assessments, insurance premiums, or otherwise) due to third Persons within 
applicable grace periods, or fails to make any deposits or furnish any 
required proof of payment or deposit, all as required under the terms of this 
Agreement, then, to the extent that Foothill reasonably determines that such 
failure by Borrower could have a material adverse effect on Foothill's 
interests in the Collateral, in its discretion and without prior notice to 
Borrower, Foothill may do any or all of the following:  (a) make payment of 
the same or any part thereof; (b) set up such reserves in Borrower's loan 
account as Foothill deems necessary to protect Foothill from the exposure 
created by such failure; or (c) obtain and maintain insurance policies of the 
type described in Section 6.12, and take any action with respect to such 
policies as Foothill deems prudent. Any such amounts paid by Foothill shall 
constitute Foothill Expenses.  Any such payments made by Foothill shall not 
constitute an agreement by Foothill to make similar payments in the future or 
a waiver by Foothill of any Event of Default under this Agreement.  Foothill 
need not inquire as to, or contest the validity of, any such expense, tax, 
security interest, encumbrance, or lien and the receipt of the usual official 
notice for the payment thereof shall be conclusive evidence that the same was 
validly due and owing.

     11.  WAIVERS; INDEMNIFICATION.

          11.1 Demand; Protest; etc.  Borrower waives demand, protest, notice 
of protest, notice of default or dishonor, notice of payment and nonpayment, 
notice of any default, nonpayment at maturity, release, compromise, 
settlement, extension, or renewal of accounts, documents, instruments, 
chattel paper, and guarantees at any time held by Foothill on which Borrower 
may in any way be liable.

          11.2 Foothill's Liability for Collateral.  So long as Foothill 
complies with its obligations, if any, under Section 9207 of the Code, 
Foothill shall not in any way or manner be liable or responsible for:  (a) 
the safekeeping of the Collateral; (b) any loss or damage thereto occurring 
or arising in any manner or fashion from any cause; (c) any diminution in the 
value thereof; or (d) any act or default of any carrier, warehouseman, 
bailee, forwarding agency, or other Person.  All risk of loss, damage, or 
destruction of the Collateral shall be borne by Borrower.

                                      -36-






          11.3 Indemnification.  Borrower agrees to defend, indemnify, save, and
hold Foothill and its officers, employees, and agents harmless against: (a) all
obligations, demands, claims, and liabilities claimed or asserted by any other
Person arising out of or relating to the transactions contemplated by this
Agreement or any other Loan Document, and (b) all losses (including attorneys
fees and disbursements) in any way suffered, incurred, or paid by Foothill as a
result of or in any way arising out of, following, or consequential to the
transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any other Loan Document. This
provision shall survive the termination of this Agreement.

     12.  NOTICES.

          Unless otherwise provided in this Agreement, all notices or demands by
any party relating to this Agreement or any other Loan Document shall be in
writing and (except for financial statements and other informational documents
which may be sent by first-class mail, postage prepaid) shall be personally
delivered or sent by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, return
receipt requested, or by prepaid telex, TWX, telefacsimile, or telegram (with
messenger delivery specified) to Borrower or to Foothill, as the case may be, at
its address set forth below:

   If to Borrower:    THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.
                      One Dodge Drive
                      West Caldwell, New Jersey 07006
                      Attn.: Mr. Stanley B. Silver, Chief Operating Officer and
                      Attn.: General Counsel
                      Telefacsimile No. (201) 808-5637

     With copy to:    STROOCK & STROOCK & LAVAN LLP
                      180 Maiden Lane
                      New York, New York 10038
                      Attn: Jeffrey S. Lowenthal
                      Telefacsimile No. (212) 806-6006

     If to Foothill:  FOOTHILL CAPITAL CORPORATION
                      11111 Santa Monica Boulevard
                      Suite 1500
                      Los Angeles, California 90025-3333
                      Attn.:  Business Finance Division Manager
                      Telefacsimile No. (310) 479-2690



                                          37





          The parties hereto may change the address at which they are to receive
notices hereunder, by notice in writing in the foregoing manner given to the
other.  All notices or demands sent in accordance with this Section 12, other
than notices by Foothill in connection with Sections 9504 or 9505 of the Code,
shall be deemed received on the earlier of the date of actual receipt or three
(3) days after the deposit thereof in the mail.  Borrower acknowledges and
agrees that notices sent by Foothill in connection with Sections 9504 or 9505 of
the Code shall be deemed sent when deposited in the mail or transmitted by
telefacsimile or other similar method set forth above.

     13.  CHOICE OF LAW AND VENUE; JURY TRIAL WAIVER.

          THE VALIDITY OF THIS AGREEMENT, ITS CONSTRUCTION, INTERPRETATION, AND
ENFORCEMENT, AND THE RIGHTS OF THE PARTIES HERETO WITH RESPECT TO ALL MATTERS
ARISING HEREUNDER OR RELATED HERETO SHALL BE DETERMINED UNDER, GOVERNED BY, AND
CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF CALIFORNIA, WITHOUT GIVING
EFFECT TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAWS PRINCIPLES.  THE PARTIES AGREE THAT ALL ACTIONS
OR PROCEEDINGS ARISING IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE TRIED AND
LITIGATED ONLY IN THE STATE AND FEDERAL COURTS LOCATED IN THE COUNTY OF LOS
ANGELES, STATE OF CALIFORNIA OR, AT THE SOLE OPTION OF FOOTHILL, IN ANY OTHER
COURT IN WHICH FOOTHILL SHALL INITIATE LEGAL OR EQUITABLE PROCEEDINGS AND WHICH
HAS SUBJECT MATTER JURISDICTION OVER THE MATTER IN CONTROVERSY.  EACH OF
BORROWER AND FOOTHILL WAIVES, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW, ANY
RIGHT EACH MAY HAVE TO ASSERT THE DOCTRINE OF FORUM NON CONVENIENS OR TO OBJECT
TO VENUE TO THE EXTENT ANY PROCEEDING IS BROUGHT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THIS SECTION
13.  BORROWER AND FOOTHILL HEREBY WAIVE THEIR RESPECTIVE RIGHTS TO A JURY TRIAL
OF ANY CLAIM OR CAUSE OF ACTION BASED UPON OR ARISING OUT OF ANY OF THE LOAN
DOCUMENTS OR ANY OF THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED THEREIN, INCLUDING CONTRACT
CLAIMS, TORT CLAIMS, BREACH OF DUTY CLAIMS, AND ALL OTHER COMMON LAW OR
STATUTORY CLAIMS.  BORROWER AND FOOTHILL REPRESENT THAT EACH HAS REVIEWED THIS
WAIVER AND EACH KNOWINGLY AND VOLUNTARILY WAIVES ITS JURY TRIAL RIGHTS FOLLOWING
CONSULTATION WITH LEGAL COUNSEL.  IN THE EVENT OF LITIGATION, A COPY OF THIS
AGREEMENT MAY BE FILED AS A WRITTEN CONSENT TO A TRIAL BY THE COURT.

     14.  DESTRUCTION OF BORROWER'S DOCUMENTS.

          All documents, schedules, invoices, agings, or other papers delivered
to Foothill may be destroyed or otherwise disposed of by Foothill four (4)
months after they are delivered  



                                          38



to or received by Foothill, unless Borrower requests, in writing, the return of
said documents, schedules, or other papers and makes arrangements, at Borrower's
expense, for their return.

     15.  GENERAL PROVISIONS.

          15.1 Effectiveness.  This Agreement shall be binding and deemed
effective when executed by Borrower and Foothill.

          15.2 Successors and Assigns.  This Agreement shall bind and inure to
the benefit of the respective successors and assigns of each of the parties;
provided, however, that Borrower may not assign this Agreement or any rights or
duties hereunder without Foothill's prior written consent and any prohibited
assignment shall be absolutely void.  No consent to an assignment by Foothill
shall release Borrower from its Obligations.  Foothill may assign this Agreement
and its rights and duties hereunder and no consent or approval by Borrower is
required in connection with any such assignment.  Foothill reserves the right to
sell, assign, transfer, negotiate, or grant participations in all or any part
of, or any interest in Foothill's rights and benefits hereunder.  In connection
with any such assignment or participation, Foothill may disclose all documents
and information which Foothill now or hereafter may have relating to Borrower or
Borrower's business.  To the extent that Foothill assigns its rights and
obligations hereunder to a third Person, Foothill shall thereafter be released
from such assigned obligations to Borrower and such assignment shall effect a
novation between Borrower and such third Person.

          15.3 Section Headings.  Headings and numbers have been set forth
herein for convenience only.  Unless the contrary is compelled by the context,
everything contained in each section applies equally to this entire Agreement.

          15.4 Interpretation.  Neither this Agreement nor any uncertainty or
ambiguity herein shall be construed or resolved against Foothill or Borrower,
whether under any rule of construction or otherwise.  On the contrary, this
Agreement has been reviewed by all parties and shall be construed and
interpreted according to the ordinary meaning of the words used so as to fairly
accomplish the purposes and intentions of all parties hereto.

          15.5 Severability of Provisions.  Each provision of this Agreement
shall be severable from every other provision of this Agreement for the purpose
of determining the legal enforceability of any specific provision.

          15.6 Amendments in Writing.  This Agreement can only be amended by a
writing signed by both Foothill and Borrower.

          15.7 Counterparts; Telefacsimile Execution.  This Agreement may be
executed in any number of counterparts and by different parties on separate
counterparts, each of which, when executed and delivered, shall be deemed to be
an original, and all of which, when taken together, shall constitute but one and
the same Agreement.  Delivery of an executed counterpart of this Agreement by
telefacsimile shall be equally as effective as delivery of a 


                                          39



manually executed counterpart of this Agreement.  Any party delivering an
executed counterpart of this Agreement by telefacsimile also shall deliver a
manually executed counterpart of this Agreement but the failure to deliver a
manually executed counterpart shall not affect the validity, enforceability,
and binding effect of this Agreement.

          15.8 Revival and Reinstatement of Obligations.  If the incurrence or
payment of the Obligations by Borrower or any guarantor of the Obligations or
the transfer by either or both of such parties to Foothill of any property of
either or both of such parties should for any reason subsequently be declared to
be void or voidable under any state or federal law relating to creditors'
rights, including provisions of the Bankruptcy Code relating to fraudulent
conveyances, preferences, and other voidable or recoverable payments of money or
transfers of property (collectively, a "Voidable Transfer"), and if Foothill is
required to repay or restore, in whole or in part, any such Voidable Transfer,
or elects to do so upon the reasonable advice of its counsel, then, as to any
such Voidable Transfer, or the amount thereof that Foothill is required or
elects to repay or restore, and as to all reasonable costs, expenses, and
attorneys fees of Foothill related thereto, the liability of Borrower or such
guarantor automatically shall be revived, reinstated, and restored and shall
exist as though such Voidable Transfer had never been made.

          15.9 Integration.  This Agreement, together with the other Loan
Documents, reflect the entire understanding of the parties with respect to the
transactions contemplated hereby and shall not be contradicted or qualified by
any other agreement, oral or written, before the date hereof.

          IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Agreement to
be executed in Los Angeles, California.


                              FOOTHILL CAPITAL CORPORATION,
                              a California corporation


                              By
                                ----------------------------------------
                              Title:  Vice President


                              THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.,
                              a Delaware corporation


                              By
                                ----------------------------------------
                              Title:  President







                                          40



                       LIBOR SUPPLEMENT TO AMENDED AND RESTATED
                             LOAN AND SECURITY AGREEMENT


         This Libor Supplement ("Supplement") is a supplement to the Amended
and Restated Loan and Security Agreement between THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL
STORES, INC. ("Borrower") and FOOTHILL CAPITAL CORPORATION ("Foothill") dated as
of July 31, 1997 (as amended, the "Agreement").  This Supplement is: (a) hereby
incorporated into the Agreement; (b) made a part thereof; and (c) subject to the
other terms, conditions, covenants and warranties thereof.  All terms (including
capitalized terms) used herein shall have the meanings ascribed to them
respectively in the Agreement, unless otherwise defined in this Supplement.

         1.   DEFINITIONS.  The following terms shall have the meanings set
forth below:

              "ADJUSTED LIBOR RATE" means, for any Interest Period, the rate
per annum (rounded upwards, if necessary, to the next 1/16 of 1%) determined
pursuant to the following formula:

              Adjusted            =                   Libor Rate          
                                            ------------------------------
              Libor Rate                         1-Reserve Percentage

For purposes hereof, "LIBOR RATE" means the one month London Interbank Offered
Rate set in London two Business days prior to the commencement of each Interest
Period as published in The Wall Street Journal.

              "BUSINESS DAY" means a day on which banks in California are open
for the transaction of business.

              "BUSINESS DAY IN LONDON" means a day which is a Business Day and
a day on which banks in London, England are open for the transaction of banking
business.

              "FUNDING LOSSES" has the meaning set forth in SECTION 3(B)
hereof.

              "INTEREST PERIOD' means, with respect to that portion of the
Loans bearing interest based on the Adjusted Libor Rate, a period of one month
duration; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that:  (a) if any Interest Period would otherwise
end on a day which shall not be a Business Day in London, such Interest Period
shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day in London, subject to
clauses (c)-(e) below; (b) interest shall accrue from and including the first
day of each Interest Period to, but excluding, the day on which any Interest
Period expires; (c) any Interest Period which would otherwise end on a day which
is not a Business Day in London shall be extended to the next succeeding
Business Day in London unless such Business Day in London falls in another
calendar 


                                          41



month, in which case such Interest Period shall end on the next preceding
Business Day in London; (d) with respect to an Interest Period which begins on
the last Business Day in London of a calendar month (or on a day for which there
is no numerically corresponding day in the calendar month at the end of such
Interest Period), the Interest Period shall end on the last Business Day in
London of the calendar month which is one month after the date on which the
Interest Period began, as applicable and (e) Borrower may not elect an Interest
Period which will end after the Maturity Date.

              "LIBOR DEADLINE" has the meaning set forth in SECTION 3(A)
hereof.

              "LIBOR OPTION" has the meaning set forth in SECTION 2 hereof.

              "LOAN" or "LOANS" means Borrower's Obligations to Foothill that
arise under the Agreement.

              "MATURITY DATE" means, at the time of selection of an Interest
Period, the last day of the then current term of the Agreement.

              "RESERVE PERCENTAGE" means, on any day, the percentage (expressed
as a decimal) prescribed by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
(or any successor or any other banking authority to which federal or state
chartered banks are subject, including any board or governmental or
administrative agency of the United States or any other jurisdiction to which
banks are subject), for determining the reserve requirement (including without
limitation any basic, supplemental, marginal or emergency reserves) which is or
would be applicable to deposits of United States Dollars in a non-United States
or an international banking office of a bank used to fund a loan subject to an
Adjusted Libor Rate or any loan made with the proceeds of such deposit.  The
Adjusted Libor Rate shall be adjusted on and as of the effective day of any
change in the Reserve Percentage.

         2.   INTEREST AND INTEREST PAYMENT DATES.  In lieu of having charged
based upon the Reference Rate, Borrower shall have the option (the "Libor
Option") to have interest on a portion of its Loans be charged based on the
Adjusted Libor Rate.  For purposes hereof, interest "based on the Adjusted Libor
Rate" shall mean interest at the Adjusted Libor Rate PLUS 2.0% per annum;
PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that during any calendar month in which the Borrower's EBITDA
(for the most recent 12 months) is at least $20,000,000, "based on the Adjusted
Libor Rate" shall mean interest at the Adjusted Libor Rate PLUS 1.50% per annum.
Interest on that portion of the Loans bearing interest based on the Adjusted
Libor Rate ("Adjusted Libor Rate Loans") shall be payable on the last day of
each month and on the last day of each Interest Period and may, at Foothill's
option, be charged directly to Borrower's loan account maintained by Foothill. 
Interest based on the Adjusted Libor Rate shall be calculated for each month (or
portion thereof) based on the number of days elapsed and a year of 360 days.  On
and after the date of any Event of Default or termination or non-renewal of the
Agreement, interest on all outstanding Adjusted 


                                          42



Libor Rate Loans shall accrue at a rate equal to two percent per annum in excess
of the pre-default rate set forth above from the date of such Event of Default
or termination or non-renewal until the end of the Interest Period, and all such
interest accruing hereunder shall thereafter be payable on demand.  Upon
expiration of the Interest Period, or earlier at Foothill's option following an
Event of Default or termination or non-renewal of the Agreement, and until
Borrower's subsequent permitted exercise, if any, of the Libor Option, all Loans
shall accrue interest in accordance with SECTION 2.3 of the Agreement.  In no
event shall charges constituting interest, payable by Borrower under this
Supplement, exceed the rate permitted under any applicable law or regulation,
and if any part or provision of this Supplement is in contravention of any such
law or regulation, such part or provision shall be deemed amended to conform
thereto.

         3.   LIBOR ELECTION.

              (a)  Borrower may, at any time prior to an Event of Default or
termination or non-renewal of the Agreement, exercise the Libor Option by
Notifying Foothill prior to 3:00 p.m. (Los Angeles time) at least three Business
Days in London prior to the commencement of the proposed Interest Period (the
"Libor Deadline").  Notice of Borrower's election of the Libor Option for a
permitted portion of the Loans and an Interest Period pursuant to this SECTION 3
shall be made by delivery to Foothill of a Libor Notice in a form reasonably
requested by Foothill via facsimile teletransmission received by Foothill before
the Libor Deadline, or by telephonic notice received by Foothill before the
Libor Deadline (to be confirmed by facsimile teletransmission to Foothill of the
Libor Notice to be received by Foothill prior to 5:00 p.m. (Los Angeles time) on
the same day; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that Borrower's failure to deliver such
confirming Libor Notice shall not affect the applicability of such rate if
Borrower's election is implemented by Foothill).

              (b)  Each Libor Notice pursuant to this SECTION 3 shall be
irrevocable and binding on Borrower.  In connection with the Adjusted Libor Rate
Loans, Borrower shall indemnify Foothill against a loss, cost or expense
incurred by Foothill as a result of any failure to fulfill on or before the date
specified in the Libor Notice, the applicable conditions set forth herein or the
termination prior to the end of an Interest Period of the applicability of
interest based on the Adjusted Libor Rate, as provided hereunder, including,
without limitation, any loss (including loss of anticipated profits), cost or
expense incurred by reason of the liquidation or reemployment of deposits or
other funds acquired or committed to be acquired by Foothill or its participants
to fund the requested Adjusted Libor Rate Loans which, as a result of such
failure, are not so employed on such date (such losses, costs, and expenses,
collectively "Funding Losses").

              (c)  Borrower shall only have two Interest Periods in existence
at any given time.  Borrower may only exercise the Libor Option for Adjusted
Libor Rate Loans of at least $500,000 and integral multiples of $500,000 in
excess thereof.  The maximum amount of Adjusted Libor Rate Loans at any given
time shall not exceed 90% of the projected average daily balance of the Loans
for the Interest Period in question as 


                                          43



determined by Foothill, based upon information furnished by Borrower, but
without creating any obligation on Foothill's part to make any Loans available
other than on the terms and conditions set forth in the Agreement.

         4.   PREPAYMENTS.

              (a)  Borrower may elect to prepay any Adjusted Rate Loans only on
the last day of the applicable Interest Period, PROVIDED, that in the event of
the prepayment of any such Loans, including any automatic prepayment through
required application by Foothill of proceed of Accounts and other Collateral
received by Foothill,on a date other than the last day of an Interest Period for
any reason, including, without limitation, acceleration pursuant to SECTION 4(B)
hereof or pursuant to the Agreement, Borrower shall indemnify Foothill for
Funding Losses which may arise in connection with such prepayment.
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, if the outstanding
Loans are reduced below the balance of the outstanding Adjusted Libor Rate by
virtue of automatic prepayment from proceeds of Accounts and other collateral,
then Foothill will automatically make an advance to Borrower so that the
outstanding Loans will equal the outstanding Adjusted Libor Rate Loans so long
as Borrower has sufficient borrowing availability under the formulas set forth
in the Agreement and subject to the reserves and applicable sublimits
thereunder.

              (b)  In the event that the aggregate amount with respect to which
the Borrower has exercised the Libor Option exceeds the amount of Loans actually
outstanding at any time, or in the event that the Adjusted Libor Rate Loans
shall at any time exceed the amounts of Loans under the Agreement which Foothill
determines are available under the lending formulas and subject to reserves, the
definitions of Maximum Credit and Maximum Revolving Credit and applicable
sublimits, all as set forth in the Agreement, then, in addition to all other
rights and remedies to Foothill, Foothill may, at its option, require that such
Adjusted Libor Rate Loans cease to accrue based on the Adjusted Libor Rate.  In
such event, the Adjusted Libor Rate Loans will bear interest as provided in
SECTION 2.5(A) of the Agreement, and Borrower shall indemnify Foothill for
Funding Losses which may arise in connection with the termination of
applicability of interest based on the Adjusted Libor Rate.

         5.   SPECIAL PROVISIONS APPLICABLE TO ADJUSTED LIBOR RATE.

              (a)  The Adjusted Libor Rate may be automatically adjusted by
Foothill on a prospective basis to take into account the additional or increased
cost to Foothill of maintaining any necessary reserves for Eurodollar deposits
or increased costs due to change in applicable law occurring subsequent to the
commencement of the then applicable Interest Period, including but not limited
to changes in tax laws (except changes of general applicability in corporate
income tax laws) and changes in the reserve requirements imposed by the Board of
Governors of the Federal Reserve System (or any successor), excluding the
Reserve Percentage, that increase or would increase the costs of 


                                          44



funding loans bearing interest based on the Adjusted Libor Rate.  Foothill shall
give Borrower's notice of such determination and adjustment and Borrower may, by
notice to Foothill:  (i) require Foothill to furnish to Borrower a statement
setting forth the basis for adjusting such Adjusted Libor Rate and the method
for determining the amount of such adjustment; and/or (ii) repay the Adjusted
Libor Rate Loans, or portions thereof, with respect to which such adjustment is
made, as appropriate.

              (b)  In the event that any change in circumstances or any law,
regulation, treaty or directive, or any change therein or the interpretation of
application thereof, shall at any time after the date hereof, in the reasonable
opinion of Foothill, make it unlawful or impractical for Foothill to fund or
maintain an Adjusted Libor Loan or to continue such funding or maintaining or to
determine or change interest rates based on the Adjusted Libor Rate, Foothill
shall give notice of such circumstances to the Borrower and (i) in the case of
any Adjusted Libor Rate Loans which are outstanding, the date specified in
Foothill's notice shall be deemed to be the last day of the Interest Period of
such Adjusted Libor Rate Loans, and interest upon the Adjusted Libor Loans then
outstanding shall thereafter accrue as provided in SECTION 2.5(A) of the
Agreement, and (ii) Foothill shall not be obligated to permit Borrower to elect
the Libor Option as to any Loan until Foothill determines that it would no
longer be unlawful or impractical to do so.

         6.   NO REQUIREMENT FOR MATCHED FUNDING.  Notwithstanding anything to
the contrary contained in this Supplement, neither Foothill nor any participant
is required to actually acquire United States dollar deposits on the London
Interbank Market to fund or otherwise match fund any Loans as to which interest
accrues based on the Adjusted Libor Rate.  Provisions of SECTION 4 of this
Supplement shall apply as if Foothill and/or its participants had match funded
any Loans as to which interest is accruing based on the Adjusted Libor Rate by
acquiring United States dollar deposits in the London Interbank Market for each
Interest Period in the amount of the Adjusted Libor Rate Loan.  Funding 


                                          45



Losses of Foothill under this Supplement shall include the aggregate Funding
Losses of Foothill and its participants in the Adjusted Libor Rate Loans.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Supplement has been executed as of July 31,
1997.

                        THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.,
                        a Delaware corporation


                        By_____________________________________________________
                        Title__________________________________________________


                        FOOTHILL CAPITAL CORPORATION,
                        a California corporation


                        By_____________________________________________________
                        Title__________________________________________________


                                          46




                                                                  Exhibit 10.10


                              INDEMNITY AGREEMENT
                                       

    THIS INDEMNITY AGREEMENT is made and entered into as of the __ day of 
_________, 1997 by and between THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC., a 
corporation organized and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware, 
with offices at One Dodge Drive, West Caldwell, New Jersey 07006 (hereinafter 
the "Company"), and _________________ (hereinafter the "Director"),

                                       
                              W I T N E S S E T H:

    WHEREAS, the Company desires to have the Director serve as a director of 
the Company; and

    WHEREAS, the Director is willing to serve as a director of the Company 
upon the execution and delivery by the Company of this Indemnity Agreement.

    NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing premises and of the 
mutual promises herein contained, the parties hereby agree as follows:

    1.   Acceptance.  The Director hereby accepts the appointment as a 
director of the Company, and so long as he continues to be a director of the 
Company the Director shall, within the limits imposed by the law and ethics, 
exercise all functions required by the Amended and Restated Certificate of 
Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws of the Company, while observing 
to the best of his ability the interests of the Company.

    2.   Indemnification.  To the fullest extent permitted by law, the 
Company does hereby covenant and agree to indemnify the Director and to hold 
the Director harmless from and against any and all claims, threats, suits 
(whether instituted by the Company or any other person or entity), damages, 
penalties, liabilities, costs and expenses (including, without limitation, 
legal fees, costs and disbursements) incurred, suffered or expended by or 
threatened against the Director with respect to any action or inaction taken 
in the course of the Director's duties as a director of the Company.

    3.   Reimbursement.  The Company agrees to reimburse the Director 
immediately to the fullest extent permitted by law for any legal or other 
expenses reasonably incurred by either in connection with investigating, 
preparing to defend or defending, or providing evidence in or preparing to 
serve or serving as a witness with respect to any lawsuits, investigations, 
claims or other proceedings arising in any manner out of or in connection 
with the Director acting as a director of the Company (including, without 
limitation, in connection with the enforcement of this Agreement and the 
indemnification obligations set forth herein).

                                     -1-



    4.   Reservation of Right.  The indemnification provided by this 
agreement shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which those 
seeking indemnification may be entitled under any statute, agreement, vote of 
stockholders or disinterested directors or otherwise, and shall continue 
after the Director has ceased to be a director.

    5.   Amendment.  The terms of this agreement may be enlarged, modified or 
altered only by an instrument in writing by all of the parties hereto.

    6.   Waiver, Etc.  Any waiver on the part of any party hereto of any 
right or interest under this agreement shall not constitute the waiver of any 
right or interest or any subsequent waiver of such right or interest.  The 
failure of any party at any time to require performance of any provision of 
this agreement shall not affect the right of such party to require full 
performance thereof at any time thereafter.  Any waiver by any party of a 
breach of any provision of this agreement shall not constitute a waiver of 
any subsequent breach thereof and shall not nullify the effectiveness of such 
provision.  The failure by any party to give notice of a breach of any 
provision of this agreement shall not constitute a waiver of such breach.

    7.   Binding Effect.  Each reference herein to any party shall be deemed 
to include its or his successors and assigns, legal representatives, 
executors or administrators.

    8.   Governing Law.  This agreement shall be governed by and construed in 
accordance with the laws of the State of New York.

    9.   Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provision 
of this agreement shall not affect the validity or enforceability of any 
other provision of this agreement, and this agreement shall continue in full 
force and effect except for any such invalid or unenforceable provision. 

    10.  Captions.  The captions throughout this agreement are for 
convenience only and are not intended to limit or be used in the 
interpretation of the provisions of this agreement.

    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this agreement on 
the date hereinabove mentioned.

ATTEST:                           THE  CHILDREN'S PLACE, INC.



                                  By:
- ------------------------------       -------------------------
Steven Balasiano                        Ezra Dabah
Vice President, Secretary               Chairman
 and General Counsel                                       

ATTEST:                           [Director]


                                  ----------------------------


                                     -2-



                                                                Exhibit 10.12

                  AMENDED AND RESTATED REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT

    AMENDED AND RESTATED REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT dated as of September 
___, 1997 among THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC., a Delaware 
corporation (the "Company"), THE SK EQUITY FUND, L.P., a Delaware limited 
partnership ("SK"), SK INVESTMENT FUND, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership 
("SKIF"), BARRY FEINBERG, each of the Persons listed on Schedule 1 and as 
signatory hereto (each, a "Management Stockholder" and, collectively, the 
"Management Stockholders"), and LEGG MASON WOOD WALKER, INCORPORATED, a 
Maryland corporation ("Legg Mason") (all such Persons, other than the 
Company, the "Stockholders").

                                   RECITALS

    A.   The Company and the Stockholders entered into a Registration Rights 
Agreement  dated as of June 28, 1996 (the "Original Registration Rights 
Agreement"), setting forth certain obligations of the Company in respect of 
the registration of shares of its Common Stock under the Securities Act of 
1933, as amended.

    B.  The Company and the Stockholders have now agreed that, in connection 
with the Company's initial public offering, it is desirable and in the best 
interest of the Company that the Original Registration Rights Agreement be 
amended and restated in its entirety to read as hereinafter set forth.

    NOW, THEREFORE, the parties hereto agree that the Original Registration 
Rights Agreement is hereby amended and restated in its entirety, effective as 
of the Effective Date (as defined below), to read in its entirety as follows: 

                                I.  DEFINITIONS

    1.l  Definitions.  (a)  In addition to the terms defined elsewhere 
herein, the following terms have the following meanings when used herein with 
initial capital letters:

    "Affiliate" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person directly 
or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under common control with, such 
Person.  For the purposes of this definition, "control" when used with 
respect to any Person, means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the 
power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of such 
Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or 
otherwise, and the terms "controlling" and "controlled" have meanings 
correlative to the foregoing.

    "Agreement" means this Agreement, as the same may be amended from time to 
time.

    "Board of Directors" means the Board of Directors of the Company.



    "Business Day" means any day except a Saturday, Sunday or other day on 
which commercial banks in the City of New York are authorized by law to close.

    "Charter" means the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of 
the Company, as amended from time to time.

    "Commission" means the Securities and Exchange Commission.

    "Common Stock" means the Common Stock, par value $0.10 per share, of the 
Company.

    "Director" means a member of the Board of Directors.

    "Effective Date" means the date of consummation of the Company's initial 
public offering under the Securities Act.

    "Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

    "Initial Investment" means the investment of $20,505,712 by SK, SKIF, and 
Barry Feinberg in the Company.

    "Legg Mason Holder" means Legg Mason or any Transferee thereof.

    "LM Agreement" means the letter agreement dated January 25, 1996 by and 
between the Company and Legg Mason, as amended to the date hereof.

    "Management Permitted Transferee" means with respect to any Management 
Stockholder, (i) any spouse or lineal descendant of such Management 
Stockholder, (ii) any trust all of the beneficial interests in which is held 
by such Management Stockholder and/or such Management Stockholder's spouse 
and/or lineal descendants and (iii) any other Management Stockholder; 
provided, however, that each such Transferee will be a Management Permitted 
Transferee for purposes of this Agreement only if such Transferee shall have 
executed and delivered to the Company an instrument reasonably satisfactory 
to the SK Holders pursuant to which the Transferee shall have agreed to be 
bound by the terms of this Agreement applicable to its Transferor.

    "Management Stockholder Group" means each of the Management Stockholders 
or any Management Permitted Transferee.

    "Person" means an individual, corporation, partnership, trust, 
association or any other entity or organization, including without limitation 
a government or political subdivision or an agency or instrumentality thereof.

    "pro rata" means, with respect to any offer including Common Stock, an 
offer based on the relative percentages of Common Stock then held by all of 
the holders of Common Stock to whom such offer is made.

                                      -2-



    "Public Offering" means any primary or secondary public offering of 
Common Stock of the Company pursuant to an effective registration statement 
under the Securities Act, other than pursuant to a registration statement on 
Form S-4 or Form S-8 or any successor or similar form.

    "Qualified Underwriter" means a firm listed on Schedule 2 or otherwise 
selected by mutual agreement of the SK Holders and the Company.

    "Registrable Securities" means, as the context requires, (a) with respect 
to the SK Holders, the shares of Common Stock then held by the SK Holders, 
and any additional shares of Common Stock ("Additional Shares") subsequently 
paid, issued or distributed in respect of such shares of Common Stock by way 
of stock dividend or distribution or stock split or in connection with a 
combination of shares, recapitalization, reorganization, merger, 
consolidation, pursuant to the Charter or otherwise, (b) with respect to the 
Management Stockholders, the shares of Common Stock held as of the Effective 
Date and any Additional Shares issued in respect thereof and any Additional 
Shares issued upon exercise of stock options granted to any such Management 
Stockholder, and (c) with respect to Legg Mason, the shares of Common Stock 
held as of the Effective Date and any Additional Shares issued in respect 
thereof.  Registrable Securities will cease to be Registrable Securities when 
and to the extent that (i) a registration statement relating to such 
securities has been declared effective under the Securities Act and such 
Registrable Securities have been disposed of pursuant to such effective 
Registration Statement, (ii) such Registrable Securities have been 
transferred to a party in violation of the Stockholders Agreement, (iii) such 
Registrable Securities have ceased to be outstanding, or (iv) such securities 
may be sold in a single transaction without registration pursuant to Rule 144.

    "Registration Expenses" means all (i) registration and filing fees with 
the Commission, (ii) fees and expenses of compliance with state securities or 
blue sky laws (including without limitation reasonable fees and disbursements 
of a qualified independent underwriter, if any, counsel in connection 
therewith and the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel in connection 
with blue sky qualifications of the Registrable Securities), (iii) printing 
expenses, (iv) internal expenses of the Company (including without limitation 
all salaries and expenses of officers and employees performing legal or 
accounting duties), (v) fees and expenses of counsel and independent public 
accountants for the Company, (vi) fees and expenses of any additional experts 
retained by the Company in connection with such registration, (vii) fees and 
expenses of listing the Registrable Securities, if any, (viii) transfer 
taxes, and (ix) reasonable fees and expenses of one counsel for the 
Stockholders, which counsel will be selected by the Stockholders holding a 
majority of Registrable Securities included in the registration.

    "Regulation D" means Regulation D under the Securities Act.

    "Rule 144" means Rule 144 under the Securities Act, as such rule may be 
amended from time to time.

    "Securities Act" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

                                      -3-



    "Shelf Registration" means a registration statement on the appropriate 
form pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act (or any successor rule 
that may be adopted by the Commission).

    "SK Holder" means SK, SKIF or Barry Feinberg or any Transferee thereof.  
For purposes of this Agreement, any action contemplated to be taken by the SK 
Holders will be effective if approved by the SK Holder which owns the largest 
portion of the Common Stock owned by all SK Holders as of the relevant time.

    "SK Limit" means an amount of Registrable Securities equal to the lesser 
of (x) an amount comprising 50% of the aggregate amount of Registrable 
Securities to be sold by all stockholders pursuant to the registration 
statement in question and (y) an amount of Registrable Securities having a 
market value equal to the Initial Investment.

    "Stockholders Agreement" means the Amended and Restated Stockholders 
Agreement dated as of the date hereof by and among the Company, SK, SKIF, 
Barry Feinberg and the Management Stockholders.

    "Transferee" means any Person to whom any Stockholder transfers any 
Common Stock (other than in a sale pursuant to an effective registration 
statement under the Securities Act or without registration pursuant to Rule 
144) in accordance with the Stockholders Agreement and who agrees in writing 
to be bound by and to comply with all applicable provisions of this 
Agreement. 

     "Underwriter" means a securities dealer who purchases any 
Registrable Securities as a principal in connection with a distribution of 
such Registrable Securities and not as part of such dealer's market-making 
activities.

                        II.  REGISTRATION RIGHTS

    2.1  SK Demand Registration.  (a)  At any time and from time to time 
following the nine month anniversary of the Effective Date, the SK Holders 
may make written requests for registration under the Securities Act of all or 
part of the SK Holders' Registrable Securities (a "SK Demand Registration"); 
provided, however, that the Company will not be obligated to effect an SK 
Demand Registration on more than 3 occasions.  Such request will specify the 
number of shares of Registrable Securities proposed to be offered for sale by 
the SK Holders and will also specify the intended method of disposition 
thereof.  In connection therewith, the Company will give the notices required 
by Section 2.2(a) but as applied to an SK Demand Registration.

    (b)   If the SK Holders so elect, the offering of the SK Holders' 
Registrable Securities pursuant to such SK Demand Registration will be in the 
form of an underwritten offering.  The SK Holders will select a Qualified 
Underwriter as the managing Underwriter and, subject to the LM Agreement, any 
additional underwriters in connection with the offering.  A registration will 
not count as an SK Demand Registration until it has become effective.

                                      -4-



    (c)   If, in connection with any SK Demand Registration, the Company or 
any other Stockholders also propose to sell securities and the managing 
Underwriter of an offering described in this Section 2.1 advises the Company, 
the SK Holders and such other Stockholders in writing that the success or 
pricing of the offering would be materially and adversely affected by the 
inclusion of all of the securities requested to be included, then the Company 
will include in such registration (i) first, the Registrable Securities 
requested to be included by the SK Holders, which number of securities to be 
registered will be reduced to the extent necessary to reduce the total amount 
of securities to be included in such offering to the amount recommended by 
such managing Underwriter, (ii) second, such number of other Registrable 
Securities as the Management Stockholders and the Legg Mason Holder propose 
to offer for sale and the managing Underwriter recommends be included in such 
offering, allocated pro rata among such Stockholders, which number of 
securities to be registered will be reduced to the extent necessary to reduce 
the total amount of Securities to be included in such offering to the amount 
recommended by such managing underwriter, (iii) third, the securities the 
Company proposes to offer for sale, which number of securities to be 
registered will be reduced to the extent necessary to reduce the total amount 
of securities to be included in such offering to the amount recommended by 
such managing Underwriter and (iv) fourth, such number of other Registrable 
Securities as the Stockholders propose to offer for sale and the managing 
Underwriter recommends be included in such offering, allocated pro rata among 
such Stockholders.

    (d)   Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 2.1, the 
SK Holders may not request an SK Demand Registration (i) if a registration 
statement has been filed by the Company with the Commission, unless such 
registration statement has been withdrawn or has been effective for a period 
of 90 calendar days, or (ii) if an underwritten offering of Common Stock 
(whether for the account of the Company or any other security holders) has 
been consummated within the preceding nine months; provided, however, the 
limitations in this sentence will not apply if the SK Holders were not given 
the opportunity, in accordance with Section 2.2, to include their Registrable 
Securities in the registration statement described in clause (i) or the 
underwritten offering described in clause (ii) (as applicable).

    (e)   Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Section 2.1, in 
the event the Company receives notice of an SK Demand Registration, the 
Company may elect once, and only once, by written notice to the SK Holders 
within 20 days after receipt of such notice, to proceed with a registration 
of Common Stock for the Company's account in lieu of proceeding with the SK 
Demand Registration, in which case the provisions of Section 2.2 (and not 
this Section 2.1) will apply.  If the Company exercises the right described 
in the preceding sentence, the SK Holders will not be deemed (for purposes of 
determining the number of future SK Demand Registrations that may be demanded 
under the terms of this Agreement) to have exercised the right to request an 
SK Demand Registration unless at least 80% of the Registrable Securities that 
the SK Holders desired to include in such registration were included pursuant 
to Section 2.2.

    2.2  Piggyback Rights.  (a)  If the Company proposes to file a 
registration statement under the Securities Act with respect to an offering 
of any shares of Common Stock (i) for its own account (other than a 
registration statement on Form S-4 or S-8 (or any substitute form that may be 
adopted by the Commission)) or (ii) for the account of any holder of its 
securities, 

                                      -5-



including without limitation an SK Demand Registration or a Nomura Demand 
Registration or a registration of shares to be sold by the Management 
Stockholders, who will have the right to demand such registration at any time 
and from time to time, subject to the rights of the Company and the other 
Stockholders hereunder, or a registration of shares to be sold by the Legg 
Mason Holder, then the Company will give written notice of such proposed 
offering to the holders of Registrable Securities as soon as practicable 
(provided that holders of Registrable Securities will be given such notice 
not less than 20 calendar days prior to the deadline set by the Company for 
electing to include Registrable Securities in such offering), and such notice 
will offer such holders the opportunity, in accordance with Section 2.2(b), 
to register such number of shares of Registrable Securities as such holders 
may request on the same terms and conditions as the registration of the 
Company's or such other holders' securities.  If the Company so elects, the 
offering contemplated by this Section 2.2 will be in the form of an 
underwritten offering.  The Company will select a Qualified Underwriter as 
the managing Underwriter and, subject to the LM Agreement, any additional 
underwriters in connection with the offering.

    (b)   Whenever the Company proposes to file a registration statement in 
accordance with Section 2.2(a) (except in the case of an SK Demand 
Registration, for which Section 2.1(c) will govern), the Company will include 
in such registration all Registrable Securities which any Stockholder 
requests to be included therein; provided, however, that if the managing 
Underwriter of an underwritten offering under this Section 2.2 advises the 
Company and such Stockholders in writing that the number of securities 
requested to be included in such registration exceeds the number of shares of 
Common Stock which can be sold in such offering or would have an adverse 
impact on the price of such securities, then the Company will include in such 
registration (i) first, the securities the Company proposes to sell and (ii) 
second, the Registrable Securities of the Stockholders requested to be 
included in such registration, allocated in accordance with Section 2.4.

    (c)   A request by any Stockholder to include Registrable Securities in a 
proposed underwritten offering pursuant to this Section 2.2 will not be 
deemed to be a request for a demand registration pursuant to Section 2.1.

    2.3  Certain Limitations.  Notwithstanding any other provision hereof, 
(i) neither the Company nor any Stockholder will have the right to initiate 
or demand a registration hereunder unless (x) it proposes to include therein 
Registrable Securities which it believes in good faith to have a value of at 
least $30,000,000 or (y) in the case of any Stockholder, not less than 80% of 
the Registrable Securities owned by the SK Holders or the Management 
Stockholders are to be included therein and (ii) the managing Underwriter and 
any co-managing underwriter of any offering hereunder must be a Qualified 
Underwriter.

    2.4  Allocation of Registrable Securities Among Stockholders.  In the 
event of any registration to which the proviso to Section 2.2(b) applies, 
after all securities that the Company proposes to sell are included in such 
registration, Registrable Securities of the stockholders requested to be 
included in such registration will be included therein according to the 
following priorities:  (i) first, the Registrable Securities proposed to be 
included by the SK Holders will be included, up to the SK Limit (after giving 
effect to all prior sales of Registrable Securities of the 

                                      -6-



SK Holders), which number of securities to be registered will be reduced to 
the extent necessary to reduce the total amount of securities to be included 
in such offering to the amount recommended by such managing Underwriter, (ii) 
second, any Registrable Securities proposed to be included by the Management 
Stockholders and the Legg Mason Holder, up to an amount equal to the number 
of Registrable Securities to be included for the account of the SK Holders, 
allocated pro rata among such Stockholders, which number of securities to be 
registered will be reduced to the extent necessary to reduce the total amount 
of securities to be included in such offering to the amount recommended by 
such managing Underwriter, and (iii) third, any remaining Registrable 
Securities proposed to be included by the Stockholders which the managing 
Underwriter recommends be included shall be included, allocated pro rata 
among such stockholders.

                        III.  REGISTRATION PROCEDURES

    3.1  Filings; Information.  Whenever a Stockholder (the "Registering 
Stockholder") requests that any Registrable Securities be registered pursuant 
to Article II, the Company will use its best efforts to effect the 
registration of such Registrable Securities to the extent required by Article 
II, as promptly as is practicable, and in connection with any such request:

    (a)   The Company will as expeditiously as possible prepare and file with 
the Commission a registration statement on any form for which the Company 
then qualifies and which counsel for the Company deems appropriate and 
available for the sale of the Registrable Securities to be registered 
thereunder in accordance with the intended method of distribution thereof, 
and use its best efforts to cause such filed registration statement to become 
and remain effective for a period of not less than 90 calendar days or, if 
less, the period required for such Registrable Securities to be sold; 
provided, however, that if the Company furnishes to the Registering 
Stockholder a certificate signed by the Company's Chief Executive Officer 
stating that the Board of Directors has determined that it would be 
materially detrimental or otherwise materially disadvantageous to the Company 
or its Stockholders (whether because of any proposed material transaction or 
otherwise) for such a registration statement to be filed as expeditiously as 
possible, the Company will have a period of not more than 120 calendar days 
within which to file such registration statement measured from the date of 
the Company's receipt of the Registering Stockholder's request for 
registration.

    (b)   The Company will, if requested, prior to filing such registration 
statement or any amendment or supplement thereto, furnish to the Registering 
Stockholder and each applicable Underwriter, if any, copies thereof, and 
thereafter furnish to the Registering Stockholder and each such Underwriter, 
if any, such number of copies of such registration statement, amendment and 
supplement thereto (in each case including all exhibits thereto and documents 
incorporated by reference therein) and the prospectus included in such 
registration statement (including each preliminary prospectus) as the 
Registering Stockholder or each such Underwriter may reasonably request in 
order to facilitate the sale of the Registrable Securities.

    (c)   After the filing of the registration statement, the Company will 
promptly notify the Registering Stockholder of any stop order issued or, to 
the Company's knowledge, threatened 

                                      -7-



to be issued by the Commission or any state securities agency or authority 
and take all reasonable actions required to prevent the entry of such stop 
order or to remove it if entered.

    (d)   The Company will endeavor to qualify the Registrable Securities for 
offer and sale under such other securities or blue sky laws of such 
jurisdictions in the United States as the Registering Stockholder reasonably 
requests; provided, however, that the Company will not be required to (i) 
qualify generally to do business in any jurisdiction where it would not 
otherwise be required to qualify but for this subsection (d), (ii) subject 
itself to taxation in any such jurisdiction, or (iii) consent to general 
service of process in any such jurisdiction.

    (e)   The Company will as promptly as is practicable notify the 
Registering Stockholder, at any time when a prospectus relating to the sale 
of the Registrable Securities is required by law to be delivered in 
connection with sales by an Underwriter or dealer, of the occurrence of any 
event requiring the preparation of a supplement or amendment to such 
prospectus so that, as thereafter delivered to the purchasers of such 
Registrable Securities, such prospectus will not contain an untrue statement 
of a material fact or omit to state any material fact required to be stated 
therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in the light of the 
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading and promptly make 
available to the Registering Stockholder and to the Underwriters any such 
supplement or amendment.  The Registering Stockholder agrees that, upon 
receipt of any notice from the Company of the occurrence of any event of the 
kind described in the preceding sentence, the Registering Stockholder will 
forthwith discontinue the offer and sale of Registrable Securities pursuant 
to the registration statement covering such Registrable Securities until 
receipt by the Registering Stockholder and the Underwriters of the copies of 
such supplemented or amended prospectus and, if so directed by the Company, 
the Registering Stockholder will deliver to the Company all copies, other 
than permanent file copies then in the Registering Stockholder possession, of 
the most recent prospectus covering such Registrable Securities at the time 
of receipt of such notice.  In the event the Company gives such notice, the 
Company will extend the period during which such registration statement will 
be effective as provided in Section 3.1(a) by the number of days during the 
period from and including the date of the giving of such notice to the date 
when the Company will make available to the Registering Stockholder such 
supplemented or amended prospectus.

    (f)   The Company will enter into customary agreements (including in the 
case of an underwritten offering an underwriting agreement in customary form) 
and the Company and its officers will take such other actions as are 
reasonably required in order to expedite or facilitate the sale of such 
Registrable Securities, including participation in any "road show" undertaken 
in connection with such sale.

    (g)   The Company will furnish to the Registering Stockholder and to each 
Underwriter a signed counterpart, addressed to the Registering Stockholder or 
such Underwriter, of (i) an opinion or opinions of counsel to the Company and 
(ii) a comfort letter or comfort letters from the Company's independent 
public accountants, each in customary form and covering such matters of the 
type customarily covered by opinions or comfort letters, as the case may be, 
as the Registering Stockholder or the managing Underwriter may reasonably 
request.

                                      -8-



    (h)   The Company will make generally available to its security holders, 
as soon as reasonably practicable, an earnings statement covering a period of 
12 months, beginning within three months after the effective date of the 
registration statement, which earnings statement will satisfy the provisions 
of Section 11(a) of the 1933 Act and the rules and regulations of the 
Commission thereunder.

    (i)   The Company will use its reasonable efforts to cause all such 
Registrable Securities to be listed on each securities exchange on which 
securities of the same class issued by the Company are then listed.

    (j)   The Company may require the Registering Stockholder promptly to 
furnish in writing to the Company such information regarding the Registering 
Stockholder, the plan of distribution of the Registrable Securities and other 
information as the Company may from time to time reasonably request or as may 
be legally required in connection with such registration.  The furnishing of 
such information will be a condition to the Company's obligations hereunder.  

   3.2  Registration Expenses.  Registration Expenses incurred in connection 
with any registration made or requested to be made pursuant to Article II 
will be borne by the Company, whether or not any such registration statement 
becomes effective, to the extent permitted by applicable law.  The 
Registering Stockholder will pay, on a pro rata basis, any underwriting fees, 
discounts or commissions attributable to the sale of the Registrable 
Securities.

    3.3  Indemnification by the Company.  The Company agrees to indemnify and 
hold harmless each Registering Stockholder, its officers and directors, and 
each Person, if any, who controls each such Registering Stockholder within 
the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act or Section 20 of the Exchange 
Act from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities and 
expenses caused by any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a 
material fact contained in any registration statement or prospectus relating 
to the Registrable Securities (as amended or supplemented if the Company 
shall have furnished any amendments or supplements thereto) or any 
preliminary prospectus, or caused by any omission or alleged omission to 
state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to 
make the statements therein not misleading, except insofar as such losses, 
claims, damages, liabilities or expenses are caused by any such untrue 
statement or omission or alleged untrue statement or omission based upon 
information furnished in writing to the Company by or on behalf of such 
Registering Stockholder expressly for use therein; provided, however, that 
the foregoing indemnity agreement with respect to any preliminary prospectus 
will not inure to the benefit of any Registering Stockholder if a copy of the 
current prospectus was not provided to the applicable purchaser by such 
Registering Stockholder and such current copy of the prospectus would have 
cured the defect giving rise to such loss, claim, damage, liability or 
expenses.  The Company also agrees to indemnify any Underwriters of the 
Registrable Securities, their officers and directors and each Person who 
controls such underwriters on substantially the same basis as that of the 
indemnification of the Registering Stockholders provided in this Section 3.3.

    3.4  Indemnification by Registering Stockholders.  Each Registering 
Stockholder registering shares pursuant to Article II agrees, severally but 
not jointly, to indemnify and hold 

                                      -9-



harmless the Company, its officers and Directors and each Person, if any, who 
controls the Company within the meaning of either Section 15 of the 
Securities Act or Section 20 of the Exchange Act to the same extent as the 
foregoing indemnity from the Company to such Registering Stockholder, but 
only with reference to information related to such Registering Stockholder 
furnished in writing by or oh behalf of such Registering Stockholder 
expressly for use in any registration statement or prospectus relating to the 
Registrable Securities, or any amendment or supplement thereto or any 
preliminary prospectus; provided, however, that in no event will the 
liability of any Registering Stockholder under this Section 3.4 be greater in 
amount than the dollar amount of the proceeds received by such holder upon 
the sale of the Registrable Securities giving rise to such indemnification 
obligation. Each such Registering Stockholder also agrees to indemnify and 
hold harmless any Underwriters of the Registrable Securities, their officers 
and directors and each Person who controls such Underwriters on such terms as 
provided for in underwriting agreement relating to such offering.

    3.5  Conduct of Indemnification Proceedings.  In case any proceeding 
(including any governmental investigation) is instituted involving any person 
in respect of which indemnity may be sought pursuant to Section 3.3 or 
Section 3.4, such Person will promptly notify the Person against whom such 
indemnity may be sought in writing and the indemnifying party upon request of 
the indemnified party will retain counsel reasonably satisfactory to the 
indemnified party to represent the indemnified party and any others the 
indemnifying party may designate in such proceeding and will pay the fees and 
disbursements of such counsel related to the proceeding; provided, however, 
that the failure to so notify the indemnifying Person shall not relieve the 
indemnifying party from any liability that it may otherwise have to such 
indemnified Person, except to the extent the indemnifying Person shall have 
been materially prejudiced by such failure.  In any such proceeding, any 
indemnified party will have the right to retain its own counsel, but the fees 
and expenses of such counsel will be at the expense of such indemnified party 
unless (a) the indemnifying party and the indemnified party have mutually 
agreed to the retention of such counsel or (b) the named parties to any such 
proceeding (including any impleaded parties) include both the indemnified 
party and the indemnifying party and representation of both parties by the 
same counsel would be inappropriate due to actual or potential differing 
interests between them, in which case the fees and expenses of such counsel 
will be paid by the Company.  It is understood that the indemnifying party 
will not, in connection with any proceeding or related proceedings in the 
same jurisdiction, be liable for the reasonable fees and expenses of more 
than one separate firm of attorneys (in addition to any local counsel) at any 
time for all such indemnified parties, and that all such reasonable fees and 
expenses will be reimbursed as they are incurred.  In the case of the 
retention of any such separate firm for the indemnified parties, such firm 
will be designated in writing by the indemnified parties.  The indemnifying 
party will not be liable for any settlement of any proceeding effected 
without its consent, but if settled with such consent, or if there be a final 
judgment for the plaintiff, the indemnifying party will indemnify and hold 
harmless such indemnified parties from and against any loss or liability (to 
the extent stated above) by reason of such settlement or judgment.

    3.6  Contribution.  (a) If the indemnification provided for herein is for 
any reason unavailable to the indemnified parties in respect of any losses, 
claims, damages or liabilities referred to herein, then each such 
indemnifying party, in lieu of indemnifying such indemnified 

                                      -10-



party, will contribute to the amount paid or payable by such indemnified 
party as a result of such losses, claims, damages or liabilities in such 
proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative fault of the Company, 
the Registering Stockholders and any Underwriter in connection with the 
statements or omissions which resulted in such losses, claims, damages or 
liabilities, as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.  The 
relative fault of the Company, the Registering Stockholders and the 
Underwriter will be determined by reference to, among other things, whether 
the untrue or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or 
alleged omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by 
such party, and the parties' relative intent, knowledge, access to 
information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission.

    (b)  The Company and each Registering Stockholder agree that it would not 
be just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 3.6 were 
determined by pro rata allocation (even if the Underwriters were treated as 
one entity for such purpose) or by any other method of allocation which does 
not take account of the equitable considerations referred to in the 
immediately preceding subsection.  The amount paid or payable by an 
indemnified party as a result of the losses, claims, damages or liabilities 
referred to in the immediately preceding subsection will be deemed to 
include, subject to the limitations set forth above, any legal or other 
expenses reasonably incurred by such indemnified party in connection with 
investigating or defending any such action or claim.  Notwithstanding the 
provisions of this Section 3.6, no Registering Stockholder will be required 
to contribute any amount by reason of such untrue or alleged untrue statement 
or omission or alleged omission in excess of the amount received by such 
Registering Stockholder upon the sale of the Registrable Securities giving 
rise to such contribution obligation.  No person guilty of fraudulent 
misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) 
will be entitled to contribution from any person who was not guilty of such 
fraudulent misrepresentation.

    3.7  Participation in Underwritten Registrations.  Notwithstanding any 
other provision of this Agreement, no Person may participate in any 
underwritten registration hereunder unless such Person (a) agrees to sell 
such Person's securities on the basis provided in any reasonable underwriting 
arrangements approved by the Company or other Persons entitled hereunder to 
approve such arrangements and (b) completes and executes all customary 
questionnaires, powers of attorney, indemnities, underwriting agreements, 
"lock-up" agreements and other documents reasonably required under the terms 
of such underwriting arrangements and these registration rights.

    3.8  Rule 144.  The Company will file any reports required to be filed by 
it under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act and will take such further 
action as any Stockholder may reasonably request to the extent required from 
time to time to enable the Stockholders to sell Registrable Securities 
without registration under the Securities Act within the limitation of the 
exemptions provided by Rule 144 under the Exchange Act, as such Rule may be 
amended from time to time, or other appropriate rule or regulation adopted by 
the Commission.  Upon the request of any Stockholder, the Company will 
deliver to the Stockholder a written statement as to whether the Company has 
complied with such reporting requirements.

                                      -11-



    3.9  Restrictions on Public Sale by Holders of Registrable Securities.  
(a)  If and to the extent requested by the managing Underwriter or 
Underwriters in the case of an underwritten Public Offering, each of the 
Stockholders agrees not to effect, except as part of such registration, any 
sale of the shares of Common Stock or a similar security of the Company, or 
any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for such 
securities during such time period to which the Company agrees not to effect 
any sale of securities in connection therewith, or to which the Registering 
Stockholder agrees if the Company does not include any securities therein.  
In addition, each of the Stockholders agrees to execute any customary lock-up 
agreement reasonably requested by the managing Underwriter to confirm its 
agreement in accordance with the preceding sentence, but only if identical 
lock-up agreements are required of all Stockholders.

    (b)  Nothing in this Agreement will diminish or otherwise affect the 
restrictions on transfer contained in the Stockholders Agreement.

    3.10 Limitation on Future Registration Rights.  So long as the SK 
Holders continue to own Common Stock, the Company will not grant or agree to 
grant registration rights in respect of any Common Stock of the Company (or 
securities convertible or exchangeable into or exercisable for Common Stock) 
to any other Person which would interfere with the rights of the SK Holders 
hereunder, without the prior written consent of the SK Holders.  The 
provisions of this Section 3.10 will cease to apply with respect to the SK 
Holders once the shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by the SK Holders 
represent less than 10% of the shares of Common Stock beneficially owned by 
the SK Holders on the Effective Date.

                                IV.  MISCELLANEOUS

    4.1  Headings.  The headings in this Agreement are for convenience of 
reference only and will not control or affect the meaning or construction of 
any provisions hereof.

    4.2  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement 
among the parties with respect to the subject matter of this Agreement.  This 
Agreement supersedes all prior agreements and understandings, both oral and 
written, among the parties with respect to the subject matter of this 
Agreement.  This Agreement is not intended to confer upon any Person other 
than the parties hereto and thereto any rights or remedies hereunder or 
thereunder.

    4.3  Notices.  Any notice, request, instruction or other document 
required or permitted to be given hereunder by any party hereto to another 
party hereto will be in writing and will be given to such party at its 
address set forth in Annex I attached hereto, with, in the case of the 
Company, a copy sent to the Company's Secretary at the Company's principal 
executive offices or to such other address as the party to whom notice is to 
be given may provide in a written notice to the party giving such notice, a 
copy of which written notice will be on file with the Secretary of the 
Company.  Each such notice, request or other communication will be effective 
(a) if given by certified mail, 96 hours after such communication is 
deposited in the mails with certified postage prepaid addressed as aforesaid, 
(b) one Business Day after being furnished to a nationally recognized 
overnight courier for next Business Day delivery, and (c) on the date sent if 
sent by electronic facsimile transmission, receipt confirmed.

                                      -12-



    4.4  Governing Law.  This Agreement will be governed by, and construed in 
accordance with, the laws of the State of New York without regard to the 
conflict of laws rules of such state, provided, however, that to the extent 
any of the respective rights or obligations of the parties relate to matters 
of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware (the "GCL"), the 
provisions of the GCL shall govern in respect thereof.

    4.5  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any provisions 
of this Agreement in any jurisdiction will not affect the validity, legality 
or enforceability of the remainder of this Agreement in such jurisdiction or 
the validity, legality or enforceability of this Agreement, including any 
such provision, in any other jurisdiction, it being intended that all rights 
and obligations of the parties hereunder will be enforceable to the fullest 
extent permitted by law.

    4.6  Termination.  All rights and obligations hereunder will extend and 
continue to apply until such time as all Registrable Securities may be 
offered and sold without registration under the Securities Act.

    4.7  Successors, Assigns and Transferees.  The provisions of this 
Agreement will be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto 
and their respective heirs, successors, assigns and permitted Transferees.  
Except as expressly contemplated hereby, neither this Agreement nor any 
provision hereof will be construed so as to confer any right or benefit upon 
any Person other than the parties to this Agreement and their respective 
successors and permitted assigns.

    4.8  Amendments; Waivers.  (a) No failure or delay on the part of any 
party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder will operate as a 
waiver thereof, nor will any single or partial exercise thereof preclude any 
other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, power 
or privilege.  The rights and remedies herein provided will be cumulative and 
not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

    (b)  Neither this Agreement nor any term or provision hereof may be 
amended or waived except by an instrument in writing signed, by (i) the 
Company, (ii) the SK Holders owning a majority of the Common Stock then held 
by the SK Holders and entitled to the benefits of this Agreement, and (iii) 
the Stockholders, other than the SK Holders, owning a majority of the 
Registrable Securities then held by such Stockholders and entitled to the 
benefits of this Agreement.

    4.9  Counterparts.  This Agreement may be executed in any number of 
counterparts, each of which will be an original, with the same effect as if 
the signatures thereto and hereto were upon the same instrument.

    4.10  Remedies.  The parties hereby acknowledge that money damages would 
not be adequate compensation for the damages that a party would suffer by 
reason of a failure of any other party to perform any of the obligations 
under this Agreement. Therefore, each party hereto agrees that specific 
performance is the only appropriate remedy under this Agreement and hereby 
waives the claim or defense that any other party has an adequate remedy at 
law.

                                      -13-



    4.11 Consent to Jurisdiction.  Each of the parties hereto irrevocably 
submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of either (i) any court located in the 
Borough of Manhattan or the United States Federal Court sitting in the 
Southern District of New York or (ii) any court located in the State of 
Delaware or the United States District Court for the District of Delaware 
(including any appellate court therefrom) over any suit, action or proceeding 
arising out of or relating to this Agreement.  Each of the parties hereto 
consents to process being served in any such suit, action or proceeding by 
serving a copy thereof upon the agent for service of process, provided that 
to the extent lawful and possible, written notice of such service will also 
be mailed to such party, as the case may be.  Each of the parties hereto 
agrees that such service will be deemed in every respect effective service of 
process upon such party hereto, in any such suit, action or proceeding and 
will be taken and held to be valid personal service upon such party.  Nothing 
in this subsection will affect or limit any right to serve process in any 
manner permitted by law, to bring proceedings in the courts of any 
jurisdiction or to enforce in any lawful manner a judgment obtained in one 
jurisdiction in any other jurisdiction.  Each of the parties hereto waives 
any right it may have to assert the doctrine of forum non conveniens or to 
object to venue to the extent any proceeding is brought in accordance with 
this Section 4.11.  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO IRREVOCABLY WAIVES ANY AND ALL 
RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO 
THIS AGREEMENT OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

                                      -14-




    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement as of 
the date first above written.

                             THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC.

                             By:_____________________________________________
                                Name:  Ezra Dabah
                                Title:

                             THE SK EQUITY FUND, L.P.

                             By:  SKM Partners, L.P., its General Partner

                             By:_____________________________________________
                                Name:
                                Title:

                             SK INVESTMENT FUND, L.P.

                             By:  SKM Partners, L.P., its General Partner

                             By:_____________________________________________
                                Name:
                                Title:

                                _____________________________________________
                                Barry Feinberg

                             LEGG MASON WOOD WALKER, INCORPORATED

                             By:_____________________________________________
                                Name:
                                Title:

                             MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDERS:

                             ________________________________________________
                             Ezra Dabah

                             ________________________________________________
                             Renee Dabah

                                       -15-



                             ________________________________________________
                             Ivette Dabah

                             ________________________________________________
                             Stanley Silverstein

                             ________________________________________________
                             Stanley Silver

                             ________________________________________________
                             Barbara Dabah

                             ________________________________________________
                             Joseph Krusch

                             ________________________________________________
                             Elliott F. Krusch

                             ________________________________________________
                             Helissa T. Meizlish

                             ________________________________________________
                             Sherry Schirippa

                             Gila Dweck Grantor Trust

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                             u/a/d 8/25/88 f/b/o Morris Dabah Jr.

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee


                                       -16-



                             Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                             u/a/d 8/25/88 f/b/o Michael Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                             u/a/d 8/25/88 f/b/o Mac Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as Custodians
                             under the UGMA f/b/o Joia Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Custodian

                             Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as Custodians
                             under the UGMA f/b/o Yaacov Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Custodian

                             Edward Tawil as Trustee
                             u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Morris Dabah Jr.

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Edward Tawil as Trustee
                             u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Michael Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee


                                       -17-




                             Edward Tawil as Trustee
                             u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Mac Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Edward Tawil as Trustee
                             u/a/d 8/29/88 f/b/o Stephen Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees
                             u/a/d 8/31/92 f/b/o Stephen Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Nina Miner

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Renee Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Flori Silverstein

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee


                                       -18-



                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Michael Leventhal

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Leslie Kule

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Samuel Miner

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Eva Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Joia Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Moshe Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee


                                       -19-



                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Chana Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Yaacov Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Sarah Silverstein

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Benjamin Reines

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Jacqueline Reines

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Eva Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee


                                       -20-



                             Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Joia Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Moshe Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Chana Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee

                             Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein, Trustees
                             u/a/d 2/2/97 f/b/o Yaacov Dabah

                             By:_____________________________________________
                             Name:
                             Title:  Trustee


                                       -21-



                                      Schedule 1

                               Management  Stockholders

1.  Ezra Dabah

2.  Renee Dabah

3.  Barbara Dabah

4.  Ivette Dabah

5.  Stanley Silver

6.  Stanley Silverstein

7.  Joseph G. Krusch

8.  Elliot F. Krusch

9.  Helissa T. Meizlish

10. Sherry Schirippa

11. Gila Dweck Grantor Trust

12. Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as custodians under the UGMA, F/B/O Joia 
    Dabah.

13. Ezra Dabah and Renee Dabah as custodians under the UGMA, F/B/O Yaacov 
    Dabah.

14. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees, U/A/D 8/25/88, F/B/O Mac Dabah.

15. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees, U/A/D 8/25/88, F/B/O Michael 
    Dabah.

16. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees, U/A/D 8/25/88, F/B/O Morris Dabah, 
    Jr.

17. Ezra Dabah and Gila Dweck as Trustees U/A/D 8/31/92, F/B/O Stephen Dabah.

18. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Michael Dabah.

19. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Morris Dabah, Jr.

20. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Mac Dabah.

21. Edward Tawil as Trustee U/A/D 8/29/88, F/B/O Stephen Dabah.


                                       -22-



22. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Nina 
    Miner.

23. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Renee 
    Dabah.

24. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Flori 
    Silverstein.

25. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Michael 
    Leventhal.

26. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Leslie 
    Kule.

27. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Samuel 
    Miner.

28. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Eva 
    Dabah.

29. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Joia 
    Dabah.

30. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Moshe 
    Dabah.

31. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Chana 
    Dabah.

32. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Yaacov 
    Dabah.

33. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Sarah 
    Silverstein.

34. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O Benjamin 
    Reines.

35. Raine Silverstein and Ezra Dabah as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97, F/B/O 
    Jacqueline Reines.

36. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Eva 
    Dabah.

37. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Joia 
    Dabah.

38. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Moshe 
    Dabah.

39. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Chana 
    Dabah.

40. Renee Dabah and Raine Silverstein as Trustees U/A/D 2/2/97 F/B/O Yaacov 
Dabah.


                                       -23-



                                      Schedule 2

                                Qualified Underwriters

Montgomery Securities
Alex Brown & Sons
Smith Barney
Morgan Stanley
Goldman Sachs
Bear Stearns
Legg Mason Wood Walker
Donaldson Lufkin & Jenrette
Merrill Lynch
Robinson Humphrey
Lehman Brothers
CS First Boston
Paine Webber
Furman Selz
Salomon Brothers


                                       -24-





                                                           EXHIBIT 10.13


                           [THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
                       RETAIL STORES, INC. LETTERHEAD]

                                                 January 18, 1991


Ms. Diane M. Timbanard
144 Unadilla Rd.
Ridgewood, NJ 07450

Dear Diane:

As per our discussion, I confirm that we would like you to join The 
Children's Place on 1/22/91 as Vice President/Divisional Merchandise Manager 
for Boys/Girls 0-4, with an annual compensation of $130,000, a bonus of 20% 
annually based on The Children's Place Bonus Plan - with a first year 
guarantee, all Executive insurance benefits coverage and 2 weeks' vacation.

                                                 Sincerely yours,


                                                 /s/ Bill R. Lee
                                                 Bill R. Lee
                                                 Executive Vice President








                                                           EXHIBIT 10.14

                        [THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
                    RETAIL STORES, INC. LETTERHEAD]

                                                 January 22, 1991

Ms. Diane M. Timbanard
144 Unadilla Rd.
Ridgewood, NJ 07450

Dear Diane:

This will confirm our agreement regarding severance pay.

The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Company") will pay you, upon 
termination, an amount equal to nine (9) months' base salary (as of date of 
termination) after completion of one year of your service with the Company. 
Severance shall not be payable in the event of your termination by the 
Company for cause or your voluntary termination. "Cause" shall mean the 
commission by you of a crime, insubordination, inexplicable absence, 
unsatisfactory performance or any other conduct by you which is inappropriate 
behavior for an employee in your position and which causes or which may cause 
injury to the reputation of the Company. Severance shall be payable as per 
the Company's usual policy and timing of payment of its regular payroll, less 
applicable payroll deductions.

This letter shall in no way obligate the Company to employ you for any period 
of time and does not constitute an employement contract.

                                                 Very truly yours,

                                                 THE CHILDREN'S PLACE
                                                    RETAIL STORES, INC.

                                                 By: /s/ Bill Lee
                                                    ---------------------------


AGREED TO:

/s/ Diane M. Timbanard
- -----------------------
   Diane M. Timbanard






                                                                   Exhibit 10.17

                               BUYING AGENCY AGREEMENT
                               -----------------------


This agreement, dated September ____, 1996, is entered into between The
Children=s Place Retail Stores, Inc., a Delaware corporation having its
principal place of business, at One Dodge Drive, West Caldwell, New Jersey
07006, hereinafter referred to as Principal, and K S Best International, having
its principal place of business located at, 9th Floor No.1 Woh Long Street,
Taipei, Taiwan ROC, hereinafter referred to as the Agent.

    WHEREAS, The Children=s Place is engaged in the importation of children=s
wearing apparel and accessories for sale in the United States, and

    WHEREAS, K S Best International acts as a representative in Taiwan for
interested parties in the United States, and 

    WHEREAS, the parties hereto are desirous of entering into a written
agreement which incorporates all previous understandings with regard to the
agency relationship between the parties,

    NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual promises and covenants
between the parties, it is agreed as follows:

    1.   K S Best International will act as a non-exclusive Buying Agent for
The Children=s Place in connection with the latter=s purchases of wearing
apparel and accessories in the various countries.

    2.   The Agent agrees to perform the following services on behalf of the
Principal:

              a.   The Agent shall familiarize itself with the Principal=s
              needs and survey the potential markets to obtain the best
              available merchandise;

              b.   The Agent will assist in the negotiation of the most
              favorable prices for the Principal. In this connection, the Agent
              shall visit manufacturers/sellers, obtain samples of merchandise,
              submit samples of the Principal, quoting prices at which the
              merchandise can be purchased;

              c.   The Agent shall negotiate free on board (f.o.b.)  prices on
              behalf of the Principal. 

              d.   The Agent shall place orders with manufacturers/sellers on
              behalf of the Principal.  The Agent shall act only upon the
              specific instructions of the Principal and in no case shall the
              Agent act 


                                          1


              without such explicit instructions.  The Agent acknowledges that
              it has no right, power or authority to make any contract or incur
              any obligation or liability which shall be binding upon the
              Principal unless it has been specifically authorized to do so in
              advance by the Principal;

              e.   The Agent shall make periodic visits to
              manufacturers/sellers where orders are placed in order to inspect
              the quality of the merchandise shipped to the Principal and to
              provide production progress reports to the Principal.  In the
              event that such merchandise does not conform in quality or
              specifications to the order placed, the Agent shall notify the
              Principal immediately;

              f.   Upon inspection and approval, the Agent shall execute an
              Inspection Certificate in the form specified by the Principal
              certifying that Agent has, in fact, conducted the appropriate
              initial, in line and final inspections and that the merchandise
              meets the specifications, quality and conditions required.  The
              presentation of this Inspection Certificate shall be a condition
              of payment on all Letters of Credit issued in favor of the
              manufacturer or seller;

              g.   The Agent shall attend to the utilization and acquisition of
              necessary quota in a manner dictated by, and in the best interest
              of, the Principal;

              h.   The Agent shall facilitate consolidation of shipments,
              insurance and/or storage. Moreover, the Agent shall facilitate
              the acquisition of the documentation necessary for importation
              into the United States;
                                           
              i.   The Agent shall assist the Principal in the return of any
              merchandise deemed to be defective.  In addition, the Agent shall
              negotiate for the Principal in the recovery of any monies due the
              Principal from the manufacturer/seller as a result of defective
              merchandise, shortages, etc; and,

              j.   The Agent shall never act as a seller/ manufacturer in any
              transaction involving the Principal. 

              k.   At certain times and pursuant to Principal=s prior written
              approval,  the Agent may act as shipper.     

    3.   The Principal agrees to compensate the Agent in an amount equal to 5% 
of the f.o.b. price of the merchandise which is ordered and shipped pursuant to
this agreement.Where 


                                          2


merchandise is determined to be defective by the Principal, no commissions will
accrue and any commissions paid relating to defective merchandise shall be
refunded by the Agent.

    4.   The Principal shall reimburse the Agent for all expenses incurred on
Principal's behalf. Such expenses will be incurred only with consent of the
Principal.  The Agent will be separately reimbursed for these expenses only if
the parties have agreed to reimburse Agent before the expenses are incurred.

    5.   The Principal will agree upon terms of payment with manufacture of the
merchandise for the f.o.b. price of the merchandise.  The Principal may open
irrevocable transferable letter(s) of credit in favor of the Agent for the
f.o.b. price of the merchandise and the Agent will either: (a) draw down on the
letter of credit and remit the appropriate payment to the manufacturer/seller;
or, (b) instruct the bank to remit the appropriate sums directly to the
manufacturer/seller.

    6.   With respect to the invoices prepared in connection with orders and
purchases handled by Agent, Agent shall ensure that the invoices contain
accurate and complete descriptions of the merchandise, contain the names of the
specific manufacturers and/or sellers, and meet all other requirements of the
United States Customs laws and regulations.

    In addition, Agent shall ensure that the manufacturer and/or seller
provides an invoice evidencing that the merchandise was produced for the account
of, or is being sold to, Principal.  Agent shall provide Principal with the
manufacturer=s /seller=s invoice evidencing the amount paid or payable for the
merchandise with every shipment into the United States and proof of payment
therefor when requested by Principal.

    7.   The Agent shall provide the Principal with a separate invoice for the
payment of buying commissions and non-production related expenses incurred on
the Principal's behalf, such as quota charges, inland freight, hauling,
lighterage, etc., in addition to manufacturer=s/seller=s commercial invoice for
the cost of merchandise.

    8.   None of the sums set forth above for the Agent's compensation or
reimbursement shall be paid, directly or indirectly, to the manufacturer/seller
or inure to the benefit of the manufacturer/seller in any way.  Furthermore, the
Agent, its officers, directors, shareholders, and/or employees shall not solicit
or accept any payment, rebate or other form of compensation or renumeration from
any manufacturer/seller in transactions involving the Principal without the
permission of the Principal. Agent may accept trade discounts and other
renumeration from manufacturers provided that they are for ministerial buying
agency services covered by this agreement and for no other service.


                                          3


    9.   The Agent, in executing this agreement, certifies that it has no
ownership or financial interest in, nor any control of, the manufacturer or
sellers supplying the commodities purchased with the assistance of the Agent;
that it does not, of its own account, sell raw materials to the manufacturers or
sellers supplying such merchandise; and that manufacturers and/or sellers have
no ownership or financial interest in, or any control over, the Agent.  In the
event that any such interest is consummated, then the Agent will immediately
inform the Principal.  Failure to do so will result in the forfeiture of the
Agent=s commission on merchandsise purchased from the related or controlled
factories.

    10.  This Agreement will remain in effect until cancellation by either
party upon giving written notification at least forty-five (45) days prior to
the date of such cancellation.  Should such notice be given, all existing orders
will be executed and completed in accordance with the direction of the
Principal.

    11.  All confidential information made available to either party by the
other party hereto shall be kept confidential as a trade secret by the recipient
thereof and its officers, directors, and/or employees, and such information will
not, without the prior written consent of the Principal or Agent, as the case
may be, be divulged in any manner to any third party except to the extent that
the divulgence of such information shall become necessary in any litigation
concerning the provisions of this Agreement.  Agent, shall also protect the
propriety of Principal's trade name.

    12.  Each party warrants to the other that it has full right, power, legal
capacity and authority to enter into and perform this Agreement and that it will
indemnify and hold harmless the other party for any breach of this warranty.

    13.  This Agreement may be amended, modified, superseded or canceled, and
any other the terms, covenants, representation, warranties or conditions hereof
may be waived, only by a written instrument executed by Principal and Agent or,
in the case of a waiver, by a written instrument executed by the party waiving
compliance.  The failure of any party at any time to require performance of any
provisions hereof shall in no manner affect the right of that party at a later
time to enforce such performance.

    14.  Agent agrees to indemnify Principal for all damages incurred by
Principal as a result of Agent's negligence, misconduct or fraud in the
performance of its responsibilities as set forth under this Agreement.


                                          4


    15.  Any notice required to be given under this agreement shall be deemed
given sufficiently if a notice in writing is mailed by registered mail to the
addresses set forth above.

    16.  This Agreement expresses fully the understanding of the parties and
all previous understandings are canceled, and no future changes in this
Agreement shall be valid except when, and if, reduced to writing signed by both
Principal and Agent.

    17.  The Agreement shall be construed, and all rights, powers, and
liabilities of the parties hereunder shall be determined, in accordance with the
laws of the State of New Jersey.

    18.  In the event that a dispute arises under this Agreement, Agent agrees
that such action may be commenced in any state or federal court in New Jersey
and that service of process may be effectuated by mail upon the Agent at Agent's
principal place of business.

                                  The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.


Dated:______________________      By:_________________________
                                       Mark L. Rose
                                       Vice President - Sourcing
    


                                  ____________________________
                                  Agent

Dated:______________________      By:__________________________
    (Title)





                                          5


                                                                   EXHIBIT 10.18

                                    June 28, 1997


Saunders Karp & Co., L.P.
667 Madison Avenue
New York, NY 10021

Dear Ladies and Gentlemen:

         This letter confirms our understanding that The Children's Place 
Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Company") has engaged you (the "Advisor") to 
provide financial advisory services to the Company upon the request of the 
Company from time to time.  These services are to be provided in connection 
with ongoing business and financial matters, including operating and cash 
flow requirements, corporate liquidity and other ordinary and necessary 
corporate finance concerns (including acquisition, advisory and finance 
matters and any public offering of securities).

         In consideration for the Advisor agreeing to provide such advisory 
services, the Company agrees to pay the Advisor an annual fee of $150,000 
(the "Advisory Fee"), payable quarterly in advance on February 1, May 1, 
August 1, and November 1, of each year, with the first such payment due on 
the date hereof, which such payment will be pro rated for the period 
commencing on the date hereof and ending on July 31, 1996.

         The Advisory Fee is for financial advisory services to be rendered 
by the Advisor and its employees and partners and affiliates and Barry 
Feinberg and not for any such services to be rendered by any other person.  
Any additional services to be provided by the Advisor, and any additional fee 
therefor, will be agreed to in writing by the parties.

         In addition, the Company agrees to reimburse the Advisor promptly 
upon request from time to time for all reasonable out-of-pocket expenses 
incurred by the Advisor in connection with the services to be rendered by the 
Advisor pursuant to its engagement hereunder.  The Company also agrees to pay 
the Advisor an arrangement fee of $250,000 on the Closing Date (as that term 
is defined in the Purchase Agreement dated as the date hereof, by and among 
the Company, The SK Equity Fund, L.P., SK Investment Fund, L.P. and Barry 
Feinberg (the "Purchase Agreement")), and upon the request of the Advisor, to 
reimburse the Advisor on the Closing Date or thereafter for all additional 
reasonable out-out-pocket expenses incurred by the Advisor and its affiliates 
(including without limitation, the fees and disbursements of counsel and the 
fees and disbursements incurred in connection with the due diligence effort) 
in connection with the Purchase Agreement and the other transactions 
contemplated thereby.

         The Advisor hereby acknowledges that none of the persons designated 
from time to time by the Advisor to serve as a director of the Company will 
be entitled to any annual fee or



attendance fee for attending meetings of the board of directors of the 
Company other than reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in attending 
such board meetings.

         The Advisor further acknowledges that upon an Event of Default under 
the Note and Warrant Purchase Agreement (the "Nomura Agreement") dated as of 
the date hereof by and between the Company and Nomura Holding America Inc., 
the Company shall not be obligated to pay the Advisory Fee upon the 
occurrence and during the continuance of such Event of Default, which such 
Advisory Fee shall continue to accrue and become due and payable at such time 
as the Payment of Default is cured or waived in accordance with the terms of 
the Nomura Agreement.

         The Company also agrees to indemnify the Advisor and certain other 
persons and to limit the Advisor's liability to the Company as set forth in 
Schedule I hereto, which Schedule constitutes an integral part hereof.  The 
Company's agreements contained or referred to in this paragraph will survive 
any termination of this agreement.

         Except for the provisions of the immediately preceding paragraph and 
Schedule I hereto (which will survive termination of this letter agreement), 
this letter agreement will terminate when (i) (A) neither Advisor nor any of 
its affiliates no longer own any shares of Series B Common Stock of the 
Company or (B) the liquidation preference of the Series B Common Stock 
terminates and (ii) Advisor and any of its affiliates' total ownership of the 
Company's outstanding shares of Common Stock is below 10% on a fully-diluted 
basis.

         This letter constitutes the entire agreement between the parties 
hereto and will not be amended except in writing by the Company and the 
Advisor. This agreement will be governed by, and construed in accordance 
with, the laws of the State of New York without regard to the conflict of 
laws rules of such state.

                                       2


         If the foregoing accurately describes our agreement with respect to 
the foregoing, please so indicate by signing this letter in the space 
indicated below.

                                       Very truly yours,


                                        THE CHILDREN'S PLACE 
                                          RETAIL STORES, INC.




                                         By:
                                            -----------------------------------
                                            Name:
                                            Title:




ACCEPTED AND AGREED:

SAUNDERS KARP & CO., L.P.

By:  SK Partners, L.P., its
     general partner



By
    -----------------------------
    John F. Megrue
    Attorney-in-Fact

                                               3





                                      SCHEDULE I


         The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc. (the "Company") will 
indemnify and hold harmless Saunders Karp & Co., L.P. (the "Advisor"), its 
affiliates and the respective partners, agents and employees of the Advisor 
and their respective affiliates (collectively, the "Advisor Group") from and 
against any claims, liabilities, damages, losses and expenses, including 
reasonable fees and expenses of counsel, arising out of or in connection with 
the services rendered by the Advisor under this agreement, and will reimburse 
the Advisor Group for all such fees and expenses, including the reasonable 
fees and expenses of counsel, as they are incurred by the Advisor Group in 
connection with pending or threatened litigation whether or not the Advisor 
Group is a party thereto. The Company will not, however, be responsible for 
any claims, liabilities, damages, losses or expenses to the extent that such 
claim, liabilities, damages, losses or expenses are finally determined by 
judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction to have resulted primarily form 
the Advisor Group's gross negligence or bad faith.  The foregoing agreement 
will be in addition to any rights that the Advisor Group may have at common 
law or otherwise, including, but not limited to, any right to contribution.

         Notwithstanding anything else contained herein, the Company also 
agrees that the Advisor Group will have no liability to the Company in 
connection with the services rendered hereunder (whether in tort, contract or 
otherwise) for claims, liabilities, damages, losses, or expenses, including 
reasonable fees and expenses of counsel, incurred by the Company unless, and 
to the extent, they are finally determined by judgment of a court of 
competent jurisdiction to have resulted primarily from the Advisor Group's 
gross negligence or bad faith.

         If indemnification is to be sought hereunder by a member of the 
Advisor Group, the such member will notify the Company of the commencement of 
any action or proceeding in respect thereof; provided, however, that the 
failure to so notify the Company will not relieve the Company from any 
liability that it may otherwise have to such indemnified person, except to 
the extent the Company shall have been materially prejudiced by such failure. 
 Following such notification, the Company may elect in writing to assume the 
defense of such action or proceeding, and upon such election, it will not be 
liable for any legal costs subsequently incurred by such member (other than 
reasonable costs of investigation) in connection therewith, unless (i) the 
Company has filed to provide counsel reasonably satisfactory to such member 
in a timely manner or (ii) counsel that has been provided by the Company 
reasonably determines that its representation of such member would present it 
with a conflict of interest. In any litigation or proceeding, the Company 
will not be responsible for the fees and expenses of more than one counsel 
for all members of the Advisor Group claiming indemnification hereunder in 
any one jurisdiction, unless any of such members has a separate and 
conflicting defense with regard to such litigation or proceedings, as 
reasonably determined by the counsel that has been provided by the Company.  
The Company will not be liable for any settlement of any litigation or 
proceeding effected without its prior written consent, which consent will not 
be unreasonably



withheld.  Should the Company assume the defense of any action, the Company 
will not, without the Advisor Group's prior written consent, settle, 
compromise, consent to the entry of any judgment in or otherwise seek to 
terminate such action if such settlement, compromise, consent or termination 
imposes obligations on any member of the Advisor Group (through injunctive 
relief or otherwise) other than the payment of money.

                                         2

                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.1
 
                         CONSENT OF ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
    After the stock split of the Company described in Note 15 to the Company's
Financial Statements is effected, we expect to be in a position to render the
following consent.
 
   
                                          /S/ ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
    
 
New York, New York
 
September 2, 1997
 
                   CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To The Children's Place Retail Stores, Inc.:
 
As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of our report
dated        , 1997 (and to all references to our Firm) included in or made a
part of this Registration Statement on Form S-1.
 
New York, New York
 
            , 1997
 


5 THIS FINANCIAL DATA SCHEDULE CONTAINS SUMMARY FINANCIAL INFORMATION EXTRACTED FROM THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE CHILDREN'S PLACE RETAIL STORES, INC. AND IS QUALIFIED IN ITS ENTIRETY BY REFERENCE TO SUCH FINANCIAL STATEMENTS. 1,000 YEAR YEAR FEB-01-1997 AUG-02-1997 FEB-01-1997 AUG-02-1997 3,422 631 0 0 890 1,637 0 0 14,425 22,445 27,688 34,782 32,382 42,473 12,083 14,620 64,479 79,748 15,737 32,703 0 0 0 0 0 0 1,281 1,281 26,017 24,796 67,479 79,748 143,838 72,737 143,838 72,737 89,786 48,917 37,233 20,509 396 106 0 0 2,884 1,815 9,522 (1,225) (20,919) (492) 30,441 (733) 0 0 0 0 0 0 30,441 (733) 0 0 0 0